You are on page 1of 229

FAR Part 25

AIRWORTHINESS STANDARD:
TRANSPORT CATEGORY AIRPLANES

Federal Aviation Administration

[Amdt. 25-27, 55 FR 29788, July 20, 1990, as amended by Amdt.


25-79, Aug. 26, 1993; Amdt. 25-117, 69 FR 67499, Nov. 17, 2004]

Octubre de 2006
Pt. 25 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

[Amdt. 2345, 58 FR 42167, Aug. 6, 1993; 58 FR 51970, Oct. 5, 1993]

PART 25AIRWORTHINESS STAND- Subpart AGeneral


ARDS: TRANSPORT CATEGORY Sec.
AIRPLANES 25.1 Applicability.
25.2 Special retroactive requirements.
SPECIAL FEDERAL AVIATION REGULATION NO.
13

340
EC28SE91.032</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00350 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25

Subpart BFlight Subpart CStructure


GENERAL GENERAL
25.21 Proof of compliance. 25.301 Loads.
25.23 Load distribution limits. 25.303 Factor of safety.
25.25 Weight limits. 25.305 Strength and deformation.
25.27 Center of gravity limits. 25.307 Proof of structure.
25.29 Empty weight and corresponding cen- FLIGHT LOADS
ter of gravity.
25.31 Removable ballast. 25.321 General.
25.33 Propeller speed and pitch limits.
FLIGHT MANEUVER AND GUST CONDITIONS
PERFORMANCE 25.331 Symmetric maneuvering conditions.
25.101 General. 25.333 Flight maneuvering envelope.
25.103 Stall speed. 25.335 Design airspeeds.
25.337 Limit maneuvering load factors.
25.105 Takeoff.
25.341 Gust and turbulence loads.
25.107 Takeoff speeds. 25.343 Design fuel and oil loads.
25.109 Accelerate-stop distance. 25.345 High lift devices.
25.111 Takeoff path. 25.349 Rolling conditions.
25.113 Takeoff distance and takeoff run. 25.351 Yaw maneuver conditions.
25.115 Takeoff flight path.
25.117 Climb: general. SUPPLEMENTARY CONDITIONS
25.119 Landing climb: All-engines-operating. 25.361 Engine torque.
25.121 Climb: One-engine-inoperative. 25.363 Side load on engine and auxiliary
25.123 En route flight paths. power unit mounts.
25.125 Landing. 25.365 Pressurized compartment loads.
25.367 Unsymmetrical loads due to engine
CONTROLLABILITY AND MANEUVERABILITY failure.
25.143 General. 25.371 Gyroscopic loads.
25.145 Longitudinal control. 25.373 Speed control devices.
25.147 Directional and lateral control.
CONTROL SURFACE AND SYSTEM LOADS
25.149 Minimum control speed.
25.391 Control surface loads: General.
TRIM 25.393 Loads parallel to hinge line.
25.395 Control system.
25.161 Trim.
25.397 Control system loads.
STABILITY 25.399 Dual control system.
25.405 Secondary control system.
25.171 General. 25.407 Trim tab effects.
25.173 Static longitudinal stability. 25.409 Tabs.
25.175 Demonstration of static longitudinal 25.415 Ground gust conditions.
stability. 25.427 Unsymmetrical loads.
25.177 Static lateral-directional stability. 25.445 Auxilliary aerodynamic surfaces.
25.181 Dynamic stability. 25.457 Wing flaps.
25.459 Special devices.
STALLS
GROUND LOADS
25.201 Stall demonstration.
25.203 Stall characteristics. 25.471 General.
25.207 Stall warning. 25.473 Landing load conditions and assump-
tions.
GROUND AND WATER HANDLING 25.477 Landing gear arrangement.
CHARACTERISTICS 25.479 Level landing conditions.
25.481 Tail-down landing conditions.
25.231 Longitudinal stability and control.
25.483 One-gear landing conditions.
25.233 Directional stability and control.
25.485 Side load conditions.
25.235 Taxiing condition.
25.487 Rebound landing condition.
25.237 Wind velocities.
25.489 Ground handling conditions.
25.239 Spray characteristics, control, and 25.491 Taxi, takeoff and landing roll.
stability on water. 25.493 Braked roll conditions.
MISCELLANEOUS FLIGHT REQUIREMENTS 25.495 Turning.
25.497 Tail-wheel yawing.
25.251 Vibration and buffeting. 25.499 Nose-wheel yaw and steering.
25.253 High-speed characteristics. 25.503 Pivoting.
25.255 Out-of-trim characteristics. 25.507 Reversed braking.

341

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00351 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
25.509 Towing loads. 25.689 Cable systems.
25.511 Ground load: unsymmetrical loads on 25.693 Joints.
multiple-wheel units. 25.697 Lift and drag devices, controls.
25.519 Jacking and tie-down provisions. 25.699 Lift and drag device indicator.
25.701 Flap and slat interconnection.
WATER LOADS 25.703 Takeoff warning system.
25.521 General.
LANDING GEAR
25.523 Design weights and center of gravity
positions. 25.721 General.
25.525 Application of loads. 25.723 Shock absorption tests.
25.527 Hull and main float load factors. 25.72525.727 [Reserved]
25.529 Hull and main float landing condi- 25.729 Retracting mechanism.
tions. 25.731 Wheels.
25.531 Hull and main float takeoff condi- 25.733 Tires.
tion. 25.735 Brakes and braking systems.
25.533 Hull and main float bottom pressures. 25.737 Skis.
25.535 Auxiliary float loads.
25.537 Seawing loads. FLOATS AND HULLS
25.751 Main float buoyancy.
EMERGENCY LANDING CONDITIONS
25.753 Main float design.
25.561 General. 25.755 Hulls.
25.562 Emergency landing dynamic condi-
tions. PERSONNEL AND CARGO ACCOMMODATIONS
25.563 Structural ditching provisions. 25.771 Pilot compartment.
FATIGUE EVALUATION 25.772 Pilot compartment doors.
25.773 Pilot compartment view.
25.571 Damagetolerance and fatigue eval- 25.775 Windshields and windows.
uation of structure. 25.777 Cockpit controls.
25.779 Motion and effect of cockpit controls.
LIGHTNING PROTECTION 25.781 Cockpit control knob shape.
25.581 Lightning protection. 25.783 Fuselage doors.
25.785 Seats, berths, safety belts, and har-
Subpart DDesign and Construction nesses.
25.787 Stowage compartments.
GENERAL 25.789 Retention of items of mass in pas-
25.601 General. senger and crew compartments and gal-
25.603 Materials. leys.
25.605 Fabrication methods. 25.791 Passenger information signs and plac-
25.607 Fasteners. ards.
25.609 Protection of structure. 25.793 Floor surfaces.
25.611 Accessibility provisions. 25.795 Security considerations.
25.613 Material strength properties and ma-
EMERGENCY PROVISIONS
terial design values.
25.619 Special factors. 25.801 Ditching.
25.621 Casting factors. 25.803 Emergency evacuation.
25.623 Bearing factors. 25.807 Emergency exits.
25.625 Fitting factors. 25.809 Emergency exit arrangement.
25.629 Aeroelastic stability requirements. 25.810 Emergency egress assist means and
25.631 Bird strike damage. escape routes.
25.811 Emergency exit marking.
CONTROL SURFACES 25.812 Emergency lighting.
25.651 Proof of strength. 25.813 Emergency exit access.
25.655 Installation. 25.815 Width of aisle.
25.657 Hinges. 25.817 Maximum number of seats abreast.
25.819 Lower deck service compartments
CONTROL SYSTEMS (including galleys).
25.820 Lavatory doors.
25.671 General.
25.672 Stability augmentation and auto- VENTILATION AND HEATING
matic and power-operated systems.
25.675 Stops. 25.831 Ventilation.
25.677 Trim systems. 25.832 Cabin ozone concentration.
25.679 Control system gust locks. 25.833 Combustion heating systems.
25.681 Limit load static tests.
PRESSURIZATION
25.683 Operation tests.
25.685 Control system details. 25.841 Pressurized cabins.

342

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00352 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25
25.843 Tests for pressurized cabins. 25.981 Fuel tank ignition prevention.
FIRE PROTECTION FUEL SYSTEM COMPONENTS
25.851 Fire extinguishers. 25.991 Fuel pumps.
25.853 Compartment interiors. 25.993 Fuel system lines and fittings.
25.854 Lavatory fire protection. 25.994 Fuel system components.
25.855 Cargo or baggage compartments. 25.995 Fuel valves.
25.856 Thermal/Acoustic insulation mate- 25.997 Fuel strainer or filter.
rials. 25.999 Fuel system drains.
25.857 Cargo compartment classification. 25.1001 Fuel jettisoning system.
25.858 Cargo or baggage compartment
smoke or fire detection systems. OIL SYSTEM
25.859 Combustion heater fire protection. 25.1011 General.
25.863 Flammable fluid fire protection. 25.1013 Oil tanks.
25.865 Fire protection of flight controls, en- 25.1015 Oil tank tests.
gine mounts, and other flight structure. 25.1017 Oil lines and fittings.
25.867 Fire protection: other components. 25.1019 Oil strainer or filter.
25.869 Fire protection: systems. 25.1021 Oil system drains.
25.1023 Oil radiators.
MISCELLANEOUS
25.1025 Oil valves.
25.871 Leveling means. 25.1027 Propeller feathering system.
25.875 Reinforcement near propellers.
COOLING
Subpart EPowerplant 25.1041 General.
25.1043 Cooling tests.
GENERAL
25.1045 Cooling test procedures.
25.901 Installation.
25.903 Engines. INDUCTION SYSTEM
25.904 Automatic takeoff thrust control sys- 25.1091 Air induction.
tem (ATTCS). 25.1093 Induction system icing protection.
25.905 Propellers. 25.1101 Carburetor air preheater design.
25.907 Propeller vibration. 25.1103 Induction system ducts and air duct
25.925 Propeller clearance. systems.
25.929 Propeller deicing. 25.1105 Induction system screens.
25.933 Reversing systems. 25.1107 Inter-coolers and after-coolers.
25.934 Turbojet engine thrust reverser sys-
tem tests. EXHAUST SYSTEM
25.937 Turbopropeller-drag limiting sys-
25.1121 General.
tems.
25.1123 Exhaust piping.
25.939 Turbine engine operating characteris-
25.1125 Exhaust heat exchangers.
tics.
25.1127 Exhaust driven turbo-superchargers.
25.941 Inlet, engine, and exhaust compat-
ibility. POWERPLANT CONTROLS AND ACCESSORIES
25.943 Negative acceleration.
25.945 Thrust or power augmentation sys- 25.1141 Powerplant controls: general.
tem. 25.1142 Auxiliary power unit controls.
25.1143 Engine controls.
FUEL SYSTEM 25.1145 Ignition switches.
25.1147 Mixture controls.
25.951 General.
25.952 Fuel system analysis and test. 25.1149 Propeller speed and pitch controls.
25.953 Fuel system independence. 25.1153 Propeller feathering controls.
25.954 Fuel system lightning protection. 25.1155 Reverse thrust and propeller pitch
25.955 Fuel flow. settings below the flight regime.
25.957 Flow between interconnected tanks. 25.1157 Carburetor air temperature controls.
25.959 Unusable fuel supply. 25.1159 Supercharger controls.
25.961 Fuel system hot weather operation. 25.1161 Fuel jettisoning system controls.
25.963 Fuel tanks: general. 25.1163 Powerplant accessories.
25.965 Fuel tank tests. 25.1165 Engine ignition systems.
25.967 Fuel tank installations. 25.1167 Accessory gearboxes.
25.969 Fuel tank expansion space.
POWERPLANT FIRE PROTECTION
25.971 Fuel tank sump.
25.973 Fuel tank filler connection. 25.1181 Designated fire zones; regions in-
25.975 Fuel tank vents and carburetor vapor cluded.
vents. 25.1182 Nacelle areas behind firewalls, and
25.977 Fuel tank outlet. engine pod attaching structures con-
25.979 Pressure fueling system. taining flammable fluid lines.

343

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00353 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
25.1183 Flammable fluid-carrying compo- 25.1399 Riding light.
nents. 25.1401 Anticollision light system.
25.1185 Flammable fluids. 25.1403 Wing icing detection lights.
25.1187 Drainage and ventilation of fire
zones. SAFETY EQUIPMENT
25.1189 Shutoff means. 25.1411 General.
25.1191 Firewalls. 25.1415 Ditching equipment.
25.1192 Engine accessory section diaphragm. 25.1419 Ice protection.
25.1193 Cowling and nacelle skin. 25.1421 Megaphones.
25.1195 Fire extinguishing systems. 25.1423 Public address system.
25.1197 Fire extinguishing agents.
25.1199 Extinguishing agent containers. MISCELLANEOUS EQUIPMENT
25.1201 Fire extinguishing system materials.
25.1431 Electronic equipment.
25.1203 Fire detector system.
25.1433 Vacuum systems.
25.1207 Compliance.
25.1435 Hydraulic systems.
25.1438 Pressurization and pneumatic sys-
Subpart FEquipment
tems.
GENERAL 25.1439 Protective breathing equipment.
25.1441 Oxygen equipment and supply.
25.1301 Function and installation. 25.1443 Minimum mass flow of supplemental
25.1303 Flight and navigation instruments. oxygen.
25.1305 Powerplant instruments. 25.1445 Equipment standards for the oxygen
25.1307 Miscellaneous equipment. distributing system.
25.1309 Equipment, systems, and installa- 25.1447 Equipment standards for oxygen dis-
tions. pensing units.
25.1316 System lightning protection. 25.1449 Means for determining use of oxy-
gen.
INSTRUMENTS: INSTALLATION
25.1450 Chemical oxygen generators.
25.1321 Arrangement and visibility. 25.1453 Protection of oxygen equipment
25.1322 Warning, caution, and advisory from rupture.
lights. 25.1455 Draining of fluids subject to freez-
25.1323 Airspeed indicating system. ing.
25.1325 Static pressure systems. 25.1457 Cockpit voice recorders.
25.1326 Pitot heat indication systems. 25.1459 Flight recorders.
25.1327 Magnetic direction indicator. 25.1461 Equipment containing high energy
25.1329 Automatic pilot system. rotors.
25.1331 Instruments using a power supply.
25.1333 Instrument systems. Subpart GOperating Limitations and
25.1335 Flight director systems. Information
25.1337 Powerplant instruments.
25.1501 General.
ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS AND EQUIPMENT
OPERATING LIMITATIONS
25.1351 General.
25.1353 Electrical equipment and installa- 25.1503 Airspeed limitations: general.
tions. 25.1505 Maximum operating limit speed.
25.1355 Distribution system. 25.1507 Maneuvering speed.
25.1357 Circuit protective devices. 25.1511 Flap extended speed.
25.1363 Electrical system tests. 25.1513 Minimum control speed.
25.1515 Landing gear speeds.
LIGHTS 25.1516 Other speed limitations.
25.1381 Instrument lights. 25.1517 Rough air speed, VRA.
25.1383 Landing lights. 25.1519 Weight, center of gravity, and
25.1385 Position light system installation. weight distribution.
25.1387 Position light system dihedral an- 25.1521 Powerplant limitations.
gles. 25.1522 Auxiliary power unit limitations.
25.1389 Position light distribution and in- 25.1523 Minimum flight crew.
tensities. 25.1525 Kinds of operation.
25.1391 Minimum intensities in the hori- 25.1527 Ambient air temperature and oper-
zontal plane of forward and rear position ating altitude.
lights. 25.1529 Instructions for Continued Air-
25.1393 Minimum intensities in any vertical worthiness.
plane of forward and rear position lights. 25.1531 Maneuvering flight load factors.
25.1395 Maximum intensities in overlapping 25.1533 Additional operating limitations.
beams of forward and rear position
MARKINGS AND PLACARDS
lights.
25.1397 Color specifications. 25.1541 General.

344

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00354 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, SFAR No. 13
25.1543 Instrument markings: general. modification in accordance with the rules of
25.1545 Airspeed limitation information. Part 4b in effect on the date of application
25.1547 Magnetic direction indicator. for the modification in lieu of Part 4a or
25.1549 Powerplant and auxiliary power unit Part 4b as in effect on September 1, 1953: And
instruments. provided further, That each specific modifica-
25.1551 Oil quantity indication. tion must be accomplished in accordance
25.1553 Fuel quantity indicator. with all of the provisions contained in the
25.1555 Control markings. elected rules relating to the particular modi-
25.1557 Miscellaneous markings and plac- fication.
ards. 3. Specific conditions for approval. An appli-
25.1561 Safety equipment. cant for any approval of the following spe-
25.1563 Airspeed placard. cific changes shall comply with section 2 of
this regulation as modified by the applicable
AIRPLANE FLIGHT MANUAL
provisions of this section.
25.1581 General. (a) Increase in take-off power limitation
25.1583 Operating limitations. 1,200 to 1,350 horsepower. The engine take-off
25.1585 Operating procedures. power limitation for the airplane may be in-
25.1587 Performance information. creased to more than 1,200 horsepower but
APPENDIX A TO PART 25 not to more than 1,350 horsepower per engine
APPENDIX B TO PART 25 if the increase in power does not adversely
APPENDIX C TO PART 25 affect the flight characteristics of the air-
APPENDIX D TO PART 25 plane.
APPENDIX E TO PART 25 (b) Increase in take-off power limitation to
APPENDIX F TO PART 25 more than 1,350 horsepower. The engine take-
APPENDIX G TO PART 25CONTINUOUS GUST off power limitation for the airplane may be
DESIGN CRITERIA increased to more than 1,350 horsepower per
APPENDIX H TO PART 25INSTRUCTIONS FOR engine if compliance is shown with the flight
CONTINUED AIRWORTHINESS characteristics and ground handling require-
APPENDIX I TO PART 25INSTALLATION OF AN ments of Part 4b.
AUTOMATIC TAKEOFF THRUST CONTROL (c) Installation of engines of not more than
SYSTEM (ATTCS) 1,830 cubic inches displacement and not having
APPENDIX J TO PART 25EMERGENCY EVACU- a certificated take-off rating of more than 1,350
ATION horsepower. Engines of not more than 1,830
AUTHORITY: 49 U.S.C. 106(g), 40113, 44701, cubic inches displacement and not having a
44702 and 44704. certificated take-off rating of more than
1,350 horsepower which necessitate a major
SOURCE: Docket No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. modification of redesign of the engine instal-
24, 1964, unless otherwise noted. lation may be installed, if the engine fire
prevention and fire protection are equivalent
SPECIAL FEDERAL AVIATION REGULATION to that on the prior engine installation.
NO. 13 (d) Installation of engines of more than 1,830
cubic inches displacement or having certificated
1. Applicability. Contrary provisions of the take-off rating of more than 1,350 horsepower.
Civil Air Regulations regarding certification Engines of more than 1,830 cubic inches dis-
notwithstanding,1 this regulation shall pro- placement or having certificated take-off
vide the basis for approval by the Adminis- rating of more than 1,350 horsepower may be
trator of modifications of individual Douglas installed if compliance is shown with the en-
DC3 and Lockheed L18 airplanes subse- gine installation requirements of Part 4b:
quent to the effective date of this regulation. Provided, That where literal compliance with
2. General modifications. Except as modified the engine installation requirements of Part
in sections 3 and 4 of this regulation, an ap- 4b is extremely difficult to accomplish and
plicant for approval of modifications to a would not contribute materially to the ob-
DC3 or L18 airplane which result in jective sought, and the Administrator finds
changes in design or in changes to approved that the experience with the DC3 or L18
limitations shall show that the modifica- airplanes justifies it, he is authorized to ac-
tions were accomplished in accordance with cept such measures of compliance as he finds
the rules of either Part 4a or Part 4b in ef- will effectively accomplish the basic objec-
fect on September 1, 1953, which are applica- tive.
ble to the modification being made: Provided,
4. Establishment of new maximum certificated
That an applicant may elect to accomplish a
weights. An applicant for approval of new
maximum certificated weights shall apply
1 It is not intended to waive compliance for an amendment of the airworthiness cer-
with such airworthiness requirements as are tificate of the airplane and shall show that
included in the operating parts of the Civil the weights sought have been established,
Air Regulations for specific types of oper- and the appropriate manual material ob-
ation. tained, as provided in this section.

345

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00355 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
NOTE: Transport category performance re- Subpart AGeneral
quirements result in the establishment of
maximum certificated weights for various
25.1 Applicability.
altitudes.
(a) Weights25,200 to 26,900 for the DC3 and (a) This part prescribes airworthiness
18,500 to 19,500 for the L18. New maximum standards for the issue of type certifi-
certificated weights of more than 25,200 but cates, and changes to those certifi-
not more than 26,900 pounds for DC3 and cates, for transport category airplanes.
more than 18,500 but not more than 19,500
pounds for L18 airplanes may be established (b) Each person who applies under
in accordance with the transport category Part 21 for such a certificate or change
performance requirements of either Part 4a must show compliance with the appli-
or Part 4b, if the airplane at the new max- cable requirements in this part.
imum weights can meet the structural re-
quirements of the elected part. 25.2 Special retroactive require-
(b) Weights of more than 26,900 for the DC3 ments.
and 19,500 for the L18. New maximum certifi-
cated weights of more than 26,900 pounds for The following special retroactive re-
DC3 and 19,500 pounds for L18 airplanes quirements are applicable to an air-
shall be established in accordance with the plane for which the regulations ref-
structural performance, flight characteris- erenced in the type certificate predate
tics, and ground handling requirements of the sections specified below
Part 4b: Provided, That where literal compli-
ance with the structural requirements of (a) Irrespective of the date of applica-
Part 4b is extremely difficult to accomplish tion, each applicant for a supplemental
and would not contribute materially to the type certificate (or an amendment to a
objective sought, and the Administrator type certificate) involving an increase
finds that the experience with the DC3 or L in passenger seating capacity to a total
18 airplanes justifies it, he is authorized to
accept such measures of compliance as he
greater than that for which the air-
finds will effectively accomplish the basic plane has been type certificated must
objective. show that the airplane concerned
(c) Airplane flight manual-performance oper- meets the requirements of:
ating information. An approved airplane flight (1) Sections 25.721(d), 25.783(g),
manual shall be provided for each DC3 and 25.785(c), 25.803(c)(2) through (9), 25.803
L18 airplane which has had new maximum
certificated weights established under this
(d) and (e), 25.807 (a), (c), and (d), 25.809
section. The airplane flight manual shall (f) and (h), 25.811, 25.812, 25.813 (a), (b),
contain the applicable performance informa- and (c), 25.815, 25.817, 25.853 (a) and (b),
tion prescribed in that part of the regula- 25.855(a), 25.993(f), and 25.1359(c) in ef-
tions under which the new certificated fect on October 24, 1967, and
weights were established and such additional
(2) Sections 25.803(b) and 25.803(c)(1)
information as may be necessary to enable
the application of the take-off, en route, and in effect on April 23, 1969.
landing limitations prescribed for transport (b) Irrespective of the date of applica-
category airplanes in the operating parts of tion, each applicant for a supplemental
the Civil Air Regulations. type certificate (or an amendment to a
(d) Performance operating limitations. Each type certificate) for an airplane manu-
airplane for which new maximum certifi-
factured after October 16, 1987, must
cated weights are established in accordance
with paragraphs (a) or (b) of this section show that the airplane meets the re-
shall be considered a transport category air- quirements of 25.807(c)(7) in effect on
plane for the purpose of complying with the July 24, 1989.
performance operating limitations applica- (c) Compliance with subsequent revi-
ble to the operations in which it is utilized. sions to the sections specified in para-
5. Reference. Unless otherwise provided, all
graph (a) or (b) of this section may be
references in this regulation to Part 4a and
Part 4b are those parts of the Civil Air Regu- elected or may be required in accord-
lations in effect on September 1, 1953. ance with 21.101(a) of this chapter.
This regulation supersedes Special Civil [Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29773, July 20, 1990, as
Air Regulation SR398 and shall remain ef-
amended by Amdt. 2599, 65 FR 36266, June 7,
fective until superseded or rescinded by the
2000]
Board.
[19 FR 5039, Aug. 11, 1954. Redesignated at 29
FR 19099, Dec. 30, 1964]

346

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00356 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.25

Subpart BFlight spanwise) that could be inadvertently


exceeded, these limits and the cor-
GENERAL responding weight and center of grav-
ity combinations must be established.
25.21 Proof of compliance. (b) The load distribution limits may
(a) Each requirement of this subpart not exceed
must be met at each appropriate com- (1) The selected limits;
bination of weight and center of grav- (2) The limits at which the structure
ity within the range of loading condi- is proven; or
tions for which certification is re- (3) The limits at which compliance
quested. This must be shown with each applicable flight require-
(1) By tests upon an airplane of the
ment of this subpart is shown.
type for which certification is re-
quested, or by calculations based on, 25.25 Weight limits.
and equal in accuracy to, the results of
testing; and (a) Maximum weights. Maximum
(2) By systematic investigation of weights corresponding to the airplane
each probable combination of weight operating conditions (such as ramp,
and center of gravity, if compliance ground or water taxi, takeoff, en route,
cannot be reasonably inferred from and landing), environmental conditions
combinations investigated. (such as altitude and temperature), and
(b) [Reserved] loading conditions (such as zero fuel
(c) The controllability, stability, weight, center of gravity position and
trim, and stalling characteristics of weight distribution) must be estab-
the airplane must be shown for each al- lished so that they are not more than
titude up to the maximum expected in (1) The highest weight selected by
operation. the applicant for the particular condi-
(d) Parameters critical for the test tions; or
being conducted, such as weight, load- (2) The highest weight at which com-
ing (center of gravity and inertia), air- pliance with each applicable structural
speed, power, and wind, must be main- loading and flight requirement is
tained within acceptable tolerances of shown, except that for airplanes
the critical values during flight test- equipped with standby power rocket
ing. engines the maximum weight must not
(e) If compliance with the flight be more than the highest weight estab-
characteristics requirements is depend- lished in accordance with appendix E of
ent upon a stability augmentation sys- this part; or
tem or upon any other automatic or (3) The highest weight at which com-
power-operated system, compliance pliance is shown with the certification
must be shown with 25.671 and 25.672. requirements of Part 36 of this chapter.
(f) In meeting the requirements of
(b) Minimum weight. The minimum
25.105(d), 25.125, 25.233, and 25.237, the
weight (the lowest weight at which
wind velocity must be measured at a
compliance with each applicable re-
height of 10 meters above the surface,
quirement of this part is shown) must
or corrected for the difference between
be established so that it is not less
the height at which the wind velocity
than
is measured and the 10-meter height.
(1) The lowest weight selected by the
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as applicant;
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5671, Apr. 8,
(2) The design minimum weight (the
1970; Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2320, Jan. 16, 1978;
Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29774, July 20, 1990] lowest weight at which compliance
with each structural loading condition
25.23 Load distribution limits. of this part is shown); or
(a) Ranges of weights and centers of (3) The lowest weight at which com-
gravity within which the airplane may pliance with each applicable flight re-
be safely operated must be established. quirement is shown.
If a weight and center of gravity com- [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
bination is allowable only within cer- amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5671, Apr. 8,
tain load distribution limits (such as 1970; Amdt. 2563, 53 FR 16365, May 6, 1988]

347

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00357 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.27 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

25.27 Center of gravity limits. (c) The means used to limit the low
pitch position of the propeller blades
The extreme forward and the extreme
must be set so that the engine does not
aft center of gravity limitations must
exceed 103 percent of the maximum al-
be established for each practicably sep-
lowable engine rpm or 99 percent of an
arable operating condition. No such
approved maximum overspeed, which-
limit may lie beyond
ever is greater, with
(a) The extremes selected by the ap-
(1) The propeller blades at the low
plicant;
pitch limit and governor inoperative;
(b) The extremes within which the
(2) The airplane stationary under
structure is proven; or
standard atmospheric conditions with
(c) The extremes within which com-
no wind; and
pliance with each applicable flight re-
(3) The engines operating at the take-
quirement is shown.
off manifold pressure limit for recipro-
25.29 Empty weight and cor- cating engine powered airplanes or the
responding center of gravity. maximum takeoff torque limit for tur-
bopropeller engine-powered airplanes.
(a) The empty weight and cor-
responding center of gravity must be [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
determined by weighing the airplane amended by Amdt. 2557, 49 FR 6848, Feb. 23,
with 1984; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29774, July 20, 1990]
(1) Fixed ballast; PERFORMANCE
(2) Unusable fuel determined under
25.959; and 25.101 General.
(3) Full operating fluids, including
(a) Unless otherwise prescribed, air-
(i) Oil;
planes must meet the applicable per-
(ii) Hydraulic fluid; and
formance requirements of this subpart
(iii) Other fluids required for normal
for ambient atmospheric conditions
operation of airplane systems, except
and still air.
potable water, lavatory precharge (b) The performance, as affected by
water, and fluids intended for injection engine power or thrust, must be based
in the engine. on the following relative humidities;
(b) The condition of the airplane at (1) For turbine engine powered air-
the time of determining empty weight planes, a relative humidity of
must be one that is well defined and (i) 80 percent, at and below standard
can be easily repeated. temperatures; and
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as (ii) 34 percent, at and above standard
amended by Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2320, Jan. 16, temperatures plus 50 F.
1978; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29774, July 20, 1990] Between these two temperatures, the
25.31 Removable ballast. relative humidity must vary linearly.
(2) For reciprocating engine powered
Removable ballast may be used on airplanes, a relative humidity of 80 per-
showing compliance with the flight re- cent in a standard atmosphere. Engine
quirements of this subpart. power corrections for vapor pressure
must be made in accordance with the
25.33 Propeller speed and pitch lim- following table:
its.
(a) The propeller speed and pitch Vapor Specific humidity
Altitude Density ratio
pressure e w (Lb. moisture
must be limited to values that will en- H (ft.) r / s=0.0023769
(In. Hg.) per lb. dry air)
sure
0 0.403 0.00849 0.99508
(1) Safe operation under normal oper- 1,000 .354 .00773 .96672
ating conditions; and 2,000 .311 .00703 .93895
(2) Compliance with the performance 3,000 .272 .00638 .91178
4,000 .238 .00578 .88514
requirements of 25.101 through 25.125. 5,000 .207 .00523 .85910
(b) There must be a propeller speed 6,000 .1805 .00472 .83361
limiting means at the governor. It 7,000 .1566 .00425 .80870
8,000 .1356 .00382 .78434
must limit the maximum possible gov- 9,000 .1172 .00343 .76053
erned engine speed to a value not ex- 10,000 .1010 .00307 .73722
ceeding the maximum allowable r.p.m. 15,000 .0463 .001710 .62868

348

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00358 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.103

Altitude Vapor Specific humidity Density ratio


25.125, respectively, must be deter-
pressure e w (Lb. moisture mined with all the airplane wheel
H (ft.) r / s=0.0023769
(In. Hg.) per lb. dry air)
brake assemblies at the fully worn
20,000 .01978 .000896 .53263 limit of their allowable wear range.
25,000 .00778 .000436 .44806
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
(c) The performance must correspond amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55466, Dec. 20,
to the propulsive thrust available 1976; Amdt. 2592, 63 FR 8318, Feb. 18, 1998]
under the particular ambient atmos-
pheric conditions, the particular flight 25.103 Stall speed.
condition, and the relative humidity (a) The reference stall speed, VSR, is a
specified in paragraph (b) of this sec- calibrated airspeed defined by the ap-
tion. The available propulsive thrust plicant. VSR may not be less than a 1-g
must correspond to engine power or stall speed. VSR is expressed as:
thrust, not exceeding the approved
power or thrust less VCL MAX
(1) Installation losses; and VSR
(2) The power or equivalent thrust n ZW
absorbed by the accessories and serv- where:
ices appropriate to the particular am- VCLMAX = Calibrated airspeed obtained when
bient atmospheric conditions and the the load factor-corrected lift coefficient
particular flight condition.
(d) Unless otherwise prescribed, the n ZW W
applicant must select the takeoff, en
route, approach, and landing configura- qS
tions for the airplane. is first a maximum during the maneuver
(e) The airplane configurations may prescribed in paragraph (c) of this section. In
vary with weight, altitude, and tem- addition, when the maneuver is limited by a
perature, to the extent they are com- device that abruptly pushes the nose down at
patible with the operating procedures a selected angle of attack (e.g., a stick push-
required by paragraph (f) of this sec- er), VCLMAX may not be less than the speed ex-
tion. isting at the instant the device operates;
(f) Unless otherwise prescribed, in de- nZW = Load factor normal to the flight path
at VCLMAX
termining the accelerate-stop dis-
W = Airplane gross weight;
tances, takeoff flight paths, takeoff S = Aerodynamic reference wing area; and
distances, and landing distances, q = Dynamic pressure.
changes in the airplanes configura-
tion, speed, power, and thrust, must be (b) VCLMAX is determined with:
made in accordance with procedures es- (1) Engines idling, or, if that result-
tablished by the applicant for oper- ant thrust causes an appreciable de-
ation in service. crease in stall speed, not more than
(g) Procedures for the execution of zero thrust at the stall speed;
balked landings and missed approaches (2) Propeller pitch controls (if appli-
associated with the conditions pre- cable) in the takeoff position;
scribed in 25.119 and 25.121(d) must be (3) The airplane in other respects
established. (such as flaps and landing gear) in the
(h) The procedures established under condition existing in the test or per-
paragraphs (f) and (g) of this section formance standard in which VSR is
must being used;
(1) Be able to be consistently exe- (4) The weight used when VSR is being
cuted in service by crews of average used as a factor to determine compli-
skill; ance with a required performance
(2) Use methods or devices that are standard;
safe and reliable; and (5) The center of gravity position
(3) Include allowance for any time that results in the highest value of ref-
delays, in the execution of the proce- erence stall speed; and
dures, that may reasonably be expected (6) The airplane trimmed for straight
ER26NO02.002</MATH>

in service. flight at a speed selected by the appli-


(i) The accelerate-stop and landing cant, but not less than 1.13VSR and not
distances prescribed in 25.109 and greater than 1.3VSR.

349
ER26NO02.001</MATH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00359 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.105 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(c) Starting from the stabilized trim (2) Effective runway gradients.
condition, apply the longitudinal con- [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
trol to decelerate the airplane so that amended by Amdt. 2592, 63 FR 8318, Feb. 18,
the speed reduction does not exceed 1998]
one knot per second.
(d) In addition to the requirements of 25.107 Takeoff speeds.
paragraph (a) of this section, when a (a) V1 must be established in relation
device that abruptly pushes the nose to VEF as follows:
down at a selected angle of attack (e.g., (1) VEF is the calibrated airspeed at
a stick pusher) is installed, the ref- which the critical engine is assumed to
erence stall speed, VSR, may not be less fail. VEF must be selected by the appli-
than 2 knots or 2 percent, whichever is cant, but may not be less than VMCG
greater, above the speed at which the determined under 25.149(e).
device operates. (2) V1, in terms of calibrated air-
speed, is selected by the applicant;
[Doc. No. 28404, 67 FR 70825, Nov. 26, 2002] however, V1 may not be less than VEF
plus the speed gained with critical en-
25.105 Takeoff. gine inoperative during the time inter-
(a) The takeoff speeds described in val between the instant at which the
25.107, the accelerate-stop distance de- critical engine is failed, and the in-
scribed in 25.109, the takeoff path de- stant at which the pilot recognizes and
scribed in 25.111, and the takeoff dis- reacts to the engine failure, as indi-
tance and takeoff run described in cated by the pilots initiation of the
25.113, must be determined first action (e.g., applying brakes, re-
(1) At each weight, altitude, and am- ducing thrust, deploying speed brakes)
bient temperature within the oper- to stop the airplane during accelerate-
ational limits selected by the appli- stop tests.
(b) V2MIN, in terms of calibrated air-
cant; and
speed, may not be less than
(2) In the selected configuration for (1) 1.13 VSR for
takeoff. (i) Two-engine and three-engine tur-
(b) No takeoff made to determine the bopropeller and reciprocating engine
data required by this section may re- powered airplanes; and
quire exceptional piloting skill or (ii) Turbojet powered airplanes with-
alertness. out provisions for obtaining a signifi-
(c) The takeoff data must be based cant reduction in the one-engine-inop-
on erative power-on stall speed;
(1) In the case of land planes and am- (2) 1.08 VSR for
phibians: (i) Turbopropeller and reciprocating
(i) Smooth, dry and wet, hard-sur- engine powered airplanes with more
faced runways; and than three engines; and
(ii) At the option of the applicant, (ii) Turbojet powered airplanes with
grooved or porous friction course wet, provisions for obtaining a significant
hard-surfaced runways. reduction in the one-engine-inoper-
(2) Smooth water, in the case of sea- ative power-on stall speed; and
(3) 1.10 times VMC established under
planes and amphibians; and
25.149.
(3) Smooth, dry snow, in the case of (c) V2, in terms of calibrated air-
skiplanes. speed, must be selected by the appli-
(d) The takeoff data must include, cant to provide at least the gradient of
within the established operational lim- climb required by 25.121(b) but may
its of the airplane, the following oper- not be less than
ational correction factors: (1) V2MIN;
(1) Not more than 50 percent of nomi- (2) VR plus the speed increment at-
nal wind components along the takeoff tained (in accordance with 25.111(c)(2))
path opposite to the direction of take- before reaching a height of 35 feet
off, and not less than 150 percent of above the takeoff surface; and
nominal wind components along the (3) A speed that provides the maneu-
takeoff path in the direction of takeoff. vering capability specified in 25.143(g).

350

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00360 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.109

(d) VMU is the calibrated airspeed at (f) VLOF is the calibrated airspeed at
and above which the airplane can safe- which the airplane first becomes air-
ly lift off the ground, and con- tinue borne.
the takeoff. VMU speeds must be se- (g) VFTO, in terms of calibrated air-
lected by the applicant throughout the speed, must be selected by the appli-
range of thrust-to-weight ratios to be cant to provide at least the gradient of
certificated. These speeds may be es- climb required by 25.121(c), but may
tablished from free air data if these not be less than
data are verified by ground takeoff (1) 1.18 VSR; and
tests. (2) A speed that provides the maneu-
(e) VR, in terms of calibrated air- vering capability specified in 25.143(g).
speed, must be selected in accordance [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
with the conditions of paragraphs (e)(1) amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55466, Dec. 20,
through (4) of this section: 1976; Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2320, Jan. 16, 1978;
(1) VR may not be less than Amdt. 2592, 63 FR 8318, Feb. 18, 1998; Amdt.
2594, 63 FR 8848, Feb. 23, 1998; Amdt. 25108,
(i) V1;
67 FR 70826, Nov. 26, 2002]
(ii) 105 percent of VMC;
(iii) The speed (determined in accord- 25.109 Accelerate-stop distance.
ance with 25.111(c)(2)) that allows
(a) The accelerate-stop distance on a
reaching V2 before reaching a height of
dry runway is the greater of the fol-
35 feet above the takeoff surface; or
lowing distances:
(iv) A speed that, if the airplane is (1) The sum of the distances nec-
rotated at its maximum practicable essary to
rate, will result in a VLOF of not less
(i) Accelerate the airplane from a
than 110 percent of VMU in the all-en-
standing start with all engines oper-
gines-operating condition and not less ating to VEF for takeoff from a dry run-
than 105 percent of VMU determined at way;
the thrust-to-weight ratio cor-
(ii) Allow the airplane to accelerate
responding to the one-engine-inoper- from VEF to the highest speed reached
ative condition. during the rejected takeoff, assuming
(2) For any given set of conditions the critical engine fails at VEF and the
(such as weight, configuration, and pilot takes the first action to reject
temperature), a single value of VR, ob- the takeoff at the V1 for takeoff from a
tained in accordance with this para- dry runway; and
graph, must be used to show compli- (iii) Come to a full stop on a dry run-
ance with both the one-engine-inoper- way from the speed reached as pre-
ative and the all-engines-operating scribed in paragraph (a)(1)(ii) of this
takeoff provisions. section; plus
(3) It must be shown that the one-en- (iv) A distance equivalent to 2 sec-
gine-inoperative takeoff distance, onds at the V1 for takeoff from a dry
using a rotation speed of 5 knots less runway.
than VR established in accordance with (2) The sum of the distances nec-
paragraphs (e)(1) and (2) of this section, essary to
does not exceed the corresponding one- (i) Accelerate the airplane from a
engine-inoperative takeoff distance standing start with all engines oper-
using the established VR. The takeoff ating to the highest speed reached dur-
distances must be determined in ac- ing the rejected takeoff, assuming the
cordance with 25.113(a)(1). pilot takes the first action to reject
(4) Reasonably expected variations in the takeoff at the V1 for takeoff from a
service from the established takeoff dry runway; and
procedures for the operation of the air- (ii) With all engines still operating,
plane (such as over-rotation of the air- come to a full stop on dry runway from
plane and out-of-trim conditions) may the speed reached as prescribed in para-
not result in unsafe flight characteris- graph (a)(2)(i) of this section; plus
tics or in marked increases in the (iii) A distance equivalent to 2 sec-
scheduled takeoff distances established onds at the V1 for takeoff from a dry
in accordance with 25.113(a). runway.

351

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00361 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.109 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(b) The accelerate-stop distance on a (ii) The force resulting from the wet
wet runway is the greater of the fol- runway braking coefficient of friction
lowing distances: determined in accordance with para-
(1) The accelerate-stop distance on a graphs (c) or (d) of this section, as ap-
dry runway determined in accordance plicable, taking into account the dis-
with paragraph (a) of this section; or tribution of the normal load between
(2) The accelerate-stop distance de- braked and unbraked wheels at the
termined in accordance with paragraph most adverse center-of-gravity position
(a) of this section, except that the run-
approved for takeoff.
way is wet and the corresponding wet
runway values of VEF and V1 are used. (c) The wet runway braking coeffi-
In determining the wet runway accel- cient of friction for a smooth wet run-
erate-stop distance, the stopping force way is defined as a curve of friction co-
from the wheel brakes may never ex- efficient versus ground speed and must
ceed: be computed as follows:
(i) The wheel brakes stopping force (1) The maximum tire-to-ground wet
determined in meeting the require- runway braking coefficient of friction
ments of 25.101(i) and paragraph (a) of is defined as:
this section; and

Where ing coefficient of friction determined


Tire Pressure=maximum airplane operating in paragraph (c)(1) of this section must
tire pressure (psi); be multiplied by the efficiency value
t/gMAX=maximum tire-to-ground braking co- associated with the type of anti-skid
efficient; system installed on the airplane:
V=airplane true ground speed (knots); and
Linear interpolation may be used for tire Effi-
Type of anti-skid system ciency
pressures other than those listed. value
(2) The maximum tire-to-ground wet On-Off ........................................................................ 0.30
runway braking coefficient of friction Quasi-Modulating ....................................................... 0.50
must be adjusted to take into account Fully Modulating ........................................................ 0.80
the efficiency of the anti-skid system
on a wet runway. Anti-skid system op- (d) At the option of the applicant, a
eration must be demonstrated by flight higher wet runway braking coefficient
testing on a smooth wet runway, and of friction may be used for runway sur-
its efficiency must be determined. Un- faces that have been grooved or treated
less a specific anti-skid system effi- with a porous friction course material.
ciency is determined from a quan- For grooved and porous friction course
titative analysis of the flight testing runways, the wet runway braking
on a smooth wet runway, the max- coefficent of friction is defined as ei-
imum tire-to-ground wet runway brak- ther:

352
ER18FE98.004</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00362 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.111

(1) 70 percent of the dry runway brak- section, except that a specific anti-skid
ing coefficient of friction used to deter- system efficiency, if determined, is ap-
mine the dry runway accelerate-stop propriate for a grooved or porous fric-
distance; or tion course wet runway, and the max-
(2) The wet runway braking coeffi- imum tire-to-ground wet runway brak-
cient defined in paragraph (c) of this ing coefficient of friction is defined as:

Where (h) If the accelerate-stop distance in-


Tire Pressure=maximum airplane operating cludes a stopway with surface charac-
tire pressure (psi); teristics substantially different from
t/gMAX=maximum tire-to-ground braking co- those of the runway, the takeoff data
efficient; must include operational correction
V=airplane true ground speed (knots); and
factors for the accelerate-stop dis-
Linear interpolation may be used for tire
pressures other than those listed. tance. The correction factors must ac-
count for the particular surface charac-
(e) Except as provided in paragraph teristics of the stopway and the vari-
(f)(1) of this section, means other than ations in these characteristics with
wheel brakes may be used to determine seasonal weather conditions (such as
the accelerate-stop distance if that temperature, rain, snow, and ice) with-
means in the established operational limits.
(1) Is safe and reliable; (i) A flight test demonstration of the
(2) Is used so that consistent results maximum brake kinetic energy accel-
can be expected under normal oper- erate-stop distance must be conducted
ating conditions; and with not more than 10 percent of the
(3) Is such that exceptional skill is allowable brake wear range remaining
not required to control the airplane. on each of the airplane wheel brakes.
(f) The effects of available reverse
thrust [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
(1) Shall not be included as an addi- amended by Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2321, Jan. 16,
tional means of deceleration when de- 1978; Amdt. 2592, 63 FR 8318, Feb. 18, 1998]
termining the accelerate-stop distance
25.111 Takeoff path.
on a dry runway; and
(2) May be included as an additional (a) The takeoff path extends from a
means of deceleration using rec- standing start to a point in the takeoff
ommended reverse thrust procedures at which the airplane is 1,500 feet above
when determining the accelerate-stop the takeoff surface, or at which the
distance on a wet runway, provided the transition from the takeoff to the en
requirements of paragraph (e) of this route configuration is completed and
section are met. VFTO is reached, whichever point is
(g) The landing gear must remain ex- higher. In addition
tended throughout the accelerate-stop (1) The takeoff path must be based on
distance. the procedures prescribed in 25.101(f);

353
ER18FE98.005</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00363 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.113 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(2) The airplane must be accelerated (3) The flight path must be based on
on the ground to VEF, at which point the airplanes performance without
the critical engine must be made inop- ground effect; and
erative and remain inoperative for the (4) The takeoff path data must be
rest of the takeoff; and checked by continuous demonstrated
(3) After reaching VEF, the airplane takeoffs up to the point at which the
must be accelerated to V2. airplane is out of ground effect and its
(b) During the acceleration to speed speed is stabilized, to ensure that the
V2, the nose gear may be raised off the path is conservative relative to the
ground at a speed not less than VR. continous path.
However, landing gear retraction may The airplane is considered to be out of
not be begun until the airplane is air- the ground effect when it reaches a
borne. height equal to its wing span.
(c) During the takeoff path deter- (e) For airplanes equipped with
mination in accordance with para- standby power rocket engines, the
graphs (a) and (b) of this section takeoff path may be determined in ac-
(1) The slope of the airborne part of cordance with section II of appendix E.
the takeoff path must be positive at
each point; [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 256, 30 FR 8468, July 2,
(2) The airplane must reach V2 before
1965; Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2321, Jan. 16, 1978;
it is 35 feet above the takeoff surface Amdt. 2554, 45 FR 60172, Sept. 11, 1980; Amdt.
and must continue at a speed as close 2572, 55 FR 29774, July 20, 1990; Amdt. 2594,
as practical to, but not less than V2, 63 FR 8848, Feb. 23, 1998; Amdt. 25108, 67 FR
until it is 400 feet above the takeoff 70826, Nov. 26, 2002; Amdt. 25115, 69 FR 40527,
surface; July 2, 2004]
(3) At each point along the takeoff
path, starting at the point at which the 25.113 Takeoff distance and takeoff
airplane reaches 400 feet above the run.
takeoff surface, the available gradient (a) Takeoff distance on a dry runway
of climb may not be less than is the greater of
(i) 1.2 percent for two-engine air- (1) The horizontal distance along the
planes; takeoff path from the start of the take-
(ii) 1.5 percent for three-engine air- off to the point at which the airplane is
planes; and 35 feet above the takeoff surface, deter-
(iii) 1.7 percent for four-engine air- mined under 25.111 for a dry runway;
planes; and or
(4) Except for gear retraction and (2) 115 percent of the horizontal dis-
automatic propeller feathering, the tance along the takeoff path, with all
airplane configuration may not be engines operating, from the start of the
changed, and no change in power or takeoff to the point at which the air-
thrust that requires action by the pilot plane is 35 feet above the takeoff sur-
may be made, until the airplane is 400 face, as determined by a procedure con-
feet above the takeoff surface. sistent with 25.111.
(d) The takeoff path must be deter- (b) Takeoff distance on a wet runway
mined by a continuous demonstrated is the greater of
takeoff or by synthesis from segments. (1) The takeoff distance on a dry run-
If the takeoff path is determined by the way determined in accordance with
segmental method paragraph (a) of this section; or
(1) The segments must be clearly de- (2) The horizontal distance along the
fined and must be related to the dis- takeoff path from the start of the take-
tinct changes in the configuration, off to the point at which the airplane is
power or thrust, and speed; 15 feet above the takeoff surface,
(2) The weight of the airplane, the achieved in a manner consistent with
configuration, and the power or thrust the achievement of V2 before reaching
must be constant throughout each seg- 35 feet above the takeoff surface, deter-
ment and must correspond to the most mined under 25.111 for a wet runway.
critical condition prevailing in the seg- (c) If the takeoff distance does not in-
ment; clude a clearway, the takeoff run is

354

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00364 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.121

equal to the takeoff distance. If the (1) 0.8 percent for two-engine air-
takeoff distance includes a clearway planes;
(1) The takeoff run on a dry runway (2) 0.9 percent for three-engine air-
is the greater of planes; and
(i) The horizontal distance along the (3) 1.0 percent for four-engine air-
takeoff path from the start of the take- planes.
off to a point equidistant between the (c) The prescribed reduction in climb
point at which VLOF is reached and the gradient may be applied as an equiva-
point at which the airplane is 35 feet lent reduction in acceleration along
above the takeoff surface, as deter- that part of the takeoff flight path at
mined under 25.111 for a dry runway; which the airplane is accelerated in
or level flight.
(ii) 115 percent of the horizontal dis- [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
tance along the takeoff path, with all amended by Amdt. 2592, 63 FR 8320, Feb. 18,
engines operating, from the start of the 1998]
takeoff to a point equidistant between
the point at which VLOF is reached and 25.117 Climb: general.
the point at which the airplane is 35 Compliance with the requirements of
feet above the takeoff surface, deter- 25.119 and 25.121 must be shown at
mined by a procedure consistent with each weight, altitude, and ambient
25.111. temperature within the operational
(2) The takeoff run on a wet runway limits established for the airplane and
is the greater of with the most unfavorable center of
(i) The horizontal distance along the gravity for each configuration.
takeoff path from the start of the take-
off to the point at which the airplane is 25.119 Landing climb: All-engines-op-
15 feet above the takeoff surface, erating.
achieved in a manner consistent with In the landing configuration, the
the achievement of V2 before reaching steady gradient of climb may not be
35 feet above the takeoff surface, as de- less than 3.2 percent, with
termined under 25.111 for a wet run- (a) The engines at the power or
way; or thrust that is available eight seconds
(ii) 115 percent of the horizontal dis- after initiation of movement of the
tance along the takeoff path, with all power or thrust controls from the min-
engines operating, from the start of the imum flight idle to the go-around
takeoff to a point equidistant between power or thrust setting; and
the point at which VLOF is reached and (b) A climb speed of not more than
the point at which the airplane is 35 VREF.
feet above the takeoff surface, deter-
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
mined by a procedure consistent with amended by Amdt. 2584, 60 FR 30749, June 9,
25.111. 1995; Amdt. 25108, 67 FR 70826, Nov. 26, 2002]
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5671, Apr. 8, 25.121 Climb: One-engine-inoper-
1970; Amdt. 2592, 63 FR 8320, Feb. 18, 1998] ative.
(a) Takeoff; landing gear extended. In
25.115 Takeoff flight path. the critical takeoff configuration exist-
(a) The takeoff flight path shall be ing along the flight path (between the
considered to begin 35 feet above the points at which the airplane reaches
takeoff surface at the end of the take- VLOF and at which the landing gear is
off distance determined in accordance fully retracted) and in the configura-
with 25.113(a) or (b), as appropriate for tion used in 25.111 but without ground
the runway surface condition. effect, the steady gradient of climb
(b) The net takeoff flight path data must be positive for two-engine air-
must be determined so that they rep- planes, and not less than 0.3 percent for
resent the actual takeoff flight paths three-engine airplanes or 0.5 percent
(determined in accordance with 25.111 for four-engine airplanes, at VLOF and
and with paragraph (a) of this section) with
reduced at each point by a gradient of (1) The critical engine inoperative
climb equal to and the remaining engines at the power

355

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00365 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.123 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

or thrust available when retraction of not be less than 2.1 percent for two-en-
the landing gear is begun in accordance gine airplanes, 2.4 percent for three-en-
with 25.111 unless there is a more crit- gine airplanes, and 2.7 percent for four
ical power operating condition existing engine airplanes, with
later along the flight path but before (1) The critical engine inoperative,
the point at which the landing gear is the remaining engines at the go-around
fully retracted; and power or thrust setting;
(2) The weight equal to the weight (2) The maximum landing weight;
existing when retraction of the landing (3) A climb speed established in con-
gear is begun, determined under nection with normal landing proce-
25.111. dures, but not more than 1.4 VSR; and
(b) Takeoff; landing gear retracted. In (4) Landing gear retracted.
the takeoff configuration existing at [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
the point of the flight path at which amended by Amdt. 2584, 60 FR 30749, June 9,
the landing gear is fully retracted, and 1995; Amdt. 25108, 67 FR 70826, Nov. 26, 2002]
in the configuration used in 25.111 but
without ground effect, the steady gra- 25.123 En route flight paths.
dient of climb may not be less than 2.4 (a) For the en route configuration,
percent for two-engine airplanes, 2.7 the flight paths prescribed in para-
percent for three-engine airplanes, and graphs (b) and (c) of this section must
3.0 percent for four-engine airplanes, at be determined at each weight, altitude,
V2 and with and ambient temperature, within the
(1) The critical engine inoperative, operating limits established for the
the remaining engines at the takeoff airplane. The variation of weight along
power or thrust available at the time the flight path, accounting for the pro-
the landing gear is fully retracted, de- gressive consumption of fuel and oil by
termined under 25.111, unless there is the operating engines, may be included
a more critical power operating condi- in the computation. The flight paths
tion existing later along the flight path must be determined at any selected
but before the point where the airplane speed, with
reaches a height of 400 feet above the (1) The most unfavorable center of
takeoff surface; and gravity;
(2) The weight equal to the weight (2) The critical engines inoperative;
existing when the airplanes landing (3) The remaining engines at the
gear is fully retracted, determined available maximum continuous power
under 25.111. or thrust; and
(c) Final takeoff. In the en route con- (4) The means for controlling the en-
figuration at the end of the takeoff gine-cooling air supply in the position
path determined in accordance with that provides adequate cooling in the
25.111, the steady gradient of climb hot-day condition.
may not be less than 1.2 percent for (b) The one-engine-inoperative net
two-engine airplanes, 1.5 percent for flight path data must represent the ac-
three-engine airplanes and 1.7 percent tual climb performance diminished by
for four-engine airplanes, at VFTO and a gradient of climb of 1.1 percent for
with two-engine airplanes, 1.4 percent for
(1) The critical engine inoperative three-engine airplanes, and 1.6 percent
and the remaining engines at the avail- for four-engine airplanes.
able maximum continuous power or (c) For three- or four-engine air-
thrust; and planes, the two-engine-inoperative net
(2) The weight equal to the weight flight path data must represent the ac-
existing at the end of the takeoff path, tual climb performance diminished by
determined under 25.111. a gradient of climb of 0.3 percent for
(d) Approach. In a configuration cor- three-engine airplanes and 0.5 percent
responding to the normal all-engines- for four-engine airplanes.
operating procedure in which VSR for
this configuration does not exceed 110 25.125 Landing.
percent of the VSR for the related all- (a) The horizontal distance necessary
engines-operating landing configura- to land and to come to a complete stop
tion, the steady gradient of climb may (or to a speed of approximately 3 knots

356

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00366 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.143

for water landings) from a point 50 feet (f) If any device is used that depends
above the landing surface must be de- on the operation of any engine, and if
termined (for standard temperatures, the landing distance would be notice-
at each weight, altitude, and wind ably increased when a landing is made
within the operational limits estab- with that engine inoperative, the land-
lished by the applicant for the air- ing distance must be determined with
plane) as follows: that engine inoperative unless the use
(1) The airplane must be in the land- of compensating means will result in a
ing configuration. landing distance not more than that
(2) A stabilized approach, with a cali- with each engine operating.
brated airspeed of VREF, must be main- Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
tained down to the 50 foot height. VREF amended by Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29774, July 20,
may not be less than 1990; Amdt. 2584, 60 FR 30749, June 9, 1995;
(i) 1.23 VSR0; Amdt. 25108, 67 FR 70826, Nov. 26, 2002]
(ii) VMCL established under 25.149(f);
and CONTROLLABILITY AND
(iii) A speed that provides the maneu- MANEUVERABILITY
vering capability specified in 25.143(g).
(3) Changes in configuration, power 25.143 General.
or thrust, and speed, must be made in (a) The airplane must be safely con-
accordance with the established proce- trollable and maneuverable during
dures for service operation. (1) Takeoff;
(4) The landing must be made with- (2) Climb;
out excessive vertical acceleration, (3) Level flight;
tendency to bounce, nose over, ground (4) Descent; and
loop, porpoise, or water loop. (5) Landing.
(5) The landings may not require ex- (b) It must be possible to make a
ceptional piloting skill or alertness. smooth transition from one flight con-
(b) For landplanes and amphibians, dition to any other flight condition
the landing distance on land must be without exceptional piloting skill,
determined on a level, smooth, dry, alertness, or strength, and without
hard-surfaced runway. In addition danger of exceeding the airplane limit-
(1) The pressures on the wheel brak- load factor under any probable oper-
ing systems may not exceed those spec- ating conditions, including
ified by the brake manufacturer; (1) The sudden failure of the critical
(2) The brakes may not be used so as engine;
to cause excessive wear of brakes or (2) For airplanes with three or more
tires; and engines, the sudden failure of the sec-
(3) Means other than wheel brakes ond critical engine when the airplane is
may be used if that means in the en route, approach, or landing
(i) Is safe and reliable; configuration and is trimmed with the
(ii) Is used so that consistent results critical engine inoperative; and
can be expected in service; and (3) Configuration changes, including
(iii) Is such that exceptional skill is deployment or retraction of decelera-
not required to control the airplane. tion devices.
(c) For seaplanes and amphibians, the (c) The following table prescribes, for
landing distance on water must be de- conventional wheel type controls, the
termined on smooth water. maximum control forces permitted
(d) For skiplanes, the landing dis- during the testing required by para-
tance on snow must be determined on graphs (a) and (b) of this section:
smooth, dry, snow. Force, in pounds, applied to the
(e) The landing distance data must Pitch Roll Yaw
control wheel or rudder pedals
include correction factors for not more
For short term application for
than 50 percent of the nominal wind pitch and roll controltwo
components along the landing path op- hands available for control .... 75 50 ............
posite to the direction of landing, and For short term application for
pitch and roll controlone
not less than 150 percent of the nomi- hand available for control ...... 50 25 ............
nal wind components along the landing For short term application for
path in the direction of landing. yaw control ............................. ............ ............ 150

357

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00367 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.145 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

Force, in pounds, applied to the Pitch Roll Yaw


(f) When maneuvering at a constant
control wheel or rudder pedals airspeed or Mach number (up to VFC/
For long term application .......... 10 5 20 MFC), the stick forces and the gradient
of the stick force versus maneuvering
(d) Approved operating procedures or load factor must lie within satisfactory
conventional operating practices must limits. The stick forces must not be so
be followed when demonstrating com- great as to make excessive demands on
pliance with the control force limita- the pilots strength when maneuvering
tions for short term application that the airplane, and must not be so low
are prescribed in paragraph (c) of this that the airplane can easily be over-
section. The airplane must be in trim, stressed inadvertently. Changes of gra-
dient that occur with changes of load
or as near to being in trim as practical,
factor must not cause undue difficulty
in the immediately preceding steady
in maintaining control of the airplane,
flight condition. For the takeoff condi- and local gradients must not be so low
tion, the airplane must be trimmed ac- as to result in a danger of overcontrol-
cording to the approved operating pro- ling.
cedures. (g) The maneuvering capabilities in a
(e) When demonstrating compliance constant speed coordinated turn at for-
with the control force limitations for ward center of gravity, as specified in
long term application that are pre- the following table, must be free of
scribed in paragraph (c) of this section, stall warning or other characteristics
the airplane must be in trim, or as near that might interfere with normal ma-
to being in trim as practical. neuvering:
Maneuvering
Configuration Speed bank angle in a Thrust power setting
coordinated turn

Takeoff .......... V2 30 Asymmetric WAT-Limited.1


Takeoff .......... 2V + XX 40 All-engines-operating climb.3
2
En route ........ VFTO 40 Asymmetric WAT-Limited.1
Landing ......... VREF 40 Symmetric for 3 flight path angle.
1 A combination of weight, altitude, and temperature (WAT) such that the thrust or power setting produces the minimum climb
gradient specified in 25.121 for the flight condition.
2 Airspeed approved for all-engines-operating initial climb.
3 That thrust or power setting which, in the event of failure of the critical engine and without any crew action to adjust the thrust
or power of the remaining engines, would result in the thrust or power specified for the takeoff condition at V2, or any lesser
thrust or power setting that is used for all-engines-operating initial climb procedures.

[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as (representative of the maximum short
amended by Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2321, Jan. 16, term force that can be applied readily
1978; Amdt. 2584, 60 FR 30749, June 9, 1995; by one hand) may be required for the
Amdt. 25108, 67 FR 70826, Nov. 26, 2002]
following maneuvers:
25.145 Longitudinal control. (1) With power off, flaps retracted,
and the airplane trimmed at 1.3 VSR1,
(a) It must be possible, at any point extend the flaps as rapidly as possible
between the trim speed prescribed in while maintaining the airspeed at ap-
25.103(b)(6) and stall identification (as proximately 30 percent above the ref-
defined in 25.201(d)), to pitch the nose erence stall speed existing at each in-
downward so that the acceleration to stant throughout the maneuver.
this selected trim speed is prompt with (2) Repeat paragraph (b)(1) except ini-
(1) The airplane trimmed at the trim tially extend the flaps and then retract
speed prescribed in 25.103(b)(6); them as rapidly as possible.
(2) The landing gear extended; (3) Repeat paragraph (b)(2), except at
(3) The wing flaps (i) retracted and the go-around power or thrust setting.
(ii) extended; and (4) With power off, flaps retracted,
(4) Power (i) off and (ii) at maximum and the airplane trimmed at 1.3 VSR1,
continuous power on the engines. rapidly set go-around power or thrust
(b) With the landing gear extended, while maintaining the same airspeed.
no change in trim control, or exertion (5) Repeat paragraph (b)(4) except
of more than 50 pounds control force with flaps extended.

358

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00368 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.147

(6) With power off, flaps extended, 25.147 Directional and lateral con-
and the airplane trimmed at 1.3 VSR1, trol.
obtain and maintain airspeeds between (a) Directional control; general. It must
VSW and either 1.6 VSR1 or VFE, which- be possible, with the wings level, to
ever is lower. yaw into the operative engine and to
(c) It must be possible, without ex- safely make a reasonably sudden
ceptional piloting skill, to prevent loss change in heading of up to 15 degrees in
of altitude when complete retraction of the direction of the critical inoperative
the high lift devices from any position engine. This must be shown at 1.3 VSR1
is begun during steady, straight, level for heading changes up to 15 degrees
flight at 1.08 VSR1 for propeller powered (except that the heading change at
airplanes, or 1.13 VSR1 for turbojet pow- which the rudder pedal force is 150
ered airplanes, with pounds need not be exceeded), and
(1) Simultaneous movement of the with
power or thrust controls to the go- (1) The critical engine inoperative
and its propeller in the minimum drag
around power or thrust setting;
position;
(2) The landing gear extended; and (2) The power required for level flight
(3) The critical combinations of land- at 1.3 VSR1, but not more than max-
ing weights and altitudes. imum continuous power;
(d) If gated high-lift device control (3) The most unfavorable center of
positions are provided, paragraph (c) of gravity;
this section applies to retractions of (4) Landing gear retracted;
the high-lift devices from any position (5) Flaps in the approach position;
from the maximum landing position to and
the first gated position, between gated (6) Maximum landing weight.
positions, and from the last gated posi- (b) Directional control; airplanes with
tion to the fully retracted position. four or more engines. Airplanes with
The requirements of paragraph (c) of four or more engines must meet the re-
this section also apply to retractions quirements of paragraph (a) of this sec-
from each approved landing position to tion except that
the control position(s) associated with (1) The two critical engines must be
inoperative with their propellers (if ap-
the high-lift device configuration(s)
plicable) in the minimum drag posi-
used to establish the go-around proce-
tion;
dure(s) from that landing position. In (2) [Reserved]
addition, the first gated control posi- (3) The flaps must be in the most fa-
tion from the maximum landing posi- vorable climb position.
tion must correspond with a configura- (c) Lateral control; general. It must be
tion of the high-lift devices used to es- possible to make 20 banked turns, with
tablish a go-around procedure from a and against the inoperative engine,
landing configuration. Each gated con- from steady flight at a speed equal to
trol position must require a separate 1.3 VSR1, with
and distinct motion of the control to (1) The critical engine inoperative
pass through the gated position and and its propeller (if applicable) in the
must have features to prevent inad- minimum drag position;
vertent movement of the control (2) The remaining engines at max-
through the gated position. It must imum continuous power;
only be possible to make this separate (3) The most unfavorable center of
and distinct motion once the control gravity;
has reached the gated position. (4) Landing gear (i) retracted and (ii)
extended;
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as (5) Flaps in the most favorable climb
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5671, Apr. 8, position; and
1970; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29774, July 20, 1990; (6) Maximum takeoff weight.
Amdt. 2584, 60 FR 30749, June 9, 1995; Amdt. (d) Lateral control; roll capability. With
2598, 64 FR 6164, Feb. 8, 1999; 64 FR 10740, the critical engine inoperative, roll re-
Mar. 5, 1999; Amdt. 25108, 67 FR 70827, Nov.
sponse must allow normal maneuvers.
26, 2002]
Lateral control must be sufficient, at

359

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00369 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.149 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

the speeds likely to be used with one (5) The airplane in the most critical
engine inoperative, to provide a roll takeoff configuration existing along
rate necessary for safety without ex- the flight path after the airplane be-
cessive control forces or travel. comes airborne, except with the land-
(e) Lateral control; airplanes with four ing gear retracted;
or more engines. Airplanes with four or (6) The airplane airborne and the
more engines must be able to make 20 ground effect negligible; and
banked turns, with and against the in- (7) If applicable, the propeller of the
operative engines, from steady flight at inoperative engine
a speed equal to 1.3 VSR1, with max- (i) Windmilling;
imum continuous power, and with the (ii) In the most probable position for
airplane in the configuration pre- the specific design of the propeller con-
scribed by paragraph (b) of this section. trol; or
(f) Lateral control; all engines oper- (iii) Feathered, if the airplane has an
ating. With the engines operating, roll automatic feathering device acceptable
response must allow normal maneuvers for showing compliance with the climb
(such as recovery from upsets produced requirements of 25.121.
by gusts and the initiation of evasive (d) The rudder forces required to
maneuvers). There must be enough ex- maintain control at VMC may not ex-
cess lateral control in sideslips (up to ceed 150 pounds nor may it be nec-
sideslip angles that might be required essary to reduce power or thrust of the
in normal operation), to allow a lim- operative engines. During recovery, the
ited amount of maneuvering and to airplane may not assume any dan-
correct for gusts. Lateral control must gerous attitude or require exceptional
be enough at any speed up to VFC/MFC piloting skill, alertness, or strength to
to provide a peak roll rate necessary prevent a heading change of more than
for safety, without excessive control 20 degrees.
forces or travel. (e) VMCG, the minimum control speed
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
on the ground, is the calibrated air-
amended by Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2321, Jan. 16, speed during the takeoff run at which,
1978; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29774, July 20, 1990; when the critical engine is suddenly
Amdt. 25108, 67 FR 70827, Nov. 26, 2002; made inoperative, it is possible to
Amdt. 25115, 69 FR 40527, July 2, 2004] maintain control of the airplane using
the rudder control alone (without the
25.149 Minimum control speed. use of nosewheel steering), as limited
(a) In establishing the minimum con- by 150 pounds of force, and the lateral
trol speeds required by this section, the control to the extent of keeping the
method used to simulate critical en- wings level to enable the takeoff to be
gine failure must represent the most safely continued using normal piloting
critical mode of powerplant failure skill. In the determination of VMCG, as-
with respect to controllability ex- suming that the path of the airplane
pected in service. accelerating with all engines operating
(b) VMC is the calibrated airspeed at is along the centerline of the runway,
which, when the critical engine is sud- its path from the point at which the
denly made inoperative, it is possible critical engine is made inoperative to
to maintain control of the airplane the point at which recovery to a direc-
with that engine still inoperative and tion parallel to the centerline is com-
maintain straight flight with an angle pleted may not deviate more than 30
of bank of not more than 5 degrees. feet laterally from the centerline at
(c) VMC may not exceed 1.13 VSR any point. VMCG must be established
with with
(1) Maximum available takeoff power (1) The airplane in each takeoff con-
or thrust on the engines; figuration or, at the option of the ap-
(2) The most unfavorable center of plicant, in the most critical takeoff
gravity; configuration;
(3) The airplane trimmed for takeoff; (2) Maximum available takeoff power
(4) The maximum sea level takeoff or thrust on the operating engines;
weight (or any lesser weight necessary (3) The most unfavorable center of
to show VMC); gravity;

360

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00370 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.161

(4) The airplane trimmed for takeoff; (4) The most unfavorable weight, or,
and at the option of the applicant, as a
(5) The most unfavorable weight in function of weight;
the range of takeoff weights. (5) For propeller airplanes, the pro-
(f) VMCL, the minimum control speed peller of the more critical inoperative
during approach and landing with all engine in the position it achieves with-
engines operating, is the calibrated air- out pilot action, assuming the engine
speed at which, when the critical en- fails while at the power or thrust nec-
gine is suddenly made inoperative, it is essary to maintain a three degree ap-
possible to maintain control of the air- proach path angle, and the propeller of
plane with that engine still inoper- the other inoperative engine feathered;
ative, and maintain straight flight (6) The power or thrust on the oper-
with an angle of bank of not more than ating engine(s) necessary to maintain
5 degrees. VMCL must be established an approach path angle of three de-
with grees when one critical engine is inop-
(1) The airplane in the most critical erative; and
configuration (or, at the option of the (7) The power or thrust on the oper-
applicant, each configuration) for ap- ating engine(s) rapidly changed, imme-
proach and landing with all engines op- diately after the second critical engine
erating; is made inoperative, from the power or
(2) The most unfavorable center of thrust prescribed in paragraph (g)(6) of
gravity; this section to
(3) The airplane trimmed for ap- (i) Minimum power or thrust; and
proach with all engines operating; (ii) Go-around power or thrust set-
(4) The most favorable weight, or, at ting.
the option of the applicant, as a func- (h) In demonstrations of VMCL and
tion of weight; VMCL-2
(5) For propeller airplanes, the pro- (1) The rudder force may not exceed
peller of the inoperative engine in the 150 pounds;
position it achieves without pilot ac- (2) The airplane may not exhibit haz-
tion, assuming the engine fails while at ardous flight characteristics or require
the power or thrust necessary to main- exceptional piloting skill, alertness, or
tain a three degree approach path strength;
angle; and (3) Lateral control must be sufficient
(6) Go-around power or thrust setting to roll the airplane, from an initial
on the operating engine(s). condition of steady flight, through an
(g) For airplanes with three or more angle of 20 degrees in the direction nec-
engines, VMCL-2, the minimum control essary to initiate a turn away from the
speed during approach and landing inoperative engine(s), in not more than
with one critical engine inoperative, is 5 seconds; and
the calibrated airspeed at which, when (4) For propeller airplanes, hazardous
a second critical engine is suddenly flight characteristics must not be ex-
made inoperative, it is possible to hibited due to any propeller position
maintain control of the airplane with achieved when the engine fails or dur-
both engines still inoperative, and ing any likely subsequent movements
maintain straight flight with an angle of the engine or propeller controls.
of bank of not more than 5 degrees.
VMCL-2 must be established with [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2321, Jan. 16,
(1) The airplane in the most critical 1978; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29774, July 20, 1990; 55
configuration (or, at the option of the FR 37607, Sept. 12, 1990; Amdt. 2584, 60 FR
applicant, each configuration) for ap- 30749, June 9, 1995; Amdt. 25108, 67 FR 70827,
proach and landing with one critical Nov. 26, 2002]
engine inoperative;
(2) The most unfavorable center of TRIM
gravity;
(3) The airplane trimmed for ap- 25.161 Trim.
proach with one critical engine inoper- (a) General. Each airplane must meet
ative; the trim requirements of this section

361

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00371 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.171 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

after being trimmed, and without fur- establishing the en route flight paths
ther pressure upon, or movement of, ei- with two engines inoperative.
ther the primary controls or their cor- [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
responding trim controls by the pilot amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5671, Apr. 8,
or the automatic pilot. 1970; Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55466, Dec. 20, 1976;
(b) Lateral and directional trim. The Amdt. 25108, 67 FR 70827, Nov. 26, 2002;
airplane must maintain lateral and di- Amdt. 25115, 69 FR 40527, July 2, 2004]
rectional trim with the most adverse
lateral displacement of the center of STABILITY
gravity within the relevant operating
25.171 General.
limitations, during normally expected
conditions of operation (including op- The airplane must be longitudinally,
eration at any speed from 1.3 VSR1 to directionally, and laterally stable in
VMO/MMO). accordance with the provisions of
(c) Longitudinal trim. The airplane 25.173 through 25.177. In addition,
must maintain longitudinal trim dur- suitable stability and control feel
ing (static stability) is required in any con-
(1) A climb with maximum contin- dition normally encountered in service,
uous power at a speed not more than if flight tests show it is necessary for
1.3 VSR1, with the landing gear re- safe operation.
tracted, and the flaps (i) retracted and [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
(ii) in the takeoff position; amended by Amdt. 257, 30 FR 13117, Oct. 15,
(2) Either a glide with power off at a 1965]
speed not more than 1.3 VSR1, or an ap-
proach within the normal range of ap- 25.173 Static longitudinal stability.
proach speeds appropriate to the Under the conditions specified in
weight and configuration with power 25.175, the characteristics of the eleva-
settings corresponding to a 3 degree tor control forces (including friction)
glidepath, whichever is the most se- must be as follows:
vere, with the landing gear extended, (a) A pull must be required to obtain
the wing flaps (i) retracted and (ii) ex- and maintain speeds below the speci-
tended, and with the most unfavorable fied trim speed, and a push must be re-
combination of center of gravity posi- quired to obtain and maintain speeds
tion and weight approved for landing; above the specified trim speed. This
and must be shown at any speed that can be
(3) Level flight at any speed from 1.3 obtained except speeds higher than the
VSR1, to VMO/MMO, with the landing landing gear or wing flap operating
gear and flaps retracted, and from 1.3 limit speeds or VFC/MFC, whichever is
VSR1 to VLE with the landing gear ex- appropriate, or lower than the min-
tended. imum speed for steady unstalled flight.
(d) Longitudinal, directional, and lat- (b) The airspeed must return to with-
eral trim. The airplane must maintain in 10 percent of the original trim speed
longitudinal, directional, and lateral for the climb, approach, and landing
trim (and for the lateral trim, the conditions specified in 25.175 (a), (c),
angle of bank may not exceed five de- and (d), and must return to within 7.5
grees) at 1.3 VSR1 during climbing flight percent of the original trim speed for
with the cruising condition specified in
(1) The critical engine inoperative; 25.175(b), when the control force is
(2) The remaining engines at max- slowly released from any speed within
imum continuous power; and the range specified in paragraph (a) of
(3) The landing gear and flaps re- this section.
tracted. (c) The average gradient of the stable
(e) Airplanes with four or more en- slope of the stick force versus speed
gines. Each airplane with four or more curve may not be less than 1 pound for
engines must also maintain trim in each 6 knots.
rectilinear flight with the most unfa- (d) Within the free return speed range
vorable center of gravity and at the specified in paragraph (b) of this sec-
climb speed, configuration, and power tion, it is permissible for the airplane,
required by 25.123(a) for the purpose of without control forces, to stabilize on

362

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00372 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.175

speeds above or below the desired trim (v) The airplane trimmed for level
speeds if exceptional attention on the flight with the power required in para-
part of the pilot is not required to re- graph (b)(1)(iv) of this section.
turn to and maintain the desired trim (2) With the landing gear retracted at
speed and altitude. low speed, the stick force curve must
have a stable slope at all speeds within
[Amdt. 257, 30 FR 13117, Oct. 15, 1965]
a range which is the greater of 15 per-
25.175 Demonstration of static longi- cent of the trim speed plus the result-
tudinal stability. ing free return speed range, or 50 knots
plus the resulting free return speed
Static longitudinal stability must be range, above and below the trim speed
shown as follows: (except that the speed range need not
(a) Climb. The stick force curve must include speeds less than 1.3 VSR1, nor
have a stable slope at speeds between speeds greater than the minimum
85 and 115 percent of the speed at which speed of the applicable speed range pre-
the airplane scribed in paragraph (b)(1), nor speeds
(1) Is trimmed, with that require a stick force of more than
(i) Wing flaps retracted; 50 pounds), with
(ii) Landing gear retracted; (i) Wing flaps, center of gravity posi-
(iii) Maximum takeoff weight; and tion, and weight as specified in para-
(iv) 75 percent of maximum contin- graph (b)(1) of this section;
uous power for reciprocating engines or (ii) Power required for level flight at
the maximum power or thrust selected a speed equal to (VMO + 1.3 VSR1)/2; and
by the applicant as an operating limi- (iii) The airplane trimmed for level
tation for use during climb for turbine flight with the power required in para-
engines; and graph (b)(2)(ii) of this section.
(2) Is trimmed at the speed for best (3) With the landing gear extended,
rate-of-climb except that the speed the stick force curve must have a sta-
need not be less than 1.3 VSR1. ble slope at all speeds within a range
(b) Cruise. Static longitudinal sta- which is the greater of 15 percent of the
bility must be shown in the cruise con- trim speed plus the resulting free re-
dition as follows: turn speed range, or 50 knots plus the
(1) With the landing gear retracted at resulting free return speed range,
high speed, the stick force curve must above and below the trim speed (except
have a stable slope at all speeds within that the speed range need not include
a range which is the greater of 15 per- speeds less than 1.3 VSR1, nor speeds
cent of the trim speed plus the result- greater than VLE, nor speeds that re-
ing free return speed range, or 50 knots quire a stick force of more than 50
plus the resulting free return speed pounds), with
range, above and below the trim speed (i) Wing flap, center of gravity posi-
(except that the speed range need not tion, and weight as specified in para-
include speeds less than 1.3 VSR1, nor graph (b)(1) of this section;
speeds greater than VFC/MFC, nor (ii) 75 percent of maximum contin-
speeds that require a stick force of uous power for reciprocating engines
more than 50 pounds), with or, for turbine engines, the maximum
(i) The wing flaps retracted; cruising power selected by the appli-
(ii) The center of gravity in the most cant as an operating limitation, except
adverse position (see 25.27); that the power need not exceed that re-
(iii) The most critical weight be- quired for level flight at VLE; and
tween the maximum takeoff and max- (iii) The aircraft trimmed for level
imum landing weights; flight with the power required in para-
(iv) 75 percent of maximum contin- graph (b)(3)(ii) of this section.
uous power for reciprocating engines or (c) Approach. The stick force curve
for turbine engines, the maximum must have a stable slope at speeds be-
cruising power selected by the appli- tween VSW and 1.7 VSR1, with
cant as an operating limitation (see (1) Wing flaps in the approach posi-
25.1521), except that the power need tion;
not exceed that required at VMO/MMO; (2) Landing gear retracted;
and (3) Maximum landing weight; and

363

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00373 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.177 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(4) The airplane trimmed at 1.3 VSR1 25.181 Dynamic stability.


with enough power to maintain level (a) Any short period oscillation, not
flight at this speed. including combined lateral-directional
(d) Landing. The stick force curve oscillations, occurring between 1.13 VSR
must have a stable slope, and the stick and maximum allowable speed appro-
force may not exceed 80 pounds, at priate to the configuration of the air-
speeds between VSW and 1.7 VSR0 with plane must be heavily damped with the
(1) Wing flaps in the landing position; primary controls
(2) Landing gear extended; (1) Free; and
(3) Maximum landing weight; (2) In a fixed position.
(4) The airplane trimmed at 1.3 VSR0 (b) Any combined lateral-directional
with oscillations (Dutch roll) occurring
(i) Power or thrust off, and between 1.13 VSR and maximum allow-
(ii) Power or thrust for level flight. able speed appropriate to the configu-
ration of the airplane must be posi-
(5) The airplane trimmed at 1.3 VSR0
tively damped with controls free, and
with power or thrust off.
must be controllable with normal use
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as of the primary controls without requir-
amended by Amdt. 257, 30 FR 13117, Oct. 15, ing exceptional pilot skill.
1965; Amdt. 25108, 67 FR 70827, Nov. 26, 2002;
Amdt. 25115, 69 FR 40527, July 2, 2004] [Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2322, Jan. 16, 1978, as
amended by Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29775, July 20,
1990; 55 FR 37607, Sept. 12, 1990; Amdt. 25108,
25.177 Static lateral-directional sta-
67 FR 70827, Nov. 26, 2002]
bility.
(a)(b) [Reserved] STALLS
(c) In straight, steady sideslips, the
aileron and rudder control movements 25.201 Stall demonstration.
and forces must be substantially pro- (a) Stalls must be shown in straight
portional to the angle of sideslip in a flight and in 30 degree banked turns
stable sense; and the factor of propor- with
tionality must lie between limits found (1) Power off; and
necessary for safe operation through- (2) The power necessary to maintain
out the range of sideslip angles appro- level flight at 1.5 VSR1 (where VSR1 cor-
priate to the operation of the airplane. responds to the reference stall speed at
At greater angles, up to the angle at maximum landing weight with flaps in
which full rudder is used or a rudder the approach position and the landing
force of 180 pounds is obtained, the rud- gear retracted).
der pedal forces may not reverse; and (b) In each condition required by
increased rudder deflection must be paragraph (a) of this section, it must
needed for increased angles of sideslip. be possible to meet the applicable re-
Compliance with this paragraph must quirements of 25.203 with
be demonstrated for all landing gear (1) Flaps, landing gear, and decelera-
and flap positions and symmetrical tion devices in any likely combination
power conditions at speeds from 1.13 of positions approved for operation;
VSR1 to VFE, VLE, or VFC/MFC, as appro- (2) Representative weights within the
priate. range for which certification is re-
quested;
(d) The rudder gradients must meet
(3) The most adverse center of grav-
the requirements of paragraph (c) at ity for recovery; and
speeds between VMO/MMO and VFC/MFC (4) The airplane trimmed for straight
except that the dihedral effect (aileron flight at the speed prescribed in
deflection opposite the corresponding 25.103(b)(6).
rudder input) may be negative provided (c) The following procedures must be
the divergence is gradual, easily recog- used to show compliance with 25.203;
nized, and easily controlled by the (1) Starting at a speed sufficiently
pilot. above the stalling speed to ensure that
[Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29774, July 20, 1990; 55 FR a steady rate of speed reduction can be
37607, Sept. 12, 1990; Amdt. 25108, 67 FR 70827, established, apply the longitudinal
Nov. 26, 2002] control so that the speed reduction

364

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00374 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.207

does not exceed one knot per second (2) Approximately 90 degrees in the
until the airplane is stalled. original direction of the turn, or 60 de-
(2) In addition, for turning flight grees in the opposite direction, for de-
stalls, apply the longitudinal control celeration rates in excess of 1 knot per
to achieve airspeed deceleration rates second.
up to 3 knots per second. [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
(3) As soon as the airplane is stalled, amended by Amdt. 2584, 60 FR 30750, June 9,
recover by normal recovery techniques. 1995]
(d) The airplane is considered stalled
when the behavior of the airplane gives 25.207 Stall warning.
the pilot a clear and distinctive indica- (a) Stall warning with sufficient mar-
tion of an acceptable nature that the gin to prevent inadvertent stalling
airplane is stalled. Acceptable indica- with the flaps and landing gear in any
tions of a stall, occurring either indi- normal position must be clear and dis-
vidually or in combination, are tinctive to the pilot in straight and
(1) A nose-down pitch that cannot be turning flight.
readily arrested; (b) The warning must be furnished ei-
(2) Buffeting, of a magnitude and se- ther through the inherent aerodynamic
verity that is a strong and effective de- qualities of the airplane or by a device
terrent to further speed reduction; or that will give clearly distinguishable
(3) The pitch control reaches the aft indications under expected conditions
stop and no further increase in pitch of flight. However, a visual stall warn-
attitude occurs when the control is ing device that requires the attention
held full aft for a short time before re- of the crew within the cockpit is not
covery is initiated. acceptable by itself. If a warning de-
vice is used, it must provide a warning
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as in each of the airplane configurations
amended by Amdt. 2584, 60 FR 30750, June 9, prescribed in paragraph (a) of this sec-
1995; Amdt. 25108, 67 FR 70827, Nov. 26, 2002]
tion at the speed prescribed in para-
25.203 Stall characteristics. graphs (c) and (d) of this section.
(c) When the speed is reduced at rates
(a) It must be possible to produce and not exceeding one knot per second,
to correct roll and yaw by unreversed stall warning must begin, in each nor-
use of the aileron and rudder controls, mal configuration, at a speed, VSW, ex-
up to the time the airplane is stalled. ceeding the speed at which the stall is
No abnormal nose-up pitching may identified in accordance with 25.201(d)
occur. The longitudinal control force by not less than five knots or five per-
must be positive up to and throughout cent CAS, whichever is greater. Once
the stall. In addition, it must be pos- initiated, stall warning must continue
sible to promptly prevent stalling and until the angle of attack is reduced to
to recover from a stall by normal use approximately that at which stall
of the controls. warning began.
(b) For level wing stalls, the roll oc- (d) In addition to the requirement of
curring between the stall and the com- paragraph (c) of this section, when the
pletion of the recovery may not exceed speed is reduced at rates not exceeding
approximately 20 degrees. one knot per second, in straight flight
(c) For turning flight stalls, the ac- with engines idling and at the center-
tion of the airplane after the stall may of-gravity position specified in
not be so violent or extreme as to 25.103(b)(5), VSW, in each normal con-
make it difficult, with normal piloting figuration, must exceed VSR by not less
skill, to effect a prompt recovery and than three knots or three percent CAS,
to regain control of the airplane. The whichever is greater.
maximum bank angle that occurs dur- (e) The stall warning margin must be
ing the recovery may not exceed sufficient to allow the pilot to prevent
(1) Approximately 60 degrees in the stalling (as defined in 25.201(d)) when
original direction of the turn, or 30 de- recovery is initiated not less than one
grees in the opposite direction, for de- second after the onset of stall warning
celeration rates up to 1 knot per sec- in slow-down turns with at least 1.5g
ond; and load factor normal to the flight path

365

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00375 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.231 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

and airspeed deceleration rates of at (b) Landplanes must be satisfactorily


least 2 knots per second, with the flaps controllable, without exceptional pilot-
and landing gear in any normal posi- ing skill or alertness, in power-off land-
tion, with the airplane trimmed for ings at normal landing speed, without
straight flight at a speed of 1.3 VSR, and using brakes or engine power to main-
with the power or thrust necessary to tain a straight path. This may be
maintain level flight at 1.3 VSR. shown during power-off landings made
(f) Stall warning must also be pro- in conjunction with other tests.
vided in each abnormal configuration (c) The airplane must have adequate
of the high lift devices that is likely to directional control during taxiing. This
be used in flight following system fail- may be shown during taxiing prior to
ures (including all configurations cov- takeoffs made in conjunction with
ered by Airplane Flight Manual proce-
other tests.
dures).
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5671, Apr. 8,
amended by Amdt. 257, 30 FR 13118, Oct. 15,
1970; Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2322, Jan. 16, 1978;
1965; Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2322, Jan. 16, 1978;
Amdt. 25108, 67 FR 70827, Nov. 26, 2002] Amdt. 2594, 63 FR 8848, Feb. 23, 1998; Amdt.
25108, 67 FR 70828, Nov. 26, 2002]
GROUND AND WATER HANDLING
25.235 Taxiing condition.
CHARACTERISTICS
The shock absorbing mechanism may
25.231 Longitudinal stability and not damage the structure of the air-
control. plane when the airplane is taxied on
(a) Landplanes may have no uncon- the roughest ground that may reason-
trollable tendency to nose over in any ably be expected in normal operation.
reasonably expected operating condi-
tion or when rebound occurs during 25.237 Wind velocities.
landing or takeoff. In addition (a) For landplanes and amphibians, a
(1) Wheel brakes must operate 90-degree cross component of wind ve-
smoothly and may not cause any undue locity, demonstrated to be safe for
tendency to nose over; and takeoff and landing, must be estab-
(2) If a tail-wheel landing gear is lished for dry runways and must be at
used, it must be possible, during the least 20 knots or 0.2 VSR0, whichever is
takeoff ground run on concrete, to greater, except that it need not exceed
maintain any attitude up to thrust line 25 knots.
level, at 75 percent of VSR1.
(b) For seaplanes and amphibians,
(b) For seaplanes and amphibians,
the following applies:
the most adverse water conditions safe
for takeoff, taxiing, and landing, must (1) A 90-degree cross component of
be established. wind velocity, up to which takeoff and
landing is safe under all water condi-
[Docket No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as tions that may reasonably be expected
amended by Amdt. 25108, 67 FR 70828, Nov. in normal operation, must be estab-
26, 2002]
lished and must be at least 20 knots or
25.233 Directional stability and con- 0.2 VSR0, whichever is greater, except
trol. that it need not exceed 25 knots.
(2) A wind velocity, for which taxiing
(a) There may be no uncontrollable
ground-looping tendency in 90 cross is safe in any direction under all water
winds, up to a wind velocity of 20 knots conditions that may reasonably be ex-
or 0.2 VSR0, whichever is greater, except pected in normal operation, must be es-
that the wind velocity need not exceed tablished and must be at least 20 knots
25 knots at any speed at which the air- or 0.2 VSR0, whichever is greater, except
plane may be expected to be operated that it need not exceed 25 knots.
on the ground. This may be shown [Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2322, Jan. 16, 1978, as
while establishing the 90 cross compo- amended by Amdt. 25108, 67 FR 70827, Nov.
nent of wind velocity required by 26, 2002]
25.237.

366

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00376 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.253

25.239 Spray characteristics, control, ating limitations of the airplane in ac-


and stability on water. cordance with 25.1505.
(a) For seaplanes and amphibians, (c) Except as provided in paragraph
during takeoff, taxiing, and landing, (d) of this section, there may be no buf-
and in the conditions set forth in para- feting condition, in normal flight, in-
graph (b) of this section, there may be cluding configuration changes during
no cruise, severe enough to interfere with
(1) Spray characteristics that would the control of the airplane, to cause ex-
impair the pilots view, cause damage, cessive fatigue to the crew, or to cause
or result in the taking in of an undue structural damage. Stall warning buf-
quantity of water; feting within these limits is allowable.
(2) Dangerously uncontrollable (d) There may be no perceptible buf-
porpoising, bounding, or swinging tend- feting condition in the cruise configu-
ency; or ration in straight flight at any speed
(3) Immersion of auxiliary floats or up to VMO/MMO, except that stall warn-
sponsons, wing tips, propeller blades, ing buffeting is allowable.
or other parts not designed to with- (e) For an airplane with MD greater
stand the resulting water loads. than .6 or with a maximum operating
(b) Compliance with the require- altitude greater than 25,000 feet, the
ments of paragraph (a) of this section positive maneuvering load factors at
must be shown which the onset of perceptible buf-
(1) In water conditions, from smooth feting occurs must be determined with
to the most adverse condition estab- the airplane in the cruise configuration
lished in accordance with 25.231; for the ranges of airspeed or Mach
(2) In wind and cross-wind velocities, number, weight, and altitude for which
water currents, and associated waves the airplane is to be certificated. The
and swells that may reasonably be ex- envelopes of load factor, speed, alti-
pected in operation on water; tude, and weight must provide a suffi-
(3) At speeds that may reasonably be cient range of speeds and load factors
expected in operation on water; for normal operations. Probable inad-
(4) With sudden failure of the critical vertent excursions beyond the bound-
engine at any time while on water; and aries of the buffet onset envelopes may
(5) At each weight and center of grav- not result in unsafe conditions.
ity position, relevant to each operating [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
condition, within the range of loading amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5671, Apr. 8,
conditions for which certification is re- 1970; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29775, July 20, 1990;
quested. Amdt. 2577, 57 FR 28949, June 29, 1992]
(c) In the water conditions of para-
graph (b) of this section, and in the 25.253 High-speed characteristics.
corresponding wind conditions, the sea- (a) Speed increase and recovery charac-
plane or amphibian must be able to teristics. The following speed increase
drift for five minutes with engines in- and recovery characteristics must be
operative, aided, if necessary, by a sea met:
anchor. (1) Operating conditions and charac-
teristics likely to cause inadvertent
MISCELLANEOUS FLIGHT REQUIREMENTS speed increases (including upsets in
pitch and roll) must be simulated with
25.251 Vibration and buffeting. the airplane trimmed at any likely
(a) The airplane must be dem- cruise speed up to VMO/MMO. These con-
onstrated in flight to be free from any ditions and characteristics include gust
vibration and buffeting that would pre- upsets, inadvertent control move-
vent continued safe flight in any likely ments, low stick force gradient in rela-
operating condition. tion to control friction, passenger
(b) Each part of the airplane must be movement, leveling off from climb, and
demonstrated in flight to be free from descent from Mach to airspeed limit al-
excessive vibration under any appro- titudes.
priate speed and power conditions up to (2) Allowing for pilot reaction time
VDF/MDF. The maximum speeds shown after effective inherent or artificial
must be used in establishing the oper- speed warning occurs, it must be shown

367

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00377 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.255 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

that the airplane can be recovered to a tem), except as limited by stops in the
normal attitude and its speed reduced trim system, including those required
to VMO/MMO, without by 25.655(b) for adjustable stabilizers;
(i) Exceptional piloting strength or or
skill; (2) The maximum mistrim that can
(ii) Exceeding VD/MD, VDF/MDF, or the be sustained by the autopilot while
structural limitations; and maintaining level flight in the high
(iii) Buffeting that would impair the speed cruising condition.
pilots ability to read the instruments (b) In the out-of-trim condition speci-
or control the airplane for recovery. fied in paragraph (a) of this section,
(3) With the airplane trimmed at any when the normal acceleration is varied
speed up to VMO/MMO, there must be no from +1 g to the positive and negative
reversal of the response to control values specified in paragraph (c) of this
input about any axis at any speed up to section
VDF/MDF. Any tendency to pitch, roll, or (1) The stick force vs. g curve must
yaw must be mild and readily control- have a positive slope at any speed up to
lable, using normal piloting tech- and including VFC/MFC; and
niques. When the airplane is trimmed (2) At speeds between VFC/MFC and
at VMO/MMO, the slope of the elevator VDF/MDF the direction of the primary
control force versus speed curve need longitudinal control force may not re-
not be stable at speeds greater than verse.
VFC/MFC, but there must be a push force (c) Except as provided in paragraphs
at all speeds up to VDF/MDF and there (d) and (e) of this section, compliance
must be no sudden or excessive reduc- with the provisions of paragraph (a) of
tion of elevator control force as VDF/ this section must be demonstrated in
MDF is reached. flight over the acceleration range
(b) Maximum speed for stability charac- (1) 1 g to +2.5 g; or
teristics, VFC/MFC. VFC/MFC is the max- (2) 0 g to 2.0 g, and extrapolating by
imum speed at which the requirements an acceptable method to 1 g and +2.5
of 25.143(f), 25.147(e), 25.175(b)(1), g.
25.177, and 25.181 must be met with (d) If the procedure set forth in para-
flaps and landing gear retracted. It graph (c)(2) of this section is used to
may not be less than a speed midway demonstrate compliance and marginal
between VMO/MMO and VDF/MDF, except conditions exist during flight test with
that for altitudes where Mach number regard to reversal of primary longitu-
is the limiting factor, MFC need not ex- dinal control force, flight tests must be
ceed the Mach number at which effec- accomplished from the normal accel-
tive speed warning occurs. eration at which a marginal condition
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as is found to exist to the applicable limit
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5671, Apr. 8, specified in paragraph (b)(1) of this sec-
1970; Amdt. 2554, 45 FR 60172, Sept. 11, 1980; tion.
Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29775, July 20, 1990; Amdt. (e) During flight tests required by
2584, 60 FR 30750, June 9, 1995] paragraph (a) of this section, the limit
maneuvering load factors prescribed in
25.255 Out-of-trim characteristics. 25.333(b) and 25.337, and the maneu-
(a) From an initial condition with vering load factors associated with
the airplane trimmed at cruise speeds probable inadvertent excursions be-
up to VMO/MMO, the airplane must have yond the boundaries of the buffet onset
satisfactory maneuvering stability and envelopes determined under 25.251(e),
controllability with the degree of out- need not be exceeded. In addition, the
of-trim in both the airplane nose-up entry speeds for flight test demonstra-
and nose-down directions, which re- tions at normal acceleration values
sults from the greater of less than 1 g must be limited to the ex-
(1) A three-second movement of the tent necessary to accomplish a recov-
longitudinal trim system at its normal ery without exceeding VDF/MDF.
rate for the particular flight condition (f) In the out-of-trim condition speci-
with no aerodynamic load (or an equiv- fied in paragraph (a) of this section, it
alent degree of trim for airplanes that must be possible from an overspeed
do not have a power-operated trim sys- condition at VDF/MDF to produce at

368

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00378 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.305

least 1.5 g for recovery by applying not 25.303 Factor of safety.


more than 125 pounds of longitudinal
Unless otherwise specified, a factor of
control force using either the primary
safety of 1.5 must be applied to the pre-
longitudinal control alone or the pri-
scribed limit load which are considered
mary longitudinal control and the lon-
external loads on the structure. When a
gitudinal trim system. If the longitu-
loading condition is prescribed in
dinal trim is used to assist in pro-
terms of ultimate loads, a factor of
ducing the required load factor, it must
safety need not be applied unless other-
be shown at VDF/MDF that the longitu-
wise specified.
dinal trim can be actuated in the air-
plane nose-up direction with the pri- [Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5672, Apr. 8, 1970]
mary surface loaded to correspond to
the least of the following airplane 25.305 Strength and deformation.
nose-up control forces: (a) The structure must be able to
(1) The maximum control forces ex- support limit loads without detri-
pected in service as specified in 25.301 mental permanent deformation. At any
and 25.397. load up to limit loads, the deformation
(2) The control force required to may not interfere with safe operation.
produce 1.5 g. (b) The structure must be able to
(3) The control force corresponding to support ultimate loads without failure
buffeting or other phenomena of such for at least 3 seconds. However, when
intensity that it is a strong deterrent proof of strength is shown by dynamic
to further application of primary longi- tests simulating actual load condi-
tudinal control force. tions, the 3-second limit does not
[Amdt. No. 2542, 43 FR 2322, Jan. 16, 1978] apply. Static tests conducted to ulti-
mate load must include the ultimate
Subpart CStructure deflections and ultimate deformation
induced by the loading. When analyt-
GENERAL ical methods are used to show compli-
ance with the ultimate load strength
25.301 Loads. requirements, it must be shown that
(a) Strength requirements are speci- (1) The effects of deformation are not
fied in terms of limit loads (the max- significant;
imum loads to be expected in service) (2) The deformations involved are
and ultimate loads (limit loads multi- fully accounted for in the analysis; or
plied by prescribed factors of safety). (3) The methods and assumptions
Unless otherwise provided, prescribed used are sufficient to cover the effects
loads are limit loads. of these deformations.
(b) Unless otherwise provided, the (c) Where structural flexibility is
specified air, ground, and water loads such that any rate of load application
must be placed in equilibrium with in- likely to occur in the operating condi-
ertia forces, considering each item of tions might produce transient stresses
mass in the airplane. These loads must appreciably higher than those cor-
be distributed to conservatively ap- responding to static loads, the effects
proximate or closely represent actual of this rate of application must be con-
conditions. Methods used to determine sidered.
load intensities and distribution must (d) [Reserved]
be validated by flight load measure- (e) The airplane must be designed to
ment unless the methods used for de- withstand any vibration and buffeting
termining those loading conditions are that might occur in any likely oper-
shown to be reliable. ating condition up to VD/MD, including
(c) If deflections under load would stall and probable inadvertent excur-
significantly change the distribution of sions beyond the boundaries of the buf-
external or internal loads, this redis- fet onset envelope. This must be shown
tribution must be taken into account. by analysis, flight tests, or other tests
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as found necessary by the Administrator.
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5672, Apr. 8, (f) Unless shown to be extremely im-
1970] probable, the airplane must be designed

369

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00379 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.305

least 1.5 g for recovery by applying not 25.303 Factor of safety.


more than 125 pounds of longitudinal
Unless otherwise specified, a factor of
control force using either the primary
safety of 1.5 must be applied to the pre-
longitudinal control alone or the pri-
scribed limit load which are considered
mary longitudinal control and the lon-
external loads on the structure. When a
gitudinal trim system. If the longitu-
loading condition is prescribed in
dinal trim is used to assist in pro-
terms of ultimate loads, a factor of
ducing the required load factor, it must
safety need not be applied unless other-
be shown at VDF/MDF that the longitu-
wise specified.
dinal trim can be actuated in the air-
plane nose-up direction with the pri- [Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5672, Apr. 8, 1970]
mary surface loaded to correspond to
the least of the following airplane 25.305 Strength and deformation.
nose-up control forces: (a) The structure must be able to
(1) The maximum control forces ex- support limit loads without detri-
pected in service as specified in 25.301 mental permanent deformation. At any
and 25.397. load up to limit loads, the deformation
(2) The control force required to may not interfere with safe operation.
produce 1.5 g. (b) The structure must be able to
(3) The control force corresponding to support ultimate loads without failure
buffeting or other phenomena of such for at least 3 seconds. However, when
intensity that it is a strong deterrent proof of strength is shown by dynamic
to further application of primary longi- tests simulating actual load condi-
tudinal control force. tions, the 3-second limit does not
[Amdt. No. 2542, 43 FR 2322, Jan. 16, 1978] apply. Static tests conducted to ulti-
mate load must include the ultimate
Subpart CStructure deflections and ultimate deformation
induced by the loading. When analyt-
GENERAL ical methods are used to show compli-
ance with the ultimate load strength
25.301 Loads. requirements, it must be shown that
(a) Strength requirements are speci- (1) The effects of deformation are not
fied in terms of limit loads (the max- significant;
imum loads to be expected in service) (2) The deformations involved are
and ultimate loads (limit loads multi- fully accounted for in the analysis; or
plied by prescribed factors of safety). (3) The methods and assumptions
Unless otherwise provided, prescribed used are sufficient to cover the effects
loads are limit loads. of these deformations.
(b) Unless otherwise provided, the (c) Where structural flexibility is
specified air, ground, and water loads such that any rate of load application
must be placed in equilibrium with in- likely to occur in the operating condi-
ertia forces, considering each item of tions might produce transient stresses
mass in the airplane. These loads must appreciably higher than those cor-
be distributed to conservatively ap- responding to static loads, the effects
proximate or closely represent actual of this rate of application must be con-
conditions. Methods used to determine sidered.
load intensities and distribution must (d) [Reserved]
be validated by flight load measure- (e) The airplane must be designed to
ment unless the methods used for de- withstand any vibration and buffeting
termining those loading conditions are that might occur in any likely oper-
shown to be reliable. ating condition up to VD/MD, including
(c) If deflections under load would stall and probable inadvertent excur-
significantly change the distribution of sions beyond the boundaries of the buf-
external or internal loads, this redis- fet onset envelope. This must be shown
tribution must be taken into account. by analysis, flight tests, or other tests
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as found necessary by the Administrator.
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5672, Apr. 8, (f) Unless shown to be extremely im-
1970] probable, the airplane must be designed

369

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00379 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.307 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

to withstand any forced structural vi- (2) At each weight from the design
bration resulting from any failure, minimum weight to the design max-
malfunction or adverse condition in imum weight appropriate to each par-
the flight control system. These must ticular flight load condition; and
be considered limit loads and must be (3) For each required altitude and
investigated at airspeeds up to VC/MC. weight, for any practicable distribution
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as of disposable load within the operating
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5672, Apr. 8, limitations recorded in the Airplane
1970; Amdt. 2554, 45 FR 60172, Sept. 11, 1980; Flight Manual.
Amdt. 2577, 57 FR 28949, June 29, 1992; Amdt. (c) Enough points on and within the
2586, 61 FR 5220, Feb. 9, 1996]
boundaries of the design envelope must
25.307 Proof of structure. be investigated to ensure that the max-
imum load for each part of the airplane
(a) Compliance with the strength and
deformation requirements of this sub- structure is obtained.
part must be shown for each critical (d) The significant forces acting on
loading condition. Structural analysis the airplane must be placed in equi-
may be used only if the structure con- librium in a rational or conservative
forms to that for which experience has manner. The linear inertia forces must
shown this method to be reliable. The be considered in equilibrium with the
Administrator may require ultimate thrust and all aerodynamic loads,
load tests in cases where limit load while the angular (pitching) inertia
tests may be inadequate. forces must be considered in equi-
(b)(c) [Reserved] librium with thrust and all aero-
(d) When static or dynamic tests are dynamic moments, including moments
used to show compliance with the re- due to loads on components such as
quirements of 25.305(b) for flight tail surfaces and nacelles. Critical
structures, appropriate material cor- thrust values in the range from zero to
rection factors must be applied to the maximum continuous thrust must be
test results, unless the structure, or considered.
part thereof, being tested has features
such that a number of elements con- [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
tribute to the total strength of the amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5672, Apr. 8,
structure and the failure of one ele- 1970; Amdt. 2586, 61 FR 5220, Feb. 9, 1996]
ment results in the redistribution of
the load through alternate load paths. FLIGHT MANEUVER AND GUST
CONDITIONS
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5672, Apr. 8, 25.331 Symmetric maneuvering con-
1970; Amdt. 2554, 45 FR 60172, Sept. 11, 1980; ditions.
Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29775, July 20, 1990]
(a) Procedure. For the analysis of the
FLIGHT LOADS maneuvering flight conditions specified
in paragraphs (b) and (c) of this sec-
25.321 General. tion, the following provisions apply:
(a) Flight load factors represent the (1) Where sudden displacement of a
ratio of the aerodynamic force compo- control is specified, the assumed rate
nent (acting normal to the assumed of control surface displacement may
longitudinal axis of the airplane) to the not be less than the rate that could be
weight of the airplane. A positive load applied by the pilot through the con-
factor is one in which the aerodynamic trol system.
force acts upward with respect to the (2) In determining elevator angles
airplane.
and chordwise load distribution in the
(b) Considering compressibility ef-
maneuvering conditions of paragraphs
fects at each speed, compliance with
the flight load requirements of this (b) and (c) of this section, the effect of
subpart must be shown corresponding pitching velocities must
(1) At each critical altitude within be taken into account. The in-trim and
the range of altitudes selected by the out-of-trim flight conditions specified
applicant; in 25.255 must be considered.

370

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00380 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.333

(b) Maneuvering balanced conditions. currently with the airplane load factor
Assuming the airplane to be in equi- of 1.0 (Points A1 to D1, 25.333(b)). The
librium with zero pitching accelera- positive acceleration must be equal to
tion, the maneuvering conditions A at least
through I on the maneuvering envelope
in 25.333(b) must be investigated.
(c) Pitch maneuver conditions. The
39n
v
(
( n 1.5), Radians/sec.2 )
conditions specified in paragraphs
(c)(1) and (2) of this section must be in- where
vestigated. The movement of the pitch n is the positive load factor at the speed
control surfaces may be adjusted to under consideration, and V is the airplane
take into account limitations imposed equivalent speed in knots.
by the maximum pilot effort specified (ii) A negative pitching acceleration
by 25.397(b), control system stops and (nose down) is assumed to be reached
any indirect effect imposed by limita- concurrently with the positive maneu-
tions in the output side of the control vering load factor (points A2 to D2,
system (for example, stalling torque or 25.333(b)). This negative pitching ac-
maximum rate obtainable by a power celeration must be equal to at least
control system.)
26n
( )
(1) Maximum pitch control displacement
at VA. The airplane is assumed to be ( n 1.5), Radians/sec.2
flying in steady level flight (point A1, v
25.333(b)) and the cockpit pitch con- where
trol is suddenly moved to obtain ex- n is the positive load factor at the speed
treme nose up pitching acceleration. In under consideration; and V is the airplane
defining the tail load, the response of equivalent speed in knots.
the airplane must be taken into ac- [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
count. Airplane loads that occur subse- amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5672, Apr. 8,
quent to the time when normal accel- 1970; Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50594, Oct. 30, 1978; 43
eration at the c.g. exceeds the positive FR 52495, Nov. 13, 1978; 43 FR 54082, Nov. 20,
limit maneuvering load factor (at point 1978; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29775, July 20, 1990; 55
A2 in 25.333(b)), or the resulting FR 37607, Sept. 12, 1990; Amdt. 2586, 61 FR
tailplane normal load reaches its max- 5220, Feb. 9, 1996; Amdt. 2591, 62 FR 40704,
imum, whichever occurs first, need not July 29, 1997]
be considered.
25.333 Flight maneuvering envelope.
(2) Specified control displacement. A
checked maneuver, based on a rational (a) General. The strength require-
pitching control motion vs. time pro- ments must be met at each combina-
file, must be established in which the tion of airspeed and load factor on and
design limit load factor specified in within the boundaries of the represent-
25.337 will not be exceeded. Unless ative maneuvering envelope (V-n dia-
lesser values cannot be exceeded, the gram) of paragraph (b) of this section.
airplane response must result in pitch- This envelope must also be used in de-
ing accelerations not less than the fol- termining the airplane structural oper-
lowing: ating limitations as specified in
(i) A positive pitching acceleration 25.1501.
(nose up) is assumed to be reached con- (b) Maneuvering envelope. EC28SE91.034</MATH>

371
EC28SE91.033</MATH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00381 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.335 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as amended by Amdt. 2586, 61 FR 5220, Feb. 9, 1996]

25.335 Design airspeeds. (1) From an initial condition of sta-


The selected design airspeeds are bilized flight at VC/MC, the airplane is
equivalent airspeeds (EAS). Estimated upset, flown for 20 seconds along a
values of VS0 and VS1 must be conserv- flight path 7.5 below the initial path,
ative. and then pulled up at a load factor of
(a) Design cruising speed, VC. For VC, 1.5g (0.5g acceleration increment). The
the following apply: speed increase occurring in this maneu-
(1) The minimum value of VC must be ver may be calculated if reliable or
sufficiently greater than VB to provide conservative aerodynamic data is used.
for inadvertent speed increases likely Power as specified in 25.175(b)(1)(iv) is
to occur as a result of severe atmos- assumed until the pullup is initiated,
pheric turbulence. at which time power reduction and the
(2) Except as provided in 25.335(d)(2), use of pilot controlled drag devices
VC may not be less than VB + 1.32 U REF may be assumed;
(with UREF as specified in (2) The minimum speed margin must
25.341(a)(5)(i)). However VC need not be enough to provide for atmospheric
exceed the maximum speed in level variations (such as horizontal gusts,
flight at maximum continuous power and penetration of jet streams and cold
for the corresponding altitude. fronts) and for instrument errors and
(3) At altitudes where VD is limited airframe production variations. These
by Mach number, VC may be limited to
factors may be considered on a prob-
a selected Mach number.
ability basis. The margin at altitude
(b) Design dive speed, VD. VD must be
selected so that VC/MC is not greater where MC is limited by compressibility
than 0.8 VD/MD, or so that the min- effects must not less than 0.07M unless
imum speed margin between VC/MC and a lower margin is determined using a
VD/MD is the greater of the following rational analysis that includes the ef-
values: fects of any automatic systems. In any

372
EC28SE91.035</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00382 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.337

case, the margin may not be reduced to greater than the operating speed rec-
less than 0.05M. ommended for the corresponding stage
(c) Design maneuvering speed VA. For of flight (including balked landings) to
VA, the following apply: allow for probable variations in control
(1) VA may not be less than VS1 n of airspeed and for transition from one
where flap position to another.
(i) n is the limit positive maneu- (2) If an automatic flap positioning or
vering load factor at VC; and load limiting device is used, the speeds
(ii) VS1 is the stalling speed with and corresponding flap positions pro-
flaps retracted. grammed or allowed by the device may
(2) VA and VS must be evaluated at be used.
the design weight and altitude under (3) VF may not be less than
consideration. (i) 1.6 VS1 with the flaps in takeoff po-
(3) VA need not be more than VC or sition at maximum takeoff weight;
the speed at which the positive CN max
(ii) 1.8 VS1 with the flaps in approach
curve intersects the positive maneuver
position at maximum landing weight,
load factor line, whichever is less.
and
(d) Design speed for maximum gust in-
tensity, VB. (iii) 1.8 VS0 with the flaps in landing
(1) VB may not be less than position at maximum landing weight.
(f) Design drag device speeds, VDD. The
12 selected design speed for each drag de-
K g U ref Vc a vice must be sufficiently greater than
VS1 1 + the speed recommended for the oper-
498w ation of the device to allow for prob-
where able variations in speed control. For
VS1=the 1-g stalling speed based on CNAmax drag devices intended for use in high
with the flaps retracted at the particular speed descents, VDD may not be less
weight under consideration; than VD. When an automatic drag de-
Vc=design cruise speed (knots equivalent air-
vice positioning or load limiting means
speed);
Uref=the reference gust velocity (feet per sec- is used, the speeds and corresponding
ond equivalent airspeed) from drag device positions programmed or
25.341(a)(5)(i); allowed by the automatic means must
w=average wing loading (pounds per square be used for design.
foot) at the particular weight under con-
sideration. [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5672, Apr. 8,
.88 1970; Amdt. 2586, 61 FR 5220, Feb. 9, 1996;
Kg = Amdt. 2591, 62 FR 40704, July 29, 1997]
5.3 + 25.337 Limit maneuvering load fac-
tors.
2w
= (a) Except where limited by max-
cag imum (static) lift coefficients, the air-
r=density of air (slugs/ft3); plane is assumed to be subjected to
c=mean geometric chord of the wing (feet); symmetrical maneuvers resulting in
g=acceleration due to gravity (ft/sec2); the limit maneuvering load factors pre-
a=slope of the airplane normal force coeffi- scribed in this section. Pitching veloci-
cient curve, CNA per radian; ties appropriate to the corresponding
(2) At altitudes where VC is limited pull-up and steady turn maneuvers
by Mach number must be taken into account.
(i) VB may be chosen to provide an (b) The positive limit maneuvering
optimum margin between low and high load factor n for any speed up to Vn
speed buffet boundaries; and, may not be less than 2.1+24,000/ (W
(ii) VB need not be greater than VC. +10,000) except that n may not be less
(e) Design flap speeds, VF. For VF, the than 2.5 and need not be greater than
following apply: 3.8where W is the design maximum
(1) The design flap speed for each flap takeoff weight.
ER09FE96.017</MATH>

position (established in accordance (c) The negative limit maneuvering


with 25.697(a)) must be sufficiently load factor

373
ER09fe96.016</MATH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00383 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.341 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(1) May not be less than 1.0 at (i) At the airplane design speed VC:
speeds up to VC; and Positive and negative gusts with ref-
(2) Must vary linearly with speed erence gust velocities of 56.0 ft/sec EAS
from the value at VC to zero at VD. must be considered at sea level. The
(d) Maneuvering load factors lower reference gust velocity may be reduced
than those specified in this section linearly from 56.0 ft/sec EAS at sea
may be used if the airplane has design level to 44.0 ft/sec EAS at 15000 feet.
features that make it impossible to ex- The reference gust velocity may be fur-
ceed these values in flight. ther reduced linearly from 44.0 ft/sec
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as EAS at 15000 feet to 26.0 ft/sec EAS at
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5672, Apr. 8, 50000 feet.
1970] (ii) At the airplane design speed VD:
The reference gust velocity must be 0.5
25.341 Gust and turbulence loads.
times the value obtained under
(a) Discrete Gust Design Criteria. The 25.341(a)(5)(i).
airplane is assumed to be subjected to (6) The flight profile alleviation fac-
symmetrical vertical and lateral gusts tor, Fg, must be increased linearly from
in level flight. Limit gust loads must the sea level value to a value of 1.0 at
be determined in accordance with the
the maximum operating altitude de-
provisions:
fined in 25.1527. At sea level, the flight
(1) Loads on each part of the struc-
profile alleviation factor is determined
ture must be determined by dynamic
analysis. The analysis must take into by the following equation:

( )
account unsteady aerodynamic charac-
teristics and all significant structural Fg = 0.5 Fgz + Fgm
degrees of freedom including rigid body
motions. Where:
(2) The shape of the gust must be:
Z mo
U s Fgz = 1 ;
U = ds 1- Cos 250000
2 H
R1
Fgm = R 2 Tan
for 0 s 2H
where 4;
s=distance penetrated into the gust (feet);
Uds=the design gust velocity in equivalent
Maximum Landing Weight
airspeed specified in paragraph (a)(4) of
this section; and
R1 = ;
H=the gust gradient which is the distance Maximum Take-off Weight
(feet) parallel to the airplanes flight path
for the gust to reach its peak velocity. Maximum Zero Fuel Weight
R2 = ;
(3) A sufficient number of gust gra- Maximum Take-off Weight
dient distances in the range 30 feet to
350 feet must be investigated to find Zmo=Maximum operating altitude defined in
the critical response for each load 25.1527.
quantity. (7) When a stability augmentation
(4) The design gust velocity must be: system is included in the analysis, the
effect of any significant system non-
( )
16
U ds = U ref Fg H 350 linearities should be accounted for
when deriving limit loads from limit
EN08MR96.004</MATH>

where gust conditions.


Uref=the reference gust velocity in equivalent (b) Continuous Gust Design Criteria.
airspeed defined in paragraph (a)(5) of this The dynamic response of the airplane
section.
to vertical and lateral continuous tur-
Fg=the flight profile alleviation factor de-
fined in paragraph (a)(6) of this section. bulence must be taken into account.
ER09FE96.019</MATH>

The continuous gust design criteria of


(5) The following reference gust ve- appendix G of this part must be used to
locities apply:

374
ER09FE96.018</MATH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00384 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.349

establish the dynamic response unless be determined by rational analysis.


more rational criteria are shown. The analysis must take into account
[Doc. No. 27902, 61 FR 5221, Feb. 9, 1996; 61 FR
the unsteady aerodynamic characteris-
9533, Mar. 8, 1996] tics and rigid body motions of the air-
craft. The shape of the gust must be as
25.343 Design fuel and oil loads. described in 25.341(a)(2) except that
(a) The disposable load combinations Uds=25 ft/sec EAS;
must include each fuel and oil load in H=12.5 c; and
the range from zero fuel and oil to the c=mean geometric chord of the wing (feet).
selected maximum fuel and oil load. A (b) The airplane must be designed for
structural reserve fuel condition, not the conditions prescribed in paragraph
exceeding 45 minutes of fuel under the
(a) of this section, except that the air-
operating conditions in 25.1001(e) and
plane load factor need not exceed 1.0,
(f), as applicable, may be selected.
taking into account, as separate condi-
(b) If a structural reserve fuel condi-
tions, the effects of
tion is selected, it must be used as the
(1) Propeller slipstream cor-
minimum fuel weight condition for
responding to maximum continuous
showing compliance with the flight
load requirements as prescribed in this power at the design flap speeds VF, and
subpart. In addition with takeoff power at not less than 1.4
(1) The structure must be designed times the stalling speed for the par-
for a condition of zero fuel and oil in ticular flap position and associated
the wing at limit loads corresponding maximum weight; and
to (2) A head-on gust of 25 feet per sec-
(i) A maneuvering load factor of ond velocity (EAS).
+2.25; and (c) If flaps or other high lift devices
(ii) The gust conditions of 25.341(a) are to be used in en route conditions,
but assuming 85% of the design veloci- and with flaps in the appropriate posi-
ties prescribed in 25.341(a)(4). tion at speeds up to the flap design
(2) Fatigue evaluation of the struc- speed chosen for these conditions, the
ture must account for any increase in airplane is assumed to be subjected to
operating stresses resulting from the symmetrical maneuvers and gusts
design condition of paragraph (b)(1) of within the range determined by
this section; and (1) Maneuvering to a positive limit
(3) The flutter, deformation, and vi- load factor as prescribed in 25.337(b);
bration requirements must also be met and
with zero fuel. (2) The discrete vertical gust criteria
in 25.341(a).
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2518, 33 FR 12226, Aug. 30,
(d) The airplane must be designed for
1968; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 37607, Sept. 12, 1990; a maneuvering load factor of 1.5 g at
Amdt. 2586, 61 FR 5221, Feb. 9, 1996] the maximum take-off weight with the
wing-flaps and similar high lift devices
25.345 High lift devices. in the landing configurations.
(a) If wing flaps are to be used during [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
takeoff, approach, or landing, at the amended by Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50595, Oct. 30,
design flap speeds established for these 1978; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 37607, Sept. 17, 1990;
stages of flight under 25.335(e) and Amdt. 2586, 61 FR 5221, Feb. 9, 1996; Amdt.
with the wing flaps in the cor- 2591, 62 FR 40704, July 29, 1997]
responding positions, the airplane is
assumed to be subjected to symmet- 25.349 Rolling conditions.
rical maneuvers and gusts. The result- The airplane must be designed for
ing limit loads must correspond to the loads resulting from the rolling condi-
conditions determined as follows: tions specified in paragraphs (a) and (b)
(1) Maneuvering to a positive limit of this section. Unbalanced aero-
load factor of 2.0; and dynamic moments about the center of
(2) Positive and negative gusts of 25 gravity must be reacted in a rational
ft/sec EAS acting normal to the flight or conservative manner, considering
path in level flight. Gust loads result- the principal masses furnishing the re-
ing on each part of the structure must acting inertia forces.

375

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00385 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.351 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(a) Maneuvering. The following condi- gravity must be reacted in a rational


tions, speeds, and aileron deflections or conservative manner considering the
(except as the deflections may be lim- airplane inertia forces. In computing
ited by pilot effort) must be considered the tail loads the yawing velocity may
in combination with an airplane load be assumed to be zero.
factor of zero and of two-thirds of the (a) With the airplane in unacceler-
positive maneuvering factor used in de- ated flight at zero yaw, it is assumed
sign. In determining the required aile- that the cockpit rudder control is sud-
ron deflections, the torsional flexi- denly displaced to achieve the result-
bility of the wing must be considered
ing rudder deflection, as limited by:
in accordance with 25.301(b):
(1) Conditions corresponding to (1) The control system on control
steady rolling velocities must be inves- surface stops; or
tigated. In addition, conditions cor- (2) A limit pilot force of 300 pounds
responding to maximum angular accel- from VMC to VA and 200 pounds from VC/
eration must be investigated for air- MC to VD/MD, with a linear variation
planes with engines or other weight between VA and VC/MC.
concentrations outboard of the fuse- (b) With the cockpit rudder control
lage. For the angular acceleration con- deflected so as always to maintain the
ditions, zero rolling velocity may be maximum rudder deflection available
assumed in the absence of a rational within the limitations specified in
time history investigation of the ma- paragraph (a) of this section, it is as-
neuver. sumed that the airplane yaws to the
(2) At VA, a sudden deflection of the overswing sideslip angle.
aileron to the stop is assumed. (c) With the airplane yawed to the
(3) At VC, the aileron deflection must static equilibrium sideslip angle, it is
be that required to produce a rate of assumed that the cockpit rudder con-
roll not less than that obtained in
trol is held so as to achieve the max-
paragraph (a)(2) of this section.
imum rudder deflection available with-
(4) At VD, the aileron deflection must
be that required to produce a rate of in the limitations specified in para-
roll not less than one-third of that in graph (a) of this section.
paragraph (a)(2) of this section. (d) With the airplane yawed to the
(b) Unsymmetrical gusts. The airplane static equilibrium sideslip angle of
is assumed to be subjected to unsym- paragraph (c) of this section, it is as-
metrical vertical gusts in level flight. sumed that the cockpit rudder control
The resulting limit loads must be de- is suddenly returned to neutral.
termined from either the wing max-
[Amdt. 2591, 62 FR 40704, July 29, 1997]
imum airload derived directly from
25.341(a), or the wing maximum air- SUPPLEMENTARY CONDITIONS
load derived indirectly from the
vertical load factor calculated from 25.361 Engine torque.
25.341(a). It must be assumed that 100
percent of the wing air load acts on one (a) Each engine mount and its sup-
side of the airplane and 80 percent of porting structure must be designed for
the wing air load acts on the other the effects of
side. (1) A limit engine torque cor-
responding to takeoff power and pro-
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5672, Apr. 8,
peller speed acting simultaneously
1970; Amdt. 2586, 61 FR 5222, Feb. 9, 1996; with 75 percent of the limit loads from
Amdt. 2594, 63 FR 8848, Feb. 23, 1998] flight condition A of 25.333(b);
(2) A limit torque corresponding to
25.351 Yaw maneuver conditions. the maximum continuous power and
The airplane must be designed for propeller speed, acting simultaneously
loads resulting from the yaw maneuver with the limit loads from flight condi-
conditions specified in paragraphs (a) tion A of 25.333(b); and
through (d) of this section at speeds (3) For turbopropeller installations,
from VMC to VD. Unbalanced aero- in addition to the conditions specified
dynamic moments about the center of

376

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00386 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.365

in paragraphs (a)(1) and (2) of this sec- 25.365 Pressurized compartment


tion, a limit engine torque cor- loads.
responding to takeoff power and pro-
For airplanes with one or more pres-
peller speed, multiplied by a factor ac-
surized compartments the following
counting for propeller control system
malfunction, including quick feath- apply:
ering, acting simultaneously with 1g (a) The airplane structure must be
level flight loads. In the absence of a strong enough to withstand the flight
rational analysis, a factor of 1.6 must loads combined with pressure differen-
be used. tial loads from zero up to the max-
(b) For turbine engine installations, imum relief valve setting.
the engine mounts and supporting (b) The external pressure distribution
structure must be designed to with- in flight, and stress concentrations and
stand each of the following: fatigue effects must be accounted for.
(1) A limit engine torque load im- (c) If landings may be made with the
posed by sudden engine stoppage due to compartment pressurized, landing
malfunction or structural failure (such loads must be combined with pressure
as compressor jamming). differential loads from zero up to the
(2) A limit engine torque load im- maximum allowed during landing.
posed by the maximum acceleration of
(d) The airplane structure must be
the engine.
designed to be able to withstand the
(c) The limit engine torque to be con-
sidered under paragraph (a) of this sec- pressure differential loads cor-
tion must be obtained by multiplying responding to the maximum relief
mean torque for the specified power valve setting multiplied by a factor of
and speed by a factor of 1.33 for airplanes to be approved for op-
(1) 1.25 for turbopropeller installa- eration to 45,000 feet or by a factor of
tions; 1.67 for airplanes to be approved for op-
(2) 1.33 for reciprocating engines with eration above 45,000 feet, omitting
five or more cylinders; or other loads.
(3) Two, three, or four, for engines (e) Any structure, component or part,
with four, three, or two cylinders, re- inside or outside a pressurized com-
spectively. partment, the failure of which could
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as interfere with continued safe flight and
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5672, Apr. 8, landing, must be designed to withstand
1970; Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50595, Oct. 30, 1978; the effects of a sudden release of pres-
Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29776, July 20, 1990] sure through an opening in any com-
partment at any operating altitude re-
25.363 Side load on engine and auxil-
iary power unit mounts. sulting from each of the following con-
ditions:
(a) Each engine and auxiliary power
(1) The penetration of the compart-
unit mount and its supporting struc-
ment by a portion of an engine fol-
ture must be designed for a limit load
factor in lateral direction, for the side lowing an engine disintegration;
load on the engine and auxiliary power (2) Any opening in any pressurized
unit mount, at least equal to the max- compartment up to the size Ho in
imum load factor obtained in the square feet; however, small compart-
yawing conditions but not less than ments may be combined with an adja-
(1) 1.33; or cent pressurized compartment and both
(2) One-third of the limit load factor considered as a single compartment for
for flight condition A as prescribed in openings that cannot reasonably be ex-
25.333(b). pected to be confined to the small com-
(b) The side load prescribed in para- partment. The size Ho must be com-
graph (a) of this section may be as- puted by the following formula:
sumed to be independent of other flight
Ho=PAs
conditions.
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as where,
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5672, Apr. 8, Ho=Maximum opening in square feet, need
1970; Amdt. 2591, 62 FR 40704, July 29, 1997] not exceed 20 square feet.

377

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00387 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.367 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

As because of fuel flow interruption are


P= +.024 considered to be limit loads.
6240 (2) At speeds between VMC and VC, the
loads resulting from the disconnection
As=Maximum cross-sectional area of the of the engine compressor from the tur-
pressurized shell normal to the longitu- bine or from loss of the turbine blades
dinal axis, in square feet; and are considered to be ultimate loads.
(3) The maximum opening caused by (3) The time history of the thrust
airplane or equipment failures not decay and drag build-up occurring as a
shown to be extremely improbable. result of the prescribed engine failures
(f) In complying with paragraph (e) of must be substantiated by test or other
this section, the fail-safe features of data applicable to the particular en-
the design may be considered in deter- gine-propeller combination.
mining the probability of failure or (4) The timing and magnitude of the
penetration and probable size of open- probable pilot corrective action must
ings, provided that possible improper be conservatively estimated, consid-
operation of closure devices and inad- ering the characteristics of the par-
vertent door openings are also consid- ticular engine-propeller-airplane com-
ered. Furthermore, the resulting dif- bination.
ferential pressure loads must be com- (b) Pilot corrective action may be as-
bined in a rational and conservative sumed to be initiated at the time max-
manner with 1g level flight loads and imum yawing velocity is reached, but
any loads arising from emergency de- not earlier than two seconds after the
pressurization conditions. These loads engine failure. The magnitude of the
may be considered as ultimate condi- corrective action may be based on the
tions; however, any deformations asso- control forces specified in 25.397(b) ex-
ciated with these conditions must not cept that lower forces may be assumed
interfere with continued safe flight and where it is shown by anaylsis or test
landing. The pressure relief provided by that these forces can control the yaw
intercompartment venting may also be and roll resulting from the prescribed
considered. engine failure conditions.
(g) Bulkheads, floors, and partitions 25.371 Gyroscopic loads.
in pressurized compartments for occu-
pants must be designed to withstand The structure supporting any engine
the conditions specified in paragraph or auxiliary power unit must be de-
(e) of this section. In addition, reason- signed for the loads including the gyro-
able design precautions must be taken scopic loads arising from the condi-
to minimize the probability of parts tions specified in 25.331, 25.341(a),
becoming detached and injuring occu- 25.349, 25.351, 25.473, 25.479, and 25.481,
pants while in their seats. with the engine or auxiliary power unit
at the maximum rpm appropriate to
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as the condition. For the purposes of com-
amended by Amdt. 2554, 45 FR 60172, Sept. pliance with this section, the pitch ma-
11, 1980; Amdt. 2571, 55 FR 13477, Apr. 10, neuver in 25.331(c)(1) must be carried
1990; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29776, July 20, 1990;
out until the positive limit maneu-
Amdt. 2587, 61 FR 28695, June 5, 1996]
vering load factor (point A2 in
25.367 Unsymmetrical loads due to 25.333(b)) is reached.
engine failure. [Amdt. 2591, 62 FR 40704, July 29, 1997]
(a) The airplane must be designed for
the unsymmetrical loads resulting 25.373 Speed control devices.
from the failure of the critical engine. If speed control devices (such as
Turbopropeller airplanes must be de- spoilers and drag flaps) are installed
signed for the following conditions in for use in en route conditions
combination with a single malfunction (a) The airplane must be designed for
of the propeller drag limiting system, the symmetrical maneuvers prescribed
considering the probable pilot correc- in 25.333 and 25.337, the yawing ma-
tive action on the flight controls: neuvers prescribed in 25.351, and the
(1) At speeds between VMC and VD, vertical and later gust conditions pre-
the loads resulting from power failure scribed in 25.341(a), at each setting

378

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00388 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.397

and the maximum speed associated automatic or power devices operating


with that setting; and the controls.
(b) If the device has automatic oper- (c) The loads must not be less than
ating or load limiting features, the air- those resulting from application of the
plane must be designed for the maneu- minimum forces prescribed in
ver and gust conditions prescribed in 25.397(c).
paragraph (a) of this section, at the
speeds and corresponding device posi- [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
tions that the mechanism allows. amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5672, Apr. 8,
1970; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29776, July 20, 1990]
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29776, July 20, 25.397 Control system loads.
1990; Amdt. 2586, 61 FR 5222, Feb. 9, 1996]
(a) General. The maximum and min-
CONTROL SURFACE AND SYSTEM LOADS imum pilot forces, specified in para-
graph (c) of this section, are assumed
25.391 Control surface loads: Gen- to act at the appropriate control grips
eral.
or pads (in a manner simulating flight
The control surfaces must be de- conditions) and to be reacted at the at-
signed for the limit loads resulting tachment of the control system to the
from the flight conditions in 25.331, control surface horn.
25.341(a), 25.349 and 25.351 and the
(b) Pilot effort effects. In the control
ground gust conditions in 25.415, con-
surface flight loading condition, the air
sidering the requirements for
(a) Loads parallel to hinge line, in loads on movable surfaces and the cor-
25.393; responding deflections need not exceed
(b) Pilot effort effects, in 25.397; those that would result in flight from
(c) Trim tab effects, in 25.407; the application of any pilot force with-
(d) Unsymmetrical loads, in 25.427; in the ranges specified in paragraph (c)
and of this section. Two-thirds of the max-
(e) Auxiliary aerodynamic surfaces, imum values specified for the aileron
in 25.445. and elevator may be used if control
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
surface hinge moments are based on re-
amended by Amdt. 2586, 61 FR 5222, Feb. 9, liable data. In applying this criterion,
1996] the effects of servo mechanisms, tabs,
and automatic pilot systems, must be
25.393 Loads parallel to hinge line. considered.
(a) Control surfaces and supporting (c) Limit pilot forces and torques. The
hinge brackets must be designed for in- limit pilot forces and torques are as
ertia loads acting parallel to the hinge follows:
line.
(b) In the absence of more rational Maximum Minimum
Control forces or forces or
data, the inertia loads may be assumed torques torques
to be equal to KW, where
(1) K=24 for vertical surfaces; Aileron:
Stick .............................. 100 lbs ............ 40 lbs.
(2) K=12 for horizontal surfaces; and
Wheel 1 .......................... 80 D in.-lbs 2 ... 40 D in.-lbs.
(3) W=weight of the movable surfaces. Elevator:
Stick .............................. 250 lbs ............ 100 lbs.
25.395 Control system. Wheel (symmetrical) ..... 300 lbs ............ 100 lbs.
(a) Longitudinal, lateral, directional, Wheel (unsymmetrical) 3 ......................... 100 lbs.
and drag control system and their sup- Rudder .............................. 300 lbs ............ 130 lbs.
porting structures must be designed for 1 The critical parts of the aileron control system must be de-

loads corresponding to 125 percent of signed for a single tangential force with a limit value equal to
1.25 times the couple force determined from these criteria.
the computed hinge moments of the 2 D=wheel diameter (inches).

movable control surface in the condi- 3 The unsymmetrical forces must be applied at one of the
normal handgrip points on the periphery of the control wheel.
tions prescribed in 25.391.
(b) The system limit loads, except
[Doc. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
the loads resulting from ground gusts, amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55466, Dec. 20,
need not exceed the loads that can be 1976; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29776, July 20, 1990]
produced by the pilot (or pilots) and by

379

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00389 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.399 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

25.399 Dual control system. loading conditions, with appropriate


allowance for rigging tolerances.
(a) Each dual control system must be
designed for the pilots operating in op- 25.409 Tabs.
position, using individual pilot forces
not less than (a) Trim tabs. Trim tabs must be de-
(1) 0.75 times those obtained under signed to withstand loads arising from
25.395; or all likely combinations of tab setting,
(2) The minimum forces specified in primary control position, and airplane
25.397(c). speed (obtainable without exceeding
(b) The control system must be de- the flight load conditions prescribed
signed for pilot forces applied in the for the airplane as a whole), when the
same direction, using individual pilot effect of the tab is opposed by pilot ef-
forces not less than 0.75 times those ob- fort forces up to those specified in
tained under 25.395. 25.397(b).
(b) Balancing tabs. Balancing tabs
25.405 Secondary control system. must be designed for deflections con-
sistent with the primary control sur-
Secondary controls, such as wheel
face loading conditions.
brake, spoiler, and tab controls, must
(c) Servo tabs. Servo tabs must be de-
be designed for the maximum forces
signed for deflections consistent with
that a pilot is likely to apply to those
the primary control surface loading
controls. The following values may be
conditions obtainable within the pilot
used:
maneuvering effort, considering pos-
sible opposition from the trim tabs.
PILOT CONTROL FORCE LIMITS (SECONDARY
CONTROLS) 25.415 Ground gust conditions.
(a) The control system must be de-
Control Limit pilot forces
signed as follows for control surface
loads due to ground gusts and taxiing
Miscellaneous: 1+R downwind:
*Crank, wheel, or )lll* 50 lbs., but
(1) The control system between the
lever. 3
stops nearest the surfaces and the
not less than 50 lbs. nor cockpit controls must be designed for
more than 150 lbs. loads corresponding to the limit hinge
(R=radius). (Applicable to any moments H of paragraph (a)(2) of this
angle within 20 of plane of
control). section. These loads need not exceed
Twist ................................... 133 in.lbs. (i) The loads corresponding to the
Push-pull ............................ To be chosen by applicant. maximum pilot loads in 25.397(c) for
*Limited to flap, tab, stabilizer, spoiler, and landing gear op- each pilot alone; or
eration controls. (ii) 0.75 times these maximum loads
for each pilot when the pilot forces are
25.407 Trim tab effects. applied in the same direction.
The effects of trim tabs on the con- (2) The control system stops nearest
trol surface design conditions must be the surfaces, the control system locks,
accounted for only where the surface and the parts of the systems (if any)
loads are limited by maximum pilot ef- between these stops and locks and the
fort. In these cases, the tabs are con- control surface horns, must be designed
sidered to be deflected in the direction for limit hinge moments H, in foot
that would assist the pilot, and the de- pounds, obtained from the formula,
flections are H=.0034KV2cS, where
(a) For elevator trim tabs, those re-
quired to trim the airplane at any V=65 (wind speed in knots)
K=limit hinge moment factor for ground
point within the positive portion of the
gusts derived in paragraph (b) of this sec-
pertinent flight envelope in 25.333(b), tion.
except as limited by the stops; and c=mean chord of the control surface aft of
(b) For aileron and rudder trim tabs, the hinge line (ft);
those required to trim the airplane in S=area of the control surface aft of the hinge
the critical unsymmetrical power and line (sq ft);

380

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00390 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.471

(b) The limit hinge moment factor K 25.445 Auxiliary aerodynamic sur-
for ground gusts must be derived as fol- faces.
lows: (a) When significant, the aero-
Surface K Position of controls dynamic influence between auxiliary
aerodynamic surfaces, such as out-
(a) Aileron ..................... 0.75 Control column locked board fins and winglets, and their sup-
or lashed in mid-posi-
tion.
porting aerodynamic surfaces, must be
(b) ......do ...................... 11 Ailerons at full throw. taken into account for all loading con-
0.50 ditions including pitch, roll, and yaw
(c) Elevator ................... 11 (c) Elevator full down. maneuvers, and gusts as specified in
0.75 25.341(a) acting at any orientation at
(d) ......do ...................... 11 (d) Elevator full up.
0.75
right angles to the flight path.
(e) Rudder .................... 0.75 (e) Rudder in neutral. (b) To provide for unsymmetrical
(f) ......do ....................... 0.75 (f) Rudder at full throw. loading when outboard fins extend
1 A positive value of K indicates a moment tending to de- above and below the horizontal surface,
press the surface, while a negative value of K indicates a mo- the critical vertical surface loading
ment tending to raise the surface. (load per unit area) determined under
25.391 must also be applied as follows:
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29776, July 20, (1) 100 percent to the area of the
1990; Amdt. 2591, 62 FR 40705, July 29, 1997] vertical surfaces above (or below) the
horizontal surface.
25.427 Unsymmetrical loads. (2) 80 percent to the area below (or
above) the horizontal surface.
(a) In designing the airplane for lat-
eral gust, yaw maneuver and roll ma- [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
neuver conditions, account must be amended by Amdt. 2586, 61 FR 5222, Feb. 9,
taken of unsymmetrical loads on the 1996]
empennage arising from effects such as
25.457 Wing flaps.
slipstream and aerodynamic inter-
ference with the wing, vertical fin and Wing flaps, their operating mecha-
other aerodynamic surfaces. nisms, and their supporting structures
(b) The horizontal tail must be as- must be designed for critical loads oc-
sumed to be subjected to unsymmet- curring in the conditions prescribed in
rical loading conditions determined as 25.345, accounting for the loads occur-
follows: ring during transition from one flap po-
sition and airspeed to another.
(1) 100 percent of the maximum load-
ing from the symmetrical maneuver 25.459 Special devices.
conditions of 25.331 and the vertical
gust conditions of 25.341(a) acting sep- The loading for special devices using
arately on the surface on one side of aerodynamic surfaces (such as slots,
the plane of symmetry; and slats and spoilers) must be determined
from test data.
(2) 80 percent of these loadings acting
on the other side. [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
(c) For empennage arrangements amended by Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29776, July 20,
where the horizontal tail surfaces have 1990]
dihedral angles greater than plus or
GROUND LOADS
minus 10 degrees, or are supported by
the vertical tail surfaces, the surfaces 25.471 General.
and the supporting structure must be
designed for gust velocities specified in (a) Loads and equilibrium. For limit
25.341(a) acting in any orientation at ground loads
right angles to the flight path. (1) Limit ground loads obtained
(d) Unsymmetrical loading on the under this subpart are considered to be
external forces applied to the airplane
empennage arising from buffet condi-
structure; and
tions of 25.305(e) must be taken into
account. (2) In each specified ground load con-
dition, the external loads must be
[Doc. No. 27902, 61 FR 5222, Feb. 9, 1996] placed in equilibrium with the linear

381

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00391 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.473 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

and angular inertia loads in a rational the presence of systems or procedures


or conservative manner. significantly affects the lift.
(b) Critical centers of gravity. The crit- (c) The method of analysis of air-
ical centers of gravity within the range plane and landing gear loads must take
for which certification is requested into account at least the following ele-
must be selected so that the maximum ments:
design loads are obtained in each land- (1) Landing gear dynamic character-
ing gear element. Fore and aft, istics.
vertical, and lateral airplane centers of (2) Spin-up and springback.
gravity must be considered. Lateral (3) Rigid body response.
displacements of the c.g. from the air- (4) Structural dynamic response of
plane centerline which would result in the airframe, if significant.
main gear loads not greater than 103 (d) The landing gear dynamic charac-
percent of the critical design load for teristics must be validated by tests as
symmetrical loading conditions may be defined in 25.723(a).
selected without considering the ef- (e) The coefficient of friction between
fects of these lateral c.g. displacements the tires and the ground may be estab-
on the loading of the main gear ele- lished by considering the effects of
ments, or on the airplane structure skidding velocity and tire pressure.
provided However, this coefficient of friction
(1) The lateral displacement of the need not be more than 0.8.
c.g. results from random passenger or [Amdt. 2591, 62 FR 40705, July 29, 1997; Amdt.
cargo disposition within the fuselage or 2591, 62 FR 45481, Aug. 27, 1997; Amdt 25103,
from random unsymmetrical fuel load- 66 FR 27394, May 16, 2001]
ing or fuel usage; and
(2) Appropriate loading instructions 25.477 Landing gear arrangement.
for random disposable loads are in- Sections 25.479 through 25.485 apply
cluded under the provisions of to airplanes with conventional ar-
25.1583(c)(1) to ensure that the lateral rangements of main and nose gears, or
displacement of the center of gravity is main and tail gears, when normal oper-
maintained within these limits. ating techniques are used.
(c) Landing gear dimension data. Fig-
ure 1 of appendix A contains the basic 25.479 Level landing conditions.
landing gear dimension data. (a) In the level attitude, the airplane
[Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5673, Apr. 8, 1970] is assumed to contact the ground at
forward velocity components, ranging
25.473 Landing load conditions and from VL1 to 1.25 VL2 parallel to the
assumptions. ground under the conditions prescribed
(a) For the landing conditions speci- in 25.473 with
fied in 25.479 to 25.485 the airplane is (1) VL1 equal to VS0 (TAS) at the ap-
assumed to contact the ground propriate landing weight and in stand-
(1) In the attitudes defined in 25.479 ard sea level conditions; and
and 25.481; (2) VL2 equal to VS0 (TAS) at the ap-
(2) With a limit descent velocity of 10 propriate landing weight and altitudes
fps at the design landing weight (the in a hot day temperature of 41 degrees
maximum weight for landing condi- F. above standard.
tions at maximum descent velocity); (3) The effects of increased contact
and speed must be investigated if approval
(3) With a limit descent velocity of 6 of downwind landings exceeding 10
fps at the design take-off weight (the knots is requested.
maximum weight for landing condi- (b) For the level landing attitude for
tions at a reduced descent velocity). airplanes with tail wheels, the condi-
(4) The prescribed descent velocities tions specified in this section must be
may be modified if it is shown that the investigated with the airplane hori-
airplane has design features that make zontal reference line horizontal in ac-
it impossible to develop these veloci- cordance with Figure 2 of Appendix A
ties. of this part.
(b) Airplane lift, not exceeding air- (c) For the level landing attitude for
plane weight, may be assumed unless airplanes with nose wheels, shown in

382

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00392 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.485

Figure 2 of Appendix A of this part, the (2) VL2 equal to VS0 (TAS) at the ap-
conditions specified in this section propriate landing weight and altitudes
must be investigated assuming the fol- in a hot day temperature of 41 degrees
lowing attitudes: F. above standard.
(1) An attitude in which the main (3) The combination of vertical and
wheels are assumed to contact the drag components considered to be act-
ground with the nose wheel just clear ing at the main wheel axle centerline.
of the ground; and (b) For the tail-down landing condi-
(2) If reasonably attainable at the tion for airplanes with tail wheels, the
specified descent and forward veloci- main and tail wheels are assumed to
ties, an attitude in which the nose and contact the ground simultaneously, in
main wheels are assumed to contact accordance with figure 3 of appendix A.
the ground simultaneously. Ground reaction conditions on the tail
(d) In addition to the loading condi- wheel are assumed to act
tions prescribed in paragraph (a) of this (1) Vertically; and
section, but with maximum vertical (2) Up and aft through the axle at 45
ground reactions calculated from para- degrees to the ground line.
graph (a), the following apply: (c) For the tail-down landing condi-
(1) The landing gear and directly af- tion for airplanes with nose wheels, the
fected attaching structure must be de- airplane is assumed to be at an atti-
signed for the maximum vertical tude corresponding to either the stall-
ground reaction combined with an aft ing angle or the maximum angle allow-
acting drag component of not less than ing clearance with the ground by each
25% of this maximum vertical ground part of the airplane other than the
reaction. main wheels, in accordance with figure
(2) The most severe combination of 3 of appendix A, whichever is less.
loads that are likely to arise during a [Docket No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
lateral drift landing must be taken amended by Amdt. 2591, 62 FR 40705, July 29,
into account. In absence of a more ra- 1997; Amdt. 2594, 63 FR 8848, Feb. 23, 1998]
tional analysis of this condition, the
following must be investigated: 25.483 One-gear landing conditions.
(i) A vertical load equal to 75% of the For the one-gear landing conditions,
maximum ground reaction of 25.473 the airplane is assumed to be in the
must be considered in combination level attitude and to contact the
with a drag and side load of 40% and ground on one main landing gear, in
25% respectively of that vertical load. accordance with Figure 4 of Appendix
(ii) The shock absorber and tire de- A of this part. In this attitude
flections must be assumed to be 75% of (a) The ground reactions must be the
the deflection corresponding to the same as those obtained on that side
maximum ground reaction of under 25.479(d)(1), and
25.473(a)(2). This load case need not be (b) Each unbalanced external load
considered in combination with flat must be reacted by airplane inertia in
tires. a rational or conservative manner.
(3) The combination of vertical and
[Docket No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
drag components is considered to be
amended by Amdt. 2591, 62 FR 40705, July 29,
acting at the wheel axle centerline. 1997]
[Amdt. 2591, 62 FR 40705, July 29, 1997; Amdt.
2591, 62 FR 45481, Aug. 27, 1997] 25.485 Side load conditions.
In addition to 25.479(d)(2) the fol-
25.481 Tail-down landing conditions. lowing conditions must be considered:
(a) In the tail-down attitude, the air- (a) For the side load condition, the
plane is assumed to contact the ground airplane is assumed to be in the level
at forward velocity components, rang- attitude with only the main wheels
ing from VL1 to VL2 parallel to the contacting the ground, in accordance
ground under the conditions prescribed with figure 5 of appendix A.
in 25.473 with (b) Side loads of 0.8 of the vertical re-
(1) VL1 equal to VS0 (TAS) at the ap- action (on one side) acting inward and
propriate landing weight and in stand- 0.6 of the vertical reaction (on the
ard sea level conditions; and other side) acting outward must be

383

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00393 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.487 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

combined with one-half of the max- accordance with figure 6 of appendix A.


imum vertical ground reactions ob- The limit vertical load factor is 1.2 at
tained in the level landing conditions. the design landing weight and 1.0 at
These loads are assumed to be applied the design ramp weight. A drag reac-
at the ground contact point and to be tion equal to the vertical reaction mul-
resisted by the inertia of the airplane. tiplied by a coefficient of friction of
The drag loads may be assumed to be 0.8, must be combined with the vertical
zero. ground reaction and applied at the
[Docket No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as ground contact point.
amended by Amdt. 2591, 62 FR 40705, July 29, (b) For an airplane with a nose wheel
1997] the limit vertical load factor is 1.2 at
the design landing weight, and 1.0 at
25.487 Rebound landing condition.
the design ramp weight. A drag reac-
(a) The landing gear and its sup- tion equal to the vertical reaction,
porting structure must be investigated multiplied by a coefficient of friction
for the loads occurring during rebound of 0.8, must be combined with the
of the airplane from the landing sur- vertical reaction and applied at the
face. ground contact point of each wheel
(b) With the landing gear fully ex-
with brakes. The following two atti-
tended and not in contact with the
tudes, in accordance with figure 6 of
ground, a load factor of 20.0 must act
appendix A, must be considered:
on the unsprung weights of the landing
gear. This load factor must act in the (1) The level attitude with the wheels
direction of motion of the unsprung contacting the ground and the loads
weights as they reach their limiting distributed between the main and nose
positions in extending with relation to gear. Zero pitching acceleration is as-
the sprung parts of the landing gear. sumed.
(2) The level attitude with only the
25.489 Ground handling conditions. main gear contacting the ground and
Unless otherwise prescribed, the with the pitching moment resisted by
landing gear and airplane structure angular acceleration.
must be investigated for the conditions (c) A drag reaction lower than that
in 25.491 through 25.509 with the air- prescribed in this section may be used
plane at the design ramp weight (the if it is substantiated that an effective
maximum weight for ground handling drag force of 0.8 times the vertical re-
conditions). No wing lift may be con- action cannot be attained under any
sidered. The shock absorbers and tires likely loading condition.
may be assumed to be in their static (d) An airplane equipped with a nose
position. gear must be designed to withstand the
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as loads arising from the dynamic pitch-
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5673, Apr. 8, ing motion of the airplane due to sud-
1970] den application of maximum braking
force. The airplane is considered to be
25.491 Taxi, takeoff and landing roll. at design takeoff weight with the nose
Within the range of appropriate and main gears in contact with the
ground speeds and approved weights, ground, and with a steady-state
the airplane structure and landing gear vertical load factor of 1.0. The steady-
are assumed to be subjected to loads state nose gear reaction must be com-
not less than those obtained when the bined with the maximum incremental
aircraft is operating over the roughest nose gear vertical reaction caused by
ground that may reasonably be ex- the sudden application of maximum
pected in normal operation. braking force as described in para-
[Amdt. 2591, 62 FR 40705, July 29, 1997] graphs (b) and (c) of this section.
(e) In the absence of a more rational
25.493 Braked roll conditions. analysis, the nose gear vertical reac-
(a) An airplane with a tail wheel is tion prescribed in paragraph (d) of this
assumed to be in the level attitude section must be calculated according
with the load on the main wheels, in to the following formula:

384

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00394 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.499

25.499 Nose-wheel yaw and steering.


WT fAE
VN = B + (a) A vertical load factor of 1.0 at the
A+B A + B + E airplane center of gravity, and a side
Where: component at the nose wheel ground
VN=Nose gear vertical reaction.
contact equal to 0.8 of the vertical
WT=Design takeoff weight. ground reaction at that point are as-
A=Horizontal distance between the c.g. of sumed.
the airplane and the nose wheel. (b) With the airplane assumed to be
B=Horizontal distance between the c.g. of in static equilibrium with the loads re-
the airplane and the line joining the cen-
ters of the main wheels. sulting from the use of brakes on one
E=Vertical height of the c.g. of the airplane side of the main landing gear, the nose
above the ground in the 1.0 g static condi- gear, its attaching structure, and the
tion. fuselage structure forward of the cen-
=Coefficient of friction of 0.80. ter of gravity must be designed for the
f=Dynamic response factor; 2.0 is to be used
unless a lower factor is substantiated. In
following loads:
the absence of other information, the dy- (1) A vertical load factor at the cen-
namic response factor f may be defined by ter of gravity of 1.0.
the equation: (2) A forward acting load at the air-
plane center of gravity of 0.8 times the
vertical load on one main gear.
f = 1 + exp (3) Side and vertical loads at the
1 2
ground contact point on the nose gear
that are required for static equi-
Where:
librium.
x is the effective critical damping ratio of
the rigid body pitching mode about the
(4) A side load factor at the airplane
main landing gear effective ground contact center of gravity of zero.
point. (c) If the loads prescribed in para-
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as graph (b) of this section result in a
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5673, Apr. 8, nose gear side load higher than 0.8
1970; Amdt. 2597, 63 FR 29072, May 27, 1998] times the vertical nose gear load, the
design nose gear side load may be lim-
25.495 Turning. ited to 0.8 times the vertical load, with
In the static position, in accordance unbalanced yawing moments assumed
with figure 7 of appendix A, the air- to be resisted by airplane inertia
plane is assumed to execute a steady forces.
turn by nose gear steering, or by appli- (d) For other than the nose gear, its
cation of sufficient differential power, attaching structure, and the forward
so that the limit load factors applied at fuselage structure, the loading condi-
the center of gravity are 1.0 vertically tions are those prescribed in paragraph
and 0.5 laterally. The side ground reac- (b) of this section, except that
tion of each wheel must be 0.5 of the (1) A lower drag reaction may be used
vertical reaction.
if an effective drag force of 0.8 times
25.497 Tail-wheel yawing. the vertical reaction cannot be reached
under any likely loading condition; and
(a) A vertical ground reaction equal
(2) The forward acting load at the
to the static load on the tail wheel, in
combination with a side component of center of gravity need not exceed the
equal magnitude, is assumed. maximum drag reaction on one main
(b) If there is a swivel, the tail wheel gear, determined in accordance with
is assumed to be swiveled 90 to the air- 25.493(b).
plane longitudinal axis with the result- (e) With the airplane at design ramp
ant load passing through the axle. weight, and the nose gear in any steer-
(c) If there is a lock, steering device, able position, the combined application
or shimmy damper the tail wheel is of full normal steering torque and
also assumed to be in the trailing posi- vertical force equal to 1.33 times the
ER27MY98.018</GPH>

tion with the side load acting at the maximum static reaction on the nose
ground contact point. gear must be considered in designing

385
ER27MY98.017</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00395 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.503 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

the nose gear, its attaching structure, (1) A vertical load factor equal to 1.0
and the forward fuselage structure. must be considered acting at the center
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
of gravity;
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5673, Apr. 8, (2) The shock struts and tires must
1970; Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50595, Oct. 30, 1978; be in their static positions; and
Amdt. 2591, 62 FR 40705, July 29, 1997] (3) With WT as the design ramp
weight, the towing load, FTOW, is
25.503 Pivoting. (i) 0.3 WT for WT less than 30,000
(a) The airplane is assumed to pivot pounds;
about one side of the main gear with (ii) (6WT+450,000)/7 for WT between
the brakes on that side locked. The 30,000 and 100,000 pounds; and
limit vertical load factor must be 1.0 (iii) 0.15 WT for WT over 100,000
and the coefficient of friction 0.8. pounds.
(b) The airplane is assumed to be in (b) For towing points not on the
static equilibrium, with the loads being landing gear but near the plane of sym-
applied at the ground contact points, metry of the airplane, the drag and
in accordance with figure 8 of appendix side tow load components specified for
A. the auxiliary gear apply. For towing
points located outboard of the main
25.507 Reversed braking. gear, the drag and side tow load compo-
(a) The airplane must be in a three nents specified for the main gear apply.
point static ground attitude. Hori- Where the specified angle of swivel
zontal reactions parallel to the ground cannot be reached, the maximum ob-
and directed forward must be applied tainable angle must be used.
at the ground contact point of each (c) The towing loads specified in
wheel with brakes. The limit loads paragraph (d) of this section must be
must be equal to 0.55 times the vertical reacted as follows:
load at each wheel or to the load devel- (1) The side component of the towing
oped by 1.2 times the nominal max- load at the main gear must be reacted
imum static brake torque, whichever is by a side force at the static ground line
less. of the wheel to which the load is ap-
(b) For airplanes with nose wheels, plied.
the pitching moment must be balanced (2) The towing loads at the auxiliary
by rotational inertia. gear and the drag components of the
(c) For airplanes with tail wheels, the towing loads at the main gear must be
resultant of the ground reactions must reacted as follows:
pass through the center of gravity of (i) A reaction with a maximum value
the airplane. equal to the vertical reaction must be
applied at the axle of the wheel to
25.509 Towing loads. which the load is applied. Enough air-
(a) The towing loads specified in plane inertia to achieve equilibrium
paragraph (d) of this section must be must be applied.
considered separately. These loads (ii) The loads must be reacted by air-
must be applied at the towing fittings plane inertia.
and must act parallel to the ground. In (d) The prescribed towing loads are as
addition follows:
Load
Tow point Position
Magnitude No. Direction

Main gear ............................... ................................................ 0.75 FTOW per main 1 Forward, parallel to drag axis.
gear unit. 2 Forward, at 30 to drag axis.
3 Aft, parallel to drag axis.
4 Aft, at 30 to drag axis.
Auxiliary gear ......................... Swiveled forward .................... 1.0 FTOW .................. 5 Forward.
6 Aft.
Swiveled aft ............................ ......do ....................... 7 Forward.
8 Aft.
Swiveled 45 from forward ..... 0.5 FTOW .................. 9 Forward, in plane of wheel.
10 Aft, in plane of wheel.

386

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00396 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.511

Load
Tow point Position
Magnitude No. Direction

Swiveled 45 from aft ............. ......do ....................... 11 Forward, in plane of wheel.


12 Aft, in plane of wheel.

[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5673, Apr. 8, 1970]

25.511 Ground load: unsymmetrical considered with the nose gear unit on
loads on multiple-wheel units. either slope of the crown.
(a) General. Multiple-wheel landing (5) The airplane attitude.
gear units are assumed to be subjected (6) Any structural deflections.
to the limit ground loads prescribed in (c) Deflated tires. The effect of de-
this subpart under paragraphs (b) flated tires on the structure must be
through (f) of this section. In addi- considered with respect to the loading
tion conditions specified in paragraphs (d)
(1) A tandem strut gear arrangement through (f) of this section, taking into
is a multiple-wheel unit; and account the physical arrangement of
(2) In determining the total load on a the gear components. In addition
gear unit with respect to the provisions (1) The deflation of any one tire for
of paragraphs (b) through (f) of this each multiple wheel landing gear unit,
section, the transverse shift in the load and the deflation of any two critical
centroid, due to unsymmetrical load tires for each landing gear unit using
distribution on the wheels, may be ne- four or more wheels per unit, must be
glected. considered; and
(b) Distribution of limit loads to wheels; (2) The ground reactions must be ap-
tires inflated. The distribution of the plied to the wheels with inflated tires
limit loads among the wheels of the except that, for multiple-wheel gear
landing gear must be established for units with more than one shock strut,
each landing, taxiing, and ground han- a rational distribution of the ground
dling condition, taking into account reactions between the deflated and in-
the effects of the following factors:
flated tires, accounting for the dif-
(1) The number of wheels and their
ferences in shock strut extensions re-
physical arrangements. For truck type
sulting from a deflated tire, may be
landing gear units, the effects of any
used.
seesaw motion of the truck during the
landing impact must be considered in (d) Landing conditions. For one and
determining the maximum design loads for two deflated tires, the applied load
for the fore and aft wheel pairs. to each gear unit is assumed to be 60
(2) Any differentials in tire diameters percent and 50 percent, respectively, of
resulting from a combination of manu- the limit load applied to each gear for
facturing tolerances, tire growth, and each of the prescribed landing condi-
tire wear. A maximum tire-diameter tions. However, for the drift landing
differential equal to 23 of the most un- condition of 25.485, 100 percent of the
favorable combination of diameter vertical load must be applied.
variations that is obtained when tak- (e) Taxiing and ground handling condi-
ing into account manufacturing toler- tions. For one and for two deflated
ances, tire growth, and tire wear, may tires
be assumed. (1) The applied side or drag load fac-
(3) Any unequal tire inflation pres- tor, or both factors, at the center of
sure, assuming the maximum variation gravity must be the most critical value
to be 5 percent of the nominal tire in- up to 50 percent and 40 percent, respec-
flation pressure. tively, of the limit side or drag load
(4) A runway crown of zero and a run- factors, or both factors, corresponding
way crown having a convex upward to the most severe condition resulting
shape that may be approximated by a from consideration of the prescribed
slope of 112 percent with the hori- taxiing and ground handling condi-
zontal. Runway crown effects must be tions;

387

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00397 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.519 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(2) For the braked roll conditions of static reaction applied in any direc-
25.493 (a) and (b)(2), the drag loads on tion.
each inflated tire may not be less than (c) Tie-down. If tie-down points are
those at each tire for the symmetrical provided, the main tie-down points and
load distribution with no deflated tires; local structure must withstand the
(3) The vertical load factor at the limit loads resulting from a 65-knot
center of gravity must be 60 percent horizontal wind from any direction.
and 50 percent, respectively, of the fac- [Doc. No. 26129, 59 FR 22102, Apr. 28, 1994]
tor with no deflated tires, except that
it may not be less than 1g; and WATER LOADS
(4) Pivoting need not be considered.
(f) Towing conditions. For one and for 25.521 General.
two deflated tires, the towing load, (a) Seaplanes must be designed for
FTOW, must be 60 percent and 50 per- the water loads developed during take-
cent, respectively, of the load pre- off and landing, with the seaplane in
scribed. any attitude likely to occur in normal
operation, and at the appropriate for-
25.519 Jacking and tie-down provi- ward and sinking velocities under the
sions. most severe sea conditions likely to be
(a) General. The airplane must be de- encountered.
signed to withstand the limit load con- (b) Unless a more rational analysis of
ditions resulting from the static the water loads is made, or the stand-
ground load conditions of paragraph (b) ards in ANC3 are used, 25.523
of this section and, if applicable, para- through 25.537 apply.
graph (c) of this section at the most (c) The requirements of this section
critical combinations of airplane and 25.523 through 25.537 apply also to
weight and center of gravity. The max- amphibians.
imum allowable load at each jack pad
must be specified. 25.523 Design weights and center of
gravity positions.
(b) Jacking. The airplane must have
provisions for jacking and must with- (a) Design weights. The water load re-
stand the following limit loads when quirements must be met at each oper-
the airplane is supported on jacks ating weight up to the design landing
(1) For jacking by the landing gear at weight except that, for the takeoff con-
the maximum ramp weight of the air- dition prescribed in 25.531, the design
plane, the airplane structure must be water takeoff weight (the maximum
designed for a vertical load of 1.33 weight for water taxi and takeoff run)
times the vertical static reaction at must be used.
each jacking point acting singly and in (b) Center of gravity positions. The
combination with a horizontal load of critical centers of gravity within the
0.33 times the vertical static reaction limits for which certification is re-
applied in any direction. quested must be considered to reach
(2) For jacking by other airplane maximum design loads for each part of
structure at maximum approved jack- the seaplane structure.
ing weight: [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
(i) The airplane structure must be de- amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5673, Apr. 8,
signed for a vertical load of 1.33 times 1970]
the vertical reaction at each jacking
point acting singly and in combination 25.525 Application of loads.
with a horizontal load of 0.33 times the (a) Unless otherwise prescribed, the
vertical static reaction applied in any seaplane as a whole is assumed to be
direction. subjected to the loads corresponding to
(ii) The jacking pads and local struc- the load factors specified in 25.527.
ture must be designed for a vertical (b) In applying the loads resulting
load of 2.0 times the vertical static re- from the load factors prescribed in
action at each jacking point, acting 25.527, the loads may be distributed
singly and in combination with a hori- over the hull or main float bottom (in
zontal load of 0.33 times the vertical order to avoid excessive local shear

388

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00398 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.529

loads and bending moments at the lo- load factor is being computed to the ra-
cation of water load application) using dius of gyration in pitch of the sea-
pressures not less than those pre- plane, the hull reference axis being a
scribed in 25.533(b). straight line, in the plane of sym-
(c) For twin float seaplanes, each metry, tangential to the keel at the
float must be treated as an equivalent main step.
hull on a fictitious seaplane with a (c) For a twin float seaplane, because
weight equal to one-half the weight of of the effect of flexibility of the attach-
the twin float seaplane. ment of the floats to the seaplane, the
(d) Except in the takeoff condition of factor K1 may be reduced at the bow
25.531, the aerodynamic lift on the and stern to 0.8 of the value shown in
seaplane during the impact is assumed figure 2 of appendix B. This reduction
to be 23 of the weight of the seaplane. applies only to the design of the carry-
through and seaplane structure.
25.527 Hull and main float load fac-
tors. [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5673, Apr. 8,
(a) Water reaction load factors nW
1970]
must be computed in the following
manner: 25.529 Hull and main float landing
(1) For the step landing case conditions.
C1VS 0 2 (a) Symmetrical step, bow, and stern
nw = landing. For symmetrical step, bow,
Tan W
2
3
1
3
and stern landings, the limit water re-
action load factors are those computed
under 25.527. In addition
(2) For the bow and stern landing (1) For symmetrical step landings,
cases the resultant water load must be ap-
plied at the keel, through the center of
C1VS 0 2 K1 gravity, and must be directed per-
nw = 1 2 pendicularly to the keel line;
Tan W
2

(1 + rx )
3 3
3 2 (2) For symmetrical bow landings,
the resultant water load must be ap-
(b) The following values are used: plied at the keel, one-fifth of the longi-
(1) nW=water reaction load factor tudinal distance from the bow to the
(that is, the water reaction divided by step, and must be directed perpendicu-
seaplane weight). larly to the keel line; and
(2) C1=empirical seaplane operations (3) For symmetrical stern landings,
factor equal to 0.012 (except that this the resultant water load must be ap-
factor may not be less than that nec- plied at the keel, at a point 85 percent
essary to obtain the minimum value of of the longitudinal distance from the
step load factor of 2.33). step to the stern post, and must be di-
(3) VS0=seaplane stalling speed in rected perpendicularly to the keel line.
knots with flaps extended in the appro- (b) Unsymmetrical landing for hull and
priate landing position and with no single float seaplanes. Unsymmetrical
slipstream effect. step, bow, and stern landing conditions
(4) b=angle of dead rise at the longi- must be investigated. In addition
tudinal station at which the load fac- (1) The loading for each condition
tor is being determined in accordance consists of an upward component and a
with figure 1 of appendix B. side component equal, respectively, to
(5) W= seaplane design landing 0.75 and 0.25 tan b times the resultant
weight in pounds. load in the corresponding symmetrical
(6) K1=empirical hull station weigh- landing condition; and
ing factor, in accordance with figure 2 (2) The point of application and di-
of appendix B. rection of the upward component of the
(7) rx=ratio of distance, measured load is the same as that in the sym-
EC28SE91.037</MATH>

parallel to hull reference axis, from the metrical condition, and the point of ap-
center of gravity of the seaplane to the plication of the side component is at
hull longitudinal station at which the the same longitudinal station as the

389
EC28SE91.036</MATH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00399 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.531 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

upward component but is directed in- in accordance with figure 3 of appendix


ward perpendicularly to the plane of B. The pressure at the keel (psi) is
symmetry at a point midway between computed as follows:
the keel and chine lines.
(c) Unsymmetrical landing; twin float K 2 VS12
seaplanes. The unsymmetrical loading Pk = C2
consists of an upward load at the step tan k
of each float of 0.75 and a side load of where
0.25 tan b at one float times the step
Pk=pressure (p.s.i.) at the keel;
landing load reached under 25.527. The
C2=0.00213;
side load is directed inboard, per-
K2=hull station weighing factor, in accord-
pendicularly to the plane of symmetry
ance with figure 2 of appendix B;
midway between the keel and chine
VS1=seaplane stalling speed (Knots) at the
lines of the float, at the same longitu- design water takeoff weight with flaps ex-
dinal station as the upward load. tended in the appropriate takeoff position;
and
25.531 Hull and main float takeoff
condition. bK=angle of dead rise at keel, in accordance
with figure 1 of appendix B.
For the wing and its attachment to
the hull or main float (2) For a flared bottom, the pressure
(a) The aerodynamic wing lift is as- at the beginning of the flare is the
sumed to be zero; and same as that for an unflared bottom,
(b) A downward inertia load, cor- and the pressure between the chine and
responding to a load factor computed the beginning of the flare varies lin-
from the following formula, must be early, in accordance with figure 3 of ap-
applied: pendix B. The pressure distribution is
the same as that prescribed in para-
C TO VS12 graph (b)(1) of this section for an
n= unflared bottom except that the pres-
tan 23 W 13
sure at the chine is computed as fol-
lows:
where
n=inertia load factor; K 2 VS12
CTO=empirical seaplane operations factor Pch = C3
equal to 0.004; tan
VS1=seaplane stalling speed (knots) at the de-
where
sign takeoff weight with the flaps extended
in the appropriate takeoff position; Pch=pressure (p.s.i.) at the chine;
b=angle of dead rise at the main step (de- C3=0.0016;
grees); and K2=hull station weighing factor, in accord-
W=design water takeoff weight in pounds. ance with figure 2 of appendix B;
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as VS1=seaplane stalling speed at the design
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5673, Apr. 8, water takeoff weight with flaps extended
1970] in the appropriate takeoff position; and
b=angle of dead rise at appropriate station.
25.533 Hull and main float bottom
pressures. The area over which these pressures
(a) General. The hull and main float are applied must simulate pressures oc-
structure, including frames and bulk- curring during high localized impacts
heads, stringers, and bottom plating, on the hull or float, but need not ex-
must be designed under this section. tend over an area that would induce
(b) Local pressures. For the design of critical stresses in the frames or in the
EC28SE91.040</MATH>

the bottom plating and stringers and overall structure.


their attachments to the supporting (c) Distributed pressures. For the de-
structure, the following pressure dis- sign of the frames, keel, and chine
tributions must be applied: structure, the following pressure dis-
(1) For an unflared bottom, the pres- tributions apply:
EC28SE91.039</MATH>

sure at the chine is 0.75 times the pres- (1) Symmetrical pressures are com-
sure at the keel, and the pressures be-
puted as follows:
tween the keel and chine vary linearly,

390
EC28SE91.038</MATH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00400 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.535

K 2 VS 0 2 2
P = C4 C5 VS 2 W 3
tan L = 0
2

( )
2
2 3
where tan s 1 + ry
3
P=pressure (p.s.i.);
C4=0.078 C1 (with C1 computed under 25.527); where
K2=hull station weighing factor, determined L=limit load (lbs.);
in accordance with figure 2 of appendix B; C5=0.0053;
VS0=seaplane stalling speed (Knots) with VS0=seaplane stalling speed (knots) with
landing flaps extended in the appropriate landing flaps extended in the appropriate
position and with no slipstream effect; and position and with no slipstream effect;
VS0=seaplane stalling speed with landing W=seaplane design landing weight in pounds;
flaps extended in the appropriate position
bS=angle of dead rise at a station 34 of the
and with no slipstream effect; and b=angle
distance from the bow to the step, but need
of dead rise at appropriate station.
not be less than 15 degrees; and
(2) The unsymmetrical pressure dis- ry=ratio of the lateral distance between the
tribution consists of the pressures pre- center of gravity and the plane of sym-
scribed in paragraph (c)(1) of this sec- metry of the float to the radius of gyration
tion on one side of the hull or main in roll.
float centerline and one-half of that (c) Bow loading. The resultant limit
pressure on the other side of the hull or load must be applied in the plane of
main float centerline, in accordance symmetry of the float at a point one-
with figure 3 of appendix B. fourth of the distance from the bow to
These pressures are uniform and must the step and must be perpendicular to
be applied simultaneously over the en- the tangent to the keel line at that
tire hull or main float bottom. The point. The magnitude of the resultant
loads obtained must be carried into the load is that specified in paragraph (b)
sidewall structure of the hull proper, of this section.
but need not be transmitted in a fore (d) Unsymmetrical step loading. The re-
and aft direction as shear and bending sultant water load consists of a compo-
loads. nent equal to 0.75 times the load speci-
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as fied in paragraph (a) of this section and
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5673, Apr. 8, a side component equal to 3.25 tan b
1970] times the load specified in paragraph
(b) of this section. The side load must
25.535 Auxiliary float loads.
be applied perpendicularly to the plane
(a) General. Auxiliary floats and their of symmetry of the float at a point
attachments and supporting structures midway between the keel and the
must be designed for the conditions chine.
prescribed in this section. In the cases (e) Unsymmetrical bow loading. The re-
specified in paragraphs (b) through (e) sultant water load consists of a compo-
of this section, the prescribed water nent equal to 0.75 times the load speci-
loads may be distributed over the float fied in paragraph (b) of this section and
bottom to avoid excessive local loads, a side component equal to 0.25 tan b
using bottom pressures not less than times the load specified in paragraph
those prescribed in paragraph (g) of
(c) of this section. The side load must
this section.
be applied perpendicularly to the plane
(b) Step loading. The resultant water
of symmetry at a point midway be-
load must be applied in the plane of
tween the keel and the chine.
symmetry of the float at a point three-
fourths of the distance from the bow to (f) Immersed float condition. The re-
the step and must be perpendicular to sultant load must be applied at the
the keel. The resultant limit load is centroid of the cross section of the
computed as follows, except that the float at a point one-third of the dis-
tance from the bow to the step. The
EC28SE91.042</MATH>

value of L need not exceed three times


the weight of the displaced water when limit load components are as follows:
the float is completely submerged:

391
EC28SE91.041</MATH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00401 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.537 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
(ii) Forward, 9.0g
vertical= gV (iii) Sideward, 3.0g on the airframe;
2 and 4.0g on the seats and their attach-
2
aft = Cx 2 V KVS
3 ments.
0
(iv) Downward, 6.0g
(v) Rearward, 1.5g
2 2 (c) For equipment, cargo in the pas-
side = Cy 2 V KVS
3
senger compartments and any other
0 large masses, the following apply:
where (1) Except as provided in paragraph
=mass density of water (slugs/ft.2); (c)(2) of this section, these items must
V=volume of float (ft.2); be positioned so that if they break
Cx=coefficient of drag force, equal to 0.133; loose they will be unlikely to:
Cy=coefficient of side force, equal to 0.106; (i) Cause direct injury to occupants;
K=0.8, except that lower values may be used (ii) Penetrate fuel tanks or lines or
if it is shown that the floats are incapable
cause fire or explosion hazard by dam-
of submerging at a speed of 0.8 VS0 in nor-
mal operations; age to adjacent systems; or
VS0=seaplane stalling speed (knots) with (iii) Nullify any of the escape facili-
landing flaps extended in the appropriate ties provided for use after an emer-
position and with no slipstream effect; and gency landing.
g=acceleration due to gravity (ft./sec.2). (2) When such positioning is not prac-
(g) Float bottom pressures. The float tical (e.g. fuselage mounted engines or
bottom pressures must be established auxiliary power units) each such item
under 25.533, except that the value of of mass shall be restrained under all
K2 in the formulae may be taken as 1.0. loads up to those specified in paragraph
The angle of dead rise to be used in de- (b)(3) of this section. The local attach-
termining the float bottom pressures is ments for these items should be de-
set forth in paragraph (b) of this sec- signed to withstand 1.33 times the spec-
tion. ified loads if these items are subject to
severe wear and tear through frequent
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as removal (e.g. quick change interior
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5673, Apr. 8,
1970]
items).
(d) Seats and items of mass (and
25.537 Seawing loads. their supporting structure) must not
deform under any loads up to those
Seawing design loads must be based
specified in paragraph (b)(3) of this sec-
on applicable test data.
tion in any manner that would impede
EMERGENCY LANDING CONDITIONS subsequent rapid evacuation of occu-
pants.
25.561 General.
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
(a) The airplane, although it may be amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5673, Apr. 8,
damaged in emergency landing condi- 1970; Amdt. 2564, 53 FR 17646, May 17, 1988;
tions on land or water, must be de- Amdt. 2591, 62 FR 40706, July 29, 1997]
signed as prescribed in this section to
protect each occupant under those con- 25.562 Emergency landing dynamic
ditions. conditions.
(b) The structure must be designed to (a) The seat and restraint system in
give each occupant every reasonable the airplane must be designed as pre-
chance of escaping serious injury in a scribed in this section to protect each
minor crash landing when occupant during an emergency landing
(1) Proper use is made of seats, belts, condition when
and all other safety design provisions; (1) Proper use is made of seats, safety
(2) The wheels are retracted (where belts, and shoulder harnesses provided
applicable); and for in the design; and
(3) The occupant experiences the fol- (2) The occupant is exposed to loads
lowing ultimate inertia forces acting resulting from the conditions pre-
separately relative to the surrounding scribed in this section.
structure: (b) Each seat type design approved
(i) Upward, 3.0g for crew or passenger occupancy during

392
EC28SE91.043</MATH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00402 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.562

takeoff and landing must successfully fittings must be misaligned with re-
complete dynamic tests or be dem- spect to the adjacent set of rails or fit-
onstrated by rational analysis based on tings by at least 10 degrees vertically
dynamic tests of a similar type seat, in (i.e., out of Parallel) with one rolled 10
accordance with each of the following degrees.
emergency landing conditions. The (c) The following performance meas-
tests must be conducted with an occu- ures must not be exceeded during the
pant simulated by a 170-pound dynamic tests conducted in accordance
anthropomorphic test dummy, as de- with paragraph (b) of this section:
fined by 49 CFR Part 572, Subpart B, or (1) Where upper torso straps are used
its equivalent, sitting in the normal for crewmembers, tension loads in indi-
upright position. vidual straps must not exceed 1,750
(1) A change in downward vertical ve- pounds. If dual straps are used for re-
locity (D v) of not less than 35 feet per straining the upper torso, the total
second, with the airplanes longitu- strap tension loads must not exceed
dinal axis canted downward 30 degrees 2,000 pounds.
with respect to the horizontal plane
(2) The maximum compressive load
and with the wings level. Peak floor de-
measured between the pelvis and the
celeration must occur in not more than
0.08 seconds after impact and must lumbar column of the anthropomorphic
reach a minimum of 14g. dummy must not exceed 1,500 pounds.
(2) A change in forward longitudinal (3) The upper torso restraint straps
velocity (D v) of not less than 44 feet (where installed) must remain on the
per second, with the airplanes longitu- occupants shoulder during the impact.
dinal axis horizontal and yawed 10 de- (4) The lap safety belt must remain
grees either right or left, whichever on the occupants pelvis during the im-
would cause the greatest likelihood of pact.
the upper torso restraint system (5) Each occupant must be protected
(where installed) moving off the occu- from serious head injury under the con-
pants shoulder, and with the wings ditions prescribed in paragraph (b) of
level. Peak floor deceleration must this section. Where head contact with
occur in not more than 0.09 seconds seats or other structure can occur, pro-
after impact and must reach a min- tection must be provided so that the
imum of 16g. Where floor rails or floor head impact does not exceed a Head In-
fittings are used to attach the seating jury Criterion (HIC) of 1,000 units. The
devices to the test fixture, the rails or level of HIC is defined by the equation:

1
2 .5

HIC = ( t 2 t 1 )
t2
a(t )dt
( t 2 t 1 ) t1
max

Where: (7) The seat must remain attached at


t1 is the initial integration time, all points of attachment, although the
t2 is the final integration time, and structure may have yielded.
a(t) is the total acceleration vs. time curve (8) Seats must not yield under the
for the head strike, and where tests specified in paragraphs (b)(1) and
(t) is in seconds, and (a) is in units of gravity (b)(2) of this section to the extent they
(g).
would impede rapid evacuation of the
(6) Where leg injuries may result airplane occupants.
from contact with seats or other struc- [Amdt. 2564, 53 FR 17646, May 17, 1988]
ture, protection must be provided to
prevent axially compressive loads ex-
ceeding 2,250 pounds in each femur.

393
EC28SE91.044</MATH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00403 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.563 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

25.563 Structural ditching provi- ness Limitations Section of the In-


sions. structions for Continued Airworthiness
Structural strength considerations of required by 25.1529. Inspection thresh-
ditching provisions must be in accord- olds for the following types of struc-
ance with 25.801(e). ture must be established based on
crack growth analyses and/or tests, as-
FATIGUE EVALUATION suming the structure contains an ini-
tial flaw of the maximum probable size
25.571 Damagetolerance and fa- that could exist as a result of manufac-
tigue evaluation of structure.
turing or service-induced damage:
(a) General. An evaluation of the (i) Single load path structure, and
strength, detail design, and fabrication (ii) Multiple load path fail-safe
must show that catastrophic failure structure and crack arrest fail-safe
due to fatigue, corrosion, manufac- structure, where it cannot be dem-
turing defects, or accidental damage, onstrated that load path failure, par-
will be avoided throughout the oper- tial failure, or crack arrest will be de-
ational life of the airplane. This eval- tected and repaired during normal
uation must be conducted in accord- maintenance, inspection, or operation
ance with the provisions of paragraphs of an airplane prior to failure of the re-
(b) and (e) of this section, except as maining structure.
specified in paragraph (c) of this sec-
(b) Damage-tolerance evaluation. The
tion, for each part of the structure that
evaluation must include a determina-
could contribute to a catastrophic fail-
tion of the probable locations and
ure (such as wing, empennage, control
modes of damage due to fatigue, corro-
surfaces and their systems, the fuse-
lage, engine mounting, landing gear, sion, or accidental damage. Repeated
and their related primary attach- load and static analyses supported by
ments). For turbojet powered air- test evidence and (if available) service
planes, those parts that could con- experience must also be incorporated
tribute to a catastrophic failure must in the evaluation. Special consider-
also be evaluated under paragraph (d) ation for widespread fatigue damage
of this section. In addition, the fol- must be included where the design is
lowing apply: such that this type of damage could
(1) Each evaluation required by this occur. It must be demonstrated with
section must include sufficient full-scale fatigue test evi-
(i) The typical loading spectra, tem- dence that widespread fatigue damage
peratures, and humidities expected in will not occur within the design service
service; goal of the airplane. The type certifi-
(ii) The identification of principal cate may be issued prior to completion
structural elements and detail design of full-scale fatigue testing, provided
points, the failure of which could cause the Administrator has approved a plan
catastrophic failure of the airplane; for completing the required tests, and
and the airworthiness limitations section
(iii) An analysis, supported by test of the instructions for continued air-
evidence, of the principal structural worthiness required by 25.1529 of this
elements and detail design points iden- part specifies that no airplane may be
tified in paragraph (a)(1)(ii) of this sec- operated beyond a number of cycles
tion. equal to 12 the number of cycles accu-
(2) The service history of airplanes of mulated on the fatigue test article,
similar structural design, taking due until such testing is completed. The ex-
account of differences in operating con- tent of damage for residual strength
ditions and procedures, may be used in evaluation at any time within the
the evaluations required by this sec- operational life of the airplane must be
tion. consistent with the initial detect-
(3) Based on the evaluations required ability and subsequent growth under
by this section, inspections or other repeated loads. The residual strength
procedures must be established, as nec- evaluation must show that the remain-
essary, to prevent catastrophic failure, ing structure is able to withstand loads
and must be included in the Airworthi- (considered as static ultimate loads)

394

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00404 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.581

corresponding to the following condi- (1) Sonic fatigue cracks are not prob-
tions: able in any part of the flight structure
(1) The limit symmetrical maneu- subject to sonic excitation; or
vering conditions specified in 25.337 at (2) Catastrophic failure caused by
all speeds up to Vc and in 25.345. sonic cracks is not probable assuming
(2) The limit gust conditions speci- that the loads prescribed in paragraph
fied in 25.341 at the specified speeds up (b) of this section are applied to all
to VC and in 25.345. areas affected by those cracks.
(3) The limit rolling conditions speci- (e) Damage-tolerance (discrete source)
fied in 25.349 and the limit unsymmet- evaluation. The airplane must be capa-
rical conditions specified in 25.367 ble of successfully completing a flight
and 25.427 (a) through (c), at speeds up during which likely structural damage
to VC.
occurs as a result of
(4) The limit yaw maneuvering condi-
tions specified in 25.351(a) at the spec- (1) Impact with a 4-pound bird when
ified speeds up to VC. the velocity of the airplane relative to
(5) For pressurized cabins, the fol- the bird along the airplanes flight
lowing conditions: path is equal to Vc at sea level or 0.85Vc
(i) The normal operating differential at 8,000 feet, whichever is more critical;
pressure combined with the expected (2) Uncontained fan blade impact;
external aerodynamic pressures applied (3) Uncontained engine failure; or
simultaneously with the flight loading (4) Uncontained high energy rotating
conditions specified in paragraphs machinery failure.
(b)(1) through (4) of this section, if they The damaged structure must be able to
have a significant effect. withstand the static loads (considered
(ii) The maximum value of normal as ultimate loads) which are reason-
operating differential pressure (includ- ably expected to occur on the flight.
ing the expected external aerodynamic Dynamic effects on these static loads
pressures during 1 g level flight) multi- need not be considered. Corrective ac-
plied by a factor of 1.15, omitting other
tion to be taken by the pilot following
loads.
the incident, such as limiting maneu-
(6) For landing gear and directly-af-
vers, avoiding turbulence, and reducing
fected airframe structure, the limit
speed, must be considered. If signifi-
ground loading conditions specified in
25.473, 25.491, and 25.493. cant changes in structural stiffness or
geometry, or both, follow from a struc-
If significant changes in structural tural failure or partial failure, the ef-
stiffness or geometry, or both, follow fect on damage tolerance must be fur-
from a structural failure, or partial
ther investigated.
failure, the effect on damage tolerance
must be further investigated. [Amdt. 2545, 43 FR 46242, Oct. 5, 1978, as
(c) Fatigue (safe-life) evaluation. Com- amended by Amdt. 2554, 45 FR 60173, Sept.
pliance with the damage-tolerance re- 11, 1980; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29776, July 20,
quirements of paragraph (b) of this sec- 1990; Amdt. 2586, 61 FR 5222, Feb. 9, 1996;
Amdt. 2596, 63 FR 15714, Mar. 31, 1998; 63 FR
tion is not required if the applicant es-
23338, Apr. 28, 1998]
tablishes that their application for par-
ticular structure is impractical. This LIGHTNING PROTECTION
structure must be shown by analysis,
supported by test evidence, to be able 25.581 Lightning protection.
to withstand the repeated loads of vari-
able magnitude expected during its (a) The airplane must be protected
service life without detectable cracks. against catastrophic effects from light-
Appropriate safe-life scatter factors ning.
must be applied. (b) For metallic components, compli-
(d) Sonic fatigue strength. It must be ance with paragraph (a) of this section
shown by analysis, supported by test may be shown by
evidence, or by the service history of (1) Bonding the components properly
airplanes of similar structural design to the airframe; or
and sonic excitation environment, (2) Designing the components so that
that a strike will not endanger the airplane.

395

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00405 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.601 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(c) For nonmetallic components, (b) Each new aircraft fabrication


compliance with paragraph (a) of this method must be substantiated by a
section may be shown by test program.
(1) Designing the components to min- [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
imize the effect of a strike; or amended by Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50595, Oct. 30,
(2) Incorporating acceptable means of 1978]
diverting the resulting electrical cur-
rent so as not to endanger the airplane. 25.607 Fasteners.
(a) Each removable bolt, screw, nut,
[Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5674, Apr. 8, 1970]
pin, or other removable fastener must
incorporate two separate locking de-
Subpart DDesign and vices if
Construction (1) Its loss could preclude continued
flight and landing within the design
GENERAL limitations of the airplane using nor-
mal pilot skill and strength; or
25.601 General. (2) Its loss could result in reduction
The airplane may not have design in pitch, yaw, or roll control capability
features or details that experience has or response below that required by
shown to be hazardous or unreliable. Subpart B of this chapter.
The suitability of each questionable (b) The fasteners specified in para-
design detail and part must be estab- graph (a) of this section and their lock-
ing devices may not be adversely af-
lished by tests.
fected by the environmental conditions
25.603 Materials. associated with the particular installa-
tion.
The suitability and durability of ma- (c) No self-locking nut may be used
terials used for parts, the failure of on any bolt subject to rotation in oper-
which could adversely affect safety, ation unless a nonfriction locking de-
must vice is used in addition to the self-lock-
(a) Be established on the basis of ex- ing device.
perience or tests; [Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5674, Apr. 8, 1970]
(b) Conform to approved specifica-
tions (such as industry or military 25.609 Protection of structure.
specifications, or Technical Standard Each part of the structure must
Orders) that ensure their having the (a) Be suitably protected against de-
strength and other properties assumed terioration or loss of strength in serv-
in the design data; and ice due to any cause, including
(c) Take into account the effects of (1) Weathering;
environmental conditions, such as tem- (2) Corrosion; and
perature and humidity, expected in (3) Abrasion; and
service. (b) Have provisions for ventilation
and drainage where necessary for pro-
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
tection.
amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55466, Dec. 20
1976; Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50595, Oct. 30, 1978]
25.611 Accessibility provisions.
25.605 Fabrication methods. Means must be provided to allow in-
spection (including inspection of prin-
(a) The methods of fabrication used cipal structural elements and control
must produce a consistently sound systems), replacement of parts nor-
structure. If a fabrication process (such mally requiring replacement, adjust-
as gluing, spot welding, or heat treat- ment, and lubrication as necessary for
ing) requires close control to reach this continued airworthiness. The inspec-
objective, the process must be per- tion means for each item must be prac-
formed under an approved process spec- ticable for the inspection interval for
ification. the item. Nondestructive inspection
aids may be used to inspect structural
elements where it is impracticable to

396

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00406 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.621

provide means for direct visual inspec- 25.619 Special factors.


tion if it is shown that the inspection
The factor of safety prescribed in
is effective and the inspection proce-
25.303 must be multiplied by the high-
dures are specified in the maintenance
est pertinent special factor of safety
manual required by 25.1529.
prescribed in 25.621 through 25.625 for
[Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5674, Apr. 8, 1970] each part of the structure whose
strength is
25.613 Material strength properties (a) Uncertain;
and material design values.
(b) Likely to deteriorate in service
(a) Material strength properties must before normal replacement; or
be based on enough tests of material (c) Subject to appreciable variability
meeting approved specifications to es- because of uncertainties in manufac-
tablish design values on a statistical turing processes or inspection methods.
basis.
(b) Material design values must be [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5674, Apr. 8,
chosen to minimize the probability of
1970]
structural failures due to material var-
iability. Except as provided in para- 25.621 Casting factors.
graphs (e) and (f) of this section, com-
pliance must be shown by selecting ma- (a) General. The factors, tests, and in-
terial design values which assure mate- spections specified in paragraphs (b)
rial strength with the following prob- through (d) of this section must be ap-
ability: plied in addition to those necessary to
(1) Where applied loads are eventu- establish foundry quality control. The
ally distributed through a single mem- inspections must meet approved speci-
ber within an assembly, the failure of fications. Paragraphs (c) and (d) of this
which would result in loss of structural section apply to any structural cast-
integrity of the component, 99 percent ings except castings that are pressure
probability with 95 percent confidence. tested as parts of hydraulic or other
(2) For redundant structure, in which fluid systems and do not support struc-
the failure of individual elements tural loads.
would result in applied loads being (b) Bearing stresses and surfaces. The
safely distributed to other load car- casting factors specified in paragraphs
rying members, 90 percent probability (c) and (d) of this section
with 95 percent confidence. (1) Need not exceed 1.25 with respect
(c) The effects of environmental con- to bearing stresses regardless of the
ditions, such as temperature and mois- method of inspection used; and
ture, on material design values used in (2) Need not be used with respect to
an essential component or structure the bearing surfaces of a part whose
must be considered where these effects bearing factor is larger than the appli-
are significant within the airplane op- cable casting factor.
erating envelope. (c) Critical castings. For each casting
(d) [Reserved] whose failure would preclude continued
(e) Greater material design values safe flight and landing of the airplane
may be used if a premium selection or result in serious injury to occu-
of the material is made in which a pants, the following apply:
specimen of each individual item is (1) Each critical casting must
tested before use to determine that the (i) Have a casting factor of not less
actual strength properties of that par- than 1.25; and
ticular item will equal or exceed those (ii) Receive 100 percent inspection by
used in design. visual, radiographic, and magnetic par-
(f) Other material design values may ticle or penetrant inspection methods
be used if approved by the Adminis- or approved equivalent nondestructive
trator. inspection methods.
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as (2) For each critical casting with a
amended by Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50595, Oct. 30, casting factor less than 1.50, three sam-
1978; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29776, July 20, 1990; ple castings must be static tested and
Amdt. 25112, 68 FR 46431, Aug. 5, 2003] shown to meet

397

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00407 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.623 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(i) The strength requirements of bearing factor large enough to provide


25.305 at an ultimate load cor- for the effects of normal relative mo-
responding to a casting factor of 1.25; tion.
and (b) No bearing factor need be used for
(ii) The deformation requirements of a part for which any larger special fac-
25.305 at a load of 1.15 times the limit tor is prescribed.
load.
(3) Examples of these castings are 25.625 Fitting factors.
structural attachment fittings, parts of For each fitting (a part or terminal
flight control systems, control surface used to join one structural member to
hinges and balance weight attach- another), the following apply:
ments, seat, berth, safety belt, and fuel (a) For each fitting whose strength is
and oil tank supports and attachments, not proven by limit and ultimate load
and cabin pressure valves. tests in which actual stress conditions
(d) Noncritical castings. For each cast- are simulated in the fitting and sur-
ing other than those specified in para- rounding structures, a fitting factor of
graph (c) of this section, the following at least 1.15 must be applied to each
apply: part of
(1) Except as provided in paragraphs (1) The fitting;
(d)(2) and (3) of this section, the casting (2) The means of attachment; and
factors and corresponding inspections
(3) The bearing on the joined mem-
must meet the following table:
bers.
Casting factor Inspection (b) No fitting factor need be used
(1) For joints made under approved
2.0 or more ................... 100 percent visual.
Less than 2.0 but more 100 percent visual, and magnetic practices and based on comprehensive
than 1.5. particle or penetrant or equiva- test data (such as continuous joints in
lent nondestructive inspection metal plating, welded joints, and scarf
methods.
1.25 through 1.50 .......... 100 percent visual, magnetic par-
joints in wood); or
ticle or penetrant, and radio- (2) With respect to any bearing sur-
graphic, or approved equivalent face for which a larger special factor is
nondestructive inspection meth-
ods.
used.
(c) For each integral fitting, the part
(2) The percentage of castings in- must be treated as a fitting up to the
spected by nonvisual methods may be point at which the section properties
reduced below that specified in para- become typical of the member.
graph (d)(1) of this section when an ap- (d) For each seat, berth, safety belt,
proved quality control procedure is es- and harness, the fitting factor specified
tablished. in 25.785(f)(3) applies.
(3) For castings procured to a speci- [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
fication that guarantees the mechan- amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5674, Apr. 8,
ical properties of the material in the 1970; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29776, July 20, 1990]
casting and provides for demonstration
of these properties by test of coupons 25.629 Aeroelastic stability require-
cut from the castings on a sampling ments.
basis (a) General. The aeroelastic stability
(i) A casting factor of 1.0 may be evaluations required under this section
used; and include flutter, divergence, control re-
(ii) The castings must be inspected as versal and any undue loss of stability
provided in paragraph (d)(1) of this sec- and control as a result of structural de-
tion for casting factors of 1.25 through formation. The aeroelastic evaluation
1.50 and tested under paragraph (c)(2) must include whirl modes associated
of this section. with any propeller or rotating device
that contributes significant dynamic
25.623 Bearing factors. forces. Compliance with this section
(a) Except as provided in paragraph must be shown by analyses, wind tun-
(b) of this section, each part that has nel tests, ground vibration tests, flight
clearance (free fit), and that is subject tests, or other means found necessary
to pounding or vibration, must have a by the Administrator.

398

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00408 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.629

(b) Aeroelastic stability envelopes. The imum likely ice accumulation expected
airplane must be designed to be free as a result of an inadvertent encounter.
from aeroelastic instability for all con- (4) Failure of any single element of
figurations and design conditions with- the structure supporting any engine,
in the aeroelastic stability envelopes independently mounted propeller shaft,
as follows: large auxiliary power unit, or large ex-
(1) For normal conditions without ternally mounted aerodynamic body
failures, malfunctions, or adverse con- (such as an external fuel tank).
ditions, all combinations of altitudes (5) For airplanes with engines that
and speeds encompassed by the VD/MD have propellers or large rotating de-
versus altitude envelope enlarged at all vices capable of significant dynamic
points by an increase of 15 percent in forces, any single failure of the engine
equivalent airspeed at both constant structure that would reduce the rigid-
Mach number and constant altitude. In ity of the rotational axis.
addition, a proper margin of stability (6) The absence of aerodynamic or gy-
must exist at all speeds up to VD/MD roscopic forces resulting from the most
and, there must be no large and rapid adverse combination of feathered pro-
reduction in stability as VD/MD is ap- pellers or other rotating devices capa-
proached. The enlarged envelope may ble of significant dynamic forces. In
be limited to Mach 1.0 when MD is less addition, the effect of a single feath-
than 1.0 at all design altitudes, and ered propeller or rotating device must
(2) For the conditions described in be coupled with the failures of para-
25.629(d) below, for all approved alti- graphs (d)(4) and (d)(5) of this section.
tudes, any airspeed up to the greater (7) Any single propeller or rotating
airspeed defined by; device capable of significant dynamic
forces rotating at the highest likely
(i) The VD/MD envelope determined by
overspeed.
25.335(b); or,
(8) Any damage or failure condition,
(ii) An altitude-airspeed envelope de- required or selected for investigation
fined by a 15 percent increase in equiv- by 25.571. The single structural fail-
alent airspeed above VC at constant al- ures described in paragraphs (d)(4) and
titude, from sea level to the altitude of (d)(5) of this section need not be consid-
the intersection of 1.15 VC with the ex- ered in showing compliance with this
tension of the constant cruise Mach section if;
number line, MC, then a linear vari- (i) The structural element could not
ation in equivalent airspeed to MC+.05 fail due to discrete source damage re-
at the altitude of the lowest VC/MC sulting from the conditions described
intersection; then, at higher altitudes, in 25.571(e), and
up to the maximum flight altitude, the (ii) A damage tolerance investigation
boundary defined by a .05 Mach in- in accordance with 25.571(b) shows
crease in MC at constant altitude. that the maximum extent of damage
(c) Balance weights. If concentrated assumed for the purpose of residual
balance weights are used, their effec- strength evaluation does not involve
tiveness and strength, including sup- complete failure of the structural ele-
porting structure, must be substan- ment.
tiated. (9) Any damage, failure, or malfunc-
(d) Failures, malfunctions, and adverse tion considered under 25.631, 25.671,
conditions. The failures, malfunctions, 25.672, and 25.1309.
and adverse conditions which must be (10) Any other combination of fail-
considered in showing compliance with ures, malfunctions, or adverse condi-
this section are: tions not shown to be extremely im-
(1) Any critical fuel loading condi- probable.
tions, not shown to be extremely im- (e) Flight flutter testing. Full scale
probable, which may result from mis- flight flutter tests at speeds up to VDF/
management of fuel. MDF must be conducted for new type
(2) Any single failure in any flutter designs and for modifications to a type
damper system. design unless the modifications have
(3) For airplanes not approved for op- been shown to have an insignificant ef-
eration in icing conditions, the max- fect on the aeroelastic stability. These

399

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00409 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.631 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

tests must demonstrate that the air- are operated through their full angular
plane has a proper margin of damping movement.
at all speeds up to VDF/MDF, and that (b) If an adjustable stabilizer is used,
there is no large and rapid reduction in it must have stops that will limit its
damping as VDF/MDF, is approached. If a range of travel to the maximum for
failure, malfunction, or adverse condi- which the airplane is shown to meet
tion is simulated during flight test in the trim requirements of 25.161.
showing compliance with paragraph (d)
of this section, the maximum speed in- 25.657 Hinges.
vestigated need not exceed VFC/MFC if it (a) For control surface hinges, in-
is shown, by correlation of the flight cluding ball, roller, and self-lubricated
test data with other test data or anal- bearing hinges, the approved rating of
yses, that the airplane is free from any the bearing may not be exceeded. For
aeroelastic instability at all speeds nonstandard bearing hinge configura-
within the altitude-airspeed envelope tions, the rating must be established
described in paragraph (b)(2) of this on the basis of experience or tests and,
section. in the absence of a rational investiga-
[Doc. No. 26007, 57 FR 28949, June 29, 1992] tion, a factor of safety of not less than
6.67 must be used with respect to the
25.631 Bird strike damage. ultimate bearing strength of the soft-
est material used as a bearing.
The empennage structure must be de- (b) Hinges must have enough
signed to assure capability of contin- strength and rigidity for loads parallel
ued safe flight and landing of the air- to the hinge line.
plane after impact with an 8-pound bird
when the velocity of the airplane (rel- [Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5674, Apr. 8, 1970]
ative to the bird along the airplanes
flight path) is equal to VC at sea level, CONTROL SYSTEMS
selected under 25.335(a). Compliance
25.671 General.
with this section by provision of redun-
dant structure and protected location (a) Each control and control system
of control system elements or protec- must operate with the ease, smooth-
tive devices such as splitter plates or ness, and positiveness appropriate to
energy absorbing material is accept- its function.
able. Where compliance is shown by (b) Each element of each flight con-
analysis, tests, or both, use of data on trol system must be designed, or dis-
airplanes having similar structural de- tinctively and permanently marked, to
sign is acceptable. minimize the probability of incorrect
assembly that could result in the mal-
[Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5674, Apr. 8, 1970]
functioning of the system.
CONTROL SURFACES (c) The airplane must be shown by
analysis, tests, or both, to be capable
25.651 Proof of strength. of continued safe flight and landing
after any of the following failures or
(a) Limit load tests of control sur- jamming in the flight control system
faces are required. These tests must in- and surfaces (including trim, lift, drag,
clude the horn or fitting to which the and feel systems), within the normal
control system is attached. flight envelope, without requiring ex-
(b) Compliance with the special fac- ceptional piloting skill or strength.
tors requirements of 25.619 through Probable malfunctions must have only
25.625 and 25.657 for control surface minor effects on control system oper-
hinges must be shown by analysis or ation and must be capable of being
individual load tests. readily counteracted by the pilot.
(1) Any single failure, excluding jam-
25.655 Installation. ming (for example, disconnection or
(a) Movable tail surfaces must be in- failure of mechanical elements, or
stalled so that there is no interference structural failure of hydraulic compo-
between any surfaces when one is held nents, such as actuators, control spool
in its extreme position and the others housing, and valves).

400

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00410 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.677

(2) Any combination of failures not (c) It must be shown that after any
shown to be extremely improbable, ex- single failure of the stability aug-
cluding jamming (for example, dual mentation system or any other auto-
electrical or hydraulic system failures, matic or power-operated system
or any single failure in combination (1) The airplane is safely controllable
with any probable hydraulic or elec- when the failure or malfunction occurs
trical failure). at any speed or altitude within the ap-
(3) Any jam in a control position nor- proved operating limitations that is
mally encountered during takeoff, critical for the type of failure being
climb, cruise, normal turns, descent, considered;
and landing unless the jam is shown to (2) The controllability and maneuver-
be extremely improbable, or can be al- ability requirements of this part are
leviated. A runaway of a flight control met within a practical operational
to an adverse position and jam must be flight envelope (for example, speed, al-
accounted for if such runaway and sub- titude, normal acceleration, and air-
sequent jamming is not extremely im- plane configurations) which is de-
probable. scribed in the Airplane Flight Manual;
(d) The airplane must be designed so and
that it is controllable if all engines (3) The trim, stability, and stall char-
fail. Compliance with this requirement acteristics are not impaired below a
may be shown by analysis where that level needed to permit continued safe
method has been shown to be reliable. flight and landing.
[Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5675 Apr. 8, 1970]
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5674, Apr. 8,
1970]
25.675 Stops.
(a) Each control system must have
25.672 Stability augmentation and stops that positively limit the range of
automatic and power-operated sys- motion of each movable aerodynamic
tems. surface controlled by the system.
If the functioning of stability aug- (b) Each stop must be located so that
mentation or other automatic or wear, slackness, or take-up adjust-
power-operated systems is necessary to ments will not adversely affect the
show compliance with the flight char- control characteristics of the airplane
acteristics requirements of this part, because of a change in the range of sur-
such systems must comply with 25.671 face travel.
and the following: (c) Each stop must be able to with-
(a) A warning which is clearly distin- stand any loads corresponding to the
guishable to the pilot under expected design conditions for the control sys-
flight conditions without requiring his tem.
attention must be provided for any [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
failure in the stability augmentation amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55466, Dec. 20,
system or in any other automatic or 1976]
power-operated system which could re-
sult in an unsafe condition if the pilot 25.677 Trim systems.
were not aware of the failure. Warning (a) Trim controls must be designed to
systems must not activate the control prevent inadvertent or abrupt oper-
systems. ation and to operate in the plane, and
(b) The design of the stability aug- with the sense of motion, of the air-
mentation system or of any other auto- plane.
matic or power-operated system must (b) There must be means adjacent to
permit initial counteraction of failures the trim control to indicate the direc-
of the type specified in 25.671(c) with- tion of the control movement relative
out requiring exceptional pilot skill or to the airplane motion. In addition,
strength, by either the deactivation of there must be clearly visible means to
the system, or a failed portion thereof, indicate the position of the trim device
or by overriding the failure by move- with respect to the range of adjust-
ment of the flight controls in the nor- ment. The indicator must be clearly
mal sense. marked with the range within which it

401

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00411 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.679 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

has been demonstrated that takeoff is ered portions of the control system are
safe for all center of gravity positions loaded to the maximum load expected
approved for takeoff. in normal operation, the system is free
(c) Trim control systems must be de- from
signed to prevent creeping in flight. (a) Jamming;
Trim tab controls must be irreversible (b) Excessive friction; and
unless the tab is appropriately bal- (c) Excessive deflection.
anced and shown to be free from flut- [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
ter. amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5675, Apr. 8,
(d) If an irreversible tab control sys- 1970]
tem is used, the part from the tab to
the attachment of the irreversible unit 25.685 Control system details.
to the airplane structure must consist (a) Each detail of each control sys-
of a rigid connection. tem must be designed and installed to
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as prevent jamming, chafing, and inter-
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5675, Apr. 8, ference from cargo, passengers, loose
1970; Amdt. 25115, 69 FR 40527, July 2, 2004] objects, or the freezing of moisture.
(b) There must be means in the cock-
25.679 Control system gust locks. pit to prevent the entry of foreign ob-
(a) There must be a device to prevent jects into places where they would jam
damage to the control surfaces (includ- the system.
ing tabs), and to the control system, (c) There must be means to prevent
from gusts striking the airplane while the slapping of cables or tubes against
it is on the ground or water. If the de- other parts.
vice, when engaged, prevents normal (d) Sections 25.689 and 25.693 apply to
operation of the control surfaces by the cable systems and joints.
pilot, it must [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
(1) Automatically disengage when the amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55466, Dec. 20,
pilot operates the primary flight con- 1976]
trols in a normal manner; or
(2) Limit the operation of the air- 25.689 Cable systems.
plane so that the pilot receives unmis- (a) Each cable, cable fitting, turn-
takable warning at the start of takeoff. buckle, splice, and pulley must be ap-
(b) The device must have means to proved. In addition
preclude the possibility of it becoming (1) No cable smaller than 18 inch in
inadvertently engaged in flight. diameter may be used in the aileron,
elevator, or rudder systems; and
25.681 Limit load static tests. (2) Each cable system must be de-
(a) Compliance with the limit load signed so that there will be no haz-
requirements of this Part must be ardous change in cable tension
shown by tests in which throughout the range of travel under
(1) The direction of the test loads operating conditions and temperature
produces the most severe loading in the variations.
control system; and (b) Each kind and size of pulley must
(2) Each fitting, pulley, and bracket correspond to the cable with which it is
used in attaching the system to the used. Pulleys and sprockets must have
main structure is included. closely fitted guards to prevent the ca-
(b) Compliance must be shown (by bles and chains from being displaced or
analyses or individual load tests) with fouled. Each pulley must lie in the
the special factor requirements for plane passing through the cable so that
control system joints subject to angu- the cable does not rub against the pul-
lar motion. ley flange.
(c) Fairleads must be installed so
25.683 Operation tests. that they do not cause a change in
It must be shown by operation tests cable direction of more than three de-
that when portions of the control sys- grees.
tem subject to pilot effort loads are (d) Clevis pins subject to load or mo-
loaded to 80 percent of the limit load tion and retained only by cotter pins
specified for the system and the pow- may not be used in the control system.

402

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00412 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.701

(e) Turnbuckles must be attached to engine power at any speed below VF


parts having angular motion in a man- +9.0 (knots).
ner that will positively prevent binding [Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5675, Apr. 8, 1970, as
throughout the range of travel. amended by Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50595, Oct. 30,
(f) There must be provisions for vis- 1978; Amdt. 2557, 49 FR 6848, Feb. 23, 1984]
ual inspection of fairleads, pulleys, ter-
minals, and turnbuckles. 25.699 Lift and drag device indicator.
(a) There must be means to indicate
25.693 Joints. to the pilots the position of each lift or
Control system joints (in push-pull drag device having a separate control
systems) that are subject to angular in the cockpit to adjust its position. In
motion, except those in ball and roller addition, an indication of unsymmet-
bearing systems, must have a special rical operation or other malfunction in
factor of safety of not less than 3.33 the lift or drag device systems must be
provided when such indication is nec-
with respect to the ultimate bearing
essary to enable the pilots to prevent
strength of the softest material used as
or counteract an unsafe flight or
a bearing. This factor may be reduced
ground condition, considering the ef-
to 2.0 for joints in cable control sys- fects on flight characteristics and per-
tems. For ball or roller bearings, the formance.
approved ratings may not be exceeded. (b) There must be means to indicate
[Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29777, July 20, 1990] to the pilots the takeoff, en route, ap-
proach, and landing lift device posi-
25.697 Lift and drag devices, con- tions.
trols. (c) If any extension of the lift and
(a) Each lift device control must be drag devices beyond the landing posi-
tion is possible, the controls must be
designed so that the pilots can place
clearly marked to identify this range
the device in any takeoff, en route, ap-
of extension.
proach, or landing position established
under 25.101(d). Lift and drag devices [Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5675, Apr. 8, 1970]
must maintain the selected positions,
except for movement produced by an 25.701 Flap and slat interconnection.
automatic positioning or load limiting (a) Unless the airplane has safe flight
device, without further attention by characteristics with the flaps or slats
the pilots. retracted on one side and extended on
(b) Each lift and drag device control the other, the motion of flaps or slats
must be designed and located to make on opposite sides of the plane of sym-
inadvertent operation improbable. Lift metry must be synchronized by a me-
and drag devices intended for ground chanical interconnection or approved
equivalent means.
operation only must have means to
(b) If a wing flap or slat interconnec-
prevent the inadvertant operation of
tion or equivalent means is used, it
their controls in flight if that oper- must be designed to account for the ap-
ation could be hazardous. plicable unsymmetrical loads, includ-
(c) The rate of motion of the surfaces ing those resulting from flight with the
in response to the operation of the con- engines on one side of the plane of sym-
trol and the characteristics of the metry inoperative and the remaining
automatic positioning or load limiting engines at takeoff power.
device must give satisfactory flight (c) For airplanes with flaps or slats
and performance characteristics under that are not subjected to slipstream
steady or changing conditions of air- conditions, the structure must be de-
speed, engine power, and airplane atti- signed for the loads imposed when the
tude. wing flaps or slats on one side are car-
(d) The lift device control must be rying the most severe load occurring in
designed to retract the surfaces from the prescribed symmetrical conditions
the fully extended position, during and those on the other side are car-
steady flight at maximum continuous rying not more than 80 percent of that
load.

403

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00413 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.703 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(d) The interconnection must be de- seats, of nine seats or less, the spillage
signed for the loads resulting when of enough fuel from any fuel system in
interconnected flap or slat surfaces on the fuselage to constitute a fire hazard;
one side of the plane of symmetry are and
jammed and immovable while the sur- (2) For airplanes that have a pas-
faces on the other side are free to move senger seating configuration, excluding
and the full power of the surface actu- pilots seats, of 10 seats or more, the
ating system is applied. spillage of enough fuel from any part of
the fuel system to constitute a fire
[Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29777, July 20, 1990]
hazard.
25.703 Takeoff warning system. (b) Each airplane that has a pas-
senger seating configuration excluding
A takeoff warning system must be in- pilots seats, of 10 seats or more must
stalled and must meet the following re- be designed so that with the airplane
quirements: under control it can be landed on a
(a) The system must provide to the paved runway with any one or more
pilots an aural warning that is auto- landing gear legs not extended without
matically activated during the initial sustaining a structural component fail-
portion of the takeoff roll if the air- ure that is likely to cause the spillage
plane is in a configuration, including of enough fuel to constitute a fire haz-
any of the following, that would not ard.
allow a safe takeoff: (c) Compliance with the provisions of
(1) The wing flaps or leading edge de- this section may be shown by analysis
vices are not within the approved range or tests, or both.
of takeoff positions.
[Amdt. 2532, 37 FR 3969, Feb. 24, 1972]
(2) Wing spoilers (except lateral con-
trol spoilers meeting the requirements 25.723 Shock absorption tests.
of 25.671), speed brakes, or longitu-
dinal trim devices are in a position (a) The analytical representation of
that would not allow a safe takeoff. the landing gear dynamic characteris-
tics that is used in determining the
(b) The warning required by para-
landing loads must be validated by en-
graph (a) of this section must continue
ergy absorption tests. A range of tests
until
must be conducted to ensure that the
(1) The configuration is changed to
analytical representation is valid for
allow a safe takeoff;
the design conditions specified in
(2) Action is taken by the pilot to
25.473.
terminate the takeoff roll; (1) The configurations subjected to
(3) The airplane is rotated for takeoff; energy absorption tests at limit design
or conditions must include at least the
(4) The warning is manually deacti- design landing weight or the design
vated by the pilot. takeoff weight, whichever produces the
(c) The means used to activate the greater value of landing impact energy.
system must function properly (2) The test attitude of the landing
throughout the ranges of takeoff gear unit and the application of appro-
weights, altitudes, and temperatures priate drag loads during the test must
for which certification is requested. simulate the airplane landing condi-
[Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2323, Jan. 16, 1978] tions in a manner consistent with the
development of rational or conserv-
LANDING GEAR ative limit loads.
(b) The landing gear may not fail in
25.721 General. a test, demonstrating its reserve en-
(a) The main landing gear system ergy absorption capacity, simulating a
must be designed so that if it fails due descent velocity of 12 f.p.s. at design
to overloads during takeoff and landing landing weight, assuming airplane lift
(assuming the overloads to act in the not greater than airplane weight act-
upward and aft directions), the failure ing during the landing impact.
mode is not likely to cause (c) In lieu of the tests prescribed in
(1) For airplanes that have passenger this section, changes in previously ap-
seating configuration, excluding pilots proved design weights and minor

404

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00414 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.729

changes in design may be substantiated (2) The failure of any single source of
by analyses based on previous tests hydraulic, electric, or equivalent en-
conducted on the same basic landing ergy supply.
gear system that has similar energy (d) Operation test. The proper func-
absorption characteristics. tioning of the retracting mechanism
[Doc. No. 19995835, 66 FR 27394, May 16, 2001] must be shown by operation tests.
(e) Position indicator and warning de-
25.72525.727 [Reserved] vice. If a retractable landing gear is
used, there must be a landing gear po-
25.729 Retracting mechanism.
sition indicator (as well as necessary
(a) General. For airplanes with re- switches to actuate the indicator) or
tractable landing gear, the following other means to inform the pilot that
apply: the gear is secured in the extended (or
(1) The landing gear retracting mech- retracted) position. This means must
anism, wheel well doors, and sup- be designed as follows:
porting structure, must be designed (1) If switches are used, they must be
for
located and coupled to the landing gear
(i) The loads occurring in the flight
mechanical systems in a manner that
conditions when the gear is in the re-
prevents an erroneous indication of
tracted position,
(ii) The combination of friction down and locked if the landing gear
loads, inertia loads, brake torque loads, is not in a fully extended position, or of
air loads, and gyroscopic loads result- up and locked if the landing gear is
ing from the wheels rotating at a pe- not in the fully retracted position. The
ripheral speed equal to 1.3 Vs (with the switches may be located where they
flaps in takeoff position at design take- are operated by the actual landing gear
off weight), occurring during retraction locking latch or device.
and extension at any airspeed up to 1.6 (2) The flightcrew must be given an
Vs1 (with the flaps in the approach posi- aural warning that functions continu-
tion at design landing weight), and ously, or is periodically repeated, if a
(iii) Any load factor up to those spec- landing is attempted when the landing
ified in 25.345(a) for the flaps extended gear is not locked down.
condition. (3) The warning must be given in suf-
(2) Unless there are other means to ficient time to allow the landing gear
decelerate the airplane in flight at this to be locked down or a go-around to be
speed, the landing gear, the retracting made.
mechanism, and the airplane structure (4) There must not be a manual shut-
(including wheel well doors) must be off means readily available to the
designed to withstand the flight loads flightcrew for the warning required by
occurring with the landing gear in the paragraph (e)(2) of this section such
extended position at any speed up to that it could be operated instinctively,
0.67 VC. inadvertently, or by habitual reflexive
(3) Landing gear doors, their oper- action.
ating mechanism, and their supporting (5) The system used to generate the
structures must be designed for the aural warning must be designed to
yawing maneuvers prescribed for the
eliminate false or inappropriate alerts.
airplane in addition to the conditions
(6) Failures of systems used to in-
of airspeed and load factor prescribed
in paragraphs (a)(1) and (2) of this sec- hibit the landing gear aural warning,
tion. that would prevent the warning system
(b) Landing gear lock. There must be from operating, must be improbable.
positive means to keep the landing (f) Protection of equipment in wheel
gear extended, in flight and on the wells. Equipment that is essential to
ground. safe operation of the airplane and that
(c) Emergency operation. There must is located in wheel wells must be pro-
be an emergency means for extending tected from the damaging effects of
the landing gear in the event of (1) A bursting tire, unless it is shown
(1) Any reasonably probable failure in that a tire cannot burst from overheat;
the normal retraction system; or and

405

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00415 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.731 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(2) A loose tire tread, unless it is combination of airplane weight (up to


shown that a loose tire tread cannot maximum ramp weight) and center of
cause damage. gravity position with a force of 1.0g
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
acting downward at the center of grav-
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5676, Apr. 8, ity. This load may not exceed the load
1970; Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2323, Jan. 16, 1978; rating of the tire.
Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29777, July 20, 1990; Amdt. (2) The ground reaction of the tire
2575, 56 FR 63762, Dec. 5, 1991] corresponding to the most critical
combination of airplane weight (up to
25.731 Wheels. maximum landing weight) and center
(a) Each main and nose wheel must of gravity position combined with
be approved. forces of 1.0g downward and 0.31g for-
(b) The maximum static load rating ward acting at the center of gravity.
of each wheel may not be less than the The reactions in this case must be dis-
corresponding static ground reaction tributed to the nose and main wheels
with by the principles of statics with a drag
(1) Design maximum weight; and reaction equal to 0.31 times the
(2) Critical center of gravity. vertical load at each wheel with brakes
(c) The maximum limit load rating of capable of producing this ground reac-
each wheel must equal or exceed the tion. This nose tire load may not ex-
maximum radial limit load determined ceed 1.5 times the load rating of the
under the applicable ground load re- tire.
quirements of this part. (3) The ground reaction of the tire
(d) Overpressure burst prevention. corresponding to the most critical
Means must be provided in each wheel combination of airplane weight (up to
to prevent wheel failure and tire burst maximum ramp weight) and center of
that may result from excessive pressur- gravity position combined with forces
ization of the wheel and tire assembly. of 1.0g downward and 0.20g forward act-
(e) Braked wheels. Each braked wheel ing at the center of gravity. The reac-
must meet the applicable requirements tions in this case must be distributed
of 25.735. to the nose and main wheels by the
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as principles of statics with a drag reac-
amended by Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29777, July 20, tion equal to 0.20 times the vertical
1990; Amdt. 25107, 67 FR 20420, Apr. 24, 2002] load at each wheel with brakes capable
of producing this ground reaction. This
25.733 Tires. nose tire load may not exceed 1.5 times
(a) When a landing gear axle is fitted the load rating of the tire.
with a single wheel and tire assembly, (c) When a landing gear axle is fitted
the wheel must be fitted with a suit- with more than one wheel and tire as-
able tire of proper fit with a speed rat- sembly, such as dual or dual-tandem,
ing approved by the Administrator each wheel must be fitted with a suit-
that is not exceeded under critical con- able tire of proper fit with a speed rat-
ditions and with a load rating approved ing approved by the Administrator
by the Administrator that is not ex- that is not exceeded under critical con-
ceeded under ditions, and with a load rating ap-
(1) The loads on the main wheel tire, proved by the Administrator that is
corresponding to the most critical not exceeded by
combination of airplane weight (up to (1) The loads on each main wheel
maximum weight) and center of grav- tire, corresponding to the most critical
ity position, and combination of airplane weight (up to
(2) The loads corresponding to the maximum weight) and center of grav-
ground reactions in paragraph (b) of ity position, when multiplied by a fac-
this section, on the nose wheel tire, ex- tor of 1.07; and
cept as provided in paragraphs (b)(2) (2) Loads specified in paragraphs
and (b)(3) of this section. (a)(2), (b)(1), (b)(2), and (b)(3) of this
(b) The applicable ground reactions section on each nose wheel tire.
for nose wheel tires are as follows: (d) Each tire installed on a retract-
(1) The static ground reaction for the able landing gear system must, at the
tire corresponding to the most critical maximum size of the tire type expected

406

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00416 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.735

in service, have a clearance to sur- rolling on a dry and level paved runway
rounding structure and systems that is when the most adverse combination of
adequate to prevent unintended con- maximum thrust on one engine and up
tact between the tire and any part of to maximum ground idle thrust on any,
the structure or systems. or all, other engine(s) is applied. The
(e) For an airplane with a maximum control must be suitably located or be
certificated takeoff weight of more adequately protected to prevent inad-
than 75,000 pounds, tires mounted on vertent operation. There must be indi-
braked wheels must be inflated with cation in the cockpit when the parking
dry nitrogen or other gases shown to be brake is not fully released.
inert so that the gas mixture in the (e) Antiskid system. If an antiskid sys-
tire does not contain oxygen in excess tem is installed:
of 5 percent by volume, unless it can be (1) It must operate satisfactorily over
shown that the tire liner material will the range of expected runway condi-
not produce a volatile gas when heated tions, without external adjustment.
or that means are provided to prevent (2) It must, at all times, have pri-
tire temperatures from reaching unsafe ority over the automatic braking sys-
levels. tem, if installed.
[Amdt. 2548, 44 FR 68752, Nov. 29, 1979; Amdt. (f) Kinetic energy capacity(1) Design
2572, 55 FR 29777, July 20, 1990, as amended landing stop. The design landing stop is
by Amdt. 2578, 58 FR 11781, Feb. 26, 1993] an operational landing stop at max-
imum landing weight. The design land-
25.735 Brakes and braking systems. ing stop brake kinetic energy absorp-
(a) Approval. Each assembly con- tion requirement of each wheel, brake,
sisting of a wheel(s) and brake(s) must and tire assembly must be determined.
be approved. It must be substantiated by dynamom-
(b) Brake system capability. The brake eter testing that the wheel, brake and
system, associated systems and compo- tire assembly is capable of absorbing
nents must be designed and con- not less than this level of kinetic en-
structed so that: ergy throughout the defined wear
(1) If any electrical, pneumatic, hy- range of the brake. The energy absorp-
draulic, or mechanical connecting or tion rate derived from the airplane
transmitting element fails, or if any manufacturers braking requirements
single source of hydraulic or other must be achieved. The mean decelera-
brake operating energy supply is lost, tion must not be less than 10 fps 2.
it is possible to bring the airplane to (2) Maximum kinetic energy accelerate-
rest with a braked roll stopping dis- stop. The maximum kinetic energy ac-
tance of not more than two times that celerate-stop is a rejected takeoff for
obtained in determining the landing the most critical combination of air-
distance as prescribed in 25.125. plane takeoff weight and speed. The ac-
(2) Fluid lost from a brake hydraulic celerate-stop brake kinetic energy ab-
system following a failure in, or in the sorption requirement of each wheel,
vicinity of, the brakes is insufficient to brake, and tire assembly must be de-
cause or support a hazardous fire on termined. It must be substantiated by
the ground or in flight. dynamometer testing that the wheel,
(c) Brake controls. The brake controls brake, and tire assembly is capable of
must be designed and constructed so absorbing not less than this level of ki-
that: netic energy throughout the defined
(1) Excessive control force is not re- wear range of the brake. The energy
quired for their operation. absorption rate derived from the air-
(2) If an automatic braking system is plane manufacturers braking require-
installed, means are provided to: ments must be achieved. The mean de-
(i) Arm and disarm the system, and celeration must not be less than 6 fps2.
(ii) Allow the pilot(s) to override the (3) Most severe landing stop. The most
system by use of manual braking. severe landing stop is a stop at the
(d) Parking brake. The airplane must most critical combination of airplane
have a parking brake control that, landing weight and speed. The most se-
when selected on, will, without further vere landing stop brake kinetic energy
attention, prevent the airplane from absorption requirement of each wheel,

407

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00417 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.737 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

brake, and tire assembly must be de- the airplane and its systems must be
termined. It must be substantiated by substantiated.
dynamometer testing that, at the de- [Doc. No. FAA19996063, 67 FR 20420, Apr. 24,
clared fully worn limit(s) of the brake 2002, as amended by Amdt. 25108, 67 FR
heat sink, the wheel, brake and tire as- 70827, Nov. 26, 2002; 68 FR 1955, Jan. 15, 2003]
sembly is capable of absorbing not less
than this level of kinetic energy. The 25.737 Skis.
most severe landing stop need not be Each ski must be approved. The max-
considered for extremely improbable imum limit load rating of each ski
failure conditions or if the maximum must equal or exceed the maximum
kinetic energy accelerate-stop energy limit load determined under the appli-
is more severe. cable ground load requirements of this
(g) Brake condition after high kinetic part.
energy dynamometer stop(s). Following FLOATS AND HULLS
the high kinetic energy stop dem-
onstration(s) required by paragraph (f) 25.751 Main float buoyancy.
of this section, with the parking brake Each main float must have
promptly and fully applied for at least (a) A buoyancy of 80 percent in excess
3 minutes, it must be demonstrated of that required to support the max-
that for at least 5 minutes from appli- imum weight of the seaplane or am-
cation of the parking brake, no condi- phibian in fresh water; and
tion occurs (or has occurred during the (b) Not less than five watertight com-
stop), including fire associated with partments approximately equal in vol-
the tire or wheel and brake assembly, ume.
that could prejudice the safe and com-
plete evacuation of the airplane. 25.753 Main float design.
(h) Stored energy systems. An indica- Each main float must be approved
tion to the flightcrew of the usable and must meet the requirements of
stored energy must be provided if a 25.521.
stored energy system is used to show
25.755 Hulls.
compliance with paragraph (b)(1) of
this section. The available stored en- (a) Each hull must have enough wa-
ergy must be sufficient for: tertight compartments so that, with
(1) At least 6 full applications of the any two adjacent compartments flood-
ed, the buoyancy of the hull and auxil-
brakes when an antiskid system is not
iary floats (and wheel tires, if used)
operating; and
provides a margin of positive stability
(2) Bringing the airplane to a com- great enough to minimize the prob-
plete stop when an antiskid system is ability of capsizing in rough, fresh
operating, under all runway surface water.
conditions for which the airplane is (b) Bulkheads with watertight doors
certificated. may be used for communication be-
(i) Brake wear indicators. Means must tween compartments.
be provided for each brake assembly to
indicate when the heat sink is worn to PERSONNEL AND CARGO
the permissible limit. The means must ACCOMMODATIONS
be reliable and readily visible.
25.771 Pilot compartment.
(j) Overtemperature burst prevention.
Means must be provided in each braked (a) Each pilot compartment and its
wheel to prevent a wheel failure, a tire equipment must allow the minimum
burst, or both, that may result from flight crew (established under 25.1523)
to perform their duties without unrea-
elevated brake temperatures. Addition-
sonable concentration or fatigue.
ally, all wheels must meet the require-
(b) The primary controls listed in
ments of 25.731(d). 25.779(a), excluding cables and control
(k) Compatibility. Compatibility of rods, must be located with respect to
the wheel and brake assemblies with the propellers so that no member of the
minimum flight crew (established

408

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00418 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.773

under 25.1523), or part of the controls, torted view, to enable them to safely
lies in the region between the plane of perform any maneuvers within the op-
rotation of any inboard propeller and erating limitations of the airplane, in-
the surface generated by a line passing cluding taxiing takeoff, approach, and
through the center of the propeller hub landing.
making an angle of five degrees for- (2) Each pilot compartment must be
ward or aft of the plane of rotation of free of glare and reflection that could
the propeller. interfere with the normal duties of the
(c) If provision is made for a second minimum flight crew (established
pilot, the airplane must be controllable under 25.1523). This must be shown in
with equal safety from either pilot day and night flight tests under non-
seat. precipitation conditions.
(d) The pilot compartment must be (b) Precipitation conditions. For pre-
constructed so that, when flying in cipitation conditions, the following
rain or snow, it will not leak in a man- apply:
ner that will distract the crew or harm (1) The airplane must have a means
the structure. to maintain a clear portion of the
(e) Vibration and noise characteris- windshield, during precipitation condi-
tics of cockpit equipment may not tions, sufficient for both pilots to have
interfere with safe operation of the air- a sufficiently extensive view along the
plane. flight path in normal flight attitudes
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as of the airplane. This means must be de-
amended by Amdt. 254, 30 FR 6113, Apr. 30, signed to function, without continuous
1965] attention on the part of the crew, in
(i) Heavy rain at speeds up to 1.5 VSR1
25.772 Pilot compartment doors. with lift and drag devices retracted;
For an airplane that has a lockable and
door installed between the pilot com- (ii) The icing conditions specified in
partment and the passenger compart- 25.1419 if certification with ice protec-
ment: tion provisions is requested.
(a) For airplanes with a maximum (2) The first pilot must have
passenger seating configuration of (i) A window that is openable under
more than 20 seats, the emergency exit the conditions prescribed in paragraph
configuration must be designed so that (b)(1) of this section when the cabin is
neither crewmembers nor passengers not pressurized, provides the view spec-
require use of the flightdeck door in ified in that paragraph, and gives suffi-
order to reach the emergency exits pro- cient protection from the elements
vided for them; and against impairment of the pilots vi-
(b) Means must be provided to enable sion; or
flight crewmembers to directly enter (ii) An alternate means to maintain a
the passenger compartment from the clear view under the conditions speci-
pilot compartment if the cockpit door fied in paragraph (b)(1) of this section,
becomes jammed. considering the probable damage due to
(c) There must be an emergency a severe hail encounter.
means to enable a flight attendant to (c) Internal windshield and window
enter the pilot compartment in the fogging. The airplane must have a
event that the flightcrew becomes in- means to prevent fogging of the inter-
capacitated. nal portions of the windshield and win-
[Doc. No. 24344, 55 FR 29777, July 20, 1990, as dow panels over an area which would
amended by Amdt. 25106, 67 FR 2127, Jan. 15, provide the visibility specified in para-
2002] graph (a) of this section under all in-
ternal and external ambient condi-
25.773 Pilot compartment view. tions, including precipitation condi-
(a) Nonprecipitation conditions. For tions, in which the airplane is intended
nonprecipitation conditions, the fol- to be operated.
lowing apply: (d) Fixed markers or other guides
(1) Each pilot compartment must be must be installed at each pilot station
arranged to give the pilots a suffi- to enable the pilots to position them-
ciently extensive, clear, and undis- selves in their seats for an optimum

409

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00419 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.775 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

combination of outside visibility and from the maximum, in accordance with


instrument scan. If lighted markers or appropriate operating limitations, to
guides are used they must comply with allow continued safe flight of the air-
the requirements specified in 25.1381. plane with a cabin pressure altitude of
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
not more than 15,000 feet.
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5676, Apr. 8, (e) The windshield panels in front of
1970; Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50595, Oct. 30, 1978; the pilots must be arranged so that, as-
Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29778, July 20, 1990; Amdt. suming the loss of vision through any
25108, 67 FR 70827, Nov. 26, 2002] one panel, one or more panels remain
available for use by a pilot seated at a
25.775 Windshields and windows. pilot station to permit continued safe
(a) Internal panes must be made of flight and landing.
nonsplintering material.
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
(b) Windshield panes directly in front amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5676, Apr. 8,
of the pilots in the normal conduct of 1970; Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55466, Dec. 20, 1976]
their duties, and the supporting struc-
tures for these panes, must withstand, 25.777 Cockpit controls.
without penetration, the impact of a
four-pound bird when the velocity of (a) Each cockpit control must be lo-
the airplane (relative to the bird along cated to provide convenient operation
the airplanes flight path) is equal to and to prevent confusion and inad-
the value of VC, at sea level, selected vertent operation.
under 25.335(a). (b) The direction of movement of
(c) Unless it can be shown by analysis cockpit controls must meet the re-
or tests that the probability of occur- quirements of 25.779. Wherever prac-
rence of a critical windshield frag- ticable, the sense of motion involved in
mentation condition is of a low order, the operation of other controls must
the airplane must have a means to correspond to the sense of the effect of
minimize the danger to the pilots from the operation upon the airplane or
flying windshield fragments due to bird upon the part operated. Controls of a
impact. This must be shown for each variable nature using a rotary motion
transparent pane in the cockpit that must move clockwise from the off posi-
(1) Appears in the front view of the tion, through an increasing range, to
airplane; the full on position.
(2) Is inclined 15 degrees or more to (c) The controls must be located and
the longitudinal axis of the airplane; arranged, with respect to the pilots
and seats, so that there is full and unre-
(3) Has any part of the pane located stricted movement of each control
where its fragmentation will constitute without interference from the cockpit
a hazard to the pilots. structure or the clothing of the min-
(d) The design of windshields and imum flight crew (established under
windows in pressurized airplanes must 25.1523) when any member of this
be based on factors peculiar to high al- flight crew, from 52 to 63 in height,
titude operation, including the effects is seated with the seat belt and shoul-
of continuous and cyclic pressurization der harness (if provided) fastened.
loadings, the inherent characteristics (d) Identical powerplant controls for
of the material used, and the effects of each engine must be located to prevent
temperatures and temperature dif- confusion as to the engines they con-
ferentials. The windshield and window trol.
panels must be capable of withstanding (e) Wing flap controls and other aux-
the maximum cabin pressure differen- iliary lift device controls must be lo-
tial loads combined with critical aero- cated on top of the pedestal, aft of the
dynamic pressure and temperature ef- throttles, centrally or to the right of
fects after any single failure in the in- the pedestal centerline, and not less
stallation or associated systems. It than 10 inches aft of the landing gear
may be assumed that, after a single control.
failure that is obvious to the flight (f) The landing gear control must be
crew (established under 25.1523), the located forward of the throttles and
cabin pressure differential is reduced must be operable by each pilot when

410

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00420 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.781

seated with seat belt and shoulder har- (2) Secondary.


ness (if provided) fastened.
(g) Control knobs must be shaped in Controls Motion and effect
accordance with 25.781. In addition, Flaps (or auxiliary lift Forward for flaps up; rearward for
the knobs must be of the same color, devices). flaps down.
and this color must contrast with the Trim tabs (or equiva- Rotate to produce similar rotation of
color of control knobs for other pur- lent). the airplane about an axis parallel
to the axis of the control.
poses and the surrounding cockpit.
(h) If a flight engineer is required as
(b) Powerplant and auxiliary con-
part of the minimum flight crew (es-
tablished under 25.1523), the airplane trols:
must have a flight engineer station lo- (1) Powerplant.
cated and arranged so that the flight Controls Motion and effect
crewmembers can perform their func-
tions efficiently and without inter- Power or thrust ............ Forward to increase forward thrust
fering with each other. and rearward to increase rear-
ward thrust.
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as Propellers .................... Forward to increase rpm.
amended by Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50596, Oct. 30, Mixture ......................... Forward or upward for rich.
1978] Carburetor air heat ...... Forward or upward for cold.
Supercharger ............... Forward or upward for low blower.
25.779 Motion and effect of cockpit For turbosuperchargers, forward,
controls. upward, or clockwise, to increase
pressure.
Cockpit controls must be designed so
that they operate in accordance with (2) Auxiliary.
the following movement and actuation:
(a) Aerodynamic controls: Controls Motion and effect
(1) Primary. Landing gear ............... Down to extend.
Controls Motion and effect

Aileron ......................... Right (clockwise) for right wing [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
down. amended by Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29778, July 20,
Elevator ....................... Rearward for nose up. 1990]
Rudder ......................... Right pedal forward for nose right.

25.781 Cockpit control knob shape.


Cockpit control knobs must conform to the general shapes (but not necessarily
the exact sizes or specific proportions) in the following figure:

411

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00421 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8016 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.783 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as amended by Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29779, July 20, 1990]

25.783 Fuselage doors. tion as a secondary bulkhead under the


prescribed failure conditions of part 25.
(a) General. This section applies to fu-
These doors must meet the require-
selage doors, which includes all doors, ments of this section, taking into ac-
hatches, openable windows, access pan- count both pressurized and unpres-
els, covers, etc., on the exterior of the surized flight, and must be designed as
fuselage that do not require the use of follows:
tools to open or close. This also applies (1) Each door must have means to
to each door or hatch through a pres- safeguard against opening in flight as a
sure bulkhead, including any bulkhead result of mechanical failure, or failure
that is specifically designed to func- of any single structural element.

412
EC28SE91.048</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00422 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.783

(2) Each door that could be a hazard cated pressurization prevention means
if it unlatches must be designed so that if, from every possible position of the
unlatching during pressurized and un- door, it will remain open to the extent
pressurized flight from the fully closed, that it prevents pressurization or safe-
latched, and locked condition is ex- ly close and latch as pressurization
tremely improbable. This must be takes place. This must also be shown
shown by safety analysis. with any single failure and malfunc-
(3) Each element of each door oper- tion, except that
ating system must be designed or, (i) With failures or malfunctions in
where impracticable, distinctively and the latching mechanism, it need not
permanently marked, to minimize the latch after closing; and
probability of incorrect assembly and (ii) With jamming as a result of me-
adjustment that could result in a mal- chanical failure or blocking debris, the
function. door need not close and latch if it can
(4) All sources of power that could be shown that the pressurization loads
initiate unlocking or unlatching of any on the jammed door or mechanism
door must be automatically isolated would not result in an unsafe condi-
from the latching and locking systems tion.
prior to flight and it must not be pos- (d) Latching and locking. The latching
sible to restore power to the door dur- and locking mechanisms must be de-
ing flight. signed as follows:
(5) Each removable bolt, screw, nut, (1) There must be a provision to latch
pin, or other removable fastener must each door.
meet the locking requirements of
(2) The latches and their operating
25.607.
mechanism must be designed so that,
(6) Certain doors, as specified by
under all airplane flight and ground
25.807(h), must also meet the applica-
loading conditions, with the door
ble requirements of 25.809 through
latched, there is no force or torque
25.812 for emergency exits.
tending to unlatch the latches. In addi-
(b) Opening by persons. There must be
tion, the latching system must include
a means to safeguard each door against
a means to secure the latches in the
opening during flight due to inad-
latched position. This means must be
vertent action by persons. In addition,
independent of the locking system.
design precautions must be taken to
minimize the possibility for a person to (3) Each door subject to pressuriza-
open a door intentionally during flight. tion, and for which the initial opening
If these precautions include the use of movement is not inward, must
auxiliary devices, those devices and (i) Have an individual lock for each
their controlling systems must be de- latch;
signed so that (ii) Have the lock located as close as
(1) No single failure will prevent practicable to the latch; and
more than one exit from being opened; (iii) Be designed so that, during pres-
and surized flight, no single failure in the
(2) Failures that would prevent open- locking system would prevent the
ing of the exit after landing are im- locks from restraining the latches nec-
probable. essary to secure the door.
(c) Pressurization prevention means. (4) Each door for which the initial
There must be a provision to prevent opening movement is inward, and
pressurization of the airplane to an un- unlatching of the door could result in a
safe level if any door subject to pres- hazard, must have a locking means to
surization is not fully closed, latched, prevent the latches from becoming dis-
and locked. engaged. The locking means must en-
(1) The provision must be designed to sure sufficient latching to prevent
function after any single failure, or opening of the door even with a single
after any combination of failures not failure of the latching mechanism.
shown to be extremely improbable. (5) It must not be possible to position
(2) Doors that meet the conditions the lock in the locked position if the
described in paragraph (h) of this sec- latch and the latching mechanism are
tion are not required to have a dedi- not in the latched position.

413

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00423 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.783 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(6) It must not be possible to unlatch lighting conditions, or by means of a


the latches with the locks in the flashlight or equivalent light source.
locked position. Locks must be de- (g) Certain maintenance doors, remov-
signed to withstand the limit loads re- able emergency exits, and access panels.
sulting from Some doors not normally opened ex-
(i) The maximum operator effort cept for maintenance purposes or emer-
when the latches are operated manu- gency evacuation and some access pan-
ally; els need not comply with certain para-
(ii) The powered latch actuators, if graphs of this section as follows:
installed; and (1) Access panels that are not subject
(iii) The relative motion between the to cabin pressurization and would not
latch and the structural counterpart. be a hazard if open during flight need
(7) Each door for which unlatching not comply with paragraphs (a)
would not result in a hazard is not re- through (f) of this section, but must
quired to have a locking mechanism have a means to prevent inadvertent
meeting the requirements of para- opening during flight.
graphs (d)(3) through (d)(6) of this sec- (2) Inward-opening removable emer-
tion. gency exits that are not normally re-
(e) Warning, caution, and advisory in- moved, except for maintenance pur-
dications. Doors must be provided with poses or emergency evacuation, and
the following indications: flight deck-openable windows need not
(1) There must be a positive means to comply with paragraphs (c) and (f) of
indicate at each door operators station this section.
that all required operations to close, (3) Maintenance doors that meet the
latch, and lock the door(s) have been conditions of paragraph (h) of this sec-
completed. tion, and for which a placard is pro-
(2) There must be a positive means vided limiting use to maintenance ac-
clearly visible from each operator sta- cess, need not comply with paragraphs
tion for any door that could be a haz- (c) and (f) of this section.
ard if unlatched to indicate if the door (h) Doors that are not a hazard. For
is not fully closed, latched, and locked. the purposes of this section, a door is
(3) There must be a visual means on considered not to be a hazard in the un-
the flight deck to signal the pilots if latched condition during flight, pro-
any door is not fully closed, latched, vided it can be shown to meet all of the
and locked. The means must be de- following conditions:
signed such that any failure or com- (1) Doors in pressurized compart-
bination of failures that would result ments would remain in the fully closed
in an erroneous closed, latched, and position if not restrained by the
locked indication is improbable for latches when subject to a pressure
(i) Each door that is subject to pres- greater than 12 psi. Opening by persons,
surization and for which the initial either inadvertently or intentionally,
opening movement is not inward; or need not be considered in making this
(ii) Each door that could be a hazard determination.
if unlatched. (2) The door would remain inside the
(4) There must be an aural warning airplane or remain attached to the air-
to the pilots prior to or during the ini- plane if it opens either in pressurized
tial portion of takeoff roll if any door or unpressurized portions of the flight.
is not fully closed, latched, and locked, This determination must include the
and its opening would prevent a safe consideration of inadvertent and inten-
takeoff and return to landing. tional opening by persons during either
(f) Visual inspection provision. Each pressurized or unpressurized portions
door for which unlatching of the door of the flight.
could be a hazard must have a provi- (3) The disengagement of the latches
sion for direct visual inspection to de- during flight would not allow depres-
termine, without ambiguity, if the surization of the cabin to an unsafe
door is fully closed, latched, and level. This safety assessment must in-
locked. The provision must be perma- clude the physiological effects on the
nent and discernible under operational occupants.

414

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00424 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.785

(4) The open door during flight would (e) Each berth must be designed so
not create aerodynamic interference that the forward part has a padded end
that could preclude safe flight and board, canvas diaphragm, or equivalent
landing. means, that can withstand the static
(5) The airplane would meet the load reaction of the occupant when
structural design requirements with subjected to the forward inertia force
the door open. This assessment must specified in 25.561. Berths must be free
include the aeroelastic stability re- from corners and protuberances likely
quirements of 25.629, as well as the to cause injury to a person occupying
strength requirements of subpart C of the berth during emergency conditions.
this part. (f) Each seat or berth, and its sup-
(6) The unlatching or opening of the porting structure, and each safety belt
door must not preclude safe flight and or harness and its anchorage must be
landing as a result of interaction with designed for an occupant weight of 170
other systems or structures. pounds, considering the maximum load
[Doc. No. 200314193, 69 FR 24501, May 3, 2004] factors, inertia forces, and reactions
among the occupant, seat, safety belt,
25.785 Seats, berths, safety belts, and and harness for each relevant flight
harnesses. and ground load condition (including
(a) A seat (or berth for a nonambu- the emergency landing conditions pre-
lant person) must be provided for each scribed in 25.561). In addition
occupant who has reached his or her (1) The structural analysis and test-
second birthday. ing of the seats, berths, and their sup-
(b) Each seat, berth, safety belt, har- porting structures may be determined
ness, and adjacent part of the airplane by assuming that the critical load in
at each station designated as occupi- the forward, sideward, downward, up-
able during takeoff and landing must ward, and rearward directions (as de-
be designed so that a person making termined from the prescribed flight,
proper use of these facilities will not ground, and emergency landing condi-
suffer serious injury in an emergency tions) acts separately or using selected
landing as a result of the inertia forces combinations of loads if the required
specified in 25.561 and 25.562. strength in each specified direction is
(c) Each seat or berth must be ap- substantiated. The forward load factor
proved. need not be applied to safety belts for
(d) Each occupant of a seat that berths.
makes more than an 18-degree angle (2) Each pilot seat must be designed
with the vertical plane containing the for the reactions resulting from the ap-
airplane centerline must be protected plication of the pilot forces prescribed
from head injury by a safety belt and in 25.395.
an energy absorbing rest that will sup- (3) The inertia forces specified in
port the arms, shoulders, head, and 25.561 must be multiplied by a factor
spine, or by a safety belt and shoulder of 1.33 (instead of the fitting factor pre-
harness that will prevent the head scribed in 25.625) in determining the
from contacting any injurious object. strength of the attachment of each
Each occupant of any other seat must seat to the structure and each belt or
be protected from head injury by a harness to the seat or structure.
safety belt and, as appropriate to the (g) Each seat at a flight deck station
type, location, and angle of facing of must have a restraint system con-
each seat, by one or more of the fol- sisting of a combined safety belt and
lowing: shoulder harness with a single-point re-
(1) A shoulder harness that will pre- lease that permits the flight deck occu-
vent the head from contacting any in- pant, when seated with the restraint
jurious object. system fastened, to perform all of the
(2) The elimination of any injurious occupants necessary flight deck func-
object within striking radius of the tions. There must be a means to secure
head. each combined restraint system when
(3) An energy absorbing rest that will not in use to prevent interference with
support the arms, shoulders, head, and the operation of the airplane and with
spine. rapid egress in an emergency.

415

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00425 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.787 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(h) Each seat located in the pas- ducting the necessary enroute inspec-
senger compartment and designated for tion.
use during takeoff and landing by a [Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29780, July 20, 1990, as
flight attendant required by the oper- amended by Amdt. 2588, 61 FR 57956, Nov. 8,
ating rules of this chapter must be: 1996]
(1) Near a required floor level emer-
gency exit, except that another loca- 25.787 Stowage compartments.
tion is acceptable if the emergency (a) Each compartment for the stow-
egress of passengers would be enhanced age of cargo, baggage, carry-on arti-
with that location. A flight attendant cles, and equipment (such as life rafts),
seat must be located adjacent to each and any other stowage compartment
Type A or B emergency exit. Other must be designed for its placarded max-
flight attendant seats must be evenly imum weight of contents and for the
critical load distribution at the appro-
distributed among the required floor-
priate maximum load factors cor-
level emergency exits to the extent
responding to the specified flight and
feasible. ground load conditions, and to the
(2) To the extent possible, without emergency landing conditions of
compromising proximity to a required 25.561(b), except that the forces speci-
floor level emergency exit, located to fied in the emergency landing condi-
provide a direct view of the cabin area tions need not be applied to compart-
for which the flight attendant is re- ments located below, or forward, of all
sponsible. occupants in the airplane. If the air-
(3) Positioned so that the seat will plane has a passenger seating configu-
not interfere with the use of a passage- ration, excluding pilots seats, of 10
way or exit when the seat is not in use. seats or more, each stowage compart-
(4) Located to minimize the prob- ment in the passenger cabin, except for
ability that occupants would suffer in- underseat and overhead compartments
jury by being struck by items dislodged for passenger convenience, must be
from service areas, stowage compart- completely enclosed.
ments, or service equipment. (b) There must be a means to prevent
the contents in the compartments from
(5) Either forward or rearward facing
becoming a hazard by shifting, under
with an energy absorbing rest that is
the loads specified in paragraph (a) of
designed to support the arms, shoul- this section. For stowage compart-
ders, head, and spine. ments in the passenger and crew cabin,
(6) Equipped with a restraint system if the means used is a latched door, the
consisting of a combined safety belt design must take into consideration
and shoulder harness unit with a single the wear and deterioration expected in
point release. There must be means to service.
secure each restraint system when not (c) If cargo compartment lamps are
in use to prevent interference with installed, each lamp must be installed
rapid egress in an emergency. so as to prevent contact between lamp
(i) Each safety belt must be equipped bulb and cargo.
with a metal to metal latching device. [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
(j) If the seat backs do not provide a amended by Amdt. 2532, 37 FR 3969, Feb. 24,
firm handhold, there must be a hand- 1972; Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55466, Dec. 20, 1976;
grip or rail along each aisle to enable Amdt. 2551, 45 FR 7755, Feb. 4, 1980]
persons to steady themselves while
25.789 Retention of items of mass in
using the aisles in moderately rough passenger and crew compartments
air. and galleys.
(k) Each projecting object that would (a) Means must be provided to pre-
injure persons seated or moving about vent each item of mass (that is part of
the airplane in normal flight must be the airplane type design) in a passenger
padded. or crew compartment or galley from
(l) Each forward observers seat re- becoming a hazard by shifting under
quired by the operating rules must be the appropriate maximum load factors
shown to be suitable for use in con- corresponding to the specified flight

416

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00426 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.801

and ground load conditions, and to the 25.795 Security considerations.


emergency landing conditions of (a) Protection of flightdeck. If a
25.561(b). flightdeck door is required by oper-
(b) Each interphone restraint system ating rules, the door installation must
must be designed so that when sub- be designed to:
jected to the load factors specified in (1) Resist forcible intrusion by unau-
25.561(b)(3), the interphone will re- thorized persons and be capable of
main in its stowed position. withstanding impacts of 300 Joules
[Amdt. 2532, 37 FR 3969, Feb. 24, 1972, as (221.3 foot-pounds) at the critical loca-
amended by Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50596, Oct. 30, tions on the door, as well as a 250
1978] pound (1113 Newtons) constant tensile
load on the knob or handle, and
25.791 Passenger information signs (2) Resist penetration by small arms
and placards. fire and fragmentation devices to a
(a) If smoking is to be prohibited, level equivalent to level IIIa of the Na-
there must be at least one placard so tional Institute of Justice Standard
stating that is legible to each person (NIJ) 0101.04.
seated in the cabin. If smoking is to be (b) [Reserved]
allowed, and if the crew compartment [Doc. No. FAA200111032, 67 FR 2127, Jan. 15,
is separated from the passenger com- 2002]
partment, there must be at least one
sign notifying when smoking is prohib- EMERGENCY PROVISIONS
ited. Signs which notify when smoking
25.801 Ditching.
is prohibited must be operable by a
member of the flightcrew and, when il- (a) If certification with ditching pro-
luminated, must be legible under all visions is requested, the airplane must
probable conditions of cabin illumina- meet the requirements of this section
tion to each person seated in the cabin. and 25.807(e), 25.1411, and 25.1415(a).
(b) Signs that notify when seat belts (b) Each practicable design measure,
should be fastened and that are in- compatible with the general character-
stalled to comply with the operating istics of the airplane, must be taken to
rules of this chapter must be operable minimize the probability that in an
by a member of the flightcrew and, emergency landing on water, the be-
when illuminated, must be legible havior of the airplane would cause im-
under all probable conditions of cabin mediate injury to the occupants or
illumination to each person seated in would make it impossible for them to
the cabin. escape.
(c) The probable behavior of the air-
(c) A placard must be located on or
plane in a water landing must be inves-
adjacent to the door of each receptacle
tigated by model tests or by compari-
used for the disposal of flammable
son with airplanes of similar configura-
waste materials to indicate that use of
tion for which the ditching characteris-
the receptacle for disposal of ciga-
tics are known. Scoops, flaps, projec-
rettes, etc., is prohibited.
tions, and any other factor likely to af-
(d) Lavatories must have No Smok- fect the hydrodynamic characteristics
ing or No Smoking in Lavatory of the airplane, must be considered.
placards conspicuously located on or (d) It must be shown that, under rea-
adjacent to each side of the entry door. sonably probable water conditions, the
(e) Symbols that clearly express the flotation time and trim of the airplane
intent of the sign or placard may be will allow the occupants to leave the
used in lieu of letters. airplane and enter the liferafts re-
[Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29780, July 20, 1990] quired by 25.1415. If compliance with
this provision is shown by buoyancy
25.793 Floor surfaces. and trim computations, appropriate al-
lowances must be made for probable
The floor surface of all areas which
structural damage and leakage. If the
are likely to become wet in service
airplane has fuel tanks (with fuel jetti-
must have slip resistant properties.
soning provisions) that can reasonably
[Amdt. 2551, 45 FR 7755, Feb. 4, 1980] be expected to withstand a ditching

417

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00427 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.803 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

without leakage, the jettisonable vol- greater than seven inches. Type II exits
ume of fuel may be considered as buoy- must be floor-level exits unless located
ancy volume. over the wing, in which case they must
(e) Unless the effects of the collapse not have a step-up inside the airplane
of external doors and windows are ac- of more than 10 inches nor a step-down
counted for in the investigation of the outside the airplane of more than 17
probable behavior of the airplane in a inches.
water landing (as prescribed in para- (3) Type III. This type is a rectan-
graphs (c) and (d) of this section), the gular opening of not less than 20 inches
external doors and windows must be wide by 36 inches high with corner
designed to withstand the probable radii not greater than seven inches,
maximum local pressures. and with a step-up inside the airplane
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as of not more than 20 inches. If the exit
amended by Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29781, July 20, is located over the wing, the step-down
1990] outside the airplane may not exceed 27
inches.
25.803 Emergency evacuation. (4) Type IV. This type is a rectan-
(a) Each crew and passenger area gular opening of not less than 19 inches
must have emergency means to allow wide by 26 inches high, with corner
rapid evacuation in crash landings, radii not greater than 6.3 inches, lo-
with the landing gear extended as well cated over the wing, with a step-up in-
as with the landing gear retracted, con- side the airplane of not more than 29
sidering the possibility of the airplane inches and a step-down outside the air-
being on fire. plane of not more than 36 inches.
(b) [Reserved] (5) Ventral. This type is an exit from
(c) For airplanes having a seating ca- the passenger compartment through
pacity of more than 44 passengers, it the pressure shell and the bottom fuse-
must be shown that the maximum lage skin. The dimensions and physical
seating capacity, including the number configuration of this type of exit must
of crewmembers required by the oper- allow at least the same rate of egress
ating rules for which certification is as a Type I exit with the airplane in
requested, can be evacuated from the the normal ground attitude, with land-
airplane to the ground under simulated ing gear extended.
emergency conditions within 90 sec- (6) Tailcone. This type is an aft exit
onds. Compliance with this require- from the passenger compartment
ment must be shown by actual dem- through the pressure shell and through
onstration using the test criteria out- an openable cone of the fuselage aft of
lined in appendix J of this part unless the pressure shell. The means of open-
the Administrator finds that a com- ing the tailcone must be simple and ob-
bination of analysis and testing will vious and must employ a single oper-
provide data equivalent to that which ation.
would be obtained by actual dem- (7) Type A. This type is a floor-level
onstration. exit with a rectangular opening of not
(d)(e) [Reserved] less than 42 inches wide by 72 inches
[Doc. No. 24344, 55 FR 29781, July 20, 1990] high, with corner radii not greater
than seven inches.
25.807 Emergency exits. (8) Type B. This type is a floor-level
(a) Type. For the purpose of this part, exit with a rectangular opening of not
the types of exits are defined as fol- less than 32 inches wide by 72 inches
lows: high, with corner radii not greater
(1) Type I. This type is a floor-level than six inches.
exit with a rectangular opening of not (9) Type C. This type is a floor-level
less than 24 inches wide by 48 inches exit with a rectangular opening of not
high, with corner radii not greater less than 30 inches wide by 48 inches
than eight inches. high, with corner radii not greater
(2) Type II. This type is a rectangular than 10 inches.
opening of not less than 20 inches wide (b) Step down distance. Step down dis-
by 44 inches high, with corner radii not tance, as used in this section, means

418

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00428 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.807

the actual distance between the bot- of the fuselage. Except as further re-
tom of the required opening and a usa- stricted in paragraphs (g)(1) through
ble foot hold, extending out from the (g)(9) of this section, the maximum
fuselage, that is large enough to be ef- number of passenger seats permitted
fective without searching by sight or for each exit of a specific type installed
feel. in each side of the fuselage is as fol-
(c) Over-sized exits. Openings larger lows:
than those specified in this section, Type A 110
whether or not of rectangular shape, Type B 75
may be used if the specified rectan- Type C 55
gular opening can be inscribed within Type I 45
the opening and the base of the in- Type II 40
scribed rectangular opening meets the Type III 35
Type IV 9
specified step-up and step-down
heights. (1) For a passenger seating configura-
(d) Asymmetry. Exits of an exit pair tion of 1 to 9 seats, there must be at
need not be diametrically opposite least one Type IV or larger overwing
each other nor of the same size; how- exit in each side of the fuselage or, if
ever, the number of passenger seats overwing exits are not provided, at
permitted under paragraph (g) of this least one exit in each side that meets
section is based on the smaller of the the minimum dimensions of a Type III
two exits. exit.
(e) Uniformity. Exits must be distrib- (2) For a passenger seating configura-
uted as uniformly as practical, taking tion of more than 9 seats, each exit
into account passenger seat distribu- must be a Type III or larger exit.
tion. (3) For a passenger seating configura-
(f) Location. (1) Each required pas- tion of 10 to 19 seats, there must be at
senger emergency exit must be acces- least one Type III or larger exit in each
sible to the passengers and located side of the fuselage.
where it will afford the most effective (4) For a passenger seating configura-
means of passenger evacuation. tion of 20 to 40 seats, there must be at
(2) If only one floor-level exit per side least two exits, one of which must be a
is prescribed, and the airplane does not Type II or larger exit, in each side of
have a tailcone or ventral emergency the fuselage.
exit, the floor-level exits must be in (5) For a passenger seating configura-
the rearward part of the passenger tion of 41 to 110 seats, there must be at
compartment unless another location least two exits, one of which must be a
affords a more effective means of pas- Type I or larger exit, in each side of
senger evacuation. the fuselage.
(3) If more than one floor-level exit (6) For a passenger seating configura-
per side is prescribed, and the airplane tion of more than 110 seats, the emer-
does not have a combination cargo and gency exits in each side of the fuselage
passenger configuration, at least one must include at least two Type I or
floor-level exit must be located in each larger exits.
side near each end of the cabin. (7) The combined maximum number
(4) For an airplane that is required to of passenger seats permitted for all
have more than one passenger emer- Type III exits is 70, and the combined
gency exit for each side of the fuselage, maximum number of passenger seats
no passenger emergency exit shall be permitted for two Type III exits in
more than 60 feet from any adjacent each side of the fuselage that are sepa-
passenger emergency exit on the same rated by fewer than three passenger
side of the same deck of the fuselage, seat rows is 65.
as measured parallel to the airplanes (8) If a Type A, Type B, or Type C
longitudinal axis between the nearest exit is installed, there must be at least
exit edges. two Type C or larger exits in each side
(g) Type and number required. The of the fuselage.
maximum number of passenger seats (9) If a passenger ventral or tailcone
permitted depends on the type and exit is installed and that exit provides
number of exits installed in each side at least the same rate of egress as a

419

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00429 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.809 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

Type III exit with the airplane in the airplane, meeting at least the dimen-
most adverse exit opening condition sions of a Type III exit for each unit (or
that would result from the collapse of part of a unit) of 35 passenger seats,
one or more legs of the landing gear, an but no less than two such exits in the
increase in the passenger seating con- passenger cabin, with one on each side
figuration is permitted as follows: of the airplane. The passenger seat/
(i) For a ventral exit, 12 additional exit ratio may be increased through
passenger seats. the use of larger exits, or other means,
(ii) For a tailcone exit incorporating provided it is shown that the evacu-
a floor level opening of not less than 20 ation capability during ditching has
inches wide by 60 inches high, with cor- been improved accordingly.
ner radii not greater than seven inches, (3) If it is impractical to locate side
in the pressure shell and incorporating exits above the waterline, the side
an approved assist means in accordance exits must be replaced by an equal
with 25.810(a), 25 additional passenger number of readily accessible overhead
seats. hatches of not less than the dimensions
(iii) For a tailcone exit incorporating of a Type III exit, except that for air-
an opening in the pressure shell which planes with a passenger configuration
is at least equivalent to a Type III of 35 or fewer seats, excluding pilot
emergency exit with respect to dimen- seats, the two required Type III side
sions, step-up and step-down distance, exits need be replaced by only one
and with the top of the opening not overhead hatch.
less than 56 inches from the passenger (j) Flightcrew emergency exits. For air-
compartment floor, 15 additional pas- planes in which the proximity of pas-
senger seats. senger emergency exits to the
(h) Other exits. The following exits flightcrew area does not offer a conven-
also must meet the applicable emer- ient and readily accessible means of
gency exit requirements of 25.809
evacuation of the flightcrew, and for
through 25.812, and must be readily ac-
all airplanes having a passenger seat-
cessible:
ing capacity greater than 20, flightcrew
(1) Each emergency exit in the pas-
exits shall be located in the flightcrew
senger compartment in excess of the
area. Such exits shall be of sufficient
minimum number of required emer-
size and so located as to permit rapid
gency exits.
evacuation by the crew. One exit shall
(2) Any other floor-level door or exit
be provided on each side of the air-
that is accessible from the passenger
plane; or, alternatively, a top hatch
compartment and is as large or larger
than a Type II exit, but less than 46 shall be provided. Each exit must en-
inches wide. compass an unobstructed rectangular
(3) Any other ventral or tail cone opening of at least 19 by 20 inches un-
passenger exit. less satisfactory exit utility can be
(i) Ditching emergency exits for pas- demonstrated by a typical crew-
sengers. Whether or not ditching cer- member.
tification is requested, ditching emer- [Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29781, July 20, 1990, as
gency exits must be provided in accord- amended by Amdt. 2588, 61 FR 57956, Nov. 8,
ance with the following requirements, 1996; 62 FR 1817, Jan. 13, 1997; Amdt. 2594, 63
unless the emergency exits required by FR 8848, Feb. 23, 1998; 63 FR 12862, Mar. 16,
paragraph (g) of this section already 1998; Amdt. 25114, 69 FR 24502, May 3, 2004]
meet them:
(1) For airplanes that have a pas- 25.809 Emergency exit arrangement.
senger seating configuration of nine or (a) Each emergency exit, including
fewer seats, excluding pilot seats, one each flightcrew emergency exit, must
exit above the waterline in each side of be a moveable door or hatch in the ex-
the airplane, meeting at least the di- ternal walls of the fuselage, allowing
mensions of a Type IV exit. an unobstructed opening to the out-
(2) For airplanes that have a pas- side. In addition, each emergency exit
senger seating configuration of 10 of must have means to permit viewing of
more seats, excluding pilot seats, one the conditions outside the exit when
exit above the waterline in a side of the the exit is closed. The viewing means

420

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00430 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.810

may be on or adjacent to the exit pro- ments of paragraphs (b) and (c) of this
vided no obstructions exist between the section.
exit and the viewing means. Means (f) Each door must be located where
must also be provided to permit view- persons using them will not be endan-
ing of the likely areas of evacuee gered by the propellers when appro-
ground contact. The likely areas of priate operating procedures are used.
evacuee ground contact must be (g) There must be provisions to mini-
viewable during all lighting conditions mize the probability of jamming of the
with the landing gear extended as well emergency exits resulting from fuse-
as in all conditions of landing gear col- lage deformation in a minor crash
lapse. landing.
(b) Each emergency exit must be (h) When required by the operating
openable from the inside and the out- rules for any large passenger-carrying
side except that sliding window emer- turbojet-powered airplane, each ven-
gency exits in the flight crew area need tral exit and tailcone exit must be
not be openable from the outside if (1) Designed and constructed so that
other approved exits are convenient it cannot be opened during flight; and
and readily accessible to the flight (2) Marked with a placard readable
crew area. Each emergency exit must from a distance of 30 inches and in-
be capable of being opened, when there stalled at a conspicuous location near
is no fuselage deformation the means of opening the exit, stating
(1) With the airplane in the normal that the exit has been designed and
ground attitude and in each of the atti- constructed so that it cannot be opened
tudes corresponding to collapse of one during flight.
or more legs of the landing gear; and (i) Each emergency exit must have a
(2) Within 10 seconds measured from means to retain the exit in the open
the time when the opening means is ac- position, once the exit is opened in an
tuated to the time when the exit is emergency. The means must not re-
fully opened. quire separate action to engage when
(3) Even though persons may be the exit is opened, and must require
crowded against the door on the inside positive action to disengage.
of the airplane. [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
(c) The means of opening emergency amended by Amdt. 2515, 32 FR 13264, Sept.
exits must be simple and obvious; may 20, 1967; Amdt. 2532, 37 FR 3970, Feb. 24, 1972;
not require exceptional effort; and Amdt. 2534, 37 FR 25355, Nov. 30, 1972; Amdt.
2546, 43 FR 50597, Oct. 30, 1978; Amdt. 2547,
must be arranged and marked so that 44 FR 61325, Oct. 25, 1979; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR
it can be readily located and operated, 29782, July 20, 1990; Amdt. 25114, 69 FR 24502,
even in darkness. Internal exit-opening May 3, 2004; Amdt. 25116, 69 FR 62788, Oct. 27,
means involving sequence operations 2004]
(such as operation of two handles or
latches, or the release of safety 25.810 Emergency egress assist
catches) may be used for flightcrew means and escape routes.
emergency exits if it can be reasonably (a) Each non over-wing Type A, Type
established that these means are sim- B or Type C exit, and any other non
ple and obvious to crewmembers over-wing landplane emergency exit
trained in their use. more than 6 feet from the ground with
(d) If a single power-boost or single the airplane on the ground and the
power-operated system is the primary landing gear extended, must have an
system for operating more than one approved means to assist the occupants
exit in an emergency, each exit must in descending to the ground.
be capable of meeting the requirements (1) The assisting means for each pas-
of paragraph (b) of this section in the senger emergency exit must be a self-
event of failure of the primary system. supporting slide or equivalent; and, in
Manual operation of the exit (after the case of Type A or Type B exits, it
failure of the primary system) is ac- must be capable of carrying simulta-
ceptable. neously two parallel lines of evacuees.
(e) Each emergency exit must be In addition, the assisting means must
shown by tests, or by a combination of be designed to meet the following re-
analysis and tests, to meet the require- quirements

421

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00431 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.810 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(i) It must be automatically deployed means is a rope, or an approved device


and deployment must begin during the equivalent to a rope, it must be
interval between the time the exit (i) Attached to the fuselage structure
opening means is actuated from inside at or above the top of the emergency
the airplane and the time the exit is exit opening, or, for a device at a pi-
fully opened. However, each passenger lots emergency exit window, at an-
emergency exit which is also a pas- other approved location if the stowed
senger entrance door or a service door device, or its attachment, would reduce
must be provided with means to pre- the pilots view in flight;
vent deployment of the assisting means (ii) Able (with its attachment) to
when it is opened from either the in- withstand a 400-pound static load.
side or the outside under non- (b) Assist means from the cabin to
emergency conditions for normal use. the wing are required for each type A
(ii) Except for assisting means in- or Type B exit located above the wing
stalled at Type C exits, it must be and having a stepdown unless the exit
automatically erected within 6 seconds without an assist-means can be shown
after deployment is begun. Assisting to have a rate of passenger egress at
means installed at Type C exits must least equal to that of the same type of
be automatically erected within 10 sec- non over-wing exit. If an assist means
onds from the time the opening means is required, it must be automatically
of the exit is actuated. deployed and automatically erected
(iii) It must be of such length after concurrent with the opening of the
full deployment that the lower end is exit. In the case of assist means in-
self-supporting on the ground and pro- stalled at Type C exits, it must be self-
vides safe evacuation of occupants to supporting within 10 seconds from the
the ground after collapse of one or time the opening means of the exits is
more legs of the landing gear. actuated. For all other exit types, it
must be self-supporting 6 seconds after
(iv) It must have the capability, in
deployment is begun.
25-knot winds directed from the most
(c) An escape route must be estab-
critical angle, to deploy and, with the
lished from each overwing emergency
assistance of only one person, to re- exit, and (except for flap surfaces suit-
main usable after full deployment to able as slides) covered with a slip re-
evacuate occupants safely to the sistant surface. Except where a means
ground. for channeling the flow of evacuees is
(v) For each system installation provided
(mockup or airplane installed), five (1) The escape route from each Type
consecutive deployment and inflation A or Type B passenger emergency exit,
tests must be conducted (per exit) or any common escape route from two
without failure, and at least three tests Type III passenger emergency exits,
of each such five-test series must be must be at least 42 inches wide; that
conducted using a single representative from any other passenger emergency
sample of the device. The sample de- exit must be at least 24 inches wide;
vices must be deployed and inflated by and
the systems primary means after (2) The escape route surface must
being subjected to the inertia forces have a reflectance of at least 80 per-
specified in 25.561(b). If any part of the cent, and must be defined by markings
system fails or does not function prop- with a surface-to-marking contrast
erly during the required tests, the ratio of at least 5:1.
cause of the failure or malfunction (d) Means must be provided to assist
must be corrected by positive means evacuees to reach the ground for all
and after that, the full series of five Type C exits located over the wing and,
consecutive deployment and inflation if the place on the airplane structure
tests must be conducted without fail- at which the escape route required in
ure. paragraph (c) of this section termi-
(2) The assisting means for flightcrew nates is more than 6 feet from the
emergency exits may be a rope or any ground with the airplane on the ground
other means demonstrated to be suit- and the landing gear extended, for all
able for the purpose. If the assisting other exit types.

422

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00432 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.811

(1) If the escape route is over the (c) Means must be provided to assist
flap, the height of the terminal edge the occupants in locating the exits in
must be measured with the flap in the conditions of dense smoke.
takeoff or landing position, whichever (d) The location of each passenger
is higher from the ground. emergency exit must be indicated by a
(2) The assisting means must be usa- sign visible to occupants approaching
ble and self-supporting with one or along the main passenger aisle (or
more landing gear legs collapsed and aisles). There must be
under a 25-knot wind directed from the (1) A passenger emergency exit loca-
most critical angle. tor sign above the aisle (or aisles) near
(3) The assisting means provided for each passenger emergency exit, or at
each escape route leading from a Type another overhead location if it is more
A or B emergency exit must be capable practical because of low headroom, ex-
of carrying simultaneously two par- cept that one sign may serve more
allel lines of evacuees; and, the assist- than one exit if each exit can be seen
ing means leading from any other exit readily from the sign;
type must be capable of carrying as (2) A passenger emergency exit mark-
many parallel lines of evacuees as ing sign next to each passenger emer-
there are required escape routes. gency exit, except that one sign may
(4) The assisting means provided for serve two such exits if they both can be
each escape route leading from a Type seen readily from the sign; and
C exit must be automatically erected (3) A sign on each bulkhead or divider
within 10 seconds from the time the that prevents fore and aft vision along
opening means of the exit is actuated, the passenger cabin to indicate emer-
and that provided for the escape route gency exits beyond and obscured by the
leading from any other exit type must bulkhead or divider, except that if this
be automatically erected within 10 sec- is not possible the sign may be placed
onds after actuation of the erection at another appropriate location.
system.
(e) The location of the operating han-
(e) If an integral stair is installed in
dle and instructions for opening exits
a passenger entry door that is qualified
from the inside of the airplane must be
as a passenger emergency exit, the
shown in the following manner:
stair must be designed so that, under
the following conditions, the effective- (1) Each passenger emergency exit
ness of passenger emergency egress will must have, on or near the exit, a mark-
not be impaired: ing that is readable from a distance of
(1) The door, integral stair, and oper- 30 inches.
ating mechanism have been subjected (2) Each Type A, Type B, Type C or
to the inertia forces specified in Type I passenger emergency exit oper-
25.561(b)(3), acting separately relative ating handle must
to the surrounding structure. (i) Be self-illuminated with an initial
(2) The airplane is in the normal brightness of at least 160 micro-
ground attitude and in each of the atti- lamberts; or
tudes corresponding to collapse of one (ii) Be conspicuously located and well
or more legs of the landing gear. illuminated by the emergency lighting
even in conditions of occupant crowd-
[Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29782, July 20, 1990, as
amended by Amdt. 2588, 61 FR 57958, Nov. 8,
ing at the exit.
1996; 62 FR 1817, Jan. 13, 1997; Amdt. 25114, 69 (3) [Reserved]
FR 24502, May 3, 2004] (4) Each Type A, Type B, Type C,
Type I, or Type II passenger emergency
25.811 Emergency exit marking. exit with a locking mechanism re-
(a) Each passenger emergency exit, leased by rotary motion of the handle
its means of access, and its means of must be marked
opening must be conspicuously (i) With a red arrow, with a shaft at
marked. least three-fourths of an inch wide and
(b) The identity and location of each a head twice the width of the shaft, ex-
passenger emergency exit must be rec- tending along at least 70 degrees of arc
ognizable from a distance equal to the at a radius approximately equal to
width of the cabin. three-fourths of the handle length.

423

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00433 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.812 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(ii) So that the centerline of the exit tem, must be installed. However, the
handle is within 1 inch of the pro- sources of general cabin illumination
jected point of the arrow when the han- may be common to both the emergency
dle has reached full travel and has re- and the main lighting systems if the
leased the locking mechanism, and power supply to the emergency light-
(iii) With the word open in red let- ing system is independent of the power
ters 1 inch high, placed horizontally supply to the main lighting system.
near the head of the arrow. The emergency lighting system must
(f) Each emergency exit that is re- include:
quired to be openable from the outside, (1) Illuminated emergency exit mark-
and its means of opening, must be ing and locating signs, sources of gen-
marked on the outside of the airplane. eral cabin illumination, interior light-
In addition, the following apply: ing in emergency exit areas, and floor
(1) The outside marking for each pas- proximity escape path marking.
senger emergency exit in the side of (2) Exterior emergency lighting.
the fuselage must include a 2-inch col- (b) Emergency exit signs
ored band outlining the exit. (1) For airplanes that have a pas-
(2) Each outside marking including senger seating configuration, excluding
the band, must have color contrast to pilot seats, of 10 seats or more must
be readily distinguishable from the sur- meet the following requirements:
rounding fuselage surface. The contrast (i) Each passenger emergency exit lo-
must be such that if the reflectance of cator sign required by 25.811(d)(1) and
the darker color is 15 percent or less, each passenger emergency exit mark-
the reflectance of the lighter color ing sign required by 25.811(d)(2) must
must be at least 45 percent. Reflec- have red letters at least 112 inches high
tance is the ratio of the luminous flux on an illuminated white background,
reflected by a body to the luminous and must have an area of at least 21
flux it receives. When the reflectance square inches excluding the letters.
of the darker color is greater than 15 The lighted background-to-letter con-
percent, at least a 30-percent difference trast must be at least 10 : 1. The letter
between its reflectance and the reflec- height to stroke-width ratio may not
tance of the lighter color must be pro- be more than 7 : 1 nor less than 6 : 1.
vided. These signs must be internally elec-
(3) In the case of exists other than trically illuminated with a background
those in the side of the fuselage, such brightness of at least 25 foot-lamberts
as ventral or tailcone exists, the exter- and a high-to-low background contrast
nal means of opening, including in- no greater than 3 : 1.
structions if applicable, must be con- (ii) Each passenger emergency exit
spicuously marked in red, or bright sign required by 25.811(d)(3) must have
chrome yellow if the background color red letters at least 112 inches high on a
is such that red is inconspicuous. When white background having an area of at
the opening means is located on only least 21 square inches excluding the
one side of the fuselage, a conspicuous letters. These signs must be internally
marking to that effect must be pro- electrically illuminated or self-illumi-
vided on the other side. nated by other than electrical means
(g) Each sign required by paragraph and must have an initial brightness of
(d) of this section may use the word at least 400 microlamberts. The colors
exit in its legend in place of the may be reversed in the case of a sign
term emergency exit. that is self-illuminated by other than
electrical means.
[Amdt. 2515, 32 FR 13264, Sept. 20, 1967, as
amended by Amdt. 2532, 37 FR 3970, Feb. 24, (2) For airplanes that have a pas-
1972; Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50597, Oct. 30, 1978; 43 senger seating configuration, excluding
FR 52495, Nov. 13, 1978; Amdt. 2579, 58 FR pilot seats, of nine seats or less, that
45229, Aug. 26, 1993; Amdt. 2588, 61 FR 57958, are required by 25.811(d)(1), (2), and (3)
Nov. 8, 1996] must have red letters at least 1 inch
high on a white background at least 2
25.812 Emergency lighting. inches high. These signs may be inter-
(a) An emergency lighting system, nally electrically illuminated, or self-
independent of the main lighting sys- illuminated by other than electrical

424

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00434 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.812

means, with an initial brightness of at (1) The lights must be operable


least 160 microlamberts. The colors manually from the flight crew station
may be reversed in the case of a sign and from a point in the passenger com-
that is self-illuminated by other than partment that is readily accessible to a
electrical means. normal flight attendant seat.
(c) General illumination in the pas- (2) There must be a flight crew warn-
senger cabin must be provided so that ing light which illuminates when power
when measured along the centerline of is on in the airplane and the emergency
main passenger aisle(s), and cross lighting control device is not armed.
aisle(s) between main aisles, at seat (3) The cockpit control device must
arm-rest height and at 40-inch inter- have an on, off, and armed posi-
vals, the average illumination is not tion so that when armed in the cockpit
less than 0.05 foot-candle and the illu- or turned on at either the cockpit or
mination at each 40-inch interval is not flight attendant station the lights will
less than 0.01 foot-candle. A main pas- either light or remain lighted upon
senger aisle(s) is considered to extend interruption (except an interruption
along the fuselage from the most for- caused by a transverse vertical separa-
ward passenger emergency exit or tion of the fuselage during crash land-
cabin occupant seat, whichever is far- ing) of the airplanes normal electric
ther forward, to the most rearward pas- power. There must be a means to safe-
senger emergency exit or cabin occu- guard against inadvertent operation of
pant seat, whichever is farther aft. the control device from the armed or
(d) The floor of the passageway lead- on positions.
ing to each floor-level passenger emer- (g) Exterior emergency lighting must
gency exit, between the main aisles be provided as follows:
and the exit openings, must be pro- (1) At each overwing emergency exit
vided with illumination that is not less the illumination must be
than 0.02 foot-candle measured along a (i) Not less than 0.03 foot-candle
line that is within 6 inches of and par- (measured normal to the direction of
allel to the floor and is centered on the the incident light) on a 2-square-foot
passenger evacuation path. area where an evacuee is likely to
(e) Floor proximity emergency es- make his first step outside the cabin;
cape path marking must provide emer- (ii) Not less than 0.05 foot-candle
gency evacuation guidance for pas- (measured normal to the direction of
sengers when all sources of illumina- the incident light) for a minimum
tion more than 4 feet above the cabin width of 42 inches for a Type A
aisle floor are totally obscured. In the overwing emergency exit and two feet
dark of the night, the floor proximity for all other overwing emergency exits
emergency escape path marking must along the 30 percent of the slip-resist-
enable each passenger to ant portion of the escape route re-
(1) After leaving the passenger seat, quired in 25.810(c) that is farthest
visually identify the emergency escape from the exit; and
path along the cabin aisle floor to the (iii) Not less than 0.03 foot-candle on
first exits or pair of exits forward and the ground surface with the landing
aft of the seat; and gear extended (measured normal to the
(2) Readily identify each exit from direction of the incident light) where
the emergency escape path by ref- an evacuee using the established escape
erence only to markings and visual fea- route would normally make first con-
tures not more than 4 feet above the tact with the ground.
cabin floor. (2) At each non-overwing emergency
(f) Except for subsystems provided in exit not required by 25.810(a) to have
accordance with paragraph (h) of this descent assist means the illumination
section that serve no more than one as- must be not less than 0.03 foot-candle
sist means, are independent of the air- (measured normal to the direction of
planes main emergency lighting sys- the incident light) on the ground sur-
tem, and are automatically activated face with the landing gear extended
when the assist means is erected, the where an evacuee is likely to make
emergency lighting system must be de- first contact with the ground outside
signed as follows. the cabin.

425

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00435 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.813 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(h) The means required in 25.810(a) gle transverse vertical separation of


and (d) to assist the occupants in de- the fuselage during crash landing
scending to the ground must be illumi- (1) Not more than 25 percent of all
nated so that the erected assist means electrically illuminated emergency
is visible from the airplane. lights required by this section are ren-
(1) If the assist means is illuminated dered inoperative, in addition to the
by exterior emergency lighting, it lights that are directly damaged by the
must provide illumination of not less separation;
than 0.03 foot-candle (measured normal (2) Each electrically illuminated exit
to the direction of the incident light) sign required under 25.811(d)(2) re-
at the ground end of the erected assist mains operative exclusive of those that
means where an evacuee using the es- are directly damaged by the separa-
tablished escape route would normally tion; and
make first contact with the ground, (3) At least one required exterior
with the airplane in each of the atti- emergency light for each side of the
tudes corresponding to the collapse of airplane remains operative exclusive of
one or more legs of the landing gear.
those that are directly damaged by the
(2) If the emergency lighting sub- separation.
system illuminating the assist means
serves no other assist means, is inde- [Amdt. 2515, 32 FR 13265, Sept. 20, 1967, as
pendent of the airplanes main emer- amended by Amdt. 2528, 36 FR 16899, Aug. 26,
gency lighting system, and is auto- 1971; Amdt. 2532, 37 FR 3971, Feb. 24, 1972;
matically activated when the assist Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50597, Oct. 30, 1978; Amdt.
2558, 49 FR 43186, Oct. 26, 1984; Amdt. 2588,
means is erected, the lighting provi-
61 FR 57958, Nov. 8, 1996; Amdt. 25116, 69 FR
sions 62788, Oct. 27, 2004]
(i) May not be adversely affected by
stowage; and 25.813 Emergency exit access.
(ii) Must provide illumination of not
Each required emergency exit must
less than 0.03 foot-candle (measured
be accessible to the passengers and lo-
normal to the direction of incident
cated where it will afford an effective
light) at the ground and of the erected
means of evacuation. Emergency exit
assist means where an evacuee would
normally make first contact with the distribution must be as uniform as
ground, with the airplane in each of practical, taking passenger distribu-
the attitudes corresponding to the col- tion into account; however, the size
lapse of one or more legs of the landing and location of exits on both sides of
gear. the cabin need not be symmetrical. If
(i) The energy supply to each emer- only one floor level exit per side is pre-
gency lighting unit must provide the scribed, and the airplane does not have
required level of illumination for at a tailcone or ventral emergency exit,
least 10 minutes at the critical ambient the floor level exit must be in the rear-
conditions after emergency landing. ward part of the passenger compart-
(j) If storage batteries are used as the ment, unless another location affords a
energy supply for the emergency light- more effective means of passenger
ing system, they may be recharged evacuation. Where more than one floor
from the airplanes main electric power level exit per side is prescribed, at
system: Provided, That, the charging least one floor level exit per side must
circuit is designed to preclude inad- be located near each end of the cabin,
vertent battery discharge into charg- except that this provision does not
ing circuit faults. apply to combination cargo/passenger
(k) Components of the emergency configurations. In addition
lighting system, including batteries, (a) There must be a passageway lead-
wiring relays, lamps, and switches ing from the nearest main aisle to each
must be capable of normal operation Type A, Type B, Type C, Type I, or
after having been subjected to the iner- Type II emergency exit and between in-
tia forces listed in 25.561(b). dividual passenger areas. Each passage-
(l) The emergency lighting system way leading to a Type A or Type B exit
must be designed so that after any sin- must be unobstructed and at least 36

426

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00436 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.813

inches wide. Passageways between indi- (6) There must be a handle, or han-
vidual passenger areas and those lead- dles, at each assist space, located to
ing to Type I, Type II, or Type C emer- enable the crewmember to steady him-
gency exits must be unobstructed and self or herself:
at least 20 inches wide. Unless there (i) While manually activating the as-
are two or more main aisles, each Type sist means (where applicable) and,
A or B exit must be located so that (ii) While assisting passengers during
there is passenger flow along the main an evacuation.
aisle to that exit from both the forward (c) The following must be provided
and aft directions. If two or more main for each Type III or Type IV exit(1)
aisles are provided, there must be un- There must be access from the nearest
obstructed cross-aisles at least 20 aisle to each exit. In addition, for each
inches wide between main aisles. There Type III exit in an airplane that has a
must be passenger seating configuration of 60 or
(1) A cross-aisle which leads directly more
to each passageway between the near-
(i) Except as provided in paragraph
est main aisle and a Type A or B exit;
(c)(1)(ii), the access must be provided
and
by an unobstructed passageway that is
(2) A cross-aisle which leads to the
at least 10 inches in width for interior
immediate vicinity of each passageway
arrangements in which the adjacent
between the nearest main aisle and a
seat rows on the exit side of the aisle
Type 1, Type II, or Type III exit; except
contain no more than two seats, or 20
that when two Type III exits are lo-
inches in width for interior arrange-
cated within three passenger rows of
each other, a single cross-aisle may be ments in which those rows contain
used if it leads to the vicinity between three seats. The width of the passage-
the passageways from the nearest main way must be measured with adjacent
aisle to each exit. seats adjusted to their most adverse
(b) Adequate space to allow crew- position. The centerline of the required
member(s) to assist in the evacuation passageway width must not be dis-
of passengers must be provided as fol- placed more than 5 inches horizontally
lows: from that of the exit.
(1) Each assist space must be a rec- (ii) In lieu of one 10- or 20-inch pas-
tangle on the floor, of sufficient size to sageway, there may be two passage-
enable a crewmember, standing erect, ways, between seat rows only, that
to effectively assist evacuees. The as- must be at least 6 inches in width and
sist space must not reduce the unob- lead to an unobstructed space adjacent
structed width of the passageway below to each exit. (Adjacent exits must not
that required for the exit. share a common passageway.) The
(2) For each Type A or B exit, assist width of the passageways must be
space must be provided at each side of measured with adjacent seats adjusted
the exit regardless of whether an assist to their most adverse position. The un-
means is required by 25.810(a). obstructed space adjacent to the exit
(3) For each Type C, I or II exit in- must extend vertically from the floor
stalled in an airplane with seating for to the ceiling (or bottom of sidewall
more than 80 passengers, an assist stowage bins), inboard from the exit for
space must be provided at one side of a distance not less than the width of
the passageway regardless of whether the narrowest passenger seat installed
an assist means is required by on the airplane, and from the forward
25.810(a). edge of the forward passageway to the
(4) For each Type C, I or II exit, an aft edge of the aft passageway. The exit
assist space must be provided at one opening must be totally within the fore
side of the passageway if an assist and aft bounds of the unobstructed
means is required by 25.810(a). space.
(5) For any tailcone exit that quali- (2) In addition to the access
fies for 25 additional passenger seats (i) For airplanes that have a pas-
under the provisions of 25.807(d)(3)(ii), senger seating configuration of 20 or
an assist space must be provided, if an more, the projected opening of the exit
assist means is required by 25.810(a). provided must not be obstructed and

427

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00437 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.815 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

there must be no interference in open- relative to the surrounding structure,


ing the exit by seats, berths, or other listed in 25.561(b).
protrusions (including any seatback in [Amdt. 251, 30 FR 3204, Mar. 9, 1965, as
the most adverse position) for a dis- amended by Amdt. 2515, 32 FR 13265, Sept.
tance from that exit not less than the 20, 1967; Amdt. 2532, 37 FR 3971, Feb. 24, 1972;
width of the narrowest passenger seat Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50597, Oct. 30, 1978; Amdt.
installed on the airplane. 2572, 55 FR 29783, July 20, 1990; Amdt. 2576,
57 FR 19244, May 4, 1992; Amdt. 2576, 57 FR
(ii) For airplanes that have a pas-
29120, June 30, 1992; Amdt. 2588, 61 FR 57958,
senger seating configuration of 19 or Nov. 8, 1996; Amdt. 25116, 69 FR 62788, Oct.
fewer, there may be minor obstructions 27, 2004]
in this region, if there are compen-
sating factors to maintain the effec- 25.815 Width of aisle.
tiveness of the exit. The passenger aisle width at any
(3) For each Type III exit, regardless point between seats must equal or ex-
of the passenger capacity of the air- ceed the values in the following table:
plane in which it is installed, there
Minimum passenger
must be placards that aisle width (inches)
(i) Are readable by all persons seated Passenger seating capacity Less than 25 in. and
adjacent to and facing a passageway to 25 in. from more from
the exit; floor floor
(ii) Accurately state or illustrate the 10 or less ....................................... 1 12 15
proper method of opening the exit, in- 11 through 19 ................................ 12 20
cluding the use of handholds; and 20 or more ..................................... 15 20
(iii) If the exit is a removable hatch, 1 A narrower width not less than 9 inches may be approved
when substantiated by tests found necessary by the
state the weight of the hatch and indi- Administrator.
cate an appropriate location to place
the hatch after removal. [Amdt. 2515, 32 FR 13265, Sept. 20, 1967, as
(d) If it is necessary to pass through amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55466, Dec. 20,
a passageway between passenger com- 1976]
partments to reach any required emer-
25.817 Maximum number of seats
gency exit from any seat in the pas- abreast.
senger cabin, the passageway must be
unobstructed. However, curtains may On airplanes having only one pas-
be used if they allow free entry senger aisle, no more than three seats
through the passageway. abreast may be placed on each side of
the aisle in any one row.
(e) No door may be installed between
any passenger seat that is occupiable [Amdt. 2515, 32 FR 13265, Sept. 20, 1967]
for takeoff and landing and any pas-
senger emergency exit, such that the 25.819 Lower deck service compart-
ments (including galleys).
door crosses any egress path (including
aisles, crossaisles and passageways). For airplanes with a service compart-
(f) If it is necessary to pass through a ment located below the main deck,
doorway separating any crewmember which may be occupied during taxi or
seat (except those seats on the flight but not during takeoff or land-
flightdeck), occupiable for takeoff and ing, the following apply:
landing, from any emergency exit, the (a) There must be at least two emer-
door must have a means to latch it in gency evacuation routes, one at each
end of each lower deck service com-
the open position. The latching means
partment or two having sufficient sepa-
must be able to withstand the loads
ration within each compartment,
imposed upon it when the door is sub- which could be used by each occupant
jected to the ultimate inertia forces, of the lower deck service compartment
to rapidly evacuate to the main deck
under normal and emergency lighting
conditions. The routes must provide for
the evacuation of incapacitated per-
sons, with assistance. The use of the

428

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00438 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.831

evacuation routes may not be depend- (3) There must be a hatch capable of
ent on any powered device. The routes being used for evacuating persons from
must be designed to minimize the pos- the lift that is openable from inside
sibility of blockage which might result and outside the lift without tools, with
from fire, mechanical or structural the lift in any position.
failure, or persons standing on top of or [Amdt. 2553, 45 FR 41593, June 19, 1980; 45 FR
against the escape routes. In the event 43154, June 26, 1980; Amdt. 25110; 68 FR 36883,
the airplanes main power system or June 19, 2003]
compartment main lighting system
should fail, emergency illumination for 25.820 Lavatory doors.
each lower deck service compartment All lavatory doors must be designed
must be automatically provided. to preclude anyone from becoming
(b) There must be a means for two- trapped inside the lavatory. If a lock-
way voice communication between the ing mechanism is installed, it must be
flight deck and each lower deck service capable of being unlocked from the
compartment, which remains available outside without the aid of special tools.
following loss of normal electrical
power generating system. [Doc. No. 200314193, 69 FR 24502, May 3, 2004]
(c) There must be an aural emer- VENTILATION AND HEATING
gency alarm system, audible during
normal and emergency conditions, to 25.831 Ventilation.
enable crewmembers on the flight deck
(a) Under normal operating condi-
and at each required floor level emer-
tions and in the event of any probable
gency exit to alert occupants of each
failure conditions of any system which
lower deck service compartment of an
would adversely affect the ventilating
emergency situation.
air, the ventilation system must be de-
(d) There must be a means, readily signed to provide a sufficient amount
detectable by occupants of each lower of uncontaminated air to enable the
deck service compartment, that indi- crewmembers to perform their duties
cates when seat belts should be fas- without undue discomfort or fatigue
tened. and to provide reasonable passenger
(e) If a public address system is in- comfort. For normal operating condi-
stalled in the airplane, speakers must tions, the ventilation system must be
be provided in each lower deck service designed to provide each occupant with
compartment. an airflow containing at least 0.55
(f) For each occupant permitted in a pounds of fresh air per minute.
lower deck service compartment, there (b) Crew and passenger compartment
must be a forward or aft facing seat air must be free from harmful or haz-
which meets the requirements of ardous concentrations of gases or va-
25.785(d), and must be able to with- pors. In meeting this requirement, the
stand maximum flight loads when oc- following apply:
cupied. (1) Carbon monoxide concentrations
(g) For each powered lift system in- in excess of 1 part in 20,000 parts of air
stalled between a lower deck service are considered hazardous. For test pur-
compartment and the main deck for poses, any acceptable carbon monoxide
the carriage of persons or equipment, detection method may be used.
or both, the system must meet the fol- (2) Carbon dioxide concentration dur-
lowing requirements: ing flight must be shown not to exceed
(1) Each lift control switch outside 0.5 percent by volume (sea level equiva-
the lift, except emergency stop but- lent) in compartments normally occu-
tons, must be designed to prevent the pied by passengers or crewmembers.
activation of the life if the lift door, or (c) There must be provisions made to
the hatch required by paragraph (g)(3) ensure that the conditions prescribed
of this section, or both are open. in paragraph (b) of this section are met
(2) An emergency stop button, that after reasonably probable failures or
when activated will immediately stop malfunctioning of the ventilating,
the lift, must be installed within the heating, pressurization, or other sys-
lift and at each entrance to the lift. tems and equipment.

429

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00439 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.832 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(d) If accumulation of hazardous (f) Means to enable the flight crew to


quantities of smoke in the cockpit area control the temperature and quantity
is reasonably probable, smoke evacu- of ventilating air supplied to the flight
ation must be readily accomplished, crew compartment independently of
starting with full pressurization and the temperature and quantity of ven-
without depressurizing beyond safe tilating air supplied to other compart-
limits. ments are not required if all of the fol-
(e) Except as provided in paragraph lowing conditions are met:
(f) of this section, means must be pro- (1) The total volume of the flight
vided to enable the occupants of the crew and passenger compartments is
800 cubic feet or less.
following compartments and areas to
(2) The air inlets and passages for air
control the temperature and quantity
to flow between flight crew and pas-
of ventilating air supplied to their
senger compartments are arranged to
compartment or area independently of
provide compartment temperatures
the temperature and quantity of air within 5 degrees F. of each other and
supplied to other compartments and adequate ventilation to occupants in
areas: both compartments.
(1) The flight crew compartment. (3) The temperature and ventilation
(2) Crewmember compartments and controls are accessible to the flight
areas other than the flight crew com- crew.
partment unless the crewmember com- (g) The exposure time at any given
partment or area is ventilated by air temperature must not exceed the val-
interchange with other compartments ues shown in the following graph after
or areas under all operating conditions. any improbable failure condition.

[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as amended by Amdt. 2541, 42 FR 36970, July 18, 1977;
Amdt. 2587, 61 FR 28695, June 5, 1996; Amdt. 2589, 61 FR 63956, Dec. 2, 1996]

25.832 Cabin ozone concentration. (1) 0.25 parts per million by volume,
sea level equivalent, at any time above
(a) The airplane cabin ozone con-
flight level 320; and
centration during flight must be shown
(2) 0.1 parts per million by volume,
not to exceed
sea level equivalent, time-weighted av-
erage during any 3-hour interval above
flight level 270.

430
ER05JN96.007</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00440 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.841

(b) For the purpose of this section, (b) Pressurized cabins must have at
sea level equivalent refers to condi- least the following valves, controls,
tions of 25 C and 760 millimeters of and indicators for controlling cabin
mercury pressure. pressure:
(c) Compliance with this section (1) Two pressure relief valves to auto-
must be shown by analysis or tests matically limit the positive pressure
based on airplane operational proce- differential to a predetermined value
dures and performance limitations, at the maximum rate of flow delivered
that demonstrate that either by the pressure source. The combined
(1) The airplane cannot be operated capacity of the relief valves must be
at an altitude which would result in large enough so that the failure of any
cabin ozone concentrations exceeding one valve would not cause an appre-
the limits prescribed by paragraph (a) ciable rise in the pressure differential.
of this section; or The pressure differential is positive
(2) The airplane ventilation system, when the internal pressure is greater
including any ozone control equipment, than the external.
will maintain cabin ozone concentra- (2) Two reverse pressure differential
tions at or below the limits prescribed relief valves (or their equivalents) to
by paragraph (a) of this section. automatically prevent a negative pres-
sure differential that would damage
[Amdt. 2550, 45 FR 3883, Jan. 1, 1980, as
amended by Amdt. 2556, 47 FR 58489, Dec. 30,
the structure. One valve is enough,
1982; Amdt. 2594, 63 FR 8848, Feb. 23, 1998] however, if it is of a design that rea-
sonably precludes its malfunctioning.
25.833 Combustion heating systems. (3) A means by which the pressure
differential can be rapidly equalized.
Combustion heaters must be ap-
(4) An automatic or manual regulator
proved.
for controlling the intake or exhaust
[Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29783, July 20, 1990] airflow, or both, for maintaining the
required internal pressures and airflow
PRESSURIZATION rates.
(5) Instruments at the pilot or flight
25.841 Pressurized cabins.
engineer station to show the pressure
(a) Pressurized cabins and compart- differential, the cabin pressure alti-
ments to be occupied must be equipped tude, and the rate of change of the
to provide a cabin pressure altitude of cabin pressure altitude.
not more than 8,000 feet at the max- (6) Warning indication at the pilot or
imum operating altitude of the air- flight engineer station to indicate
plane under normal operating condi- when the safe or preset pressure dif-
tions. ferential and cabin pressure altitude
(1) If certification for operation limits are exceeded. Appropriate warn-
above 25,000 feet is requested, the air- ing markings on the cabin pressure dif-
plane must be designed so that occu- ferential indicator meet the warning
pants will not be exposed to cabin pres- requirement for pressure differential
sure altitudes in excess of 15,000 feet limits and an aural or visual signal (in
after any probable failure condition in addition to cabin altitude indicating
the pressurization system. means) meets the warning requirement
(2) The airplane must be designed so for cabin pressure altitude limits if it
that occupants will not be exposed to a warns the flight crew when the cabin
cabin pressure altitude that exceeds pressure altitude exceeds 10,000 feet.
the following after decompression from (7) A warning placard at the pilot or
any failure condition not shown to be flight engineer station if the structure
extremely improbable: is not designed for pressure differen-
(i) Twenty-five thousand (25,000) feet tials up to the maximum relief valve
for more than 2 minutes; or setting in combination with landing
(ii) Forty thousand (40,000) feet for loads.
any duration. (8) The pressure sensors necessary to
(3) Fuselage structure, engine and meet the requirements of paragraphs
system failures are to be considered in (b)(5) and (b)(6) of this section and
evaluating the cabin decompression. 25.1447(c), must be located and the

431

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00441 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.843 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

sensing system designed so that, in the Passenger capacity No. of extinguishers


event of loss of cabin pressure in any
31 through 60 .............................. 2
passenger or crew compartment (in- 61 through 200 ............................ 3
cluding upper and lower lobe galleys), 201 through 300 ............................ 4
the warning and automatic presen- 301 through 400 ............................ 5
401 through 500 ............................ 6
tation devices, required by those provi- 501 through 600 ............................ 7
sions, will be actuated without any 601 through 700 ............................ 8
delay that would significantly increase
the hazards resulting from decompres- (2) At least one hand fire extin-
sion. guisher must be conveniently located
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
in the pilot compartment.
amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55466, Dec. 20, (3) At least one readily accessible
1976; Amdt. 2587, 61 FR 28696, June 5, 1996] hand fire extinguisher must be avail-
able for use in each Class A or Class B
25.843 Tests for pressurized cabins. cargo or baggage compartment and in
(a) Strength test. The complete pres- each Class E cargo or baggage compart-
surized cabin, including doors, win- ment that is accessible to crew-
dows, and valves, must be tested as a members in flight.
pressure vessel for the pressure dif- (4) At least one hand fire extin-
ferential specified in 25.365(d). guisher must be located in, or readily
(b) Functional tests. The following accessible for use in, each galley lo-
functional tests must be performed: cated above or below the passenger
(1) Tests of the functioning and ca- compartment.
pacity of the positive and negative (5) Each hand fire extinguisher must
pressure differential valves, and of the be approved.
emergency release valve, to stimulate (6) At least one of the required fire
the effects of closed regulator valves. extinguishers located in the passenger
(2) Tests of the pressurization system compartment of an airplane with a pas-
to show proper functioning under each senger capacity of at least 31 and not
possible condition of pressure, tem- more than 60, and at least two of the
perature, and moisture, up to the max- fire extinguishers located in the pas-
imum altitude for which certification senger compartment of an airplane
is requested. with a passenger capacity of 61 or more
(3) Flight tests, to show the perform- must contain Halon 1211
ance of the pressure supply, pressure (bromochlorodifluoromethane CBrC1
and flow regulators, indicators, and F2), or equivalent, as the extinguishing
warning signals, in steady and stepped agent. The type of extinguishing agent
climbs and descents at rates cor- used in any other extinguisher required
responding to the maximum attainable by this section must be appropriate for
within the operating limitations of the the kinds of fires likely to occur where
airplane, up to the maximum altitude used.
for which certification is requested. (7) The quantity of extinguishing
(4) Tests of each door and emergency agent used in each extinguisher re-
exit, to show that they operate prop- quired by this section must be appro-
erly after being subjected to the flight priate for the kinds of fires likely to
tests prescribed in paragraph (b)(3) of occur where used.
this section. (8) Each extinguisher intended for
use in a personnel compartment must
FIRE PROTECTION be designed to minimize the hazard of
toxic gas concentration.
25.851 Fire extinguishers. (b) Built-in fire extinguishers. If a
(a) Hand fire extinguishers. (1) The fol- built-in fire extinguisher is provided
lowing minimum number of hand fire (1) Each built-in fire extinguishing
extinguishers must be conveniently lo- system must be installed so that
cated and evenly distributed in pas- (i) No extinguishing agent likely to
senger compartments: enter personnel compartments will be
hazardous to the occupants; and
Passenger capacity No. of extinguishers
(ii) No discharge of the extinguisher
7 through 30 .............................. 1 can cause structural damage.

432

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00442 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.854

(2) The capacity of each required this section, provided the interiors of
built-in fire extinguishing system must such compartments are isolated from
be adequate for any fire likely to occur the main passenger cabin by doors or
in the compartment where used, con- equivalent means that would normally
sidering the volume of the compart- be closed during an emergency landing
ment and the ventilation rate. condition.
[Amdt. 2574, 56 FR 15456, Apr. 16, 1991] (f) Smoking is not allowed in lava-
tories. If smoking is allowed in any
25.853 Compartment interiors. area occupied by the crew or pas-
For each compartment occupied by sengers, an adequate number of self-
the crew or passengers, the following contained, removable ashtrays must be
apply: provided in designated smoking sec-
(a) Materials (including finishes or tions for all seated occupants.
decorative surfaces applied to the ma- (g) Regardless of whether smoking is
terials) must meet the applicable test allowed in any other part of the air-
criteria prescribed in part I of appendix plane, lavatories must have self-con-
F of this part, or other approved equiv- tained, removable ashtrays located
alent methods, regardless of the pas- conspicuously on or near the entry side
senger capacity of the airplane. of each lavatory door, except that one
(b) [Reserved]
ashtray may serve more than one lava-
(c) In addition to meeting the re-
tory door if the ashtray can be seen
quirements of paragraph (a) of this sec-
tion, seat cushions, except those on readily from the cabin side of each lav-
flight crewmember seats, must meet atory served.
the test requirements of part II of ap- (h) Each receptacle used for the dis-
pendix F of this part, or other equiva- posal of flammable waste material
lent methods, regardless of the pas- must be fully enclosed, constructed of
senger capacity of the airplane. at least fire resistant materials, and
(d) Except as provided in paragraph must contain fires likely to occur in it
(e) of this section, the following inte- under normal use. The capability of the
rior components of airplanes with pas- receptacle to contain those fires under
senger capacities of 20 or more must all probable conditions of wear, mis-
also meet the test requirements of alignment, and ventilation expected in
parts IV and V of appendix F of this service must be demonstrated by test.
part, or other approved equivalent
method, in addition to the flamma- [Amdt. 2583, 60 FR 6623, Feb. 2, 1995, as
amended by Amdt. 25116, 69 FR 62788, Oct.
bility requirements prescribed in para-
27, 2004]
graph (a) of this section:
(1) Interior ceiling and wall panels, 25.854 Lavatory fire protection.
other than lighting lenses and win-
dows; For airplanes with a passenger capac-
(2) Partitions, other than transparent ity of 20 or more:
panels needed to enhance cabin safety; (a) Each lavatory must be equipped
(3) Galley structure, including ex- with a smoke detector system or equiv-
posed surfaces of stowed carts and alent that provides a warning light in
standard containers and the cavity the cockpit, or provides a warning
walls that are exposed when a full com- light or audible warning in the pas-
plement of such carts or containers is senger cabin that would be readily de-
not carried; and tected by a flight attendant; and
(4) Large cabinets and cabin stowage (b) Each lavatory must be equipped
compartments, other than underseat with a built-in fire extinguisher for
stowage compartments for stowing each disposal receptacle for towels,
small items such as magazines and paper, or waste, located within the lav-
maps. atory. The extinguisher must be de-
(e) The interiors of compartments, signed to discharge automatically into
such as pilot compartments, galleys, each disposal receptacle upon occur-
lavatories, crew rest quarters, cabinets
rence of a fire in that receptacle.
and stowage compartments, need not
meet the standards of paragraph (d) of [Amdt. 2574, 56 FR 15456, Apr. 16, 1991]

433

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00443 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.855 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

25.855 Cargo or baggage compart- system floods each such compartment


ments. simultaneously.
For each cargo or baggage compart- [Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29784, July 20, 1990, as
ment, the following apply: amended by Amdt. 2593, 63 FR 8048, Feb. 17,
(a) The compartment must meet one 1998; Amdt. 25116, 69 FR 62788, Oct. 27, 2004]
of the class requirements of 25.857.
(b) Class B through Class E cargo or 25.856 Thermal/Acoustic insulation
materials.
baggage compartments, as defined in
25.857, must have a liner, and the liner (a) Thermal/acoustic insulation ma-
must be separate from (but may be at- terial installed in the fuselage must
tached to) the airplane structure. meet the flame propagation test re-
(c) Ceiling and sidewall liner panels quirements of part VI of Appendix F to
of Class C compartments must meet this part, or other approved equivalent
the test requirements of part III of ap- test requirements. This requirement
pendix F of this part or other approved does not apply to small parts, as de-
equivalent methods. fined in part I of Appendix F of this
(d) All other materials used in the part.
construction of the cargo or baggage (b) For airplanes with a passenger ca-
compartment must meet the applicable pacity of 20 or greater, thermal/acous-
test criteria prescribed in part I of ap- tic insulation materials (including the
pendix F of this part or other approved means of fastening the materials to the
equivalent methods. fuselage) installed in the lower half of
(e) No compartment may contain any the airplane fuselage must meet the
controls, wiring, lines, equipment, or flame penetration resistance test re-
accessories whose damage or failure quirements of part VII of Appendix F
would affect safe operation, unless to this part, or other approved equiva-
those items are protected so that lent test requirements. This require-
(1) They cannot be damaged by the ment does not apply to thermal/acous-
movement of cargo in the compart- tic insulation installations that the
ment, and FAA finds would not contribute to fire
(2) Their breakage or failure will not penetration resistance.
create a fire hazard. [Amdt. 25111, 68 FR 45059, July 31, 2003]
(f) There must be means to prevent
cargo or baggage from interfering with 25.857 Cargo compartment classifica-
the functioning of the fire protective tion.
features of the compartment. (a) Class A; A Class A cargo or bag-
(g) Sources of heat within the com- gage compartment is one in which
partment must be shielded and insu- (1) The presence of a fire would be
lated to prevent igniting the cargo or easily discovered by a crewmember
baggage. while at his station; and
(h) Flight tests must be conducted to (2) Each part of the compartment is
show compliance with the provisions of easily accessible in flight.
25.857 concerning (b) Class B. A Class B cargo or bag-
(1) Compartment accessibility, gage compartment is one in which
(2) The entries of hazardous quan- (1) There is sufficient access in flight
tities of smoke or extinguishing agent to enable a crewmember to effectively
into compartments occupied by the reach any part of the compartment
crew or passengers, and with the contents of a hand fire extin-
(3) The dissipation of the extin- guisher;
guishing agent in Class C compart- (2) When the access provisions are
ments. being used, no hazardous quantity of
(i) During the above tests, it must be smoke, flames, or extinguishing agent,
shown that no inadvertent operation of will enter any compartment occupied
smoke or fire detectors in any com- by the crew or passengers;
partment would occur as a result of (3) There is a separate approved
fire contained in any other compart- smoke detector or fire detector system
ment, either during or after extin- to give warning at the pilot or flight
guishment, unless the extinguishing engineer station.

434

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00444 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.859

(c) Class C. A Class C cargo or bag- (b) The system must be capable of de-
gage compartment is one not meeting tecting a fire at a temperature signifi-
the requirements for either a Class A cantly below that at which the struc-
or B compartment but in which tural integrity of the airplane is sub-
(1) There is a separate approved stantially decreased.
smoke detector or fire detector system (c) There must be means to allow the
to give warning at the pilot or flight crew to check in flight, the functioning
engineer station; of each fire detector circuit.
(2) There is an approved built-in fire (d) The effectiveness of the detection
extinguishing or suppression system system must be shown for all approved
controllable from the cockpit. operating configurations and condi-
(3) There are means to exclude haz- tions.
ardous quantities of smoke, flames, or
extinguishing agent, from any com- [Amdt. 2554, 45 FR 60173, Sept. 11, 1980, as
partment occupied by the crew or pas- amended by Amdt. 2593, 63 FR 8048, Feb. 17,
sengers; 1998]
(4) There are means to control ven-
tilation and drafts within the compart- 25.859 Combustion heater fire pro-
tection.
ment so that the extinguishing agent
used can control any fire that may (a) Combustion heater fire zones. The
start within the compartment. following combustion heater fire zones
(d) [Reserved] must be protected from fire in accord-
(e) Class E. A Class E cargo compart- ance with the applicable provisions of
ment is one on airplanes used only for 25.1181 through 25.1191 and 25.1195
the carriage of cargo and in which through 25.1203;
(1) [Reserved] (1) The region surrounding the heat-
(2) There is a separate approved er, if this region contains any flam-
smoke or fire detector system to give mable fluid system components (ex-
warning at the pilot or flight engineer cluding the heater fuel system), that
station; could
(3) There are means to shut off the (i) Be damaged by heater malfunc-
ventilating airflow to, or within, the tioning; or
compartment, and the controls for (ii) Allow flammable fluids or vapors
these means are accessible to the flight to reach the heater in case of leakage.
crew in the crew compartment; (2) The region surrounding the heat-
(4) There are means to exclude haz- er, if the heater fuel system has fit-
ardous quantities of smoke, flames, or
tings that, if they leaked, would allow
noxious gases, from the flight crew
fuel or vapors to enter this region.
compartment; and
(3) The part of the ventilating air
(5) The required crew emergency
exits are accessible under any cargo passage that surrounds the combustion
loading condition. chamber. However, no fire extinguish-
ment is required in cabin ventilating
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as air passages.
amended by Amdt. 2532, 37 FR 3972, Feb. 24, (b) Ventilating air ducts. Each ven-
1972; Amdt. 2560, 51 FR 18243, May 16, 1986;
Amdt. 2593, 63 FR 8048, Feb. 17, 1998]
tilating air duct passing through any
fire zone must be fireproof. In addi-
25.858 Cargo or baggage compart- tion
ment smoke or fire detection sys- (1) Unless isolation is provided by
tems. fireproof valves or by equally effective
If certification with cargo or baggage means, the ventilating air duct down-
compartment smoke or fire detection stream of each heater must be fireproof
provisions is requested, the following for a distance great enough to ensure
must be met for each cargo or baggage that any fire originating in the heater
compartment with those provisions: can be contained in the duct; and
(a) The detection system must pro- (2) Each part of any ventilating duct
vide a visual indication to the flight passing through any region having a
crew within one minute after the start flammable fluid system must be con-
of a fire. structed or isolated from that system

435

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00445 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.863 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

so that the malfunctioning of any com- prescribed in paragraph (e)(1) of this


ponent of that system cannot intro- section.
duce flammable fluids or vapors into (f) Air intakes. Each combustion and
the ventilating airstream. ventilating air intake must be located
(c) Combustion air ducts. Each com- so that no flammable fluids or vapors
bustion air duct must be fireproof for a can enter the heater system under any
distance great enough to prevent dam- operating condition
age from backfiring or reverse flame (1) During normal operation; or
propagation. In addition (2) As a result of the malfunctioning
(1) No combustion air duct may have of any other component.
a common opening with the ventilating (g) Heater exhaust. Heater exhaust
airstream unless flames from backfires systems must meet the provisions of
or reverse burning cannot enter the 25.1121 and 25.1123. In addition, there
ventilating airstream under any oper- must be provisions in the design of the
ating condition, including reverse flow heater exhaust system to safely expel
or malfunctioning of the heater or its the products of combustion to prevent
associated components; and the occurrence of
(2) No combustion air duct may re- (1) Fuel leakage from the exhaust to
strict the prompt relief of any backfire surrounding compartments;
that, if so restricted, could cause heat- (2) Exhaust gas impingement on sur-
er failure. rounding equipment or structure;
(d) Heater controls; general. Provision (3) Ignition of flammable fluids by
must be made to prevent the hazardous the exhaust, if the exhaust is in a com-
accumulation of water or ice on or in partment containing flammable fluid
any heater control component, control lines; and
system tubing, or safety control. (4) Restriction by the exhaust of the
(e) Heater safety controls. For each prompt relief of backfires that, if so re-
combustion heater there must be the stricted, could cause heater failure.
following safety control means: (h) Heater fuel systems. Each heater
(1) Means independent of the compo- fuel system must meet each power-
nents provided for the normal contin- plant fuel system requirement affect-
uous control of air temperature, air- ing safe heater operation. Each heater
flow, and fuel flow must be provided, fuel system component within the ven-
for each heater, to automatically shut tilating airstream must be protected
off the ignition and fuel supply to that by shrouds so that no leakage from
heater at a point remote from that those components can enter the ven-
heater when any of the following oc- tilating airstream.
curs: (i) Drains. There must be means to
(i) The heat exchanger temperature safely drain fuel that might accumu-
exceeds safe limits. late within the combustion chamber or
(ii) The ventilating air temperature the heat exchanger. In addition
exceeds safe limits. (1) Each part of any drain that oper-
(iii) The combustion airflow becomes ates at high temperatures must be pro-
inadequate for safe operation. tected in the same manner as heater
(iv) The ventilating airflow becomes exhausts; and
inadequate for safe operation. (2) Each drain must be protected
(2) The means of complying with from hazardous ice accumulation under
paragraph (e)(1) of this section for any any operating condition.
individual heater must [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24 1964, as
(i) Be independent of components amended by Amdt. 2511, 32 FR 6912, May 5,
serving any other heater whose heat 1967; Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5676, Apr. 8, 1970]
output is essential for safe operation;
and 25.863 Flammable fluid fire protec-
(ii) Keep the heater off until re- tion.
started by the crew. (a) In each area where flammable
(3) There must be means to warn the fluids or vapors might escape by leak-
crew when any heater whose heat out- age of a fluid system, there must be
put is essential for safe operation has means to minimize the probability of
been shut off by the automatic means ignition of the fluids and vapors, and

436

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00446 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.869

the resultant hazards if ignition does the nacelles that could not be readily
occur. affected by heat, flames, or sparks
(b) Compliance with paragraph (a) of coming from a designated fire zone or
this section must be shown by analysis engine compartment of any nacelle.
or tests, and the following factors must
[Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5676, Apr. 8, 1970]
be considered:
(1) Possible sources and paths of fluid 25.869 Fire protection: systems.
leakage, and means of detecting leak-
age. (a) Electrical system components:
(2) Flammability characteristics of (1) Components of the electrical sys-
fluids, including effects of any combus- tem must meet the applicable fire and
tible or absorbing materials. smoke protection requirements of
(3) Possible ignition sources, includ- 25.831(c) and 25.863.
ing electrical faults, overheating of (2) Electrical cables, terminals, and
equipment, and malfunctioning of pro- equipment in designated fire zones,
tective devices. that are used during emergency proce-
(4) Means available for controlling or dures, must be at least fire resistant.
extinguishing a fire, such as stopping (3) Main power cables (including gen-
flow of fluids, shutting down equip- erator cables) in the fuselage must be
ment, fireproof containment, or use of designed to allow a reasonable degree
extinguishing agents. of deformation and stretching without
(5) Ability of airplane components failure and must be
that are critical to safety of flight to (i) Isolated from flammable fluid
withstand fire and heat. lines; or
(c) If action by the flight crew is re- (ii) Shrouded by means of electrically
quired to prevent or counteract a fluid insulated, flexible conduit, or equiva-
fire (e.g., equipment shutdown or actu- lent, which is in addition to the normal
ation of a fire extinguisher) quick act- cable insulation.
ing means must be provided to alert (4) Insulation on electrical wire and
the crew. electrical cable installed in any area of
(d) Each area where flammable fluids the airplane must be self-extinguishing
or vapors might escape by leakage of a when tested in accordance with the ap-
fluid system must be identified and de- plicable portions of part I, appendix F
fined. of this part.
[Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5676, Apr. 8, 1970, as (b) Each vacuum air system line and
amended by Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50597, Oct. 30, fitting on the discharge side of the
1978] pump that might contain flammable
vapors or fluids must meet the require-
25.865 Fire protection of flight con- ments of 25.1183 if the line or fitting is
trols, engine mounts, and other in a designated fire zone. Other vacuum
flight structure. air systems components in designated
Essential flight controls, engine fire zones must be at least fire resist-
mounts, and other flight structures lo- ant.
cated in designated fire zones or in ad- (c) Oxygen equipment and lines
jacent areas which would be subjected must
to the effects of fire in the fire zone (1) Not be located in any designated
must be constructed of fireproof mate- fire zone,
rial or shielded so that they are capa- (2) Be protected from heat that may
ble of withstanding the effects of fire. be generated in, or escape from, any
[Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5676, Apr. 8, 1970] designated fire zone, and
(3) Be installed so that escaping oxy-
25.867 Fire protection: other compo- gen cannot cause ignition of grease,
nents. fluid, or vapor accumulations that are
(a) Surfaces to the rear of the na- present in normal operation or as a re-
celles, within one nacelle diameter of sult of failure or malfunction of any
the nacelle centerline, must be at least system.
fire-resistant. [Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29784, July 20, 1990, as
(b) Paragraph (a) of this section does amended by Amdt. 25113, 69 FR 12530, Mar.
not apply to tail surfaces to the rear of 16, 2004]

437

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00447 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.871 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

MISCELLANEOUS be considered if the probability of such


failure is extremely remote.
25.871 Leveling means. (d) Each auxiliary power unit instal-
There must be means for determining lation must meet the applicable provi-
when the airplane is in a level position sions of this subpart.
on the ground. [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
[Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5676, Apr. 8, 1970] amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5676, Apr. 8,
1970; Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15042, Mar. 17, 1977;
Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50597, Oct. 30, 1978]
25.875 Reinforcement near propel-
lers. 25.903 Engines.
(a) Each part of the airplane near the (a) Engine type certificate. (1) Each en-
propeller tips must be strong and stiff gine must have a type certificate and
enough to withstand the effects of the must meet the applicable requirements
induced vibration and of ice thrown of part 34 of this chapter.
from the propeller. (2) Each turbine engine must comply
(b) No window may be near the pro- with one of the following:
peller tips unless it can withstand the (i) Sections 33.76, 33.77 and 33.78 of
most severe ice impact likely to occur. this chapter in effect on December 13,
2000, or as subsequently amended; or
Subpart EPowerplant (ii) Sections 33.77 and 33.78 of this
chapter in effect on April 30, 1998, or as
GENERAL subsequently amended before Decem-
ber 13, 2000; or
25.901 Installation. (iii) Comply with 33.77 of this chap-
(a) For the purpose of this part, the ter in effect on October 31, 1974, or as
airplane powerplant installation in- subsequently amended prior to April
cludes each component that 30, 1998, unless that engines foreign ob-
(1) Is necessary for propulsion; ject ingestion service history has re-
(2) Affects the control of the major sulted in an unsafe condition; or
propulsive units; or (iv) Be shown to have a foreign object
(3) Affects the safety of the major ingestion service history in similar in-
propulsive units between normal in- stallation locations which has not re-
spections or overhauls. sulted in any unsafe condition.
(b) For each powerplant NOTE: 33.77 of this chapter in effect on Oc-
(1) The installation must comply tober 31, 1974, was published in 14 CFR parts
with 1 to 59, Revised as of January 1, 1975. See 39
(i) The installation instructions pro- FR 35467, October 1, 1974.
vided under 33.5 of this chapter; and (b) Engine isolation. The powerplants
(ii) The applicable provisions of this must be arranged and isolated from
subpart; each other to allow operation, in at
(2) The components of the installa- least one configuration, so that the
tion must be constructed, arranged, failure or malfunction of any engine, or
and installed so as to ensure their con- of any system that can affect the en-
tinued safe operation between normal gine, will not
inspections or overhauls; (1) Prevent the continued safe oper-
(3) The installation must be acces- ation of the remaining engines; or
sible for necessary inspections and (2) Require immediate action by any
maintenance; and crewmember for continued safe oper-
(4) The major components of the in- ation.
stallation must be electrically bonded (c) Control of engine rotation. There
to the other parts of the airplane. must be means for stopping the rota-
(c) For each powerplant and auxiliary tion of any engine individually in
power unit installation, it must be es- flight, except that, for turbine engine
tablished that no single failure or mal- installations, the means for stopping
function or probable combination of the rotation of any engine need be pro-
failures will jeopardize the safe oper- vided only where continued rotation
ation of the airplane except that the could jeopardize the safety of the air-
failure of structural elements need not plane. Each component of the stopping

438

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00448 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.925

system on the engine side of the fire- system that automatically resets the
wall that might be exposed to fire must power or thrust on the operating en-
be at least fire-resistant. If hydraulic gine(s) when any engine fails during
propeller feathering systems are used the takeoff must comply with the re-
for this purpose, the feathering lines quirements of appendix I of this part.
must be at least fire resistant under
[Amdt. 2562, 52 FR 43156, Nov. 9, 1987]
the operating conditions that may be
expected to exist during feathering. 25.905 Propellers.
(d) Turbine engine installations. For
turbine engine installations (a) Each propeller must have a type
(1) Design precautions must be taken certificate.
to minimize the hazards to the airplane (b) Engine power and propeller shaft
in the event of an engine rotor failure rotational speed may not exceed the
or of a fire originating within the en- limits for which the propeller is certifi-
gine which burns through the engine cated.
case. (c) Each component of the propeller
(2) The powerplant systems associ- blade pitch control system must meet
ated with engine control devices, sys- the requirements of 35.42 of this chap-
tems, and instrumentation, must be de- ter.
signed to give reasonable assurance (d) Design precautions must be taken
that those engine operating limitations to minimize the hazards to the airplane
that adversely affect turbine rotor in the event a propeller blade fails or is
structural integrity will not be exceed- released by a hub failure. The hazards
ed in service. which must be considered include dam-
(e) Restart capability. (1) Means to re- age to structure and vital systems due
start any engine in flight must be pro- to impact of a failed or released blade
vided. and the unbalance created by such fail-
(2) An altitude and airspeed envelope ure or release.
must be established for in-flight engine [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
restarting, and each engine must have amended by Amdt. 2554, 45 FR 60173, Sept.
a restart capability within that enve- 11, 1980; Amdt. 2557, 49 FR 6848, Feb. 23, 1984;
lope. Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29784, July 20, 1990]
(3) For turbine engine powered air-
planes, if the minimum windmilling 25.907 Propeller vibration.
speed of the engines, following the (a) The magnitude of the propeller
inflight shutdown of all engines, is in- blade vibration stresses under any nor-
sufficient to provide the necessary mal condition of operation must be de-
electrical power for engine ignition, a termined by actual measurement or by
power source independent of the en- comparison with similar installations
gine-driven electrical power generating for which these measurements have
system must be provided to permit in- been made.
flight engine ignition for restarting. (b) The determined vibration stresses
(f) Auxiliary Power Unit. Each auxil- may not exceed values that have been
iary power unit must be approved or shown to be safe for continuous oper-
meet the requirements of the category ation.
for its intended use.
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as 25.925 Propeller clearance.
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5676, Apr. 8, Unless smaller clearances are sub-
1970; Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15042, Mar. 17, 1977; stantiated, propeller clearances with
Amdt. 2557, 49 FR 6848, Feb. 23, 1984; Amdt.
the airplane at maximum weight, with
2572, 55 FR 29784, July 20, 1990; Amdt. 2573,
55 FR 32861, Aug. 10, 1990; Amdt. 2594, 63 FR the most adverse center of gravity, and
8848, Feb. 23, 1998; Amdt. 2595, 63 FR 14798, with the propeller in the most adverse
Mar. 26, 1998; Amdt. 25100, 65 FR 55854, Sept. pitch position, may not be less than
14, 2000] the following:
(a) Ground clearance. There must be a
25.904 Automatic takeoff thrust con- clearance of at least seven inches (for
trol system (ATTCS). each airplane with nose wheel landing
Each applicant seeking approval for gear) or nine inches (for each airplane
installation of an engine power control with tail wheel landing gear) between

439

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00449 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.929 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

each propeller and the ground with the (ii) The airplane is capable of contin-
landing gear statically deflected and in ued safe flight and landing under any
the level takeoff, or taxiing attitude, possible position of the thrust reverser.
whichever is most critical. In addition, (2) Each system intended for inflight
there must be positive clearance be- use must be designed so that no unsafe
tween the propeller and the ground condition will result during normal op-
when in the level takeoff attitude with eration of the system, or from any fail-
the critical tire(s) completely deflated ure (or reasonably likely combination
and the corresponding landing gear of failures) of the reversing system,
strut bottomed. under any anticipated condition of op-
(b) Water clearance. There must be a eration of the airplane including
clearance of at least 18 inches between ground operation. Failure of structural
each propeller and the water, unless elements need not be considered if the
compliance with 25.239(a) can be probability of this kind of failure is ex-
shown with a lesser clearance. tremely remote.
(c) Structural clearance. There must (3) Each system must have means to
be prevent the engine from producing
(1) At least one inch radial clearance more than idle thrust when the revers-
between the blade tips and the airplane ing system malfunctions, except that it
structure, plus any additional radial may produce any greater forward
clearance necessary to prevent harmful thrust that is shown to allow direc-
vibration; tional control to be maintained, with
(2) At least one-half inch longitudinal aerodynamic means alone, under the
clearance between the propeller blades most critical reversing condition ex-
or cuffs and stationary parts of the air- pected in operation.
plane; and (b) For propeller reversing systems
(3) Positive clearance between other (1) Each system intended for ground
rotating parts of the propeller or spin- operation only must be designed so
ner and stationary parts of the air- that no single failure (or reasonably
plane. likely combination of failures) or mal-
Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as function of the system will result in
amended by Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29784, July 20, unwanted reverse thrust under any ex-
1990] pected operating condition. Failure of
structural elements need not be consid-
25.929 Propeller deicing. ered if this kind of failure is extremely
(a) For airplanes intended for use remote.
where icing may be expected, there (2) Compliance with this section may
must be a means to prevent or remove be shown by failure analysis or testing,
hazardous ice accumulation on propel- or both, for propeller systems that
lers or on accessories where ice accu- allow propeller blades to move from
mulation would jeopardize engine per- the flight low-pitch position to a posi-
formance. tion that is substantially less than
(b) If combustible fluid is used for that at the normal flight low-pitch po-
propeller deicing, 25.1181 through sition. The analysis may include or be
25.1185 and 25.1189 apply. supported by the analysis made to
show compliance with the require-
25.933 Reversing systems. ments of 35.21 of this chapter for the
(a) For turbojet reversing systems propeller and associated installation
(1) Each system intended for ground components.
operation only must be designed so [Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29784, July 20, 1990]
that during any reversal in flight the
engine will produce no more than flight 25.934 Turbojet engine thrust re-
idle thrust. In addition, it must be verser system tests.
shown by analysis or test, or both,
Thrust reversers installed on tur-
that
bojet engines must meet the require-
(i) Each operable reverser can be re-
ments of 33.97 of this chapter.
stored to the forward thrust position;
and [Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5677, Apr. 8, 1970]

440

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00450 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.945

25.937 Turbopropeller-drag limiting (c) In showing compliance with para-


systems. graph (b) of this section, the pilot
Turbopropeller power airplane pro- strength required may not exceed the
peller-drag limiting systems must be limits set forth in 25.143(c), subject to
designed so that no single failure or the conditions set forth in paragraphs
malfunction of any of the systems dur- (d) and (e) of 25.143.
ing normal or emergency operation re- [Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55467, Dec. 20, 1976]
sults in propeller drag in excess of that
for which the airplane was designed 25.943 Negative acceleration.
under 25.367. Failure of structural ele- No hazardous malfunction of an en-
ments of the drag limiting systems gine, an auxiliary power unit approved
need not be considered if the prob- for use in flight, or any component or
ability of this kind of failure is ex- system associated with the powerplant
tremely remote. or auxiliary power unit may occur
when the airplane is operated at the
25.939 Turbine engine operating negative accelerations within the
characteristics.
flight envelopes prescribed in 25.333.
(a) Turbine engine operating charac- This must be shown for the greatest
teristics must be investigated in flight duration expected for the acceleration.
to determine that no adverse charac-
[Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15043, Mar. 17, 1977]
teristics (such as stall, surge, or
flameout) are present, to a hazardous 25.945 Thrust or power augmentation
degree, during normal and emergency system.
operation within the range of operating
(a) General. Each fluid injection sys-
limitations of the airplane and of the
tem must provide a flow of fluid at the
engine.
rate and pressure established for proper
(b) [Reserved]
engine functioning under each intended
(c) The turbine engine air inlet sys- operating condition. If the fluid can
tem may not, as a result of air flow dis- freeze, fluid freezing may not damage
tortion during normal operation, cause the airplane or adversely affect air-
vibration harmful to the engine. plane performance.
[Amdt. 2511, 32 FR 6912, May 5, 1967, as (b) Fluid tanks. Each augmentation
amended by Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15043, Mar. 17, system fluid tank must meet the fol-
1977] lowing requirements:
(1) Each tank must be able to with-
25.941 Inlet, engine, and exhaust stand without failure the vibration, in-
compatibility.
ertia, fluid, and structural loads that it
For airplanes using variable inlet or may be subject to in operation.
exhaust system geometry, or both (2) The tanks as mounted in the air-
(a) The system comprised of the plane must be able to withstand with-
inlet, engine (including thrust aug- out failure or leakage an internal pres-
mentation systems, if incorporated), sure 1.5 times the maximum operating
and exhaust must be shown to function pressure.
properly under all operating conditions (3) If a vent is provided, the venting
for which approval is sought, including must be effective under all normal
all engine rotating speeds and power flight conditions.
settings, and engine inlet and exhaust (4) [Reserved]
configurations; (5) Each tank must have an expan-
(b) The dynamic effects of the oper- sion space of not less than 2 percent of
ation of these (including consideration the tank capacity. It must be impos-
of probable malfunctions) upon the aer- sible to fill the expansion space inad-
odynamic control of the airplane may vertently with the airplane in the nor-
not result in any condition that would mal ground attitude.
require exceptional skill, alertness, or (c) Augmentation system drains
strength on the part of the pilot to must be designed and located in ac-
avoid exceeding an operational or cordance with 25.1455 if
structural limitation of the airplane; (1) The augmentation system fluid is
and subject to freezing; and

441

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00451 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.951 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(2) The fluid may be drained in flight 25.952 Fuel system analysis and test.
or during ground operation.
(a) Proper fuel system functioning
(d) The augmentation liquid tank ca- under all probable operating conditions
pacity available for the use of each en- must be shown by analysis and those
gine must be large enough to allow op- tests found necessary by the Adminis-
eration of the airplane under the ap- trator. Tests, if required, must be made
proved procedures for the use of liquid- using the airplane fuel system or a test
augmented power. The computation of article that reproduces the operating
liquid consumption must be based on characteristics of the portion of the
the maximum approved rate appro- fuel system to be tested.
priate for the desired engine output (b) The likely failure of any heat ex-
and must include the effect of tempera- changer using fuel as one of its fluids
ture on engine performance as well as may not result in a hazardous condi-
any other factors that might vary the tion.
amount of liquid required.
(e) This section does not apply to fuel [Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15043, Mar. 17, 1977]
injection systems.
25.953 Fuel system independence.
[Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15043, Mar. 17, 1977, as
amended by Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29785, July 20,
Each fuel system must meet the re-
1990; Amdt. 25115, 69 FR 40527, July 2, 2004] quirements of 25.903(b) by
(a) Allowing the supply of fuel to
FUEL SYSTEM each engine through a system inde-
pendent of each part of the system sup-
25.951 General. plying fuel to any other engine; or
(a) Each fuel system must be con- (b) Any other acceptable method.
structed and arranged to ensure a flow 25.954 Fuel system lightning protec-
of fuel at a rate and pressure estab- tion.
lished for proper engine and auxiliary
power unit functioning under each The fuel system must be designed
likely operating condition, including and arranged to prevent the ignition of
any maneuver for which certification is fuel vapor within the system by
requested and during which the engine (a) Direct lightning strikes to areas
or auxiliary power unit is permitted to having a high probability of stroke at-
be in operation. tachment;
(b) Each fuel system must be ar- (b) Swept lightning strokes to areas
ranged so that any air which is intro- where swept strokes are highly prob-
duced into the system will not result able; and
in (c) Corona and streamering at fuel
(1) Power interruption for more than vent outlets.
20 seconds for reciprocating engines; or [Amdt. 2514, 32 FR 11629, Aug. 11, 1967]
(2) Flameout for turbine engines.
(c) Each fuel system for a turbine en- 25.955 Fuel flow.
gine must be capable of sustained oper- (a) Each fuel system must provide at
ation throughout its flow and pressure least 100 percent of the fuel flow re-
range with fuel initially saturated with quired under each intended operating
water at 80 F and having 0.75cc of free condition and maneuver. Compliance
water per gallon added and cooled to must be shown as follows:
the most critical condition for icing (1) Fuel must be delivered to each en-
likely to be encountered in operation. gine at a pressure within the limits
(d) Each fuel system for a turbine en- specified in the engine type certificate.
gine powered airplane must meet the (2) The quantity of fuel in the tank
applicable fuel venting requirements of may not exceed the amount established
part 34 of this chapter. as the unusable fuel supply for that
tank under the requirements of 25.959
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5677, Apr. 8, plus that necessary to show compliance
1970; Amdt. 2536, 39 FR 35460, Oct. 1, 1974; with this section.
Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55467, Dec. 20, 1976; Amdt. (3) Each main pump must be used
2573, 55 FR 32861, Aug. 10, 1990] that is necessary for each operating

442

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00452 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.961

condition and attitude for which com- 25.961 Fuel system hot weather oper-
pliance with this section is shown, and ation.
the appropriate emergency pump must (a) The fuel system must perform
be substituted for each main pump so satisfactorily in hot weather operation.
used. This must be shown by showing that
(4) If there is a fuel flowmeter, it the fuel system from the tank outlets
must be blocked and the fuel must flow to each engine is pressurized, under all
through the meter or its bypass. intended operations, so as to prevent
(b) If an engine can be supplied with vapor formation, or must be shown by
fuel from more than one tank, the fuel climbing from the altitude of the air-
system must port elected by the applicant to the
(1) For each reciprocating engine, maximum altitude established as an
supply the full fuel pressure to that en- operating limitation under 25.1527. If a
gine in not more than 20 seconds after climb test is elected, there may be no
switching to any other fuel tank con- evidence of vapor lock or other mal-
taining usable fuel when engine mal- functioning during the climb test con-
functioning becomes apparent due to ducted under the following conditions:
the depletion of the fuel supply in any (1) For reciprocating engine powered
tank from which the engine can be fed; airplanes, the engines must operate at
and maximum continuous power, except
(2) For each turbine engine, in addi- that takeoff power must be used for the
tion to having appropriate manual altitudes from 1,000 feet below the crit-
switching capability, be designed to ical altitude through the critical alti-
prevent interruption of fuel flow to tude. The time interval during which
that engine, without attention by the takeoff power is used may not be less
flight crew, when any tank supplying than the takeoff time limitation.
fuel to that engine is depleted of usable (2) For turbine engine powered air-
fuel during normal operation, and any planes, the engines must operate at
other tank, that normally supplies fuel takeoff power for the time interval se-
to that engine alone, contains usable lected for showing the takeoff flight
fuel. path, and at maximum continuous
power for the rest of the climb.
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2511, 32 FR 6912, May 5, (3) The weight of the airplane must
1967] be the weight with full fuel tanks, min-
imum crew, and the ballast necessary
25.957 Flow between interconnected to maintain the center of gravity with-
tanks. in allowable limits.
If fuel can be pumped from one tank (4) The climb airspeed may not ex-
to another in flight, the fuel tank ceed
vents and the fuel transfer system (i) For reciprocating engine powered
must be designed so that no structural airplanes, the maximum airspeed es-
damage to the tanks can occur because tablished for climbing from takeoff to
of overfilling. the maximum operating altitude with
the airplane in the following configura-
25.959 Unusable fuel supply. tion:
(A) Landing gear retracted.
The unusable fuel quantity for each (B) Wing flaps in the most favorable
fuel tank and its fuel system compo- position.
nents must be established at not less (C) Cowl flaps (or other means of con-
than the quantity at which the first trolling the engine cooling supply) in
evidence of engine malfunction occurs the position that provides adequate
under the most adverse fuel feed condi- cooling in the hot-day condition.
tion for all intended operations and (D) Engine operating within the max-
flight maneuvers involving fuel feeding imum continuous power limitations.
from that tank. Fuel system compo- (E) Maximum takeoff weight; and
nent failures need not be considered. (ii) For turbine engine powered air-
[Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5677, Apr. 8, 1970, as planes, the maximum airspeed estab-
amended by Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15043, Mar. 17, lished for climbing from takeoff to the
1977] maximum operating altitude.

443

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00453 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.963 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(5) The fuel temperature must be at 25.965 Fuel tank tests.


least 110 F.
(b) The test prescribed in paragraph (a) It must be shown by tests that the
(a) of this section may be performed in fuel tanks, as mounted in the airplane,
flight or on the ground under closely can withstand, without failure or leak-
simulated flight conditions. If a flight age, the more critical of the pressures
test is performed in weather cold resulting from the conditions specified
enough to interfere with the proper in paragraphs (a)(1) and (2) of this sec-
conduct of the test, the fuel tank sur- tion. In addition, it must be shown by
faces, fuel lines, and other fuel system either analysis or tests, that tank sur-
parts subject to cold air must be insu- faces subjected to more critical pres-
lated to simulate, insofar as prac- sures resulting from the condition of
ticable, flight in hot weather. paragraphs (a)(3) and (4) of this section,
[Amdt. 2511, 32 FR 6912, May 5, 1967, as are able to withstand the following
amended by Amdt. 2557, 49 FR 6848, Feb. 23, pressures:
1984] (1) An internal pressure of 3.5 psi.
(2) 125 percent of the maximum air
25.963 Fuel tanks: general.
pressure developed in the tank from
(a) Each fuel tank must be able to ram effect.
withstand, without failure, the vibra- (3) Fluid pressures developed during
tion, inertia, fluid, and structural loads maximum limit accelerations, and de-
that it may be subjected to in oper-
flections, of the airplane with a full
ation.
tank.
(b) Flexible fuel tank liners must be
approved or must be shown to be suit- (4) Fluid pressures developed during
able for the particular application. the most adverse combination of air-
(c) Integral fuel tanks must have fa- plane roll and fuel load.
cilities for interior inspection and re- (b) Each metallic tank with large un-
pair. supported or unstiffened flat surfaces,
(d) Fuel tanks within the fuselage whose failure or deformation could
contour must be able to resist rupture cause fuel leakage, must be able to
and to retain fuel, under the inertia withstand the following test, or its
forces prescribed for the emergency equivalent, without leakage or exces-
landing conditions in 25.561. In addi- sive deformation of the tank walls:
tion, these tanks must be in a pro- (1) Each complete tank assembly and
tected position so that exposure of the its supports must be vibration tested
tanks to scraping action with the while mounted to simulate the actual
ground is unlikely. installation.
(e) Fuel tank access covers must
(2) Except as specified in paragraph
comply with the following criteria in
order to avoid loss of hazardous quan- (b)(4) of this section, the tank assembly
tities of fuel: must be vibrated for 25 hours at an am-
(1) All covers located in an area plitude of not less than 132 of an inch
where experience or analysis indicates (unless another amplitude is substan-
a strike is likely must be shown by tiated) while 23 filled with water or
analysis or tests to minimize penetra- other suitable test fluid.
tion and deformation by tire frag- (3) The test frequency of vibration
ments, low energy engine debris, or must be as follows:
other likely debris. (i) If no frequency of vibration result-
(2) All covers must be fire resistant ing from any r.p.m. within the normal
as defined in part 1 of this chapter. operating range of engine speeds is
(f) For pressurized fuel tanks, a critical, the test frequency of vibration
means with fail-safe features must be must be 2,000 cycles per minute.
provided to prevent the buildup of an (ii) If only one frequency of vibration
excessive pressure difference between resulting from any r.p.m. within the
the inside and the outside of the tank. normal operating range of engine
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as speeds is critical, that frequency of vi-
amended by Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15043, Mar. 17, bration must be the test frequency.
1977; Amdt. 2569, 54 FR 40354, Sept. 29, 1989]

444

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00454 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.971

(iii) If more than one frequency of vi- of projections that could cause wear of
bration resulting from any r.p.m. with- the liner unless
in the normal operating range of en- (i) Provisions are made for protection
gine speeds is critical, the most crit- of the liner at these points; or
ical of these frequencies must be the (ii) The construction of the liner
test frequency. itself provides that protection.
(4) Under paragraphs (b)(3)(ii) and (b) Spaces adjacent to tank surfaces
(iii) of this section, the time of test must be ventilated to avoid fume accu-
must be adjusted to accomplish the mulation due to minor leakage. If the
same number of vibration cycles that tank is in a sealed compartment, ven-
would be accomplished in 25 hours at tilation may be limited to drain holes
the frequency specified in paragraph large enough to prevent excessive pres-
(b)(3)(i) of this section. sure resulting from altitude changes.
(5) During the test, the tank assem- (c) The location of each tank must
bly must be rocked at the rate of 16 to meet the requirements of 25.1185(a).
20 complete cycles per minute, through (d) No engine nacelle skin imme-
an angle of 15 on both sides of the hor- diately behind a major air outlet from
izontal (30 total), about the most crit- the engine compartment may act as
ical axis, for 25 hours. If motion about the wall of an integral tank.
more than one axis is likely to be crit- (e) Each fuel tank must be isolated
ical, the tank must be rocked about from personnel compartments by a
each critical axis for 1212 hours. fumeproof and fuelproof enclosure.
(c) Except where satisfactory oper- 25.969 Fuel tank expansion space.
ating experience with a similar tank in
a similar installation is shown, non- Each fuel tank must have an expan-
sion space of not less than 2 percent of
metallic tanks must withstand the test
the tank capacity. It must be impos-
specified in paragraph (b)(5) of this sec-
sible to fill the expansion space inad-
tion, with fuel at a temperature of 110
vertently with the airplane in the nor-
F. During this test, a representative
mal ground attitude. For pressure fuel-
specimen of the tank must be installed
ing systems, compliance with this sec-
in a supporting structure simulating
tion may be shown with the means pro-
the installation in the airplane.
vided to comply with 25.979(b).
(d) For pressurized fuel tanks, it
must be shown by analysis or tests [Amdt. 2511, 32 FR 6913, May 5, 1967]
that the fuel tanks can withstand the
maximum pressure likely to occur on 25.971 Fuel tank sump.
the ground or in flight. (a) Each fuel tank must have a sump
with an effective capacity, in the nor-
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as mal ground attitude, of not less than
amended by Amdt. 2511, 32 FR 6913, May 5,
1967; Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15043, Mar. 17, 1977]
the greater of 0.10 percent of the tank
capacity or one-sixteenth of a gallon
25.967 Fuel tank installations. unless operating limitations are estab-
lished to ensure that the accumulation
(a) Each fuel tank must be supported of water in service will not exceed the
so that tank loads (resulting from the sump capacity.
weight of the fuel in the tanks) are not (b) Each fuel tank must allow drain-
concentrated on unsupported tank sur- age of any hazardous quantity of water
faces. In addition from any part of the tank to its sump
(1) There must be pads, if necessary, with the airplane in the ground atti-
to prevent chafing between the tank tude.
and its supports; (c) Each fuel tank sump must have
(2) Padding must be nonabsorbent or an accessible drain that
treated to prevent the absorption of (1) Allows complete drainage of the
fluids; sump on the ground;
(3) If a flexible tank liner is used, it (2) Discharges clear of each part of
must be supported so that it is not re- the airplane; and
quired to withstand fluid loads; and (3) Has manual or automatic means
(4) Each interior surface of the tank for positive locking in the closed posi-
compartment must be smooth and free tion.

445

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00455 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.973 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

25.973 Fuel tank filler connection. (b) Carburetor vapor vents. Each car-
Each fuel tank filler connection must buretor with vapor elimination connec-
prevent the entrance of fuel into any tions must have a vent line to lead va-
part of the airplane other than the pors back to one of the fuel tanks. In
tank itself. In addition addition
(a) [Reserved] (1) Each vent system must have
(b) Each recessed filler connection means to avoid stoppage by ice; and
that can retain any appreciable quan- (2) If there is more than one fuel
tity of fuel must have a drain that dis- tank, and it is necessary to use the
charges clear of each part of the air- tanks in a definite sequence, each
plane; vapor vent return line must lead back
(c) Each filler cap must provide a to the fuel tank used for takeoff and
fuel-tight seal; and landing.
(d) Each fuel filling point must have
a provision for electrically bonding the 25.977 Fuel tank outlet.
airplane to ground fueling equipment. (a) There must be a fuel strainer for
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
the fuel tank outlet or for the booster
amended by Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15043, Mar. 17, pump. This strainer must
1977; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29785, July 20, 1990; (1) For reciprocating engine powered
Amdt. 25115, 69 FR 40527, July 2, 2004] airplanes, have 8 to 16 meshes per inch;
and
25.975 Fuel tank vents and carbu- (2) For turbine engine powered air-
retor vapor vents. planes, prevent the passage of any ob-
(a) Fuel tank vents. Each fuel tank ject that could restrict fuel flow or
must be vented from the top part of the damage any fuel system component.
expansion space so that venting is ef- (b) [Reserved]
fective under any normal flight condi- (c) The clear area of each fuel tank
tion. In addition outlet strainer must be at least five
(1) Each vent must be arranged to times the area of the outlet line.
avoid stoppage by dirt or ice forma- (d) The diameter of each strainer
tion; must be at least that of the fuel tank
(2) The vent arrangement must pre- outlet.
vent siphoning of fuel during normal (e) Each finger strainer must be ac-
operation; cessible for inspection and cleaning.
(3) The venting capacity and vent
pressure levels must maintain accept- [Amdt. 2511, 32 FR 6913, May 5, 1967, as
able differences of pressure between amended by Amdt. 2536, 39 FR 35460, Oct. 1,
1974]
the interior and exterior of the tank,
during 25.979 Pressure fueling system.
(i) Normal flight operation;
(ii) Maximum rate of ascent and de- For pressure fueling systems, the fol-
scent; and lowing apply:
(iii) Refueling and defueling (where (a) Each pressure fueling system fuel
applicable); manifold connection must have means
(4) Airspaces of tanks with inter- to prevent the escape of hazardous
connected outlets must be inter- quantities of fuel from the system if
connected; the fuel entry valve fails.
(5) There may be no point in any vent (b) An automatic shutoff means must
line where moisture can accumulate be provided to prevent the quantity of
with the airplane in the ground atti- fuel in each tank from exceeding the
tude or the level flight attitude, unless maximum quantity approved for that
drainage is provided; and tank. This means must
(6) No vent or drainage provision may (1) Allow checking for proper shutoff
end at any point operation before each fueling of the
(i) Where the discharge of fuel from tank; and
the vent outlet would constitute a fire (2) Provide indication at each fueling
hazard; or station of failure of the shutoff means
(ii) From which fumes could enter to stop the fuel flow at the maximum
personnel compartments. quantity approved for that tank.

446

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00456 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.991

(c) A means must be provided to pre- (b) Based on the evaluations required
vent damage to the fuel system in the by this section, critical design configu-
event of failure of the automatic shut- ration control limitations, inspections,
off means prescribed in paragraph (b) or other procedures must be estab-
of this section. lished, as necessary, to prevent devel-
(d) The airplane pressure fueling sys- opment of ignition sources within the
tem (not including fuel tanks and fuel fuel tank system and must be included
tank vents) must withstand an ulti- in the Airworthiness Limitations sec-
mate load that is 2.0 times the load tion of the Instructions for Continued
arising from the maximum pressures, Airworthiness required by 25.1529.
including surge, that is likely to occur Visible means to identify critical fea-
during fueling. The maximum surge tures of the design must be placed in
pressure must be established with any
areas of the airplane where mainte-
combination of tank valves being ei-
nance actions, repairs, or alterations
ther intentionally or inadvertently
may be apt to violate the critical de-
closed.
sign configuration limitations (e.g.,
(e) The airplane defueling system
color-coding of wire to identify separa-
(not including fuel tanks and fuel tank
vents) must withstand an ultimate tion limitation).
load that is 2.0 times the load arising (c) The fuel tank installation must
from the maximum permissible include either
defueling pressure (positive or nega- (1) Means to minimize the develop-
tive) at the airplane fueling connec- ment of flammable vapors in the fuel
tion. tanks (in the context of this rule,
minimize means to incorporate prac-
[Amdt. 2511, 32 FR 6913, May 5, 1967, as
ticable design methods to reduce the
amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55467, Dec. 20,
1976; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29785, July 20, 1990] likelihood of flammable vapors); or
(2) Means to mitigate the effects of
25.981 Fuel tank ignition prevention. an ignition of fuel vapors within fuel
(a) No ignition source may be present tanks such that no damage caused by
at each point in the fuel tank or fuel an ignition will prevent continued safe
tank system where catastrophic failure flight and landing.
could occur due to ignition of fuel or [Doc. No. 19996411, 66 FR 23129, May 7, 2001]
vapors. This must be shown by:
(1) Determining the highest tempera- FUEL SYSTEM COMPONENTS
ture allowing a safe margin below the
lowest expected autoignition tempera- 25.991 Fuel pumps.
ture of the fuel in the fuel tanks. (a) Main pumps. Each fuel pump re-
(2) Demonstrating that no tempera- quired for proper engine operation, or
ture at each place inside each fuel tank required to meet the fuel system re-
where fuel ignition is possible will ex- quirements of this subpart (other than
ceed the temperature determined under those in paragraph (b) of this section,
paragraph (a)(1) of this section. This
is a main pump. For each main pump,
must be verified under all probable op-
provision must be made to allow the
erating, failure, and malfunction con-
bypass of each positive displacement
ditions of each component whose oper-
ation, failure, or malfunction could in- fuel pump other than a fuel injection
crease the temperature inside the tank. pump (a pump that supplies the proper
(3) Demonstrating that an ignition flow and pressure for fuel injection
source could not result from each sin- when the injection is not accomplished
gle failure, from each single failure in in a carburetor) approved as part of the
combination with each latent failure engine.
condition not shown to be extremely (b) Emergency pumps. There must be
remote, and from all combinations of emergency pumps or another main
failures not shown to be extremely im- pump to feed each engine immediately
probable. The effects of manufacturing after failure of any main pump (other
variability, aging, wear, corrosion, and than a fuel injection pump approved as
likely damage must be considered. part of the engine).

447

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00457 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.993 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

25.993 Fuel system lines and fittings. ment pump, whichever is nearer the
(a) Each fuel line must be installed fuel tank outlet. This fuel strainer or
and supported to prevent excessive vi- filter must
(a) Be accessible for draining and
bration and to withstand loads due to
cleaning and must incorporate a screen
fuel pressure and accelerated flight
or element which is easily removable;
conditions.
(b) Have a sediment trap and drain
(b) Each fuel line connected to com-
except that it need not have a drain if
ponents of the airplane between which
the strainer or filter is easily remov-
relative motion could exist must have
able for drain purposes;
provisions for flexibility.
(c) Be mounted so that its weight is
(c) Each flexible connection in fuel
not supported by the connecting lines
lines that may be under pressure and
or by the inlet or outlet connections of
subjected to axial loading must use
the strainer or filter itself, unless ade-
flexible hose assemblies.
(d) Flexible hose must be approved or quate strength margins under all load-
must be shown to be suitable for the ing conditions are provided in the lines
particular application. and connections; and
(e) No flexible hose that might be ad- (d) Have the capacity (with respect to
versely affected by exposure to high operating limitations established for
temperatures may be used where exces- the engine) to ensure that engine fuel
sive temperatures will exist during op- system functioning is not impaired,
eration or after engine shut-down. with the fuel contaminated to a degree
(f) Each fuel line within the fuselage (with respect to particle size and den-
must be designed and installed to allow sity) that is greater than that estab-
a reasonable degree of deformation and lished for the engine in Part 33 of this
stretching without leakage. chapter.
[Amdt. No. 2536, 39 FR 35460, Oct. 1, 1974, as
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2557, 49 FR 6848, Feb. 23,
amended by Amdt. 2515, 32 FR 13266, Sept.
1984]
20, 1967]

25.994 Fuel system components. 25.999 Fuel system drains.


Fuel system components in an engine (a) Drainage of the fuel system must
nacelle or in the fuselage must be pro- be accomplished by the use of fuel
tected from damage which could result strainer and fuel tank sump drains.
in spillage of enough fuel to constitute (b) Each drain required by paragraph
a fire hazard as a result of a wheels-up (a) of this section must
landing on a paved runway. (1) Discharge clear of all parts of the
airplane;
[Amdt. 2557, 49 FR 6848, Feb. 23, 1984] (2) Have manual or automatic means
for positive locking in the closed posi-
25.995 Fuel valves. tion; and
In addition to the requirements of (3) Have a drain valve
25.1189 for shutoff means, each fuel (i) That is readily accessible and
valve must which can be easily opened and closed;
(a) [Reserved] and
(b) Be supported so that no loads re- (ii) That is either located or pro-
sulting from their operation or from tected to prevent fuel spillage in the
accelerated flight conditions are trans- event of a landing with landing gear re-
mitted to the lines attached to the tracted.
valve. [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55467, Dec. 20,
amended by Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15043, Mar. 17, 1976]
1977]
25.1001 Fuel jettisoning system.
25.997 Fuel strainer or filter. (a) A fuel jettisoning system must be
There must be a fuel strainer or filter installed on each airplane unless it is
between the fuel tank outlet and the shown that the airplane meets the
inlet of either the fuel metering device climb requirements of 25.119 and
or an engine driven positive displace- 25.121(d) at maximum takeoff weight,

448

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00458 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1011

less the actual or computed weight of (f) For turbine engine powered air-
fuel necessary for a 15-minute flight planes, means must be provided to pre-
comprised of a takeoff, go-around, and vent jettisoning the fuel in the tanks
landing at the airport of departure used for takeoff and landing below the
with the airplane configuration, speed, level allowing climb from sea level to
power, and thrust the same as that 10,000 feet and thereafter allowing 45
used in meeting the applicable takeoff, minutes cruise at a speed for maximum
approach, and landing climb perform- range. However, if there is an auxiliary
ance requirements of this part. control independent of the main jetti-
(b) If a fuel jettisoning system is re- soning control, the system may be de-
quired it must be capable of jettisoning signed to jettison the remaining fuel
enough fuel within 15 minutes, starting by means of the auxiliary jettisoning
with the weight given in paragraph (a) control.
of this section, to enable the airplane (g) The fuel jettisoning valve must be
to meet the climb requirements of designed to allow flight personnel to
25.119 and 25.121(d), assuming that the close the valve during any part of the
fuel is jettisoned under the conditions, jettisoning operation.
except weight, found least favorable (h) Unless it is shown that using any
during the flight tests prescribed in means (including flaps, slots, and slats)
paragraph (c) of this section. for changing the airflow across or
(c) Fuel jettisoning must be dem- around the wings does not adversely af-
onstrated beginning at maximum take- fect fuel jettisoning, there must be a
off weight with flaps and landing gear placard, adjacent to the jettisoning
up and in control, to warn flight crewmembers
(1) A power-off glide at 1.3 VSR1; against jettisoning fuel while the
(2) A climb at the one-engine inoper- means that change the airflow are
ative best rate-of-climb speed, with the being used.
critical engine inoperative and the re- (i) The fuel jettisoning system must
maining engines at maximum contin- be designed so that any reasonably
uous power; and probable single malfunction in the sys-
(3) Level flight at 1.3 V SR1; if the re- tem will not result in a hazardous con-
sults of the tests in the conditions dition due to unsymmetrical jetti-
specified in paragraphs (c)(1) and (2) of soning of, or inability to jettison, fuel.
this section show that this condition [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
could be critical. amended by Amdt. 2518, 33 FR 12226, Aug. 30,
(d) During the flight tests prescribed 1968; Amdt. 2557, 49 FR 6848, Feb. 23, 1984;
in paragraph (c) of this section, it must Amdt. 25108, 67 FR 70827, Nov. 26, 2002]
be shown that
(1) The fuel jettisoning system and OIL SYSTEM
its operation are free from fire hazard;
(2) The fuel discharges clear of any 25.1011 General.
part of the airplane; (a) Each engine must have an inde-
(3) Fuel or fumes do not enter any pendent oil system that can supply it
parts of the airplane; and with an appropriate quantity of oil at a
(4) The jettisoning operation does not temperature not above that safe for
adversely affect the controllability of continuous operation.
the airplane. (b) The usable oil capacity may not
(e) For reciprocating engine powered be less than the product of the endur-
airplanes, means must be provided to ance of the airplane under critical op-
prevent jettisoning the fuel in the erating conditions and the approved
tanks used for takeoff and landing maximum allowable oil consumption of
below the level allowing 45 minutes the engine under the same conditions,
flight at 75 percent maximum contin- plus a suitable margin to ensure sys-
uous power. However, if there is an tem circulation. Instead of a rational
auxiliary control independent of the analysis of airplane range for the pur-
main jettisoning control, the system pose of computing oil requirements for
may be designed to jettison the re- reciprocating engine powered air-
maining fuel by means of the auxiliary planes, the following fuel/oil ratios
jettisoning control. may be used:

449

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00459 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1013 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(1) For airplanes without a reserve the outlet of each oil tank used with a
oil or oil transfer system, a fuel/oil turbine engine, unless the external por-
ratio of 30:1 by volume. tion of the oil system (including the oil
(2) For airplanes with either a re- tank supports) is fireproof.
serve oil or oil transfer system, a fuel/ (f) Flexible oil tank liners. Each flexi-
oil ratio of 40:1 by volume. ble oil tank liner must be approved or
(c) Fuel/oil ratios higher than those must be shown to be suitable for the
prescribed in paragraphs (b)(1) and (2) particular application.
of this section may be used if substan-
tiated by data on actual engine oil con- [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, as amend-
sumption. ed by Amdt. 2519, 33 FR 15410, Oct. 17, 1968;
Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5677, Apr. 8, 1970; Amdt.
25.1013 Oil tanks. 2536, 39 FR 35460, Oct. 1, 1974; Amdt. 2557, 49
FR 6848, Feb. 23, 1984; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR
(a) Installation. Each oil tank instal- 29785, July 20, 1990]
lation must meet the requirements of
25.967. 25.1015 Oil tank tests.
(b) Expansion space. Oil tank expan- Each oil tank must be designed and
sion space must be provided as follows: installed so that
(1) Each oil tank used with a recipro-
(a) It can withstand, without failure,
cating engine must have an expansion
each vibration, inertia, and fluid load
space of not less than the greater of 10
that it may be subjected to in oper-
percent of the tank capacity or 0.5 gal-
ation; and
lon, and each oil tank used with a tur-
bine engine must have an expansion (b) It meets the provisions of 25.965,
space of not less than 10 percent of the except
tank capacity. (1) The test pressure
(2) Each reserve oil tank not directly (i) For pressurized tanks used with a
connected to any engine may have an turbine engine, may not be less than 5
expansion space of not less than two p.s.i. plus the maximum operating
percent of the tank capacity. pressure of the tank instead of the
(3) It must be impossible to fill the pressure specified in 25.965(a); and
expansion space inadvertently with the (ii) For all other tanks may not be
airplane in the normal ground attitude. less than 5 p.s.i. instead of the pressure
(c) Filler connection. Each recessed oil specified in 25.965(a); and
tank filler connection that can retain (2) The test fluid must be oil at 250
any appreciable quantity of oil must F. instead of the fluid specified in
have a drain that discharges clear of 25.965(c).
each part of the airplane. In addition,
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
each oil tank filler cap must provide an
amended by Amdt. 2536, 39 FR 35461, Oct. 1,
oil-tight seal. 1974]
(d) Vent. Oil tanks must be vented as
follows: 25.1017 Oil lines and fittings.
(1) Each oil tank must be vented
from the top part of the expansion (a) Each oil line must meet the re-
space so that venting is effective under quirements of 25.993 and each oil line
any normal flight condition. and fitting in any designated fire zone
(2) Oil tank vents must be arranged must meet the requirements of
so that condensed water vapor that 25.1183.
might freeze and obstruct the line can- (b) Breather lines must be arranged
not accumulate at any point. so that
(e) Outlet. There must be means to (1) Condensed water vapor that might
prevent entrance into the tank itself, freeze and obstruct the line cannot ac-
or into the tank outlet, of any object cumulate at any point;
that might obstruct the flow of oil (2) The breather discharge does not
through the system. No oil tank outlet constitute a fire hazard if foaming oc-
may be enclosed by any screen or guard curs or causes emitted oil to strike the
that would reduce the flow of oil below pilots windshield; and
a safe value at any operating tempera- (3) The breather does not discharge
ture. There must be a shutoff valve at into the engine air induction system.

450

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00460 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1027

25.1019 Oil strainer or filter. (b) Have manual or automatic means


for positive locking in the closed posi-
(a) Each turbine engine installation
tion.
must incorporate an oil strainer or fil-
ter through which all of the engine oil [Amdt. 2557, 49 FR 6848, Feb. 23, 1984]
flows and which meets the following re-
quirements: 25.1023 Oil radiators.
(1) Each oil strainer or filter that has (a) Each oil radiator must be able to
a bypass must be constructed and in- withstand, without failure, any vibra-
stalled so that oil will flow at the nor- tion, inertia, and oil pressure load to
mal rate through the rest of the sys- which it would be subjected in oper-
tem with the strainer or filter com- ation.
pletely blocked. (b) Each oil radiator air duct must be
(2) The oil strainer or filter must located so that, in case of fire, flames
have the capacity (with respect to op- coming from normal openings of the
erating limitations established for the engine nacelle cannot impinge directly
engine) to ensure that engine oil sys- upon the radiator.
tem functioning is not impaired when
the oil is contaminated to a degree 25.1025 Oil valves.
(with respect to particle size and den- (a) Each oil shutoff must meet the re-
sity) that is greater than that estab- quirements of 25.1189.
lished for the engine under Part 33 of
(b) The closing of oil shutoff means
this chapter.
may not prevent propeller feathering.
(3) The oil strainer or filter, unless it
(c) Each oil valve must have positive
is installed at an oil tank outlet, must
stops or suitable index provisions in
incorporate an indicator that will indi-
the on and off positions and must
cate contamination before it reaches
be supported so that no loads resulting
the capacity established in accordance
from its operation or from accelerated
with paragraph (a)(2) of this section.
flight conditions are transmitted to
(4) The bypass of a strainer or filter
the lines attached to the valve.
must be constructed and installed so
that the release of collected contami- 25.1027 Propeller feathering system.
nants is minimized by appropriate lo-
cation of the bypass to ensure that col- (a) If the propeller feathering system
lected contaminants are not in the by- depends on engine oil, there must be
pass flow path. means to trap an amount of oil in the
(5) An oil strainer or filter that has tank if the supply becomes depleted
no bypass, except one that is installed due to failure of any part of the lubri-
at an oil tank outlet, must have a cating system other than the tank
means to connect it to the warning itself.
system required in 25.1305(c)(7). (b) The amount of trapped oil must
(b) Each oil strainer or filter in a be enough to accomplish the feathering
powerplant installation using recipro- operation and must be available only
cating engines must be constructed and to the feathering pump.
installed so that oil will flow at the (c) The ability of the system to ac-
normal rate through the rest of the complish feathering with the trapped
system with the strainer or filter ele- oil must be shown. This may be done
ment completely blocked. on the ground using an auxiliary
source of oil for lubricating the engine
[Amdt. 2536, 39 FR 35461, Oct. 1, 1974, as
amended by Amdt. 2557, 49 FR 6848, Feb. 23,
during operation.
1984] (d) Provision must be made to pre-
vent sludge or other foreign matter
25.1021 Oil system drains. from affecting the safe operation of the
A drain (or drains) must be provided propeller feathering system.
to allow safe drainage of the oil sys- [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
tem. Each drain must amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55467, Dec. 20,
(a) Be accessible; and 1976]

451

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00461 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1041 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

COOLING cept cylinder barrels) for which tem-


perature limits are established, must
25.1041 General. be corrected by adding to them the dif-
The powerplant and auxiliary power ference between the maximum ambient
unit cooling provisions must be able to atmospheric temperature and the tem-
maintain the temperatures of power- perature of the ambient air at the time
plant components, engine fluids, and of the first occurrence of the maximum
auxiliary power unit components and component or fluid temperature re-
fluids within the temperature limits corded during the cooling test.
established for these components and (d) Correction factor for cylinder barrel
fluids, under ground, water, and flight temperatures. Unless a more rational
operating conditions, and after normal correction applies, cylinder barrel tem-
engine or auxiliary power unit shut- peratures must be corrected by adding
down, or both. to them 0.7 times the difference be-
[Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55467, Dec. 20, 1976] tween the maximum ambient atmos-
pheric temperature and the tempera-
25.1043 Cooling tests. ture of the ambient air at the time of
(a) General. Compliance with 25.1041 the first occurrence of the maximum
must be shown by tests, under critical cylinder barrel temperature recorded
ground, water, and flight operating during the cooling test.
conditions. For these tests, the fol- [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
lowing apply: amended by Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2323, Jan. 16,
(1) If the tests are conducted under 1978]
conditions deviating from the max-
imum ambient atmospheric tempera- 25.1045 Cooling test procedures.
ture, the recorded powerplant tempera- (a) Compliance with 25.1041 must be
tures must be corrected under para- shown for the takeoff, climb, en route,
graphs (c) and (d) of this section. and landing stages of flight that cor-
(2) No corrected temperatures deter- respond to the applicable performance
mined under paragraph (a)(1) of this requirements. The cooling tests must
section may exceed established limits.
be conducted with the airplane in the
(3) For reciprocating engines, the fuel
configuration, and operating under the
used during the cooling tests must be
conditions, that are critical relative to
the minimum grade approved for the
cooling during each stage of flight. For
engines, and the mixture settings must
the cooling tests, a temperature is
be those normally used in the flight
stabilized when its rate of change is
stages for which the cooling tests are
less than two degrees F. per minute.
conducted. The test procedures must be
as prescribed in 25.1045. (b) Temperatures must be stabilized
(b) Maximum ambient atmospheric tem- under the conditions from which entry
perature. A maximum ambient atmos- is made into each stage of flight being
pheric temperature corresponding to investigated, unless the entry condi-
sea level conditions of at least 100 de- tion normally is not one during which
grees F must be established. The as- component and the engine fluid tem-
sumed temperature lapse rate is 3.6 de- peratures would stabilize (in which
grees F per thousand feet of altitude case, operation through the full entry
above sea level until a temperature of condition must be conducted before
69.7 degrees F is reached, above which entry into the stage of flight being in-
altitude the temperature is considered vestigated in order to allow tempera-
constant at 69.7 degrees F. However, tures to reach their natural levels at
for winterization installations, the ap- the time of entry). The takeoff cooling
plicant may select a maximum ambi- test must be preceded by a period dur-
ent atmospheric temperature cor- ing which the powerplant component
responding to sea level conditions of and engine fluid temperatures are sta-
less than 100 degrees F. bilized with the engines at ground idle.
(c) Correction factor (except cylinder (c) Cooling tests for each stage of
barrels). Unless a more rational correc- flight must be continued until
tion applies, temperatures of engine (1) The component and engine fluid
fluids and powerplant components (ex- temperatures stabilize;

452

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00462 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1093

(2) The stage of flight is completed; (1) That part of the cowling is iso-
or lated from the engine accessory section
(3) An operating limitation is by means of a fireproof diaphragm; or
reached. (2) For reciprocating engines, there
(d) For reciprocating engine powered are means to prevent the emergence of
airplanes, it may be assumed, for cool- backfire flames.
ing test purposes, that the takeoff (d) For turbine engine powered air-
stage of flight is complete when the planes and airplanes incorporating aux-
airplane reaches an altitude of 1,500 iliary power units
feet above the takeoff surface or (1) There must be means to prevent
reaches a point in the takeoff where hazardous quantities of fuel leakage or
the transition from the takeoff to the overflow from drains, vents, or other
en route configuration is completed components of flammable fluid systems
and a speed is reached at which compli- from entering the engine or auxiliary
ance with 25.121(c) is shown, which- power unit intake system; and
ever point is at a higher altitude. The (2) The airplane must be designed to
airplane must be in the following con- prevent water or slush on the runway,
figuration: taxiway, or other airport operating
(1) Landing gear retracted. surfaces from being directed into the
(2) Wing flaps in the most favorable engine or auxiliary power unit air inlet
position. ducts in hazardous quantities, and the
(3) Cowl flaps (or other means of con- air inlet ducts must be located or pro-
trolling the engine cooling supply) in tected so as to minimize the ingestion
the position that provides adequate of foreign matter during takeoff, land-
cooling in the hot-day condition. ing, and taxiing.
(4) Critical engine inoperative and its (e) If the engine induction system
propeller stopped. contains parts or components that
(5) Remaining engines at the max- could be damaged by foreign objects
imum continuous power available for entering the air inlet, it must be shown
the altitude. by tests or, if appropriate, by analysis
(e) For hull seaplanes and amphib- that the induction system design can
ians, cooling must be shown during withstand the foreign object ingestion
taxiing downwind for 10 minutes, at test conditions of 33.76, 33.77 and
five knots above step speed. 33.78(a)(1) of this chapter without fail-
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as ure of parts or components that could
amended by Amdt. 2557, 49 FR 6848, Feb. 23, create a hazard.
1984]
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55467, Dec. 20,
INDUCTION SYSTEM 1976; Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15043, Mar. 17, 1977;
Amdt. 2557, 49 FR 6849, Feb. 23, 1984; Amdt.
25.1091 Air induction. 25100, 65 FR 55854, Sept. 14, 2000]
(a) The air induction system for each
engine and auxiliary power unit must 25.1093 Induction system icing pro-
supply tection.
(1) The air required by that engine (a) Reciprocating engines. Each recip-
and auxiliary power unit under each rocating engine air induction system
operating condition for which certifi- must have means to prevent and elimi-
cation is requested; and nate icing. Unless this is done by other
(2) The air for proper fuel metering means, it must be shown that, in air
and mixture distribution with the in- free of visible moisture at a tempera-
duction system valves in any position. ture of 30 F., each airplane with alti-
(b) Each reciprocating engine must tude engines using
have an alternate air source that pre- (1) Conventional venturi carburetors
vents the entry of rain, ice, or any have a preheater that can provide a
other foreign matter. heat rise of 120 F. with the engine at 60
(c) Air intakes may not open within percent of maximum continuous power;
the cowling, unless or

453

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00463 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1101 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(2) Carburetors tending to reduce the (a) Ensure ventilation of the pre-
probability of ice formation has a pre- heater when the engine is operated in
heater that can provide a heat rise of cold air;
100 F. with the engine at 60 percent of (b) Allow inspection of the exhaust
maximum continuous power. manifold parts that it surrounds; and
(b) Turbine engines. (1) Each turbine (c) Allow inspection of critical parts
engine must operate throughout the of the preheater itself.
flight power range of the engine (in-
cluding idling), without the accumula- 25.1103 Induction system ducts and
air duct systems.
tion of ice on the engine, inlet system
components, or airframe components (a) Each induction system duct up-
that would adversely affect engine op- stream of the first stage of the engine
eration or cause a serious loss of power supercharger and of the auxiliary
or thrust power unit compressor must have a
(i) Under the icing conditions speci- drain to prevent the hazardous accu-
fied in appendix C, and mulation of fuel and moisture in the
(ii) In falling and blowing snow with- ground attitude. No drain may dis-
in the limitations established for the charge where it might cause a fire haz-
airplane for such operation. ard.
(b) Each induction system duct must
(2) Each turbine engine must idle for
be
30 minutes on the ground, with the air
(1) Strong enough to prevent induc-
bleed available for engine icing protec-
tion system failures resulting from
tion at its critical condition, without
normal backfire conditions; and
adverse effect, in an atmosphere that is (2) Fire-resistant if it is in any fire
at a temperature between 15 and 30 F zone for which a fire-extinguishing sys-
(between 9 and 1 C) and has a liq- tem is required, except that ducts for
uid water content not less than 0.3 auxiliary power units must be fireproof
grams per cubic meter in the form of within the auxiliary power unit fire
drops having a mean effective diameter zone.
not less than 20 microns, followed by (c) Each duct connected to compo-
momentary operation at takeoff power nents between which relative motion
or thrust. During the 30 minutes of idle could exist must have means for flexi-
operation, the engine may be run up bility.
periodically to a moderate power or (d) For turbine engine and auxiliary
thrust setting in a manner acceptable power unit bleed air duct systems, no
to the Administrator. hazard may result if a duct failure oc-
(c) Supercharged reciprocating engines. curs at any point between the air duct
For each engine having a supercharger source and the airplane unit served by
to pressurize the air before it enters the air.
the carburetor, the heat rise in the air (e) Each auxiliary power unit induc-
caused by that supercharging at any tion system duct must be fireproof for
altitude may be utilized in determining a sufficient distance upstream of the
compliance with paragraph (a) of this auxiliary power unit compartment to
section if the heat rise utilized is that prevent hot gas reverse flow from burn-
which will be available, automatically, ing through auxiliary power unit ducts
for the applicable altitude and oper- and entering any other compartment
ating condition because of super- or area of the airplane in which a haz-
charging. ard would be created resulting from the
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as entry of hot gases. The materials used
amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55467, Dec. 20, to form the remainder of the induction
1976; Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15043, Mar. 17, 1977; system duct and plenum chamber of
Amdt. 2557, 49 FR 6849, Feb. 23, 1984; Amdt. the auxiliary power unit must be capa-
2572, 55 FR 29785, July 20, 1990] ble of resisting the maximum heat con-
ditions likely to occur.
25.1101 Carburetor air preheater de- (f) Each auxiliary power unit induc-
sign. tion system duct must be constructed
Each carburetor air preheater must of materials that will not absorb or
be designed and constructed to trap hazardous quantities of flammable

454

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00464 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1125

fluids that could be ignited in the that are outside the engine and auxil-
event of a surge or reverse flow condi- iary power unit compartments.
tion. (d) No exhaust gases may discharge
so as to cause a fire hazard with re-
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50597, Oct. 30, spect to any flammable fluid vent or
1978] drain.
(e) No exhaust gases may discharge
25.1105 Induction system screens. where they will cause a glare seriously
If induction system screens are affecting pilot vision at night.
used (f) Each exhaust system component
(a) Each screen must be upstream of must be ventilated to prevent points of
the carburetor; excessively high temperature.
(b) No screen may be in any part of (g) Each exhaust shroud must be ven-
the induction system that is the only tilated or insulated to avoid, during
passage through which air can reach normal operation, a temperature high
the engine, unless it can be deiced by enough to ignite any flammable fluids
or vapors external to the shroud.
heated air;
(c) No screen may be deiced by alco- [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
hol alone; and amended by Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15043, Mar. 17,
(d) It must be impossible for fuel to 1977]
strike any screen.
25.1123 Exhaust piping.
25.1107 Inter-coolers and after-cool- For powerplant and auxiliary power
ers. unit installations, the following apply:
Each inter-cooler and after-cooler (a) Exhaust piping must be heat and
must be able to withstand any vibra- corrosion resistant, and must have pro-
tion, inertia, and air pressure load to visions to prevent failure due to expan-
which it would be subjected in oper- sion by operating temperatures.
ation. (b) Piping must be supported to with-
stand any vibration and inertia loads
EXHAUST SYSTEM to which it would be subjected in oper-
ation; and
25.1121 General. (c) Piping connected to components
For powerplant and auxiliary power between which relative motion could
unit installations the following apply: exist must have means for flexibility.
(a) Each exhaust system must ensure [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
safe disposal of exhaust gases without amended by Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15044, Mar. 17,
fire hazard or carbon monoxide con- 1977]
tamination in any personnel compart-
ment. For test purposes, any accept- 25.1125 Exhaust heat exchangers.
able carbon monoxide detection meth- For reciprocating engine powered
od may be used to show the absence of airplanes, the following apply:
carbon monoxide. (a) Each exhaust heat exchanger
(b) Each exhaust system part with a must be constructed and installed to
surface hot enough to ignite flammable withstand each vibration, inertia, and
fluids or vapors must be located or other load to which it would be sub-
shielded so that leakage from any sys- jected in operation. In addition
tem carrying flammable fluids or va- (1) Each exchanger must be suitable
pors will not result in a fire caused by for continued operation at high tem-
impingement of the fluids or vapors on peratures and resistant to corrosion
any part of the exhaust system includ- from exhaust gases;
ing shields for the exhaust system. (2) There must be means for the in-
(c) Each component that hot exhaust spection of the critical parts of each
gases could strike, or that could be exchanger;
subjected to high temperatures from (3) Each exchanger must have cooling
exhaust system parts, must be fire- provisions wherever it is subject to
proof. All exhaust system components contact with exhaust gases; and
must be separated by fireproof shields (4) No exhaust heat exchanger or
from adjacent parts of the airplane muff may have any stagnant areas or

455

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00465 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1127 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

liquid traps that would increase the (b) Each flexible control must be ap-
probability of ignition of flammable proved or must be shown to be suitable
fluids or vapors that might be present for the particular application.
in case of the failure or malfunction of (c) Each control must have sufficient
components carrying flammable fluids. strength and rigidity to withstand op-
(b) If an exhaust heat exchanger is erating loads without failure and with-
used for heating ventilating air out excessive deflection.
(1) There must be a secondary heat (d) Each control must be able to
exchanger between the primary ex- maintain any set position without con-
stant attention by flight crewmembers
haust gas heat exchanger and the ven-
and without creep due to control loads
tilating air system; or
or vibration.
(2) Other means must be used to pre- (e) The portion of each powerplant
clude the harmful contamination of the control located in a designated fire
ventilating air. zone that is required to be operated in
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as the event of fire must be at least fire
amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55467, Dec. 20, resistant.
1976] (f) For powerplant valve controls lo-
cated in the flight deck there must be
25.1127 Exhaust driven turbo-super- a means:
chargers. (1) For the flightcrew to select each
(a) Each exhaust driven turbo-super- intended position or function of the
charger must be approved or shown to valve; and
be suitable for the particular applica- (2) To indicate to the flightcrew:
(i) The selected position or function
tion. It must be installed and sup-
of the valve; and
ported to ensure safe operation be-
(ii) When the valve has not responded
tween normal inspections and over-
as intended to the selected position or
hauls. In addition, there must be provi- function.
sions for expansion and flexibility be-
tween exhaust conduits and the tur- [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
bine. amended by Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15044, Mar. 17,
1977; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29785, July 20, 1990;
(b) There must be provisions for lu- Amdt. 25115, 69 FR 40527, July 2, 2004]
bricating the turbine and for cooling
turbine parts where temperatures are 25.1142 Auxiliary power unit con-
critical. trols.
(c) If the normal turbo-supercharger Means must be provided on the flight
control system malfunctions, the tur- deck for starting, stopping, and emer-
bine speed may not exceed its max- gency shutdown of each installed auxil-
imum allowable value. Except for the iary power unit.
waste gate operating components, the
[Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50598, Oct. 30, 1978]
components provided for meeting this
requirement must be independent of 25.1143 Engine controls.
the normal turbo-supercharger con-
(a) There must be a separate power or
trols.
thrust control for each engine.
(b) Power and thrust controls must
POWERPLANT CONTROLS AND
be arranged to allow
ACCESSORIES
(1) Separate control of each engine;
25.1141 Powerplant controls: general. and
(2) Simultaneous control of all en-
Each powerplant control must be lo- gines.
cated, arranged, and designed under (c) Each power and thrust control
25.777 through 25.781 and marked must provide a positive and imme-
under 25.1555. In addition, it must diately responsive means of controlling
meet the following requirements: its engine.
(a) Each control must be located so (d) For each fluid injection (other
that it cannot be inadvertently oper- than fuel) system and its controls not
ated by persons entering, leaving, or provided and approved as part of the
moving normally in, the cockpit. engine, the applicant must show that

456

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00466 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1157

the flow of the injection fluid is ade- 25.1149 Propeller speed and pitch
quately controlled. controls.
(e) If a power or thrust control incor- (a) There must be a separate pro-
porates a fuel shutoff feature, the con- peller speed and pitch control for each
trol must have a means to prevent the propeller.
inadvertent movement of the control (b) The controls must be grouped and
into the shutoff position. The means arranged to allow
must (1) Separate control of each pro-
(1) Have a positive lock or stop at the peller; and
idle position; and (2) Simultaneous control of all pro-
(2) Require a separate and distinct pellers.
operation to place the control in the (c) The controls must allow synchro-
shutoff position. nization of all propellers.
[Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5677, Apr. 8, 1970, as (d) The propeller speed and pitch con-
amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55467, Dec. 20, trols must be to the right of, and at
1976; Amdt. 2557, 49 FR 6849, Feb. 23, 1984] least one inch below, the pilots throt-
tle controls.
25.1145 Ignition switches.
(a) Ignition switches must control 25.1153 Propeller feathering controls.
each engine ignition circuit on each (a) There must be a separate pro-
engine. peller feathering control for each pro-
(b) There must be means to quickly peller. The control must have means to
shut off all ignition by the grouping of prevent its inadvertent operation.
switches or by a master ignition con- (b) If feathering is accomplished by
trol. movement of the propeller pitch or
(c) Each group of ignition switches, speed control lever, there must be
except ignition switches for turbine en- means to prevent the inadvertent
gines for which continuous ignition is movement of this lever to the feath-
not required, and each master ignition ering position during normal oper-
control must have a means to prevent ation.
its inadvertent operation.
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as amended by Amdt. 2511, 32 FR 6913, May 5,
amended by Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15044 Mar. 17, 1967]
1977]
25.1155 Reverse thrust and propeller
25.1147 Mixture controls. pitch settings below the flight re-
gime.
(a) If there are mixture controls,
each engine must have a separate con- Each control for reverse thrust and
trol. The controls must be grouped and for propeller pitch settings below the
arranged to allow flight regime must have means to pre-
(1) Separate control of each engine; vent its inadvertent operation. The
and means must have a positive lock or
(2) Simultaneous control of all en- stop at the flight idle position and
gines. must require a separate and distinct
(b) Each intermediate position of the operation by the crew to displace the
mixture controls that corresponds to a control from the flight regime (forward
normal operating setting must be iden- thrust regime for turbojet powered air-
tifiable by feel and sight. planes).
(c) The mixture controls must be ac- [Amdt. 2511, 32 FR 6913, May 5, 1967]
cessible to both pilots. However, if
there is a separate flight engineer sta- 25.1157 Carburetor air temperature
tion with a control panel, the controls controls.
need be accessible only to the flight en- There must be a separate carburetor
gineer. air temperature control for each en-
gine.

457

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00467 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1159 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

25.1159 Supercharger controls. (2) The condition of a completely de-


Each supercharger control must be pleted battery with the generator run-
accessible to the pilots or, if there is a ning at its normal operating speed; and
separate flight engineer station with a (3) The condition of a completely de-
control panel, to the flight engineer. pleted battery with the generator oper-
ating at idling speed, if there is only
25.1161 Fuel jettisoning system con- one battery.
trols. (d) Magneto ground wiring (for sepa-
Each fuel jettisoning system control rate ignition circuits) that lies on the
must have guards to prevent inad- engine side of the fire wall, must be in-
vertent operation. No control may be stalled, located, or protected, to mini-
near any fire extinguisher control or mize the probability of simultaneous
other control used to combat fire. failure of two or more wires as a result
of mechanical damage, electrical
25.1163 Powerplant accessories. faults, or other cause.
(a) Each engine mounted accessory (e) No ground wire for any engine
must may be routed through a fire zone of
(1) Be approved for mounting on the another engine unless each part of that
engine involved; wire within that zone is fireproof.
(2) Use the provisions on the engine (f) Each ignition system must be
for mounting; and independent of any electrical circuit,
(3) Be sealed to prevent contamina-
not used for assisting, controlling, or
tion of the engine oil system and the
analyzing the operation of that system.
accessory system.
(b) Electrical equipment subject to (g) There must be means to warn ap-
arcing or sparking must be installed to propriate flight crewmembers if the
minimize the probability of contact malfunctioning of any part of the elec-
with any flammable fluids or vapors trical system is causing the continuous
that might be present in a free state. discharge of any battery necessary for
(c) If continued rotation of an engine- engine ignition.
driven cabin supercharger or of any re- (h) Each engine ignition system of a
mote accessory driven by the engine is turbine powered airplane must be con-
hazardous if malfunctioning occurs, sidered an essential electrical load.
there must be means to prevent rota-
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
tion without interfering with the con- amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5677, Apr. 8,
tinued operation of the engine. 1970; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29785, July 20, 1990]
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2557, 49 FR 6849, Feb. 23, 25.1167 Accessory gearboxes.
1984]
For airplanes equipped with an acces-
25.1165 Engine ignition systems. sory gearbox that is not certificated as
part of an engine
(a) Each battery ignition system
(a) The engine with gearbox and con-
must be supplemented by a generator
necting transmissions and shafts at-
that is automatically available as an
alternate source of electrical energy to tached must be subjected to the tests
allow continued engine operation if specified in 33.49 or 33.87 of this chap-
any battery becomes depleted. ter, as applicable;
(b) The capacity of batteries and gen- (b) The accessory gearbox must meet
erators must be large enough to meet the requirements of 33.25 and 33.53 or
the simultaneous demands of the en- 33.91 of this chapter, as applicable; and
gine ignition system and the greatest (c) Possible misalignments and tor-
demands of any electrical system com- sional loadings of the gearbox, trans-
ponents that draw electrical energy mission, and shaft system, expected to
from the same source. result under normal operating condi-
(c) The design of the engine ignition tions must be evaluated.
system must account for
(1) The condition of an inoperative [Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55467, Dec. 20, 1976]
generator;

458

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00468 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1185

POWERPLANT FIRE PROTECTION and other component carrying flam-


mable fluid in any area subject to en-
25.1181 Designated fire zones; re- gine fire conditions, and each compo-
gions included. nent which conveys or contains flam-
(a) Designated fire zones are mable fluid in a designated fire zone
(1) The engine power section; must be fire resistant, except that
(2) The engine accessory section; flammable fluid tanks and supports in
(3) Except for reciprocating engines, a designated fire zone must be fireproof
any complete powerplant compartment or be enclosed by a fireproof shield un-
in which no isolation is provided be- less damage by fire to any non-fire-
tween the engine power section and the proof part will not cause leakage or
engine accessory section; spillage of flammable fluid. Compo-
(4) Any auxiliary power unit com- nents must be shielded or located to
partment; safeguard against the ignition of leak-
(5) Any fuel-burning heater and other ing flammable fluid. An integral oil
combustion equipment installation de- sump of less than 25-quart capacity on
scribed in 25.859; a reciprocating engine need not be fire-
(6) The compressor and accessory sec- proof nor be enclosed by a fireproof
tions of turbine engines; and shield.
(7) Combustor, turbine, and tailpipe (b) Paragraph (a) of this section does
sections of turbine engine installations not apply to
that contain lines or components car- (1) Lines, fittings, and components
rying flammable fluids or gases. which are already approved as part of a
(b) Each designated fire zone must type certificated engine; and
meet the requirements of 25.863, (2) Vent and drain lines, and their fit-
25.865, 25.867, 25.869, and 25.1185 through tings, whose failure will not result in,
25.1203. or add to, a fire hazard.
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as (c) All components, including ducts,
amended by Amdt. 2511, 32 FR 6913, May 5, within a designated fire zone must be
1967; Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5677, Apr. 8, 1970; fireproof if, when exposed to or dam-
Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29785, July 20, 1990; Amdt. aged by fire, they could
25115, 69 FR 40527, July 2, 2004] (1) Result in fire spreading to other
regions of the airplane; or
25.1182 Nacelle areas behind fire- (2) Cause unintentional operation of,
walls, and engine pod attaching or inability to operate, essential serv-
structures containing flammable
fluid lines. ices or equipment.
(a) Each nacelle area immediately [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
behind the firewall, and each portion of amended by Amdt. 2511, 32 FR 6913, May 5,
1967; Amdt. 2536, 39 FR 35461, Oct. 1, 1974;
any engine pod attaching structure Amdt. 2557, 49 FR 6849, Feb. 23, 1984; Amdt.
containing flammable fluid lines, must 25101, 65 FR 79710, Dec. 19, 2000]
meet each requirement of 25.1103(b),
25.1165 (d) and (e), 25.1183, 25.1185(c), 25.1185 Flammable fluids.
25.1187, 25.1189, and 25.1195 through (a) Except for the integral oil sumps
25.1203, including those concerning des- specified in 25.1183(a), no tank or res-
ignated fire zones. However, engine pod ervoir that is a part of a system con-
attaching structures need not contain taining flammable fluids or gases may
fire detection or extinguishing means. be in a designated fire zone unless the
(b) For each area covered by para- fluid contained, the design of the sys-
graph (a) of this section that contains tem, the materials used in the tank,
a retractable landing gear, compliance the shut-off means, and all connec-
with that paragraph need only be tions, lines, and control provide a de-
shown with the landing gear retracted. gree of safety equal to that which
[Amdt. 2511, 32 FR 6913, May 5, 1967] would exist if the tank or reservoir
were outside such a zone.
25.1183 Flammable fluid-carrying (b) There must be at least one-half
components. inch of clear airspace between each
(a) Except as provided in paragraph tank or reservoir and each firewall or
(b) of this section, each line, fitting, shroud isolating a designated fire zone.

459

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00469 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1187 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(c) Absorbent materials close to including oil tanks, are fireproof or lo-
flammable fluid system components cated in areas not subject to engine
that might leak must be covered or fire conditions.
treated to prevent the absorption of (b) The closing of any fuel shutoff
hazardous quantities of fluids. valve for any engine may not make
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964 as
fuel unavailable to the remaining en-
amended by Amdt. 2519, 33 FR 15410, Oct. 17, gines.
1968; Amdt. 2594, 63 FR 8848, Feb. 23, 1998] (c) Operation of any shutoff may not
interfere with the later emergency op-
25.1187 Drainage and ventilation of eration of other equipment, such as the
fire zones. means for feathering the propeller.
(a) There must be complete drainage (d) Each flammable fluid shutoff
of each part of each designated fire means and control must be fireproof or
zone to minimize the hazards resulting must be located and protected so that
from failure or malfunctioning of any any fire in a fire zone will not affect its
component containing flammable operation.
fluids. The drainage means must be (e) No hazardous quantity of flam-
(1) Effective under conditions ex- mable fluid may drain into any des-
pected to prevail when drainage is ignated fire zone after shutoff.
needed; and (f) There must be means to guard
(2) Arranged so that no discharged against inadvertent operation of the
fluid will cause an additional fire haz- shutoff means and to make it possible
ard. for the crew to reopen the shutoff
(b) Each designated fire zone must be means in flight after it has been closed.
ventilated to prevent the accumulation (g) Each tank-to-engine shutoff valve
of flammable vapors. must be located so that the operation
(c) No ventilation opening may be of the valve will not be affected by
where it would allow the entry of flam- powerplant or engine mount structural
mable fluids, vapors, or flame from failure.
other zones. (h) Each shutoff valve must have a
(d) Each ventilation means must be means to relieve excessive pressure ac-
arranged so that no discharged vapors cumulation unless a means for pressure
will cause an additional fire hazard. relief is otherwise provided in the sys-
(e) Unless the extinguishing agent ca- tem.
pacity and rate of discharge are based [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
on maximum air flow through a zone, amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5677, Apr. 8,
there must be means to allow the crew 1970; Amdt. 2557, 49 FR 6849, Feb. 23, 1984]
to shut off sources of forced ventilation
to any fire zone except the engine 25.1191 Firewalls.
power section of the nacelle and the (a) Each engine, auxiliary power
combustion heater ventilating air unit, fuel-burning heater, other com-
ducts. bustion equipment intended for oper-
ation in flight, and the combustion,
25.1189 Shutoff means. turbine, and tailpipe sections of tur-
(a) Each engine installation and each bine engines, must be isolated from the
fire zone specified in 25.1181(a)(4) and rest of the airplane by firewalls,
(5) must have a means to shut off or shrouds, or equivalent means.
otherwise prevent hazardous quantities (b) Each firewall and shroud must
of fuel, oil, deicer, and other flammable be
fluids, from flowing into, within, or (1) Fireproof;
through any designated fire zone, ex- (2) Constructed so that no hazardous
cept that shutoff means are not re- quantity of air, fluid, or flame can pass
quired for from the compartment to other parts
(1) Lines, fittings, and components of the airplane;
forming an integral part of an engine; (3) Constructed so that each opening
and is sealed with close fitting fireproof
(2) Oil systems for turbine engine in- grommets, bushings, or firewall fit-
stallations in which all components of tings; and
the system in a designated fire zone, (4) Protected against corrosion.

460

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00470 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1197

25.1192 Engine accessory section dia- the rate of discharge, and the discharge
phragm. distribution must be adequate to extin-
For reciprocating engines, the engine guish fires. It must be shown by either
power section and all portions of the actual or simulated flights tests that
exhaust system must be isolated from under critical airflow conditions in
the engine accessory compartment by a flight the discharge of the extin-
diaphragm that complies with the fire- guishing agent in each designated fire
wall requirements of 25.1191. zone specified in paragraph (a) of this
[Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5678, Apr. 8, 1970]
section will provide an agent con-
centration capable of extinguishing
25.1193 Cowling and nacelle skin. fires in that zone and of minimizing
(a) Each cowling must be constructed the probability of reignition. An indi-
and supported so that it can resist any vidual one-shot system may be used
vibration, inertia, and air load to for auxiliary power units, fuel burning
which it may be subjected in operation. heaters, and other combustion equip-
(b) Cowling must meet the drainage ment. For each other designated fire
and ventilation requirements of zone, two discharges must be provided
25.1187. each of which produces adequate agent
(c) On airplanes with a diaphragm concentration.
isolating the engine power section from (c) The fire extinguishing system for
the engine accessory section, each part a nacelle must be able to simulta-
of the accessory section cowling sub- neously protect each zone of the na-
ject to flame in case of fire in the en- celle for which protection is provided.
gine power section of the powerplant
must [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50598, Oct. 30,
(1) Be fireproof; and
1978]
(2) Meet the requirements of 25.1191.
(d) Each part of the cowling subject 25.1197 Fire extinguishing agents.
to high temperatures due to its near-
ness to exhaust system parts or ex- (a) Fire extinguishing agents must
haust gas impingement must be fire- (1) Be capable of extinguishing
proof. flames emanating from any burning of
(e) Each airplane must fluids or other combustible materials
(1) Be designed and constructed so in the area protected by the fire extin-
that no fire originating in any fire zone guishing system; and
can enter, either through openings or (2) Have thermal stability over the
by burning through external skin, any temperature range likely to be experi-
other zone or region where it would enced in the compartment in which
create additional hazards; they are stored.
(2) Meet paragraph (e)(1) of this sec- (b) If any toxic extinguishing agent is
tion with the landing gear retracted (if used, provisions must be made to pre-
applicable); and
vent harmful concentrations of fluid or
(3) Have fireproof skin in areas sub-
fluid vapors (from leakage during nor-
ject to flame if a fire starts in the en-
gine power or accessory sections. mal operation of the airplane or as a
result of discharging the fire extin-
25.1195 Fire extinguishing systems. guisher on the ground or in flight) from
(a) Except for combustor, turbine, entering any personnel compartment,
and tail pipe sections of turbine engine even though a defect may exist in the
installations that contain lines or com- extinguishing system. This must be
ponents carrying flammable fluids or shown by test except for built-in car-
gases for which it is shown that a fire bon dioxide fuselage compartment fire
originating in these sections can be extinguishing systems for which
controlled, there must be a fire extin- (1) Five pounds or less of carbon diox-
guisher system serving each designated ide will be discharged, under estab-
fire zone. lished fire control procedures, into any
(b) The fire extinguishing system, the fuselage compartment; or
quantity of the extinguishing agent,

461

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00471 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1199 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(2) There is protective breathing combustion, turbine, and tailpipe sec-


equipment for each flight crewmember tions of turbine engine installations, in
on flight deck duty. numbers and locations ensuring
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as prompt detection of fire in those zones.
amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55467, Dec. 20, (b) Each fire detector system must be
1976; Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15044, Mar. 17, 1977] constructed and installed so that
(1) It will withstand the vibration, in-
25.1199 Extinguishing agent con-
tainers. ertia, and other loads to which it may
be subjected in operation;
(a) Each extinguishing agent con- (2) There is a means to warn the crew
tainer must have a pressure relief to
in the event that the sensor or associ-
prevent bursting of the container by
ated wiring within a designated fire
excessive internal pressures.
(b) The discharge end of each dis- zone is severed at one point, unless the
charge line from a pressure relief con- system continues to function as a sat-
nection must be located so that dis- isfactory detection system after the
charge of the fire extinguishing agent severing; and
would not damage the airplane. The (3) There is a means to warn the crew
line must also be located or protected in the event of a short circuit in the
to prevent clogging caused by ice or sensor or associated wiring within a
other foreign matter. designated fire zone, unless the system
(c) There must be a means for each continues to function as a satisfactory
fire extinguishing agent container to detection system after the short cir-
indicate that the container has dis- cuit.
charged or that the charging pressure (c) No fire or overheat detector may
is below the established minimum nec- be affected by any oil, water, other
essary for proper functioning. fluids or fumes that might be present.
(d) The temperature of each con-
(d) There must be means to allow the
tainer must be maintained, under in-
tended operating conditions, to prevent crew to check, in flight, the func-
the pressure in the container from tioning of each fire or overheat detec-
(1) Falling below that necessary to tor electric circuit.
provide an adequate rate of discharge; (e) Wiring and other components of
or each fire or overheat detector system
(2) Rising high enough to cause pre- in a fire zone must be at least fire-re-
mature discharge. sistant.
(e) If a pyrotechnic capsule is used to (f) No fire or overheat detector sys-
discharge the extinguishing agent, tem component for any fire zone may
each container must be installed so pass through another fire zone, un-
that temperature conditions will not less
cause hazardous deterioration of the (1) It is protected against the possi-
pyrotechnic capsule. bility of false warnings resulting from
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as fires in zones through which it passes;
amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5678, Apr. 8, or
1970; Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15044, Mar. 17, 1977] (2) Each zone involved is simulta-
neously protected by the same detector
25.1201 Fire extinguishing system
materials. and extinguishing system.
(g) Each fire detector system must be
(a) No material in any fire extin-
constructed so that when it is in the
guishing system may react chemically
configuration for installation it will
with any extinguishing agent so as to
not exceed the alarm activation time
create a hazard.
(b) Each system component in an en- approved for the detectors using the re-
gine compartment must be fireproof. sponse time criteria specified in the ap-
propriate Technical Standard Order for
25.1203 Fire detector system. the detector.
(a) There must be approved, quick [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
acting fire or overheat detectors in amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5678, Apr. 8,
each designated fire zone, and in the 1970; Amdt. 2526, 36 FR 5493, Mar. 24, 1971]

462

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00472 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1305

25.1207 Compliance. (4) A gyroscopic rate-of-turn indi-


cator combined with an integral slip-
Unless otherwise specified, compli-
skid indicator (turn-and-bank indi-
ance with the requirements of 25.1181
cator) except that only a slip-skid indi-
through 25.1203 must be shown by a full
cator is required on large airplanes
scale fire test or by one or more of the
with a third attitude instrument sys-
following methods:
tem useable through flight attitudes of
(a) Tests of similar powerplant con-
360 of pitch and roll and installed in
figurations;
accordance with 121.305(k) of this
(b) Tests of components;
title.
(c) Service experience of aircraft
with similar powerplant configura- (5) A bank and pitch indicator (gyro-
tions; scopically stabilized).
(d) Analysis. (6) A direction indicator (gyroscop-
ically stabilized, magnetic or non-
[Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50598, Oct. 30, 1978] magnetic).
(c) The following flight and naviga-
Subpart FEquipment tion instruments are required as pre-
scribed in this paragraph:
GENERAL (1) A speed warning device is required
25.1301 Function and installation. for turbine engine powered airplanes
and for airplanes with VMO/MMO great-
Each item of installed equipment er than 0.8 VDF/MDF or 0.8 V D/MD. The
must speed warning device must give effec-
(a) Be of a kind and design appro- tive aural warning (differing distinc-
priate to its intended function; tively from aural warnings used for
(b) Be labeled as to its identification, other purposes) to the pilots, whenever
function, or operating limitations, or the speed exceeds VMO plus 6 knots or
any applicable combination of these MMO +0.01. The upper limit of the pro-
factors; duction tolerance for the warning de-
(c) Be installed according to limita- vice may not exceed the prescribed
tions specified for that equipment; and warning speed.
(d) Function properly when installed. (2) A machmeter is required at each
pilot station for airplanes with com-
25.1303 Flight and navigation instru-
ments. pressibility limitations not otherwise
indicated to the pilot by the airspeed
(a) The following flight and naviga- indicating system required under para-
tion instruments must be installed so graph (b)(1) of this section.
that the instrument is visible from
each pilot station: [Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5678, Apr. 8, 1970, as
(1) A free air temperature indicator amended by Amdt. 2524, 35 FR 7108, May 6,
or an air-temperature indicator which 1970; Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55467, Dec. 20, 1976;
Amdt. 2590, 62 FR 13253, Mar. 19, 1997]
provides indications that are convert-
ible to free-air temperature. 25.1305 Powerplant instruments.
(2) A clock displaying hours, min-
utes, and seconds with a sweep-second The following are required power-
pointer or digital presentation. plant instruments:
(3) A direction indicator (non- (a) For all airplanes. (1) A fuel pres-
stabilized magnetic compass). sure warning means for each engine, or
(b) The following flight and naviga- a master warning means for all engines
tion instruments must be installed at with provision for isolating the indi-
each pilot station: vidual warning means from the master
(1) An airspeed indicator. If airspeed warning means.
limitations vary with altitude, the in- (2) A fuel quantity indicator for each
dicator must have a maximum allow- fuel tank.
able airspeed indicator showing the (3) An oil quantity indicator for each
variation of VMO with altitude. oil tank.
(2) An altimeter (sensitive). (4) An oil pressure indicator for each
(3) A rate-of-climb indicator (vertical independent pressure oil system of
speed). each engine.

463

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00473 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1305 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(5) An oil pressure warning means for continuous operation nor designed to
each engine, or a master warning prevent hazard if it failed.
means for all engines with provision (5) An indicator to indicate the func-
for isolating the individual warning tioning of the powerplant ice protec-
means from the master warning means. tion system for each engine.
(6) An oil temperature indicator for (6) An indicator for the fuel strainer
each engine. or filter required by 25.997 to indicate
(7) Fire-warning devices that provide the occurrence of contamination of the
visual and audible warning. strainer or filter before it reaches the
(8) An augmentation liquid quantity capacity established in accordance
indicator (appropriate for the manner with 25.997(d).
in which the liquid is to be used in op- (7) A warning means for the oil
eration) for each tank. strainer or filter required by 25.1019, if
(b) For reciprocating engine-powered it has no bypass, to warn the pilot of
airplanes. In addition to the powerplant the occurrence of contamination of the
instruments required by paragraph (a) strainer or filter screen before it
of this section, the following power- reaches the capacity established in ac-
plant instruments are required: cordance with 25.1019(a)(2).
(1) A carburetor air temperature indi- (8) An indicator to indicate the prop-
cator for each engine. er functioning of any heater used to
(2) A cylinder head temperature indi- prevent ice clogging of fuel system
cator for each air-cooled engine. components.
(3) A manifold pressure indicator for (d) For turbojet engine powered air-
each engine. planes. In addition to the powerplant
(4) A fuel pressure indicator (to indi- instruments required by paragraphs (a)
cate the pressure at which the fuel is and (c) of this section, the following
supplied) for each engine. powerplant instruments are required:
(5) A fuel flowmeter, or fuel mixture (1) An indicator to indicate thrust, or
indicator, for each engine without an a parameter that is directly related to
automatic altitude mixture control. thrust, to the pilot. The indication
(6) A tachometer for each engine. must be based on the direct measure-
(7) A device that indicates, to the ment of thrust or of parameters that
flight crew (during flight), any change are directly related to thrust. The indi-
in the power output, for each engine cator must indicate a change in thrust
with resulting from any engine malfunction,
(i) An automatic propeller feathering damage, or deterioration.
system, whose operation is initiated by (2) A position indicating means to in-
a power output measuring system; or dicate to the flightcrew when the
(ii) A total engine piston displace- thrust reversing device
ment of 2,000 cubic inches or more. (i) Is not in the selected position, and
(8) A means to indicate to the pilot (ii) Is in the reverse thrust position,
when the propeller is in reverse pitch, for each engine using a thrust revers-
for each reversing propeller. ing device.
(c) For turbine engine-powered air- (3) An indicator to indicate rotor sys-
planes. In addition to the powerplant tem unbalance.
instruments required by paragraph (a) (e) For turbopropeller-powered air-
of this section, the following power- planes. In addition to the powerplant
plant instruments are required: instruments required by paragraphs (a)
(1) A gas temperature indicator for and (c) of this section, the following
each engine. powerplant instruments are required:
(2) A fuel flowmeter indicator for (1) A torque indicator for each en-
each engine. gine.
(3) A tachometer (to indicate the (2) Position indicating means to indi-
speed of the rotors with established cate to the flight crew when the pro-
limiting speeds) for each engine. peller blade angle is below the flight
(4) A means to indicate, to the flight low pitch position, for each propeller.
crew, the operation of each engine (f) For airplanes equipped with fluid
starter that can be operated continu- systems (other than fuel) for thrust or
ously but that is neither designed for power augmentation, an approved

464

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00474 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1309

means must be provided to indicate the of the crew to cope with adverse oper-
proper functioning of that system to ating conditions is improbable.
the flight crew. (c) Warning information must be pro-
[Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5678, Apr. 8, 1970, as vided to alert the crew to unsafe sys-
amended by Amdt. 2535, 39 FR 1831, Jan. 15, tem operating conditions, and to en-
1974; Amdt. 2536, 39 FR 35461, Oct. 1, 1974; able them to take appropriate correc-
Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55467, Dec. 20, 1976; Amdt. tive action. Systems, controls, and as-
2554, 45 FR 60173, Sept. 11, 1980; Amdt. 2572, sociated monitoring and warning
55 FR 29785, July 20, 1990; Amdt. 25115, 69 FR means must be designed to minimize
40527, July 2, 2004] crew errors which could create addi-
tional hazards.
25.1307 Miscellaneous equipment.
(d) Compliance with the require-
The following is required miscella- ments of paragraph (b) of this section
neous equipment: must be shown by analysis, and where
(a) [Reserved] necessary, by appropriate ground,
(b) Two or more independent sources flight, or simulator tests. The analysis
of electrical energy. must consider
(c) Electrical protective devices, as (1) Possible modes of failure, includ-
prescribed in this part. ing malfunctions and damage from ex-
(d) Two systems for two-way radio ternal sources.
communications, with controls for (2) The probability of multiple fail-
each accessible from each pilot station, ures and undetected failures.
designed and installed so that failure of
(3) The resulting effects on the air-
one system will not preclude operation
plane and occupants, considering the
of the other system. The use of a com-
stage of flight and operating condi-
mon antenna system is acceptable if
tions, and
adequate reliability is shown.
(e) Two systems for radio navigation, (4) The crew warning cues, corrective
with controls for each accessible from action required, and the capability of
each pilot station, designed and in- detecting faults.
stalled so that failure of one system (e) Each installation whose func-
will not preclude operation of the other tioning is required by this subchapter,
system. The use of a common antenna and that requires a power supply, is an
system is acceptable if adequate reli- essential load on the power supply.
ability is shown. The power sources and the system
must be able to supply the following
[Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5678, Apr. 8, 1970, as power loads in probable operating com-
amended by Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50598, Oct. 30, binations and for probable durations:
1978; Amdt. 2554, 45 FR 60173, Sept. 11, 1980;
Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29785, July 20, 1990]
(1) Loads connected to the system
with the system functioning normally.
25.1309 Equipment, systems, and in- (2) Essential loads, after failure of
stallations. any one prime mover, power converter,
(a) The equipment, systems, and in- or energy storage device.
stallations whose functioning is re- (3) Essential loads after failure of
quired by this subchapter, must be de- (i) Any one engine on two-engine air-
signed to ensure that they perform planes; and
their intended functions under any (ii) Any two engines on three-or-
foreseeable operating condition. more-engine airplanes.
(b) The airplane systems and associ- (4) Essential loads for which an alter-
ated components, considered sepa- nate source of power is required by this
rately and in relation to other systems, chapter, after any failure or malfunc-
must be designed so that tion in any one power supply system,
(1) The occurrence of any failure con- distribution system, or other utiliza-
dition which would prevent the contin- tion system.
ued safe flight and landing of the air- (f) In determining compliance with
plane is extremely improbable, and paragraphs (e)(2) and (3) of this section,
(2) The occurrence of any other fail- the power loads may be assumed to be
ure conditions which would reduce the reduced under a monitoring procedure
capability of the airplane or the ability consistent with safety in the kinds of

465

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00475 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1316 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

operation authorized. Loads not re- (1) Determining the lightning strike
quired in controlled flight need not be zones for the airplane;
considered for the two-engine-inoper- (2) Establishing the external light-
ative condition on airplanes with three ning environment for the zones;
or more engines. (3) Establishing the internal environ-
(g) In showing compliance with para- ment;
graphs (a) and (b) of this section with (4) Identifying all the electrical and
regard to the electrical system and electronic systems that are subject to
equipment design and installation, the requirements of this section, and
critical environmental conditions must their locations on or within the air-
be considered. For electrical genera- plane;
tion, distribution, and utilization (5) Establishing the susceptibility of
equipment required by or used in com- the systems to the internal and exter-
plying with this chapter, except equip- nal lightning environment;
ment covered by Technical Standard (6) Designing protection; and
Orders containing environmental test (7) Verifying that the protection is
procedures, the ability to provide con- adequate.
tinuous, safe service under foreseeable [Doc. No. 25912, 59 FR 22116, Apr. 28, 1994]
environmental conditions may be
shown by environmental tests, design INSTRUMENTS: INSTALLATION
analysis, or reference to previous com-
parable service experience on other air- 25.1321 Arrangement and visibility.
craft. (a) Each flight, navigation, and pow-
erplant instrument for use by any pilot
[Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5679, Apr. 8, 1970, as must be plainly visible to him from his
amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55467, Dec. 20,
1976; Amdt. 2541, 42 FR 36970, July 18, 1977]
station with the minimum practicable
deviation from his normal position and
25.1316 System lightning protection. line of vision when he is looking for-
ward along the flight path.
(a) For functions whose failure would (b) The flight instruments required
contribute to or cause a condition that by 25.1303 must be grouped on the in-
would prevent the continued safe flight strument panel and centered as nearly
and landing of the airplane, each elec- as practicable about the vertical plane
trical and electronic system that per- of the pilots forward vision. In addi-
forms these functions must be designed tion
and installed to ensure that the oper- (1) The instrument that most effec-
ation and operational capabilities of tively indicates attitude must be on
the systems to perform these functions the panel in the top center position;
are not adversely affected when the (2) The instrument that most effec-
airplane is exposed to lightning. tively indicates airspeed must be adja-
(b) For functions whose failure would cent to and directly to the left of the
contribute to or cause a condition that instrument in the top center position:
would reduce the capability of the air- (3) The instrument that most effec-
plane or the ability of the flightcrew to tively indicates altitude must be adja-
cope with adverse operating conditions, cent to and directly to the right of the
each electrical and electronic system instrument in the top center position;
that performs these functions must be and
designed and installed to ensure that (4) The instrument that most effec-
these functions can be recovered in a tively indicates direction of flight
timely manner after the airplane is ex- must be adjacent to and directly below
posed to lightning. the instrument in the top center posi-
(c) Compliance with the lightning tion.
protection criteria prescribed in para- (c) Required powerplant instruments
graphs (a) and (b) of this section must must be closely grouped on the instru-
be shown for exposure to a severe light- ment panel. In addition
ning environment. The applicant must (1) The location of identical power-
design for and verify that aircraft elec- plant instruments for the engines must
trical/electronic systems are protected prevent confusion as to which engine
against the effects of lightning by: each instrument relates; and

466

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00476 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1325

(2) Powerplant instruments vital to (2) With the flaps and power settings
the safe operation of the airplane must corresponding to the values determined
be plainly visible to the appropriate in the establishment of the takeoff
crewmembers. path under 25.111 assuming that the
(d) Instrument panel vibration may critical engine fails at the minimum
not damage or impair the accuracy of value of V1.
any instrument. (c) The airspeed error of the installa-
(e) If a visual indicator is provided to tion, excluding the airspeed indicator
indicate malfunction of an instrument, instrument calibration error, may not
it must be effective under all probable exceed three percent or five knots,
cockpit lighting conditions. whichever is greater, throughout the
[Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5679, Apr. 8, 1970, as speed range, from
amended by Amdt. 2541, 42 FR 36970, July 18, (1) VMO to 1.23 VSR1, with flaps re-
1977] tracted; and
(2) 1.23 VSR0 to VFE with flaps in the
25.1322 Warning, caution, and advi- landing position.
sory lights.
(d) From 1.23 VSR to the speed at
If warning, caution or advisory lights which stall warning begins, the IAS
are installed in the cockpit, they must, must change perceptibly with CAS and
unless otherwise approved by the Ad- in the same sense, and at speeds below
ministrator, be stall warning speed the IAS must not
(a) Red, for warning lights (lights in- change in an incorrect sense.
dicating a hazard which may require (e) From VMO to VMO + 2/3 (VDF
immediate corrective action); VMO), the IAS must change perceptibly
(b) Amber, for caution lights (lights with CAS and in the same sense, and at
indicating the possible need for future
higher speeds up to VDF the IAS must
corrective action);
not change in an incorrect sense.
(c) Green, for safe operation lights;
(f) There must be no indication of
and
(d) Any other color, including white, airspeed that would cause undue dif-
for lights not described in paragraphs ficulty to the pilot during the takeoff
(a) through (c) of this section, provided between the initiation of rotation and
the color differs sufficiently from the the achievement of a steady climbing
colors prescribed in paragraphs (a) condition.
through (c) of this section to avoid pos- (g) The effects of airspeed indicating
sible confusion. system lag may not introduce signifi-
cant takeoff indicated airspeed bias, or
[Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55467, Dec. 20, 1976] significant errors in takeoff or accel-
erate-stop distances.
25.1323 Airspeed indicating system.
(h) Each system must be arranged, so
For each airspeed indicating system, far as practicable, to prevent malfunc-
the following apply: tion or serious error due to the entry of
(a) Each airspeed indicating instru- moisture, dirt, or other substances.
ment must be approved and must be (i) Each system must have a heated
calibrated to indicate true airspeed (at pitot tube or an equivalent means of
sea level with a standard atmosphere) preventing malfunction due to icing.
with a minimum practicable instru-
(j) Where duplicate airspeed indica-
ment calibration error when the cor-
tors are required, their respective pitot
responding pitot and static pressures
tubes must be far enough apart to
are applied.
avoid damage to both tubes in a colli-
(b) Each system must be calibrated
sion with a bird.
to determine the system error (that is,
the relation between IAS and CAS) in [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
flight and during the accelerated take- amended by Amdt. 2557, 49 FR 6849, Feb. 23,
off ground run. The ground run calibra- 1984; Amdt. 25108, 67 FR 70828, Nov. 26, 2002;
tion must be determined Amdt. 25109, 67 FR 76656, Dec. 12, 2002]
(1) From 0.8 of the minimum value of
V1 to the maximum value of V2, consid- 25.1325 Static pressure systems.
ering the approved ranges of altitude (a) Each instrument with static air
and weight; and case connections must be vented to the

467

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00477 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1326 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

outside atmosphere through an appro- standard atmosphere, excluding instru-


priate piping system. ment calibration error, does not result
(b) Each static port must be designed in an error of more than 30 feet per 100
and located in such manner that the knots speed for the appropriate con-
static pressure system performance is figuration in the speed range between
least affected by airflow variation, or 1.23 VSR0 with flaps extended and 1.7
by moisture or other foreign matter, VSR1 with flaps retracted. However, the
and that the correlation between air error need not be less than 30 feet.
pressure in the static pressure system (f) If an altimeter system is fitted
and true ambient atmospheric static with a device that provides corrections
pressure is not changed when the air- to the altimeter indication, the device
plane is exposed to the continuous and must be designed and installed in such
intermittent maximum icing condi- manner that it can be bypassed when it
tions defined in appendix C of this part. malfunctions, unless an alternate al-
(c) The design and installation of the timeter system is provided. Each cor-
static pressure system must be such rection device must be fitted with a
that means for indicating the occurrence of
(1) Positive drainage of moisture is reasonably probable malfunctions, in-
provided; chafing of the tubing and ex- cluding power failure, to the flight
cessive distortion or restriction at crew. The indicating means must be ef-
bends in the tubing is avoided; and the fective for any cockpit lighting condi-
materials used are durable, suitable for tion likely to occur.
the purpose intended, and protected (g) Except as provided in paragraph
against corrosion; and (h) of this section, if the static pressure
(2) It is airtight except for the port system incorporates both a primary
into the atmosphere. A proof test must and an alternate static pressure source,
be conducted to demonstrate the integ- the means for selecting one or the
rity of the static pressure system in other source must be designed so
the following manner: that
(i) Unpressurized airplanes. Evacuate (1) When either source is selected, the
the static pressure system to a pres- other is blocked off; and
sure differential of approximately 1
(2) Both sources cannot be blocked
inch of mercury or to a reading on the
off simultaneously.
altimeter, 1,000 feet above the airplane
(h) For unpressurized airplanes, para-
elevation at the time of the test. With-
graph (g)(1) of this section does not
out additional pumping for a period of
apply if it can be demonstrated that
1 minute, the loss of indicated altitude
the static pressure system calibration,
must not exceed 100 feet on the altim-
when either static pressure source is
eter.
selected, is not changed by the other
(ii) Pressurized airplanes. Evacuate
static pressure source being open or
the static pressure system until a pres-
blocked.
sure differential equivalent to the max-
imum cabin pressure differential for [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
which the airplane is type certificated amended by Amdt. 255, 30 FR 8261, June 29,
is achieved. Without additional pump- 1965; Amdt. 2512, 32 FR 7587, May 24, 1967;
ing for a period of 1 minute, the loss of Amdt. 2541, 42 FR 36970, July 18, 1977; Amdt.
indicated altitude must not exceed 2 25108, 67 FR 70828, Nov. 26, 2002]
percent of the equivalent altitude of
25.1326 Pitot heat indication systems.
the maximum cabin differential pres-
sure or 100 feet, whichever is greater. If a flight instrument pitot heating
(d) Each pressure altimeter must be system is installed, an indication sys-
approved and must be calibrated to in- tem must be provided to indicate to
dicate pressure altitude in a standard the flight crew when that pitot heating
atmosphere, with a minimum prac- system is not operating. The indication
ticable calibration error when the cor- system must comply with the following
responding static pressures are applied. requirements:
(e) Each system must be designed and (a) The indication provided must in-
installed so that the error in indicated corporate an amber light that is in
pressure altitude, at sea level, with a clear view of a flight crewmember.

468

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00478 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1331

(b) The indication provided must be (g) If the automatic pilot integrates
designed to alert the flight crew if ei- signals from auxiliary controls or fur-
ther of the following conditions exist: nishes signals for operation of other
(1) The pitot heating system is equipment, there must be positive
switched off. interlocks and sequencing of engage-
(2) The pitot heating system is ment to prevent improper operation.
switched on and any pitot tube heat- Protection against adverse interaction
ing element is inoperative. of integrated components, resulting
[Amdt. 2543, 43 FR 10339, Mar. 13, 1978] from a malfunction, is also required.
(h) If the automatic pilot system can
25.1327 Magnetic direction indicator. be coupled to airborne navigation
equipment, means must be provided to
(a) Each magnetic direction indicator
indicate to the flight crew the current
must be installed so that its accuracy
is not excessively affected by the air- mode of operation. Selector switch po-
planes vibration or magnetic fields. sition is not acceptable as a means of
(b) The compensated installation indication.
may not have a deviation, in level [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
flight, greater than 10 degrees on any amended by Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50598, Oct. 30,
heading. 1978]

25.1329 Automatic pilot system. 25.1331 Instruments using a power


supply.
(a) Each automatic pilot system
must be approved and must be designed (a) For each instrument required by
so that the automatic pilot can be 25.1303(b) that uses a power supply,
quickly and positively disengaged by the following apply:
the pilots to prevent it from inter- (1) Each instrument must have a vis-
fering with their control of the air- ual means integral with, the instru-
plane. ment, to indicate when power adequate
(b) Unless there is automatic syn- to sustain proper instrument perform-
chronization, each system must have a ance is not being supplied. The power
means to readily indicate to the pilot must be measured at or near the point
the alignment of the actuating device where it enters the instruments. For
in relation to the control system it op- electric instruments, the power is con-
erates. sidered to be adequate when the volt-
(c) Each manually operated control age is within approved limits.
for the system must be readily acces- (2) Each instrument must, in the
sible to the pilots. event of the failure of one power
(d) Quick release (emergency) con- source, be supplied by another power
trols must be on both control wheels, source. This may be accomplished
on the side of each wheel opposite the automatically or by manual means.
throttles. (3) If an instrument presenting navi-
(e) Attitude controls must operate in gation data receives information from
the plane and sense of motion specified sources external to that instrument
in 25.777(b) and 25.779(a) for cockpit and loss of that information would
controls. The direction of motion must render the presented data unreliable,
be plainly indicated on, or adjacent to, the instrument must incorporate a vis-
each control. ual means to warn the crew, when such
(f) The system must be designed and loss of information occurs, that the
adjusted so that, within the range of presented data should not be relied
adjustment available to the human upon.
pilot, it cannot produce hazardous (b) As used in this section, instru-
loads on the airplane, or create haz- ment includes devices that are phys-
ardous deviations in the flight path, ically contained in one unit, and de-
under any condition of flight appro- vices that are composed of two or more
priate to its use, either during normal physically separate units or compo-
operation or in the event of a malfunc- nents connected together (such as a re-
tion, assuming that corrective action mote indicating gyroscopic direction
begins within a reasonable period of indicator that includes a magnetic
time. sensing element, a gyroscopic unit, an

469

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00479 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1333 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

amplifier and an indicator connected (i) Have restricting orifices or other


together). safety devices at the source of pressure
to prevent the escape of excessive fluid
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2541, 42 FR 36970, July 18,
if the line fails; and
1977] (ii) Be installed and located so that
the escape of fluids would not create a
25.1333 Instrument systems. hazard.
(3) Each powerplant and auxiliary
For systems that operate the instru-
power unit instrument that utilizes
ments required by 25.1303(b) which are
flammable fluids must be installed and
located at each pilots station
located so that the escape of fluid
(a) Means must be provided to con- would not create a hazard.
nect the required instruments at the (b) Fuel quantity indicator. There
first pilots station to operating sys- must be means to indicate to the flight
tems which are independent of the op- crewmembers, the quantity, in gallons
erating systems at other flight crew or equivalent units, of usable fuel in
stations, or other equipment; each tank during flight. In addition
(b) The equipment, systems, and in- (1) Each fuel quantity indicator must
stallations must be designed so that be calibrated to read zero during
one display of the information essen- level flight when the quantity of fuel
tial to the safety of flight which is pro- remaining in the tank is equal to the
vided by the instruments, including at- unusable fuel supply determined under
titude, direction, airspeed, and altitude 25.959;
will remain available to the pilots, (2) Tanks with interconnected outlets
without additional crewmember ac- and airspaces may be treated as one
tion, after any single failure or com- tank and need not have separate indi-
bination of failures that is not shown cators; and
to be extremely improbable; and (3) Each exposed sight gauge, used as
(c) Additional instruments, systems, a fuel quantity indicator, must be pro-
or equipment may not be connected to tected against damage.
the operating systems for the required (c) Fuel flowmeter system. If a fuel
instruments, unless provisions are flowmeter system is installed, each
made to ensure the continued normal metering component must have a
functioning of the required instru- means for bypassing the fuel supply if
ments in the event of any malfunction malfunction of that component se-
of the additional instruments, systems, verely restricts fuel flow.
or equipment which is not shown to be (d) Oil quantity indicator. There must
extremely improbable. be a stick gauge or equivalent means
[Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5679, Apr. 8, 1970, as to indicate the quantity of oil in each
amended by Amdt. 2541, 42 FR 36970, July 18, tank. If an oil transfer or reserve oil
1977] supply system is installed, there must
be a means to indicate to the flight
25.1335 Flight director systems. crew, in flight, the quantity of oil in
If a flight director system is in- each tank.
stalled, means must be provided to in- (e) Turbopropeller blade position indi-
dicate to the flight crew its current cator. Required turbopropeller blade
mode of operation. Selector switch po- position indicators must begin indi-
sition is not acceptable as a means of cating before the blade moves more
indication. than eight degrees below the flight low
pitch stop. The source of indication
[Amdt. 2541, 42 FR 36970, July 18, 1977] must directly sense the blade position.
(f) Fuel pressure indicator. There must
25.1337 Powerplant instruments. be means to measure fuel pressure, in
(a) Instruments and instrument lines. each system supplying reciprocating
(1) Each powerplant and auxiliary engines, at a point downstream of any
power unit instrument line must meet fuel pump except fuel injection pumps.
the requirements of 25.993 and 25.1183. In addition
(2) Each line carrying flammable (1) If necessary for the maintenance
fluids under pressure must of proper fuel delivery pressure, there

470

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00480 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1353

must be a connection to transmit the the airplane, and that external power
carburetor air intake static pressure to can be electrically connected to equip-
the proper pump relief valve connec- ment other than that used for engine
tion; and starting, means must be provided to
(2) If a connection is required under ensure that no external power supply
paragraph (f)(1) of this section, the having a reverse polarity, or a reverse
gauge balance lines must be independ- phase sequence, can supply power to
ently connected to the carburetor inlet the airplanes electrical system.
pressure to avoid erroneous readings. (d) Operation without normal electrical
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as power. It must be shown by analysis,
amended by Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15044, Mar. 17, tests, or both, that the airplane can be
1977] operated safely in VFR conditions, for
a period of not less than five minutes,
ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS AND EQUIPMENT with the normal electrical power (elec-
25.1351 General. trical power sources excluding the bat-
tery) inoperative, with critical type
(a) Electrical system capacity. The re- fuel (from the standpoint of flameout
quired generating capacity, and num- and restart capability), and with the
ber and kinds of power sources must airplane initially at the maximum cer-
(1) Be determined by an electrical
tificated altitude. Parts of the elec-
load analysis; and
trical system may remain on if
(2) Meet the requirements of 25.1309.
(b) Generating system. The generating (1) A single malfunction, including a
system includes electrical power wire bundle or junction box fire, can-
sources, main power busses, trans- not result in loss of both the part
mission cables, and associated control, turned off and the part turned on; and
regulation, and protective devices. It (2) The parts turned on are elec-
must be designed so that trically and mechanically isolated
(1) Power sources function properly from the parts turned off.
when independent and when connected [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
in combination; amended by Amdt. 2541, 42 FR 36970, July 18,
(2) No failure or malfunction of any 1977; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29785, July 20, 1990]
power source can create a hazard or
impair the ability of remaining sources 25.1353 Electrical equipment and in-
to supply essential loads; stallations.
(3) The system voltage and frequency (a) Electrical equipment, controls,
(as applicable) at the terminals of all and wiring must be installed so that
essential load equipment can be main- operations of any one unit or system of
tained within the limits for which the units will not adversely affect the si-
equipment is designed, during any multaneous operation of any other
probable operating condition; and
electrical unit or system essential to
(4) System transients due to switch-
the safe operation. Any electrical in-
ing, fault clearing, or other causes do
terference likely to be present in the
not make essential loads inoperative,
airplane must not result in hazardous
and do not cause a smoke or fire haz-
effects upon the airplane or its systems
ard.
(5) There are means accessible, in except under extremely remote condi-
flight, to appropriate crewmembers for tions.
the individual and collective dis- (b) Cables must be grouped, routed,
connection of the electrical power and spaced so that damage to essential
sources from the system. circuits will be minimized if there are
(6) There are means to indicate to ap- faults in heavy current-carrying ca-
propriate crewmembers the generating bles.
system quantities essential for the safe (c) Storage batteries must be de-
operation of the system, such as the signed and installed as follows:
voltage and current supplied by each (1) Safe cell temperatures and pres-
generator. sures must be maintained during any
(c) External power. If provisions are probable charging or discharging con-
made for connecting external power to dition. No uncontrolled increase in cell

471

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00481 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1355 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

temperature may result when the bat- (2) Means of permanent identification
tery is recharged (after previous com- must be provided for electrical cables,
plete discharge) connectors and terminals.
(i) At maximum regulated voltage or (3) Electrical cables must be installed
power; such that the risk of mechanical dam-
(ii) During a flight of maximum dura- age and/or damage caused by fluids, va-
tion; and pors, or sources of heat, is minimized.
(iii) Under the most adverse cooling
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
condition likely to occur in service. amended by Amdt. 2541, 42 FR 36970, July 18,
(2) Compliance with paragraph (c)(1) 1977; Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2323, Jan. 16, 1978;
of this section must be shown by test Amdt. 25113, 69 FR 12530, Mar. 16, 2004]
unless experience with similar bat-
teries and installations has shown that 25.1355 Distribution system.
maintaining safe cell temperatures and (a) The distribution system includes
pressures presents no problem. the distribution busses, their associ-
(3) No explosive or toxic gases emit- ated feeders, and each control and pro-
ted by any battery in normal oper- tective device.
ation, or as the result of any probable (b) [Reserved]
malfunction in the charging system or
(c) If two independent sources of elec-
battery installation, may accumulate
trical power for particular equipment
in hazardous quantities within the air-
or systems are required by this chap-
plane.
ter, in the event of the failure of one
(4) No corrosive fluids or gases that
power source for such equipment or
may escape from the battery may dam-
system, another power source (includ-
age surrounding airplane structures or
ing its separate feeder) must be auto-
adjacent essential equipment.
matically provided or be manually se-
(5) Each nickel cadmium battery in-
lectable to maintain equipment or sys-
stallation must have provisions to pre-
tem operation.
vent any hazardous effect on structure
or essential systems that may be [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
caused by the maximum amount of amended by Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5679, Apr. 8,
heat the battery can generate during a 1970; Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55468, Dec. 20, 1976]
short circuit of the battery or of indi-
25.1357 Circuit protective devices.
vidual cells.
(6) Nickel cadmium battery installa- (a) Automatic protective devices
tions must have must be used to minimize distress to
(i) A system to control the charging the electrical system and hazard to the
rate of the battery automatically so as airplane in the event of wiring faults or
to prevent battery overheating; or serious malfunction of the system or
(ii) A battery temperature sensing connected equipment.
and over-temperature warning system (b) The protective and control de-
with a means for disconnecting the vices in the generating system must be
battery from its charging source in the designed to de-energize and disconnect
event of an over-temperature condi- faulty power sources and power trans-
tion; or mission equipment from their associ-
(iii) A battery failure sensing and ated busses with sufficient rapidity to
warning system with a means for dis- provide protection from hazardous
connecting the battery from its charg- over-voltage and other malfunctioning.
ing source in the event of battery fail- (c) Each resettable circuit protective
ure. device must be designed so that, when
(d) Electrical cables and cable instal- an overload or circuit fault exists, it
lations must be designed and installed will open the circuit irrespective of the
as follows: position of the operating control.
(1) The electrical cables used must be (d) If the ability to reset a circuit
compatible with the circuit protection breaker or replace a fuse is essential to
devices required by 25.1357 of this safety in flight, that circuit breaker or
part, such that a fire or smoke hazard fuse must be located and identified so
cannot be created under temporary or that it can be readily reset or replaced
continuous fault conditions. in flight.

472

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00482 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1387

(e) Each circuit for essential loads means to control the intensity of illu-
must have individual circuit protec- mination.
tion. However, individual protection [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
for each circuit in an essential load amended by Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29785, July 20,
system (such as each position light cir- 1990]
cuit in a system) is not required.
(f) If fuses are used, there must be 25.1383 Landing lights.
spare fuses for use in flight equal to at (a) Each landing light must be ap-
least 50 percent of the number of fuses proved, and must be installed so that
of each rating required for complete (1) No objectionable glare is visible
circuit protection. to the pilot;
(g) Automatic reset circuit breakers (2) The pilot is not adversely affected
by halation; and
may be used as integral protectors for
(3) It provides enough light for night
electrical equipment (such as thermal
landing.
cut-outs) if there is circuit protection (b) Except when one switch is used
to protect the cable to the equipment. for the lights of a multiple light instal-
lation at one location, there must be a
25.1363 Electrical system tests. separate switch for each light.
(a) When laboratory tests of the elec- (c) There must be a means to indicate
trical system are conducted to the pilots when the landing lights
(1) The tests must be performed on a are extended.
mock-up using the same generating
25.1385 Position light system installa-
equipment used in the airplane; tion.
(2) The equipment must simulate the
electrical characteristics of the dis- (a) General. Each part of each posi-
tion light system must meet the appli-
tribution wiring and connected loads to
cable requirements of this section and
the extent necessary for valid test re- each system as a whole must meet the
sults; and requirements of 25.1387 through
(3) Laboratory generator drives must 25.1397.
simulate the actual prime movers on (b) Forward position lights. Forward
the airplane with respect to their reac- position lights must consist of a red
tion to generator loading, including and a green light spaced laterally as
loading due to faults. far apart as practicable and installed
(b) For each flight condition that forward on the airplane so that, with
cannot be simulated adequately in the the airplane in the normal flying posi-
laboratory or by ground tests on the tion, the red light is on the left side
airplane, flight tests must be made. and the green light is on the right side.
Each light must be approved.
LIGHTS (c) Rear position light. The rear posi-
tion light must be a white light mount-
25.1381 Instrument lights. ed as far aft as practicable on the tail
(a) The instrument lights must or on each wing tip, and must be ap-
(1) Provide sufficient illumination to proved.
(d) Light covers and color filters. Each
make each instrument, switch and
light cover or color filter must be at
other device necessary for safe oper-
least flame resistant and may not
ation easily readable unless sufficient
change color or shape or lose any ap-
illumination is available from another preciable light transmission during
source; and normal use.
(2) Be installed so that
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
(i) Their direct rays are shielded from
amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55468, Dec. 20,
the pilots eyes; and 1976]
(ii) No objectionable reflections are
visible to the pilot. 25.1387 Position light system dihe-
(b) Unless undimmed instrument dral angles.
lights are satisfactory under each ex- (a) Except as provided in paragraph
pected flight condition, there must be a (e) of this section, each forward and

473

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00483 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1389 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

rear position light must, as installed, must be expressed in terms of min-


show unbroken light within the dihe- imum intensities in the horizontal
dral angles described in this section. plane, minimum intensities in any
(b) Dihedral angle L (left) is formed vertical plane, and maximum inten-
by two intersecting vertical planes, the sities in overlapping beams, within di-
first parallel to the longitudinal axis of hedral angles L, R, and A, and must
the airplane, and the other at 110 de- meet the following requirements:
grees to the left of the first, as viewed (1) Intensities in the horizontal plane.
when looking forward along the longi- Each intensity in the horizontal plane
tudinal axis. (the plane containing the longitudinal
(c) Dihedral angle R (right) is formed axis of the airplane and perpendicular
by two intersecting vertical planes, the to the plane of symmetry of the air-
first parallel to the longitudinal axis of plane) must equal or exceed the values
the airplane, and the other at 110 de- in 25.1391.
grees to the right of the first, as viewed (2) Intensities in any vertical plane.
when looking forward along the longi- Each intensity in any vertical plane
tudinal axis. (the plane perpendicular to the hori-
(d) Dihedral angle A (aft) is formed zontal plane) must equal or exceed the
by two intersecting vertical planes appropriate value in 25.1393, where I is
making angles of 70 degrees to the the minimum intensity prescribed in
right and to the left, respectively, to a 25.1391 for the corresponding angles in
vertical plane passing through the lon- the horizontal plane.
gitudinal axis, as viewed when looking (3) Intensities in overlaps between adja-
aft along the longitudinal axis. cent signals. No intensity in any over-
(e) If the rear position light, when lap between adjacent signals may ex-
mounted as far aft as practicable in ac- ceed the values given in 25.1395, except
cordance with 25.1385(c), cannot show that higher intensities in overlaps may
unbroken light within dihedral angle A be used with main beam intensities
(as defined in paragraph (d) of this sec- substantially greater than the minima
tion), a solid angle or angles of ob- specified in 25.1391 and 25.1393 if the
structed visibility totaling not more overlap intensities in relation to the
than 0.04 steradians is allowable within main beam intensities do not adversely
that dihedral angle, if such solid angle affect signal clarity. When the peak in-
is within a cone whose apex is at the tensity of the forward position lights is
rear position light and whose elements more than 100 candles, the maximum
make an angle of 30 with a vertical overlap intensities between them may
line passing through the rear position exceed the values given in 25.1395 if
light. the overlap intensity in Area A is not
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as more than 10 percent of peak position
amended by Amdt. 2530, 36 FR 21278, Nov. 5, light intensity and the overlap inten-
1971] sity in Area B is not greater than 2.5
percent of peak position light inten-
25.1389 Position light distribution sity.
and intensities.
(a) General. The intensities prescribed 25.1391 Minimum intensities in the
in this section must be provided by new horizontal plane of forward and
equipment with light covers and color rear position lights.
filters in place. Intensities must be de- Each position light intensity must
termined with the light source oper- equal or exceed the applicable values in
ating at a steady value equal to the av- the following table:
erage luminous output of the source at
the normal operating voltage of the Angle from right
or left of longitu-
airplane. The light distribution and in- Dihedral angle (light in- dinal axis, meas- Intensity
cluded) (candles)
tensity of each position light must ured from dead
ahead
meet the requirements of paragraph (b)
of this section. L and R (forward red and 0 to 10 .............. 40
(b) Forward and rear position lights. green). 10 to 20 ............ 30
20 to 110 .......... 5
The light distribution and intensities
A (rear white) ..................... 110 to 180 ........ 20
of forward and rear position lights

474

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00484 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1401

25.1393 Minimum intensities in any (c) Aviation white


vertical plane of forward and rear
x is not less than 0.300 and not greater than
position lights.
0.540;
Each position light intensity must y is not less than x0.040; or y00.010, which-
equal or exceed the applicable values in ever is the smaller; and
the following table: y is not greater than x+0.020 nor 0.6360.400x;
Where y0 is the y coordinate of the Planckian
Angle above or below the horizontal plane Intensity, l radiator for the value of x considered.
0 ......................................................................... 1.00 [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
0 to 5 ................................................................ 0.90 amended by Amdt. 2527, 36 FR 12972, July 10,
5 to 10 .............................................................. 0.80
10 to 15 ............................................................ 0.70
1971]
15 to 20 ............................................................ 0.50
20 to 30 ............................................................ 0.30 25.1399 Riding light.
30 to 40 ............................................................ 0.10
40 to 90 ............................................................ 0.05 (a) Each riding (anchor) light re-
quired for a seaplane or amphibian
must be installed so that it can
25.1395 Maximum intensities in over-
lapping beams of forward and rear (1) Show a white light for at least 2
position lights. nautical miles at night under clear at-
mospheric conditions; and
No position light intensity may ex-
(2) Show the maximum unbroken
ceed the applicable values in the fol-
light practicable when the airplane is
lowing table, except as provided in
moored or drifting on the water.
25.1389(b)(3).
(b) Externally hung lights may be
Maximum intensity used.
Overlaps Area A Area B
(candles) (candles) 25.1401 Anticollision light system.
Green in dihedral angle L ............. 10 1 (a) General. The airplane must have
Red in dihedral angle R ................ 10 1 an anticollision light system that
Green in dihedral angle A ............. 5 1
Red in dihedral angle A ................ 5 1
(1) Consists of one or more approved
Rear white in dihedral angle L ...... 5 1 anticollision lights located so that
Rear white in dihedral angle R ..... 5 1 their light will not impair the crews
vision or detract from the conspicuity
Where of the position lights; and
(a) Area A includes all directions in (2) Meets the requirements of para-
the adjacent dihedral angle that pass graphs (b) through (f) of this section.
through the light source and intersect (b) Field of coverage. The system must
the common boundary plane at more consist of enough lights to illuminate
than 10 degrees but less than 20 de- the vital areas around the airplane
grees; and considering the physical configuration
(b) Area B includes all directions in and flight characteristics of the air-
the adjacent dihedral angle that pass plane. The field of coverage must ex-
through the light source and intersect tend in each direction within at least
the common boundary plane at more 75 degrees above and 75 degrees below
than 20 degrees. the horizontal plane of the airplane,
except that a solid angle or angles of
25.1397 Color specifications. obstructed visibility totaling not more
Each position light color must have than 0.03 steradians is allowable within
the applicable International Commis- a solid angle equal to 0.15 steradians
sion on Illumination chromaticity co- centered about the longitudinal axis in
ordinates as follows: the rearward direction.
(a) Aviation red (c) Flashing characteristics. The ar-
y is not greater than 0.335; and
rangement of the system, that is, the
z is not greater than 0.002. number of light sources, beam width,
speed of rotation, and other character-
(b) Aviation green istics, must give an effective flash fre-
x is not greater than 0.4400.320y ; quency of not less than 40, nor more
x is not greater than y0.170; and than 100 cycles per minute. The effec-
y is not less than 0.3900.170x. tive flash frequency is the frequency at

475

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00485 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1403 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

which the airplanes complete anti- formation of ice on the parts of the
collision light system is observed from wings that are critical from the stand-
a distance, and applies to each sector point of ice accumulation. Any illu-
of light including any overlaps that mination that is used must be of a type
exist when the system consists of more that will not cause glare or reflection
than one light source. In overlaps, that would handicap crewmembers in
flash frequencies may exceed 100, but the performance of their duties.
not 180 cycles per minute. [Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55468, Dec. 20, 1976]
(d) Color. Each anticollision light
must be either aviation red or aviation SAFETY EQUIPMENT
white and must meet the applicable re-
quirements of 25.1397. 25.1411 General.
(e) Light intensity. The minimum (a) Accessibility. Required safety
light intensities in all vertical planes, equipment to be used by the crew in an
measured with the red filter (if used) emergency must be readily accessible.
and expressed in terms of effective (b) Stowage provisions. Stowage provi-
intensities, must meet the require- sions for required emergency equip-
ments of paragraph (f) of this section. ment must be furnished and must
The following relation must be as- (1) Be arranged so that the equip-
sumed: ment is directly accessible and its loca-
t2
tion is obvious; and
t I(t)dt (2) Protect the safety equipment
from inadvertent damage.
Ie = 1
0.2 + t 2 t 1 ( ) (c) Emergency exit descent device. The
stowage provisions for the emergency
where: exit descent devices required by
Ie=effective intensity (candles). 25.810(a) must be at each exit for
I(t)=instantaneous intensity as a function of which they are intended.
time. (d) Liferafts. (1) The stowage provi-
t2t1=flash time interval (seconds). sions for the liferafts described in
Normally, the maximum value of effec- 25.1415 must accommodate enough
tive intensity is obtained when t2 and t1 rafts for the maximum number of occu-
are chosen so that the effective inten- pants for which certification for ditch-
sity is equal to the instantaneous in- ing is requested.
tensity at t2 and t1. (2) Liferafts must be stowed near
(f) Minimum effective intensities for exits through which the rafts can be
anticollision lights. Each anticollision launched during an unplanned ditch-
light effective intensity must equal or ing.
exceed the applicable values in the fol- (3) Rafts automatically or remotely
lowing table. released outside the airplane must be
attached to the airplane by means of
Effective the static line prescribed in 25.1415.
Angle above or below the horizontal plane intensity
(candles) (4) The stowage provisions for each
portable liferaft must allow rapid de-
0 to 5 ................................................................ 400 tachment and removal of the raft for
5 to 10 .............................................................. 240
10 to 20 ............................................................ 80 use at other than the intended exits.
20 to 30 ............................................................ 40 (e) Long-range signaling device. The
30 to 75 ............................................................ 20 stowage provisions for the long-range
signaling device required by 25.1415
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as must be near an exit available during
amended by Amdt. 2527, 36 FR 12972, July 10, an unplanned ditching.
1971; Amdt. 2541, 42 FR 36970, July 18, 1977] (f) Life preserver stowage provisions.
The stowage provisions for life pre-
25.1403 Wing icing detection lights. servers described in 25.1415 must ac-
Unless operations at night in known commodate one life preserver for each
or forecast icing conditions are prohib- occupant for which certification for
ited by an operating limitation, a ditching is requested. Each life pre-
means must be provided for illu- server must be within easy reach of
minating or otherwise determining the each seated occupant.

476
EC28SE91.049</MATH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00486 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1421

(g) Life line stowage provisions. If cer- 25.1419 Ice protection.


tification for ditching under 25.801 is If certification with ice protection
requested, there must be provisions to provisions is desired, the airplane must
store life lines. These provisions be able to safely operate in the contin-
must uous maximum and intermittent max-
(1) Allow one life line to be attached imum icing conditions of appendix C.
to each side of the fuselage; and To establish that the airplane can op-
(2) Be arranged to allow the life lines erate within the continuous maximum
to be used to enable the occupants to and intermittent maximum conditions
stay on the wing after ditching. of appendix C:
(a) An analysis must be performed to
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as establish that the ice protection for
amended by Amdt. 2532, 37 FR 3972, Feb. 24, the various components of the airplane
1972; Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50598, Oct. 30, 1978; is adequate, taking into account the
Amdt. 2553, 45 FR 41593, June 19, 1980; Amdt.
various airplane operational configura-
2570, 54 FR 43925, Oct. 27, 1989; Amdt. 2579,
58 FR 45229, Aug. 26, 1993; Amdt. 25116, 69 FR
tions; and
62789, Oct. 27, 2004] (b) To verify the ice protection anal-
ysis, to check for icing anomalies, and
25.1415 Ditching equipment. to demonstrate that the ice protection
system and its components are effec-
(a) Ditching equipment used in air- tive, the airplane or its components
planes to be certificated for ditching must be flight tested in the various
under 25.801, and required by the oper- operational configurations, in meas-
ating rules of this chapter, must meet ured natural atmospheric icing condi-
the requirements of this section. tions and, as found necessary, by one
(b) Each liferaft and each life pre- or more of the following means:
server must be approved. In addition (1) Laboratory dry air or simulated
(1) Unless excess rafts of enough ca- icing tests, or a combination of both, of
pacity are provided, the buoyancy and the components or models of the com-
seating capacity beyond the rated ca- ponents.
pacity of the rafts must accommodate (2) Flight dry air tests of the ice pro-
all occupants of the airplane in the tection system as a whole, or of its in-
event of a loss of one raft of the largest dividual components.
rated capacity; and (3) Flight tests of the airplane or its
components in measured simulated
(2) Each raft must have a trailing
icing conditions.
line, and must have a static line de- (c) Caution information, such as an
signed to hold the raft near the air- amber caution light or equivalent,
plane but to release it if the airplane must be provided to alert the
becomes totally submerged. flightcrew when the anti-ice or de-ice
(c) Approved survival equipment system is not functioning normally.
must be attached to each liferaft. (d) For turbine engine powered air-
(d) There must be an approved sur- planes, the ice protection provisions of
vival type emergency locator trans- this section are considered to be appli-
mitter for use in one life raft. cable primarily to the airframe. For
(e) For airplanes not certificated for the powerplant installation, certain ad-
ditching under 25.801 and not having ditional provisions of subpart E of this
approved life preservers, there must be part may be found applicable.
an approved flotation means for each [Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29785, July 20, 1990]
occupant. This means must be within
easy reach of each seated occupant and 25.1421 Megaphones.
must be readily removable from the If a megaphone is installed, a re-
airplane. straining means must be provided that
is capable of restraining the mega-
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2529, 36 FR 18722, Sept.
phone when it is subjected to the ulti-
21, 1971; Amdt 2550, 45 FR 38348, June 9, 1980; mate inertia forces specified in
Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29785, July 20, 1990; Amdt. 25.561(b)(3).
2582, 59 FR 32057, June 21, 1994] [Amdt. 2541, 42 FR 36970, July 18, 1977]

477

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00487 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1423 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

25.1423 Public address system. their installations, critical environ-


A public address system required by mental conditions must be considered.
this chapter must (b) Radio and electronic equipment
(a) Be powerable when the aircraft is must be supplied with power under the
in flight or stopped on the ground, requirements of 25.1355(c).
after the shutdown or failure of all en- (c) Radio and electronic equipment,
gines and auxiliary power units, or the controls, and wiring must be installed
disconnection or failure of all power so that operation of any one unit or
sources dependent on their continued system of units will not adversely af-
operation, for fect the simultaneous operation of any
(1) A time duration of at least 10 min- other radio or electronic unit, or sys-
utes, including an aggregate time dura- tem of units, required by this chapter.
tion of at least 5 minutes of announce- (d) Electronic equipment must be de-
ments made by flight and cabin crew- signed and installed such that it does
members, considering all other loads not cause essential loads to become in-
which may remain powered by the operative as a result of electrical
same source when all other power power supply transients or transients
sources are inoperative; and from other causes.
(2) An additional time duration in its [Docket No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
standby state appropriate or required amended by Amdt. 25113, 69 FR 12530, Mar.
for any other loads that are powered by 16, 2004]
the same source and that are essential
to safety of flight or required during 25.1433 Vacuum systems.
emergency conditions.
There must be means, in addition to
(b) Be capable of operation within 3
the normal pressure relief, to auto-
seconds from the time a microphone is
matically relieve the pressure in the
removed from its stowage.
discharge lines from the vacuum air
(c) Be intelligible at all passenger
pump when the delivery temperature of
seats, lavatories, and flight attendant
the air becomes unsafe.
seats and work stations.
(d) Be designed so that no unused, [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
unstowed microphone will render the amended by Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29785, July 20,
system inoperative. 1990]
(e) Be capable of functioning inde-
pendently of any required crewmember 25.1435 Hydraulic systems.
interphone system. (a) Element design. Each element of
(f) Be accessible for immediate use the hydraulic system must be designed
from each of two flight crewmember to:
stations in the pilot compartment. (1) Withstand the proof pressure
(g) For each required floor-level pas- without permanent deformation that
senger emergency exit which has an ad- would prevent it from performing its
jacent flight attendant seat, have a intended functions, and the ultimate
microphone which is readily accessible pressure without rupture. The proof
to the seated flight attendant, except and ultimate pressures are defined in
that one microphone may serve more terms of the design operating pressure
than one exit, provided the proximity (DOP) as follows:
of the exits allows unassisted verbal
communication between seated flight Proof Ultimate
Element (xDOP) (xDOP)
attendants.
1. Tubes and fittings. ......................... 1.5 3.0
[Doc. No. 26003, 58 FR 45229, Aug. 26, 1993, as 2. Pressure vessels containing gas:
amended by Amdt. 25115, 69 FR 40527, July 2, High pressure (e.g., accumulators) 3.0 4.0
2004] Low pressure (e.g., reservoirs) ...... 1.5 3.0
3. Hoses ............................................ 2.0 4.0
MISCELLANEOUS EQUIPMENT 4. All other elements ......................... 1.5 2.0

25.1431 Electronic equipment. (2) Withstand, without deformation


(a) In showing compliance with that would prevent it from performing
25.1309 (a) and (b) with respect to its intended function, the design oper-
radio and electronic equipment and ating pressure in combination with

478

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00488 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1439

limit structural loads that may be im- fects, and to assure reliable system and
posed; element functioning and integration.
(3) Withstand, without rupture, the Failure or unacceptable deficiency of
design operating pressure multiplied by an element or system must be cor-
a factor of 1.5 in combination with ulti- rected and be sufficiently retested,
mate structural load that can reason- where necessary.
ably occur simultaneously; (1) The system(s), subsystem(s), or
(4) Withstand the fatigue effects of element(s) must be subjected to per-
all cyclic pressures, including tran- formance, fatigue, and endurance tests
sients, and associated externally in- representative of airplane ground and
duced loads, taking into account the flight operations.
consequences of element failure; and (2) The complete system must be
(5) Perform as intended under all en- tested to determine proper functional
vironmental conditions for which the performance and relation to the other
airplane is certificated. systems, including simulation of rel-
(b) System design. Each hydraulic sys- evant failure conditions, and to sup-
tem must: port or validate element design.
(1) Have means located at a (3) The complete hydraulic system(s)
flightcrew station to indicate appro- must be functionally tested on the air-
priate system parameters, if plane in normal operation over the
(i) It performs a function necessary range of motion of all associated user
for continued safe flight and landing; systems. The test must be conducted at
or the system relief pressure or 1.25 times
(ii) In the event of hydraulic system the DOP if a system pressure relief de-
malfunction, corrective action by the vice is not part of the system design.
crew to ensure continued safe flight Clearances between hydraulic system
and landing is necessary; elements and other systems or struc-
(2) Have means to ensure that system tural elements must remain adequate
pressures, including transient pres- and there must be no detrimental ef-
sures and pressures from fluid volu- fects.
metric changes in elements that are
[Doc. No. 28617, 66 FR 27402, May 16, 2001]
likely to remain closed long enough for
such changes to occur, are within the 25.1438 Pressurization and pneu-
design capabilities of each element, matic systems.
such that they meet the requirements
(a) Pressurization system elements
defined in 25.1435(a)(1) through (a)(5);
must be burst pressure tested to 2.0
(3) Have means to minimize the re-
times, and proof pressure tested to 1.5
lease of harmful or hazardous con-
times, the maximum normal operating
centrations of hydraulic fluid or vapors
pressure.
into the crew and passenger compart-
(b) Pneumatic system elements must
ments during flight;
be burst pressure tested to 3.0 times,
(4) Meet the applicable requirements
and proof pressure tested to 1.5 times,
of 25.863, 25.1183, 25.1185, and 25.1189 if
the maximum normal operating pres-
a flammable hydraulic fluid is used;
sure.
and
(c) An analysis, or a combination of
(5) Be designed to use any suitable
analysis and test, may be substituted
hydraulic fluid specified by the air-
for any test required by paragraph (a)
plane manufacturer, which must be
or (b) of this section if the Adminis-
identified by appropriate markings as
trator finds it equivalent to the re-
required by 25.1541.
quired test.
(c) Tests. Tests must be conducted on
the hydraulic system(s), and/or sub- [Amdt. 2541, 42 FR 36971, July 18, 1977]
system(s) and elements, except that
analysis may be used in place of or to 25.1439 Protective breathing equip-
supplement testing, where the analysis ment.
is shown to be reliable and appropriate. (a) Fixed (stationary, or built in) pro-
All internal and external influences tective breathing equipment must be
must be taken into account to an ex- installed for the use of the flightcrew,
tent necessary to evaluate their ef- and at least one portable protective

479

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00489 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1441 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

breathing equipment shall be located rate of 60 liters per minute at 8,000 feet
at or near the flight deck for use by a (45 liters per minute at sea level) and a
flight crewmember. In addition, port- supply of 600 liters of free oxygen at 70
able protective breathing equipment F. and 760 mm. Hg. pressure is consid-
must be installed for the use of appro- ered to be of 15-minute duration at the
priate crewmembers for fighting fires prescribed altitude and minute volume.
in compartments accessible in flight Continuous flow systems must not in-
other than the flight deck. This in- crease the ambient oxygen content of
cludes isolated compartments and the local atmosphere above that of de-
upper and lower lobe galleys, in which mand systems. BTPD refers to body
crewmember occupancy is permitted temperature conditions (that is, 37 C.,
during flight. Equipment must be in- at ambient pressure, dry).
stalled for the maximum number of (6) The equipment must meet the re-
crewmembers expected to be in the quirements of 25.1441.
area during any operation. [Doc. No. FAA200213859, 69 FR 40528, July 2,
(b) For protective breathing equip- 2004]
ment required by paragraph (a) of this
section or by the applicable Operating 25.1441 Oxygen equipment and sup-
Regulations: ply.
(1) The equipment must be designed (a) If certification with supplemental
to protect the appropriate crewmember oxygen equipment is requested, the
from smoke, carbon dioxide, and other equipment must meet the requirements
harmful gases while on flight deck of this section and 25.1443 through
duty or while combating fires. 25.1453.
(2) The equipment must include (b) The oxygen system must be free
(i) Masks covering the eyes, nose and from hazards in itself, in its method of
mouth, or operation, and in its effect upon other
(ii) Masks covering the nose and components.
mouth, plus accessory equipment to (c) There must be a means to allow
cover the eyes. the crew to readily determine, during
(3) Equipment, including portable flight, the quantity of oxygen available
equipment, must allow communication in each source of supply.
with other crewmembers while in use. (d) The oxygen flow rate and the oxy-
Equipment available at flightcrew as- gen equipment for airplanes for which
signed duty stations must also enable certification for operation above 40,000
the flightcrew to use radio equipment. feet is requested must be approved.
(4) The part of the equipment pro-
tecting the eyes shall not cause any ap- 25.1443 Minimum mass flow of sup-
preciable adverse effect on vision and plemental oxygen.
must allow corrective glasses to be (a) If continuous flow equipment is
worn. installed for use by flight crew-
(5) The equipment must supply pro- members, the minimum mass flow of
tective oxygen of 15 minutes duration supplemental oxygen required for each
per crewmember at a pressure altitude crewmember may not be less than the
of 8,000 feet with a respiratory minute flow required to maintain, during in-
volume of 30 liters per minute BTPD. spiration, a mean tracheal oxygen par-
The equipment and system must be de- tial pressure of 149 mm. Hg. when
signed to prevent any inward leakage breathing 15 liters per minute, BTPS,
to the inside of the device and prevent and with a maximum tidal volume of
any outward leakage causing signifi- 700 cc. with a constant time interval
cant increase in the oxygen content of between respirations.
the local ambient atmosphere. If a de- (b) If demand equipment is installed
mand oxygen system is used, a supply for use by flight crewmembers, the
of 300 liters of free oxygen at 70 F. and minimum mass flow of supplemental
760 mm. Hg. pressure is considered to oxygen required for each crewmember
be of 15-minute duration at the pre- may not be less than the flow required
scribed altitude and minute volume. If to maintain, during inspiration, a
a continuous flow open circuit protec- mean tracheal oxygen partial pressure
tive breathing system is used, a flow of 122 mm. Hg., up to and including a

480

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00490 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1447

cabin pressure altitude of 35,000 feet, the passengers and other crewmembers;
and 95 percent oxygen between cabin or
pressure altitudes of 35,000 and 40,000 (2) A common source of supply with
feet, when breathing 20 liters per means to separately reserve the min-
minute BTPS. In addition, there must imum supply required by the flight
be means to allow the crew to use undi- crew on duty.
luted oxygen at their discretion. (b) Portable walk-around oxygen
(c) For passengers and cabin attend- units of the continuous flow, diluter-
ants, the minimum mass flow of sup- demand, and straight demand kinds
plemental oxygen required for each may be used to meet the crew or pas-
person at various cabin pressure alti- senger breathing requirements.
tudes may not be less than the flow re-
quired to maintain, during inspiration 25.1447 Equipment standards for ox-
ygen dispensing units.
and while using the oxygen equipment
(including masks) provided, the fol- If oxygen dispensing units are in-
lowing mean tracheal oxygen partial stalled, the following apply:
pressures: (a) There must be an individual dis-
(1) At cabin pressure altitudes above pensing unit for each occupant for
10,000 feet up to and including 18,500 whom supplemental oxygen is to be
feet, a mean tracheal oxygen partial supplied. Units must be designed to
pressure of 100 mm. Hg. when breathing cover the nose and mouth and must be
15 liters per minute, BTPS, and with a equipped with a suitable means to re-
tidal volume of 700 cc. with a constant tain the unit in position on the face.
time interval between respirations. Flight crew masks for supplemental
oxygen must have provisions for the
(2) At cabin pressure altitudes above
use of communication equipment.
18,500 feet up to and including 40,000
(b) If certification for operation up to
feet, a mean tracheal oxygen partial
and including 25,000 feet is requested,
pressure of 83.8 mm. Hg. when breath-
an oxygen supply terminal and unit of
ing 30 liters per minute, BTPS, and
oxygen dispensing equipment for the
with a tidal volume of 1,100 cc. with a
immediate use of oxygen by each crew-
constant time interval between res-
member must be within easy reach of
pirations.
that crewmember. For any other occu-
(d) If first-aid oxygen equipment is pants, the supply terminals and dis-
installed, the minimum mass flow of pensing equipment must be located to
oxygen to each user may not be less allow the use of oxygen as required by
than four liters per minute, STPD. the operating rules in this chapter.
However, there may be a means to de- (c) If certification for operation
crease this flow to not less than two li- above 25,000 feet is requested, there
ters per minute, STPD, at any cabin al- must be oxygen dispensing equipment
titude. The quantity of oxygen re- meeting the following requirements:
quired is based upon an average flow (1) There must be an oxygen dis-
rate of three liters per minute per per- pensing unit connected to oxygen sup-
son for whom first-aid oxygen is re- ply terminals immediately available to
quired. each occupant, wherever seated, and at
(e) If portable oxygen equipment is least two oxygen dispensing units con-
installed for use by crewmembers, the nected to oxygen terminals in each lav-
minimum mass flow of supplemental atory. The total number of dispensing
oxygen is the same as specified in para- units and outlets in the cabin must ex-
graph (a) or (b) of this section, which- ceed the number of seats by at least 10
ever is applicable. percent. The extra units must be as
uniformly distributed throughout the
25.1445 Equipment standards for the cabin as practicable. If certification for
oxygen distributing system.
operation above 30,000 feet is requested,
(a) When oxygen is supplied to both the dispensing units providing the re-
crew and passengers, the distribution quired oxygen flow must be automati-
system must be designed for either cally presented to the occupants before
(1) A source of supply for the flight the cabin pressure altitude exceeds
crew on duty and a separate source for 15,000 feet. The crew must be provided

481

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00491 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1449 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

with a manual means of making the 25.1450 Chemical oxygen generators.


dispensing units immediately available
(a) For the purpose of this section, a
in the event of failure of the automatic
chemical oxygen generator is defined
system.
(2) Each flight crewmember on flight as a device which produces oxygen by
deck duty must be provided with a chemical reaction.
quick-donning type oxygen dispensing (b) Each chemical oxygen generator
unit connected to an oxygen supply must be designed and installed in ac-
terminal. This dispensing unit must be cordance with the following require-
immediately available to the flight ments:
crewmember when seated at his sta- (1) Surface temperature developed by
tion, and installed so that it: the generator during operation may
(i) Can be placed on the face from its not create a hazard to the airplane or
ready position, properly secured, to its occupants.
sealed, and supplying oxygen upon de- (2) Means must be provided to relieve
mand, with one hand, within five sec- any internal pressure that may be haz-
onds and without disturbing eyeglasses ardous.
or causing delay in proceeding with (c) In addition to meeting the re-
emergency duties; and quirements in paragraph (b) of this sec-
(ii) Allows, while in place, the per- tion, each portable chemical oxygen
formance of normal communication generator that is capable of sustained
functions. operation by successive replacement of
(3) The oxygen dispensing equipment a generator element must be placarded
for the flight crewmembers must be: to show
(i) The diluter demand or pressure de- (1) The rate of oxygen flow, in liters
mand (pressure demand mask with a per minute;
diluter demand pressure breathing reg- (2) The duration of oxygen flow, in
ulator) type, or other approved oxygen minutes, for the replaceable generator
equipment shown to provide the same element; and
degree of protection, for airplanes to be (3) A warning that the replaceable
operated above 25,000 feet.
generator element may be hot, unless
(ii) The pressure demand (pressure
the element construction is such that
demand mask with a diluter demand
the surface temperature cannot exceed
pressure breathing regulator) type with
100 degrees F.
mask-mounted regulator, or other ap-
proved oxygen equipment shown to [Amdt. 2541, 42 FR 36971, July 18, 1977]
provide the same degree of protection,
for airplanes operated at altitudes 25.1453 Protection of oxygen equip-
where decompressions that are not ex- ment from rupture.
tremely improbable may expose the Oxygen pressure tanks, and lines be-
flightcrew to cabin pressure altitudes tween tanks and the shutoff means,
in excess of 34,000 feet. must be
(4) Portable oxygen equipment must (a) Protected from unsafe tempera-
be immediately available for each tures; and
cabin attendant. The portable oxygen (b) Located where the probability and
equipment must have the oxygen dis- hazards of rupture in a crash landing
pensing unit connected to the portable are minimized.
oxygen supply.
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as 25.1455 Draining of fluids subject to
amended by Amdt. 2541, 42 FR 36971, July 18, freezing.
1977; Amdt. 2587, 61 FR 28696, June 5, 1996; If fluids subject to freezing may be
Amdt. 25116, 69 FR 62789, Oct. 27, 2004]
drained overboard in flight or during
25.1449 Means for determining use of ground operation, the drains must be
oxygen. designed and located to prevent the
formation of hazardous quantities of
There must be a means to allow the
ice on the airplane as a result of the
crew to determine whether oxygen is
drainage.
being delivered to the dispensing equip-
ment. [Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5680, Apr. 8, 1970]

482

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00492 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1457

25.1457 Cockpit voice recorders. (3) For the third channelfrom the
(a) Each cockpit voice recorder re- cockpit-mounted area microphone.
quired by the operating rules of this (4) For the fourth channel, from
chapter must be approved and must be (i) Each boom, mask, or hand-held
installed so that it will record the fol- microphone, headset, or speaker used
lowing: at the station for the third and fourth
(1) Voice communications trans- crew members; or
mitted from or received in the airplane (ii) If the stations specified in para-
by radio. graph (c)(4)(i) of this section are not re-
(2) Voice communications of flight quired or if the signal at such a station
crewmembers on the flight deck. is picked up by another channel, each
(3) Voice communications of flight microphone on the flight deck that is
crewmembers on the flight deck, using used with the passenger loudspeaker
the airplanes interphone system.
system, if its signals are not picked up
(4) Voice or audio signals identifying
by another channel.
navigation or approach aids introduced
into a headset or speaker. (5) As far as is practicable all sounds
(5) Voice communications of flight received by the microphone listed in
crewmembers using the passenger loud- paragraphs (c)(1), (2), and (4) of this
speaker system, if there is such a sys- section must be recorded without
tem and if the fourth channel is avail- interruption irrespective of the posi-
able in accordance with the require- tion of the interphone-transmitter key
ments of paragraph (c)(4)(ii) of this sec- switch. The design shall ensure that
tion. sidetone for the flight crew is produced
(b) The recording requirements of only when the interphone, public ad-
paragraph (a)(2) of this section must be dress system, or radio transmitters are
met by installing a cockpit-mounted in use.
area microphone, located in the best (d) Each cockpit voice recorder must
position for recording voice commu- be installed so that
nications originating at the first and
(1) It receives its electric power from
second pilot stations and voice commu-
the bus that provides the maximum re-
nications of other crewmembers on the
liability for operation of the cockpit
flight deck when directed to those sta-
tions. The microphone must be so lo- voice recorder without jeopardizing
cated and, if necessary, the pre- service to essential or emergency
amplifiers and filters of the recorder loads;
must be so adjusted or supplemented, (2) There is an automatic means to
that the intelligibility of the recorded simultaneously stop the recorder and
communications is as high as prac- prevent each erasure feature from func-
ticable when recorded under flight tioning, within 10 minutes after crash
cockpit noise conditions and played impact; and
back. Repeated aural or visual play- (3) There is an aural or visual means
back of the record may be used in eval- for preflight checking of the recorder
uating intelligibility. for proper operation.
(c) Each cockpit voice recorder must (e) The record container must be lo-
be installed so that the part of the cated and mounted to minimize the
communication or audio signals speci- probability of rupture of the container
fied in paragraph (a) of this section ob- as a result of crash impact and con-
tained from each of the following sequent heat damage to the record
sources is recorded on a separate chan- from fire. In meeting this requirement,
nel:
the record container must be as far aft
(1) For the first channel, from each
as practicable, but may not be where
boom, mask, or hand-held microphone,
headset, or speaker used at the first aft mounted engines may crush the
pilot station. container during impact. However, it
(2) For the second channel from each need not be outside of the pressurized
boom, mask, or hand-held microphone, compartment.
headset, or speaker used at the second (f) If the cockpit voice recorder has a
pilot station. bulk erasure device, the installation

483

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00493 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1459 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

must be designed to minimize the prob- transmission either to or from ATC can
ability of inadvertent operation and ac- be determined.
tuation of the device during crash im- (b) Each nonejectable record con-
pact. tainer must be located and mounted so
(g) Each recorder container must as to minimize the probability of con-
(1) Be either bright orange or bright tainer rupture resulting from crash im-
yellow; pact and subsequent damage to the
(2) Have reflective tape affixed to its record from fire. In meeting this re-
external surface to facilitate its loca- quirement the record container must
tion under water; and be located as far aft as practicable, but
(3) Have an underwater locating de- need not be aft of the pressurized com-
vice, when required by the operating partment, and may not be where aft-
rules of this chapter, on or adjacent to mounted engines may crush the con-
the container which is secured in such tainer upon impact.
manner that they are not likely to be
(c) A correlation must be established
separated during crash impact.
between the flight recorder readings of
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as airspeed, altitude, and heading and the
amended by Amdt. 252, 30 FR 3932, Mar. 26, corresponding readings (taking into ac-
1965; Amdt. 2516, 32 FR 13914, Oct. 6, 1967;
count correction factors) of the first pi-
Amdt. 2541, 42 FR 36971, July 18, 1977; Amdt.
2565, 53 FR 26143, July 11, 1988] lots instruments. The correlation
must cover the airspeed range over
25.1459 Flight recorders. which the airplane is to be operated,
(a) Each flight recorder required by the range of altitude to which the air-
the operating rules of this chapter plane is limited, and 360 degrees of
must be installed so that heading. Correlation may be estab-
(1) It is supplied with airspeed, alti- lished on the ground as appropriate.
tude, and directional data obtained (d) Each recorder container must
from sources that meet the accuracy (1) Be either bright orange or bright
requirements of 25.1323, 25.1325, and yellow;
25.1327, as appropriate; (2) Have reflective tape affixed to its
(2) The vertical acceleration sensor is external surface to facilitate its loca-
rigidly attached, and located longitu- tion under water; and
dinally either within the approved cen- (3) Have an underwater locating de-
ter of gravity limits of the airplane, or vice, when required by the operating
at a distance forward or aft of these rules of this chapter, on or adjacent to
limits that does not exceed 25 percent the container which is secured in such
of the airplanes mean aerodynamic a manner that they are not likely to be
chord; separated during crash impact.
(3) It receives its electrical power (e) Any novel or unique design or
from the bus that provides the max- operational characteristics of the air-
imum reliability for operation of the craft shall be evaluated to determine if
flight recorder without jeopardizing any dedicated parameters must be re-
service to essential or emergency corded on flight recorders in addition
loads;
to or in place of existing requirements.
(4) There is an aural or visual means
for preflight checking of the recorder [Amdt. 258, 31 FR 127, Jan. 6, 1966, as amend-
for proper recording of data in the stor- ed by Amdt. 2525, 35 FR 13192, Aug. 19, 1970;
age medium. Amdt. 2537, 40 FR 2577, Jan. 14, 1975; Amdt.
(5) Except for recorders powered sole- 2541, 42 FR 36971, July 18, 1977; Amdt. 2565,
ly by the engine-driven electrical gen- 53 FR 26144, July 11, 1988]
erator system, there is an automatic
25.1461 Equipment containing high
means to simultaneously stop a re- energy rotors.
corder that has a data erasure feature
and prevent each erasure feature from (a) Equipment containing high en-
functioning, within 10 minutes after ergy rotors must meet paragraph (b),
crash impact; and (c), or (d) of this section.
(6) There is a means to record data (b) High energy rotors contained in
from which the time of each radio equipment must be able to withstand

484

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00494 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1515

damage caused by malfunctions, vibra- flight (climb, cruise, or descent), unless


tion, abnormal speeds, and abnormal a higher speed is authorized for flight
temperatures. In addition test or pilot training operations. VMO/
(1) Auxiliary rotor cases must be able MMO must be established so that it is
to contain damage caused by the fail- not greater than the design cruising
ure of high energy rotor blades; and speed VC and so that it is sufficiently
(2) Equipment control devices, sys- below VD/MD or VDF/MDF, to make it
tems, and instrumentation must rea- highly improbable that the latter
sonably ensure that no operating limi- speeds will be inadvertently exceeded
tations affecting the integrity of high in operations. The speed margin be-
energy rotors will be exceeded in serv- tween VMO/MMO and VD/MD or VDFM/DF
ice. may not be less than that determined
(c) It must be shown by test that under 25.335(b) or found necessary dur-
equipment containing high energy ro- ing the flight tests conducted under
tors can contain any failure of a high 25.253.
energy rotor that occurs at the highest
speed obtainable with the normal speed [Amdt. 2523, 35 FR 5680, Apr. 8, 1970]
control devices inoperative.
(d) Equipment containing high en- 25.1507 Maneuvering speed.
ergy rotors must be located where The maneuvering speed must be es-
rotor failure will neither endanger the tablished so that it does not exceed the
occupants nor adversely affect contin- design maneuvering speed VA deter-
ued safe flight. mined under 25.335(c).
[Amdt. 2541, 42 FR 36971, July 18, 1977]
25.1511 Flap extended speed.
Subpart GOperating Limitations The established flap extended speed
and Information VFE must be established so that it does
not exceed the design flap speed VF
25.1501 General. chosen under 25.335(e) and 25.345, for
(a) Each operating limitation speci- the corresponding flap positions and
fied in 25.1503 through 25.1533 and engine powers.
other limitations and information nec-
essary for safe operation must be es- 25.1513 Minimum control speed.
tablished. The minimum control speed VMC de-
(b) The operating limitations and termined under 25.149 must be estab-
other information necessary for safe lished as an operating limitation.
operation must be made available to
the crewmembers as prescribed in 25.1515 Landing gear speeds.
25.1541 through 25.1587.
(a) The established landing gear oper-
[Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2323, Jan. 16, 1978] ating speed or speeds, VLO, may not ex-
ceed the speed at which it is safe both
OPERATING LIMITATIONS to extend and to retract the landing
25.1503 Airspeed limitations: general. gear, as determined under 25.729 or by
flight characteristics. If the extension
When airspeed limitations are a func- speed is not the same as the retraction
tion of weight, weight distribution, al- speed, the two speeds must be des-
titude, or Mach number, limitations ignated as VLO(EXT) and VLO(RET), re-
corresponding to each critical com- spectively.
bination of these factors must be estab-
(b) The established landing gear ex-
lished.
tended speed VLE may not exceed the
25.1505 Maximum operating limit speed at which it is safe to fly with the
speed. landing gear secured in the fully ex-
The maximum operating limit speed tended position, and that determined
(VMO/MMO airspeed or Mach Number, under 25.729.
whichever is critical at a particular al- [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
titude) is a speed that may not be de- amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55468, Dec. 20,
liberately exceeded in any regime of 1976]

485

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00495 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1516 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

25.1516 Other speed limitations. (3) Cylinder head and oil tempera-
Any other limitation associated with tures.
speed must be established. (4) Any other parameter for which a
limitation has been established as part
[Doc. No. 20008511, 66 FR 34024, June 26, 2001] of the engine type certificate except
25.1517 Rough air speed, VRA. that a limitation need not be estab-
lished for a parameter that cannot be
A rough air speed, VRA, for use as the exceeded during normal operation due
recommended turbulence penetration to the design of the installation or to
airspeed in 25.1585(a)(8), must be es- another established limitation.
tablished, which
(c) Turbine engine installations. Oper-
(1) Is not greater than the design air-
ating limitations relating to the fol-
speed for maximum gust intensity, se-
lected for VB; and lowing must be established for turbine
(2) Is not less than the minimum engine installations:
value of VB specified in 25.335(d); and (1) Horsepower, torque or thrust,
(3) Is sufficiently less than VMO to en- r.p.m., gas temperature, and time for
sure that likely speed variation during (i) Maximum continuous power or
rough air encounters will not cause the thrust (relating to augmented or un-
overspeed warning to operate too fre- augmented operation as applicable).
quently. In the absence of a rational (ii) Takeoff power or thrust (relating
investigation substantiating the use of to augmented or unaugmented oper-
other values, VRA must be less than ation as applicable).
VMO35 knots (TAS). (2) Fuel designation or specification.
[Doc. No. 27902, 61 FR 5222, Feb. 9, 1996] (3) Any other parameter for which a
limitation has been established as part
25.1519 Weight, center of gravity, and of the engine type certificate except
weight distribution. that a limitation need not be estab-
The airplane weight, center of grav- lished for a parameter that cannot be
ity, and weight distribution limita- exceeded during normal operation due
tions determined under 25.23 through to the design of the installation or to
25.27 must be established as operating another established limitation.
limitations. (d) Ambient temperature. An ambient
temperature limitation (including lim-
25.1521 Powerplant limitations. itations for winterization installations,
(a) General. The powerplant limita- if applicable) must be established as
tions prescribed in this section must be the maximum ambient atmospheric
established so that they do not exceed temperature established in accordance
the corresponding limits for which the with 25.1043(b).
engines or propellers are type certifi-
cated and do not exceed the values on [Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29786, July 20, 1990]
which compliance with any other re-
quirement of this part is based. 25.1522 Auxiliary power unit limita-
tions.
(b) Reciprocating engine installations.
Operating limitations relating to the If an auxiliary power unit is installed
following must be established for recip- in the airplane, limitations established
rocating engine installations: for the auxiliary power unit, including
(1) Horsepower or torque, r.p.m., categories of operation, must be speci-
manifold pressure, and time at critical fied as operating limitations for the
pressure altitude and sea level pressure airplane.
altitude for
[Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29786, July 20, 1990]
(i) Maximum continuous power (re-
lating to unsupercharged operation or 25.1523 Minimum flight crew.
to operation in each supercharger mode
as applicable); and The minimum flight crew must be es-
(ii) Takeoff power (relating to unsu- tablished so that it is sufficient for safe
percharged operation or to operation in operation, considering
each supercharger mode as applicable). (a) The workload on individual crew-
(2) Fuel grade or specification. members;

486

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00496 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1541

(b) The accessibility and ease of oper- cluding the takeoff climb provisions of
ation of necessary controls by the ap- 25.121(a) through (c), for altitudes and
propriate crewmember; and ambient temperatures).
(c) The kind of operation authorized (2) The maximum landing weights
under 25.1525. must be established as the weights at
The criteria used in making the deter- which compliance is shown with the
minations required by this section are applicable provisions of this part (in-
set forth in appendix D. cluding the landing and approach climb
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as provisions of 25.119 and 25.121(d) for
amended by Amdt. 253, 30 FR 6067, Apr. 29, altitudes and ambient temperatures).
1965] (3) The minimum takeoff distances
must be established as the distances at
25.1525 Kinds of operation. which compliance is shown with the
The kinds of operation to which the applicable provisions of this part (in-
airplane is limited are established by cluding the provisions of 25.109 and
the category in which it is eligible for 25.113, for weights, altitudes, tempera-
certification and by the installed tures, wind components, runway sur-
equipment. face conditions (dry and wet), and run-
way gradients) for smooth, hard-sur-
25.1527 Ambient air temperature and
operating altitude. faced runways. Additionally, at the op-
tion of the applicant, wet runway take-
The extremes of the ambient air tem- off distances may be established for
perature and operating altitude for runway surfaces that have been
which operation is allowed, as limited grooved or treated with a porous fric-
by flight, structural, powerplant, func- tion course, and may be approved for
tional, or equipment characteristics, use on runways where such surfaces
must be established. have been designed constructed, and
[Doc. No. 20008511, 66 FR 34024, June 26, 2001] maintained in a manner acceptable to
the Administrator.
25.1529 Instructions for Continued (b) The extremes for variable factors
Airworthiness.
(such as altitude, temperature, wind,
The applicant must prepare Instruc- and runway gradients) are those at
tions for Continued Airworthiness in which compliance with the applicable
accordance with appendix H to this provisions of this part is shown.
part that are acceptable to the Admin-
istrator. The instructions may be in- [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
complete at type certification if a pro- amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55468, Dec. 20,
gram exists to ensure their completion 1976; Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29786, July 20, 1990;
Amdt. 2592, 63 FR 8321, Feb. 18, 1998]
prior to delivery of the first airplane or
issuance of a standard certificate of MARKINGS AND PLACARDS
airworthiness, whichever occurs later.
[Amdt. 2554, 45 FR 60173, Sept. 11, 1980] 25.1541 General.
(a) The airplane must contain
25.1531 Maneuvering flight load fac-
tors. (1) The specified markings and plac-
ards; and
Load factor limitations, not exceed-
(2) Any additional information, in-
ing the positive limit load factors de-
strument markings, and placards re-
termined from the maneuvering dia-
quired for the safe operation if there
gram in 25.333(b), must be established.
are unusual design, operating, or han-
25.1533 Additional operating limita- dling characteristics.
tions. (b) Each marking and placard pre-
(a) Additional operating limitations scribed in paragraph (a) of this sec-
must be established as follows: tion
(1) The maximum takeoff weights (1) Must be displayed in a con-
must be established as the weights at spicuous place; and
which compliance is shown with the (2) May not be easily erased, dis-
applicable provisions of this part (in- figured, or obscured.

487

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00497 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1543 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

25.1543 Instrument markings: gen- 25.1551 Oil quantity indication.


eral. Each oil quantity indicating means
For each instrument must be marked to indicate the quan-
(a) When markings are on the cover tity of oil readily and accurately.
glass of the instrument, there must be [Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29786, July 20, 1990]
means to maintain the correct align-
ment of the glass cover with the face of 25.1553 Fuel quantity indicator.
the dial; and
If the unusable fuel supply for any
(b) Each instrument marking must
tank exceeds one gallon, or five per-
be clearly visible to the appropriate
cent of the tank capacity, whichever is
crewmember.
greater, a red arc must be marked on
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as its indicator extending from the cali-
amended by Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29786, July 20, brated zero reading to the lowest read-
1990] ing obtainable in level flight.
25.1545 Airspeed limitation informa- 25.1555 Control markings.
tion.
(a) Each cockpit control, other than
The airspeed limitations required by primary flight controls and controls
25.1583 (a) must be easily read and un- whose function is obvious, must be
derstood by the flight crew. plainly marked as to its function and
method of operation.
25.1547 Magnetic direction indicator. (b) Each aerodynamic control must
(a) A placard meeting the require- be marked under the requirements of
ments of this section must be installed 25.677 and 25.699.
on, or near, the magnetic direction in- (c) For powerplant fuel controls
dicator. (1) Each fuel tank selector control
(b) The placard must show the cali- must be marked to indicate the posi-
bration of the instrument in level tion corresponding to each tank and to
flight with the engines operating. each existing cross feed position;
(c) The placard must state whether (2) If safe operation requires the use
the calibration was made with radio re- of any tanks in a specific sequence,
ceivers on or off. that sequence must be marked on, or
(d) Each calibration reading must be adjacent to, the selector for those
in terms of magnetic heading in not tanks; and
more than 45 degree increments. (3) Each valve control for each engine
must be marked to indicate the posi-
25.1549 Powerplant and auxiliary tion corresponding to each engine con-
power unit instruments. trolled.
For each required powerplant and (d) For accessory, auxiliary, and
auxiliary power unit instrument, as ap- emergency controls
propriate to the type of instrument (1) Each emergency control (includ-
(a) Each maximum and, if applicable, ing each fuel jettisoning and fluid shut-
minimum safe operating limit must be off must be colored red; and
marked with a red radial or a red line; (2) Each visual indicator required by
(b) Each normal operating range 25.729(e) must be marked so that the
must be marked with a green arc or pilot can determine at any time when
green line, not extending beyond the the wheels are locked in either extreme
maximum and minimum safe limits; position, if retractable landing gear is
used.
(c) Each takeoff and precautionary
range must be marked with a yellow 25.1557 Miscellaneous markings and
arc or a yellow line; and placards.
(d) Each engine, auxiliary power
(a) Baggage and cargo compartments
unit, or propeller speed range that is
and ballast location. Each baggage and
restricted because of excessive vibra-
cargo compartment, and each ballast
tion stresses must be marked with red
location must have a placard stating
arcs or red lines.
any limitations on contents, including
[Amdt. 2540, 42 FR 15044, Mar. 17, 1977] weight, that are necessary under the

488

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00498 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1583

loading requirements. However, (e) Approved survival equipment


underseat compartments designed for must be marked for identification and
the storage of carry-on articles weigh- method of operation.
ing not more than 20 pounds need not [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
have a loading limitation placard. amended by Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50598, Oct. 30,
(b) Powerplant fluid filler openings. 1978]
The following qpply:
(1) Fuel filler openings must be 25.1563 Airspeed placard.
marked at or near the filler cover A placard showing the maximum air-
with speeds for flap extension for the take-
(i) The word fuel; off, approach, and landing positions
(ii) For reciprocating engine powered must be installed in clear view of each
airplanes, the minimum fuel grade; pilot.
(iii) For turbine engine powered air-
planes, the permissible fuel designa- AIRPLANE FLIGHT MANUAL
tions; and
(iv) For pressure fueling systems, the 25.1581 General.
maximum permissible fueling supply (a) Furnishing information. An Air-
pressure and the maximum permissible plane Flight Manual must be furnished
defueling pressure. with each airplane, and it must contain
(2) Oil filler openings must be the following:
marked at or near the filler cover with (1) Information required by 25.1583
the word oil. through 25.1587.
(3) Augmentation fluid filler open- (2) Other information that is nec-
ings must be marked at or near the essary for safe operation because of de-
filler cover to identify the required sign, operating, or handling character-
fluid. istics.
(c) Emergency exit placards. Each (3) Any limitation, procedure, or
emergency exit placard must meet the other information established as a con-
requirements of 25.811. dition of compliance with the applica-
(d) Doors. Each door that must be ble noise standards of part 36 of this
used in order to reach any required chapter.
emergency exit must have a suitable (b) Approved information. Each part of
placard stating that the door is to be the manual listed in 25.1583 through
latched in the open position during 25.1587, that is appropriate to the air-
takeoff and landing. plane, must be furnished, verified, and
approved, and must be segregated,
[Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 18291, Dec. 24, 1964, as
amended by Amdt. 2532, 37 FR 3972, Feb. 24, identified, and clearly distinguished
1972; Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55468, Dec. 20, 1976; from each unapproved part of that
Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29786, July 20, 1990] manual.
(c) [Reserved]
25.1561 Safety equipment. (d) Each Airplane Flight Manual
(a) Each safety equipment control to must include a table of contents if the
be operated by the crew in emergency, complexity of the manual indicates a
such as controls for automatic liferaft need for it.
releases, must be plainly marked as to [Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2323, Jan. 16, 1978, as
its method of operation. amended by Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29786, July 20,
(b) Each location, such as a locker or 1990]
compartment, that carries any fire ex-
tinguishing, signaling, or other life 25.1583 Operating limitations.
saving equipment must be marked ac- (a) Airspeed limitations. The following
cordingly. airspeed limitations and any other air-
(c) Stowage provisions for required speed limitations necessary for safe op-
emergency equipment must be con- eration must be furnished:
spicuously marked to identify the con- (1) The maximum operating limit
tents and facilitate the easy removal of speed VMO/MMO and a statement that
the equipment. this speed limit may not be delib-
(d) Each liferaft must have obviously erately exceeded in any regime of
marked operating instructions. flight (climb, cruise, or descent) unless

489

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00499 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
25.1585 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

a higher speed is authorized for flight for each separate center of gravity
test or pilot training. range.
(2) If an airspeed limitation is based (d) Flight crew. The number and func-
upon compressibility effects, a state- tions of the minimum flight crew de-
ment to this effect and information as termined under 25.1523 must be fur-
to any symptoms, the probable behav- nished.
ior of the airplane, and the rec- (e) Kinds of operation. The kinds of
ommended recovery procedures. operation approved under 25.1525 must
(3) The maneuvering speed VA and a be furnished.
statement that full application of rud- (f) Ambient air temperatures and oper-
der and aileron controls, as well as ma- ating altitudes. The extremes of the am-
neuvers that involve angles of attack bient air temperatures and operating
near the stall, should be confined to altitudes established under 25.1527
speeds below this value. must be furnished.
(4) The flap extended speed VFE and (g) [Reserved]
the pertinent flap positions and engine (h) Additional operating limitations.
powers. The operating limitations established
(5) The landing gear operating speed under 25.1533 must be furnished.
or speeds, and a statement explaining (i) Maneuvering flight load factors. The
the speeds as defined in 25.1515(a). positive maneuvering limit load fac-
(6) The landing gear extended speed tors for which the structure is proven,
VLE, if greater than VLO, and a state- described in terms of accelerations,
ment that this is the maximum speed must be furnished.
at which the airplane can be safely [Doc. No. 5066, 29 FR 1891, Dec. 24, 1964, as
flown with the landing gear extended. amended by Amdt. 2538, 41 FR 55468, Dec, 20,
(b) Powerplant limitations. The fol- 1976; Amdt. 2542, 43 FR 2323, Jan. 16, 1978;
lowing information must be furnished: Amdt. 2546, 43 FR 50598, Oct. 30, 1978; Amdt.
2572, 55 FR 29787, July 20, 1990; Amdt. 25105,
(1) Limitations required by 25.1521 66 FR 34024, June 26, 2001]
and 25.1522.
(2) Explanation of the limitations, 25.1585 Operating procedures.
when appropriate. (a) Operating procedures must be fur-
(3) Information necessary for mark- nished for
ing the instruments required by (1) Normal procedures peculiar to the
25.1549 through 25.1553. particular type or model encountered
(c) Weight and loading distribution. in connection with routine operations;
The weight and center of gravity limi- (2) Non-normal procedures for mal-
tations established under 25.1519 must function cases and failure conditions
be furnished in the Airplane Flight involving the use of special systems or
Manual. All of the following informa- the alternative use of regular systems;
tion, including the weight distribution and
limitations established under 25.1519, (3) Emergency procedures for foresee-
must be presented either in the Air- able but unusual situations in which
plane Flight Manual or in a separate immediate and precise action by the
weight and balance control and loading crew may be expected to substantially
document that is incorporated by ref- reduce the risk of catastrophe.
erence in the Airplane Flight Manual: (b) Information or procedures not di-
(1) The condition of the airplane and rectly related to airworthiness or not
the items included in the empty weight under the control of the crew, must not
as defined in accordance with 25.29. be included, nor must any procedure
(2) Loading instructions necessary to that is accepted as basic airmanship.
ensure loading of the airplane within (c) Information identifying each op-
the weight and center of gravity limits, erating condition in which the fuel sys-
and to maintain the loading within tem independence prescribed in 25.953
these limits in flight. is necessary for safety must be fur-
(3) If certification for more than one nished, together with instructions for
center of gravity range is requested, placing the fuel system in a configura-
the appropriate limitations, with re- tion used to show compliance with that
gard to weight and loading procedures, section.

490

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00500 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT 25.1587

(d) The buffet onset envelopes, deter- the procedures for handling the air-
mined under 25.251 must be furnished. plane and any system having a signifi-
The buffet onset envelopes presented cant effect on the performance infor-
may reflect the center of gravity at mation.
which the airplane is normally loaded (2) VSR determined in accordance
during cruise if corrections for the ef- with 25.103.
fect of different center of gravity loca- (3) The following performance infor-
tions are furnished.
mation (determined by extrapolation
(e) Information must be furnished
and computed for the range of weights
that indicates that when the fuel quan-
tity indicator reads zero in level between the maximum landing weight
flight, any fuel remaining in the fuel and the maximum takeoff weight):
tank cannot be used safely in flight. (i) Climb in the landing configura-
(f) Information on the total quantity tion.
of usable fuel for each fuel tank must (ii) Climb in the approach configura-
be furnished. tion.
[Doc. No. 20008511, 66 FR 34024, June 26, 2001] (iii) Landing distance.
(4) Procedures established under
25.1587 Performance information. 25.101(f) and (g) that are related to the
(a) Each Airplane Flight Manual limitations and information required
must contain information to permit by 25.1533 and by this paragraph (b) in
conversion of the indicated tempera- the form of guidance material, includ-
ture to free air temperature if other ing any relevant limitations or infor-
than a free air temperature indicator is mation.
used to comply with the requirements (5) An explanation of significant or
of 25.1303(a)(1). unusual flight or ground handling char-
(b) Each Airplane Flight Manual acteristics of the airplane.
must contain the performance informa- (6) Corrections to indicated values of
tion computed under the applicable airspeed, altitude, and outside air tem-
provisions of this part (including perature.
25.115, 25.123, and 25.125 for the
(7) An explanation of operational
weights, altitudes, temperatures, wind
landing runway length factors included
components, and runway gradients, as
applicable) within the operational lim- in the presentation of the landing dis-
its of the airplane, and must contain tance, if appropriate.
the following: [Doc. No. 20008511, 66 FR 34024, June 26, 2001,
(1) In each case, the conditions of as amended by Amdt. 25108, 67 FR 70828,
power, configuration, and speeds, and Nov. 26, 2002]

491

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00501 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. A 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

APPENDIX A TO PART 25

492
EC28SE91.050</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00502 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. A

493
EC28SE91.051</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00503 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. A 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

494
EC28SE91.052</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00504 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. A

495
EC28SE91.053</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00505 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. A 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

496
EC28SE91.054</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00506 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. B

APPENDIX B TO PART 25

497
EC28SE91.055</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00507 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. B 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

498
EC28SE91.056</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00508 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. C

APPENDIX C TO PART 25 (b) Intermittent maximum icing. The inter-


mittent maximum intensity of atmospheric
(a) Continuous maximum icing. The max- icing conditions (intermittent maximum
imum continuous intensity of atmospheric icing) is defined by the variables of the cloud
icing conditions (continuous maximum liquid water content, the mean effective di-
icing) is defined by the variables of the cloud
ameter of the cloud droplets, the ambient air
liquid water content, the mean effective di-
temperature, and the interrelationship of
ameter of the cloud droplets, the ambient air
temperature, and the interrelationship of these three variables as shown in figure 4 of
these three variables as shown in figure 1 of this appendix. The limiting icing envelope in
this appendix. The limiting icing envelope in terms of altitude and temperature is given in
terms of altitude and temperature is given in figure 5 of this appendix. The inter-relation-
figure 2 of this appendix. The inter-relation- ship of cloud liquid water content with drop
ship of cloud liquid water content with drop diameter and altitude is determined from
diameter and altitude is determined from figures 4 and 5. The cloud liquid water con-
figures 1 and 2. The cloud liquid water con- tent for intermittent maximum icing condi-
tent for continuous maximum icing condi- tions of a horizontal extent, other than 2.6
tions of a horizontal extent, other than 17.4 nautical miles, is determined by the value of
nautical miles, is determined by the value of cloud liquid water content of figure 4 multi-
liquid water content of figure 1, multiplied plied by the appropriate factor in figure 6 of
by the appropriate factor from figure 3 of this appendix.
this appendix.

499
EC28SE91.057</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00509 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. C 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

500
EC28SE91.058</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00510 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. C

501
EC28SE91.059</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00511 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. C 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

502
EC28SE91.060</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00512 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. C

503
EC28SE91.061</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00513 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. C 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

504
EC28SE91.062</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00514 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. D

APPENDIX D TO PART 25 (a) Basic workload functions. The following


basic workload functions are considered:
Criteria for determining minimum flight crew. (1) Flight path control.
The following are considered by the Agency (2) Collision avoidance.
in determining the minimum flight crew (3) Navigation.
under 25.1523: (4) Communications.

505
EC28SE91.063</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00515 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. E 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
(5) Operation and monitoring of aircraft that each airplane certificated under this
engines and systems. Part will operate under IFR conditions.
(6) Command decisions. [Amdt. 253, 30 FR 6067, Apr. 29, 1965]
(b) Workload factors. The following work-
load factors are considered significant when APPENDIX E TO PART 25
analyzing and demonstrating workload for
minimum flight crew determination: ILimited Weight Credit For Airplanes
(1) The accessibility, ease, and simplicity Equipped With Standby Power
of operation of all necessary flight, power, (a) Each applicant for an increase in the
and equipment controls, including emer- maximum certificated takeoff and landing
gency fuel shutoff valves, electrical controls, weights of an airplane equipped with a type-
electronic controls, pressurization system certificated standby power rocket engine
controls, and engine controls. may obtain an increase as specified in para-
(2) The accessibility and conspicuity of all graph (b) if
necessary instruments and failure warning (1) The installation of the rocket engine
devices such as fire warning, electrical sys- has been approved and it has been estab-
tem malfunction, and other failure or cau- lished by flight test that the rocket engine
tion indicators. The extent to which such in- and its controls can be operated safely and
struments or devices direct the proper cor- reliably at the increase in maximum weight;
rective action is also considered. and
(3) The number, urgency, and complexity (2) The Airplane Flight Manual, or the
of operating procedures with particular con- placard, markings or manuals required in
sideration given to the specific fuel manage- place thereof, set forth in addition to any
ment schedule imposed by center of gravity, other operating limitations the Adminis-
structural or other considerations of an air- trator may require, the increased weight ap-
worthiness nature, and to the ability of each proved under this regulation and a prohibi-
engine to operate at all times from a single tion against the operation of the airplane at
tank or source which is automatically re- the approved increased weight when
plenished if fuel is also stored in other tanks. (i) The installed standby power rocket en-
(4) The degree and duration of con- gines have been stored or installed in excess
centrated mental and physical effort in- of the time limit established by the manu-
volved in normal operation and in diagnosing facturer of the rocket engine (usually sten-
and coping with malfunctions and emer- ciled on the engine casing); or
gencies. (ii) The rocket engine fuel has been ex-
pended or discharged.
(5) The extent of required monitoring of
(b) The currently approved maximum
the fuel, hydraulic, pressurization, elec-
takeoff and landing weights at which an air-
trical, electronic, deicing, and other systems
plane is certificated without a standby power
while en route.
rocket engine installation may be increased
(6) The actions requiring a crewmember to by an amount that does not exceed any of
be unavailable at his assigned duty station, the following:
including: observation of systems, emer- (1) An amount equal in pounds to 0.014 IN,
gency operation of any control, and emer- where I is the maximum usable impulse in
gencies in any compartment. pounds-seconds available from each standby
(7) The degree of automation provided in power rocket engine and N is the number of
the aircraft systems to afford (after failures rocket engines installed.
or malfunctions) automatic crossover or iso- (2) An amount equal to 5 percent of the
lation of difficulties to minimize the need for maximum certificated weight approved in
flight crew action to guard against loss of accordance with the applicable airworthiness
hydraulic or electric power to flight controls regulations without standby power rocket
or to other essential systems. engines installed.
(8) The communications and navigation (3) An amount equal to the weight of the
workload. rocket engine installation.
(9) The possibility of increased workload (4) An amount that, together with the cur-
associated with any emergency that may rently approved maximum weight, would
lead to other emergencies. equal the maximum structural weight estab-
(10) Incapacitation of a flight crewmember lished for the airplane without standby rock-
whenever the applicable operating rule re- et engines installed.
quires a minimum flight crew of at least two
pilots. IIPerformance Credit for Transport Category
Airplanes Equipped With Standby Power
(c) Kind of operation authorized. The deter-
mination of the kind of operation authorized The Administrator may grant performance
requires consideration of the operating rules credit for the use of standby power on trans-
under which the airplane will be operated. port category airplanes. However, the per-
Unless an applicant desires approval for a formance credit applies only to the max-
more limited kind of operation. It is assumed imum certificated takeoff and landing

506

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00516 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. E
weights, the takeoff distance, and the take- from the start of the takeoff to the point
off paths, and may not exceed that found by where the airplane attains a height of 50 feet
the Administrator to result in an overall above the takeoff surface for reciprocating-
level of safety in the takeoff, approach, and engine-powered airplanes and a height of 35
landing regimes of flight equivalent to that feet above the takeoff surface for turbine-
prescribed in the regulations under which powered airplanes.
the airplane was originally certificated with- (4) Maximum certificated takeoff weights. The
out standby power. For the purposes of this maximum certificated takeoff weights must
appendix, standby power is power or be determined at all altitudes, and at ambi-
thrust, or both, obtained from rocket en- ent temperatures, if applicable, at which per-
gines for a relatively short period and actu- formance credit is to be applied and may not
ated only in cases of emergency. The fol- exceed the weights established in compliance
lowing provisions apply: with paragraphs (a) and (b) of this section.
(1) Takeoff; general. The takeoff data pre- (a) The conditions of paragraphs (2)(b)
scribed in paragraphs (2) and (3) of this ap- through (d) must be met at the maximum
pendix must be determined at all weights certificated takeoff weight.
and altitudes, and at ambient temperatures (b) Without the use of standby power, the
if applicable, at which performance credit is airplane must meet all of the en route re-
to be applied. quirements of the applicable airworthiness
(2) Takeoff path. regulations under which the airplane was
(a) The one-engine-inoperative takeoff originally certificated. In addition, turbine-
path with standby power in use must be de- powered airplanes without the use of standby
termined in accordance with the perform- power must meet the final takeoff climb re-
ance requirements of the applicable air- quirements prescribed in the applicable air-
worthiness regulations. worthiness regulations.
(b) The one-engine-inoperative takeoff (5) Maximum certificated landing weights.
path (excluding that part where the airplane (a) The maximum certificated landing
is on or just above the takeoff surface) deter- weights (one-engine-inoperative approach
mined in accordance with paragraph (a) of and all-engine-operating landing climb) must
this section must lie above the one-engine- be determined at all altitudes, and at ambi-
inoperative takeoff path without standby ent temperatures if applicable, at which per-
power at the maximum takeoff weight at formance credit is to be applied and must
which all of the applicable air-worthiness re- not exceed that established in compliance
quirements are met. For the purpose of this with paragraph (b) of this section.
comparison, the flight path is considered to (b) The flight path, with the engines oper-
extend to at least a height of 400 feet above ating at the power or thrust, or both, appro-
the takeoff surface. priate to the airplane configuration and with
(c) The takeoff path with all engines oper- standby power in use, must lie above the
ating, but without the use of standby power, flight path without standby power in use at
must reflect a conservatively greater overall the maximum weight at which all of the ap-
level of performance than the one-engine-in- plicable airworthiness requirements are met.
operative takeoff path established in accord- In addition, the flight paths must comply
ance with paragraph (a) of this section. The with subparagraphs (i) and (ii) of this para-
margin must be established by the Adminis- graph.
trator to insure safe day-to-day operations, (i) The flight paths must be established
but in no case may it be less than 15 percent. without changing the appropriate airplane
The all-engines-operating takeoff path must configuration.
be determined by a procedure consistent (ii) The flight paths must be carried out for
with that established in complying with a minimum height of 400 feet above the point
paragraph (a) of this section. where standby power is actuated.
(d) For reciprocating-engine-powered air- (6) Airplane configuration, speed, and power
planes, the takeoff path to be scheduled in and thrust; general. Any change in the air-
the Airplane Flight Manual must represent planes configuration, speed, and power or
the one-engine-operative takeoff path deter- thrust, or both, must be made in accordance
mined in accordance with paragraph (a) of with the procedures established by the appli-
this section and modified to reflect the pro- cant for the operation of the airplane in
cedure (see paragraph (6)) established by the service and must comply with paragraphs (a)
applicant for flap retraction and attainment through (c) of this section. In addition, pro-
of the en route speed. The scheduled takeoff cedures must be established for the execu-
path must have a positive slope at all points tion of balked landings and missed ap-
of the airborne portion and at no point must proaches.
it lie above the takeoff path specified in (a) The Administrator must find that the
paragraph (a) of this section. procedure can be consistently executed in
(3) Takeoff distance. The takeoff distance service by crews of average skill.
must be the horizontal distance along the (b) The procedure may not involve methods
one-engine-inoperative take off path deter- or the use of devices which have not been
mined in accordance with paragraph (2)(a) proven to be safe and reliable.

507

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00517 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
(c) Allowances must be made for such time the film travels through ducts, the ducts
delays in the execution of the procedures as must meet the requirements of subparagraph
may be reasonably expected to occur during (ii) of this paragraph.
service. (iv) Clear plastic windows and signs, parts
(7) Installation and operation; standby power. constructed in whole or in part of elas-
The standby power unit and its installation tomeric materials, edge lighted instrument
must comply with paragraphs (a) and (b) of assemblies consisting of two or more instru-
this section. ments in a common housing, seat belts,
(a) The standby power unit and its instal- shoulder harnesses, and cargo and baggage
lation must not adversely affect the safety of tiedown equipment, including containers,
the airplane. bins, pallets, etc., used in passenger or crew
(b) The operation of the standby power compartments, may not have an average
unit and its control must have proven to be burn rate greater than 2.5 inches per minute
safe and reliable. when tested horizontally in accordance with
the applicable portions of this appendix.
[Amdt. 256, 30 FR 8468, July 2, 1965]
(v) Except for small parts (such as knobs,
handles, rollers, fasteners, clips, grommets,
APPENDIX F TO PART 25
rub strips, pulleys, and small electrical
Part ITest Criteria and Procedures for parts) that would not contribute signifi-
Showing Compliance with 25.853, or 25.855. cantly to the propagation of a fire and for
electrical wire and cable insulation, mate-
(a) Material test criteria(1) Interior com- rials in items not specified in paragraphs
partments occupied by crew or passengers. (i) (a)(1)(i), (ii), (iii), or (iv) of part I of this ap-
Interior ceiling panels, interior wall panels, pendix may not have a burn rate greater
partitions, galley structure, large cabinet than 4.0 inches per minute when tested hori-
walls, structural flooring, and materials used zontally in accordance with the applicable
in the construction of stowage compart- portions of this appendix.
ments (other than underseat stowage com- (2) Cargo and baggage compartments not oc-
partments and compartments for stowing cupied by crew or passengers.
small items such as magazines and maps) (i) [Reserved]
must be self-extinguishing when tested (ii) A cargo or baggage compartment de-
vertically in accordance with the applicable fined in 25.857 as Class B or E must have a
portions of part I of this appendix. The aver- liner constructed of materials that meet the
age burn length may not exceed 6 inches and requirements of paragraph (a)(1)(ii) of part I
the average flame time after removal of the of this appendix and separated from the air-
flame source may not exceed 15 seconds. plane structure (except for attachments). In
Drippings from the test specimen may not addition, such liners must be subjected to
continue to flame for more than an average the 45 degree angle test. The flame may not
of 3 seconds after falling. penetrate (pass through) the material during
(ii) Floor covering, textiles (including application of the flame or subsequent to its
draperies and upholstery), seat cushions, removal. The average flame time after re-
padding, decorative and nondecorative coat- moval of the flame source may not exceed 15
ed fabrics, leather, trays and galley fur- seconds, and the average glow time may not
nishings, electrical conduit, air ducting, exceed 10 seconds.
joint and edge covering, liners of Class B and (iii) A cargo or baggage compartment de-
E cargo or baggage compartments, floor pan- fined in 25.857 as Class B, C, D, or E must
els of Class B, C, D, or E cargo or baggage have floor panels constructed of materials
compartments, cargo covers and trans- which meet the requirements of paragraph
parencies, molded and thermoformed parts, (a)(1)(ii) of part I of this appendix and which
air ducting joints, and trim strips (decora- are separated from the airplane structure
tive and chafing), that are constructed of (except for attachments). Such panels must
materials not covered in subparagraph (iv) be subjected to the 45 degree angle test. The
below, must be self-extinguishing when test- flame may not penetrate (pass through) the
ed vertically in accordance with the applica- material during application of the flame or
ble portions of part I of this appendix or subsequent to its removal. The average
other approved equivalent means. The aver- flame time after removal of the flame source
age burn length may not exceed 8 inches, and may not exceed 15 seconds, and the average
the average flame time after removal of the glow time may not exceed 10 seconds.
flame source may not exceed 15 seconds. (iv) Insulation blankets and covers used to
Drippings from the test specimen may not protect cargo must be constructed of mate-
continue to flame for more than an average rials that meet the requirements of para-
of 5 seconds after falling. graph (a)(1)(ii) of part I of this appendix. Tie-
(iii) Motion picture film must be safety down equipment (including containers, bins,
film meeting the Standard Specifications for and pallets) used in each cargo and baggage
Safety Photographic Film PHI.25 (available compartment must be constructed of mate-
from the American National Standards Insti- rials that meet the requirements of para-
tute, 1430 Broadway, New York, NY 10018). If graph (a)(1)(v) of part I of this appendix.

508

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00518 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F
(3) Electrical system components. Insulation cordance with Federal Test Method Standard
on electrical wire or cable installed in any 191 Model 5903 (revised Method 5902) for the
area of the fuselage must be self-extin- vertical test, or Method 5906 for horizontal
guishing when subjected to the 60 degree test test (available from the General Services Ad-
specified in part I of this appendix. The aver- ministration, Business Service Center, Re-
age burn length may not exceed 3 inches, and gion 3, Seventh & D Streets SW., Wash-
the average flame time after removal of the ington, DC 20407). Specimens which are too
flame source may not exceed 30 seconds. large for the cabinet must be tested in simi-
Drippings from the test specimen may not lar draft-free conditions.
continue to flame for more than an average (4) Vertical test. A minimum of three speci-
of 3 seconds after falling. mens must be tested and results averaged.
(b) Test Procedures(1) Conditioning. Speci- For fabrics, the direction of weave cor-
mens must be conditioned to 70 5 F., and at responding to the most critical flammability
50 percent 5 percent relative humidity until conditions must be parallel to the longest di-
moisture equilibrium is reached or for 24 mension. Each specimen must be supported
hours. Each specimen must remain in the vertically. The specimen must be exposed to
conditioning environment until it is sub- a Bunsen or Tirrill burner with a nominal 38-
jected to the flame. inch I.D. tube adjusted to give a flame of 112
(2) Specimen configuration. Except for small inches in height. The minimum flame tem-
parts and electrical wire and cable insula- perature measured by a calibrated thermo-
tion, materials must be tested either as sec-
couple pyrometer in the center of the flame
tion cut from a fabricated part as installed
must be 1550 F. The lower edge of the speci-
in the airplane or as a specimen simulating
men must be 34-inch above the top edge of
a cut section, such as a specimen cut from a
the burner. The flame must be applied to the
flat sheet of the material or a model of the
center line of the lower edge of the specimen.
fabricated part. The specimen may be cut
For materials covered by paragraph (a)(1)(i)
from any location in a fabricated part; how-
of part I of this appendix, the flame must be
ever, fabricated units, such as sandwich pan-
applied for 60 seconds and then removed. For
els, may not be separated for test. Except as
materials covered by paragraph (a)(1)(ii) of
noted below, the specimen thickness must be
no thicker than the minimum thickness to part I of this appendix, the flame must be ap-
be qualified for use in the airplane. Test plied for 12 seconds and then removed. Flame
specimens of thick foam parts, such as seat time, burn length, and flaming time of drip-
cushions, must be 12-inch in thickness. Test pings, if any, may be recorded. The burn
specimens of materials that must meet the length determined in accordance with sub-
requirements of paragraph (a)(1)(v) of part I paragraph (7) of this paragraph must be
of this appendix must be no more than 18- measured to the nearest tenth of an inch.
inch in thickness. Electrical wire and cable (5) Horizontal test. A minimum of three
specimens must be the same size as used in specimens must be tested and the results
the airplane. In the case of fabrics, both the averaged. Each specimen must be supported
warp and fill direction of the weave must be horizontally. The exposed surface, when in-
tested to determine the most critical flam- stalled in the aircraft, must be face down for
mability condition. Specimens must be the test. The specimen must be exposed to a
mounted in a metal frame so that the two Bunsen or Tirrill burner with a nominal 38-
long edges and the upper edge are held se- inch I.D. tube adjusted to give a flame of 112
curely during the vertical test prescribed in inches in height. The minimum flame tem-
subparagraph (4) of this paragraph and the perature measured by a calibrated thermo-
two long edges and the edge away from the couple pyrometer in the center of the flame
flame are held securely during the horizontal must be 1550 F. The specimen must be posi-
test prescribed in subparagraph (5) of this tioned so that the edge being tested is cen-
paragraph. The exposed area of the specimen tered 34-inch above the top of the burner.
must be at least 2 inches wide and 12 inches The flame must be applied for 15 seconds and
long, unless the actual size used in the air- then removed. A minimum of 10 inches of
plane is smaller. The edge to which the burn- specimen must be used for timing purposes,
er flame is applied must not consist of the approximately 112 inches must burn before
finished or protected edge of the specimen the burning front reaches the timing zone,
but must be representative of the actual and the average burn rate must be recorded.
cross-section of the material or part as in- (6) Forty-five degree test. A minimum of
stalled in the airplane. The specimen must three specimens must be tested and the re-
be mounted in a metal frame so that all four sults averaged. The specimens must be sup-
edges are held securely and the exposed area ported at an angle of 45 to a horizontal sur-
of the specimen is at least 8 inches by 8 face. The exposed surface when installed in
inches during the 45 test prescribed in sub- the aircraft must be face down for the test.
paragraph (6) of this paragraph. The specimens must be exposed to a Bunsen
(3) Apparatus. Except as provided in sub- or Tirrill burner with a nominal 38-inch I.D.
paragraph (7) of this paragraph, tests must tube adjusted to give a flame of 112 inches in
be conducted in a draft-free cabinet in ac- height. The minimum flame temperature

509

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00519 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
measured by a calibrated thermocouple py- Part IIFlammability of Seat Cushions
rometer in the center of the flame must be
(a) Criteria for Acceptance. Each seat cush-
1550 F. Suitable precautions must be taken
ion must meet the following criteria:
to avoid drafts. The flame must be applied
for 30 seconds with one-third contacting the (1) At least three sets of seat bottom and
material at the center of the specimen and seat back cushion specimens must be tested.
then removed. Flame time, glow time, and (2) If the cushion is constructed with a fire
whether the flame penetrates (passes blocking material, the fire blocking material
through) the specimen must be recorded. must completely enclose the cushion foam
(7) Sixty degree test. A minimum of three core material.
specimens of each wire specification (make (3) Each specimen tested must be fab-
and size) must be tested. The specimen of ricated using the principal components (i.e.,
wire or cable (including insulation) must be foam core, flotation material, fire blocking
placed at an angle of 60 with the horizontal material, if used, and dress covering) and as-
in the cabinet specified in subparagraph (3) sembly processes (representative seams and
of this paragraph with the cabinet door open closures) intended for use in the production
during the test, or must be placed within a articles. If a different material combination
chamber approximately 2 feet high by 1 foot is used for the back cushion than for the bot-
by 1 foot, open at the top and at one vertical tom cushion, both material combinations
side (front), and which allows sufficient flow must be tested as complete specimen sets,
of air for complete combustion, but which is each set consisting of a back cushion speci-
free from drafts. The specimen must be par- men and a bottom cushion specimen. If a
allel to and approximately 6 inches from the cushion, including outer dress covering, is
front of the chamber. The lower end of the demonstrated to meet the requirements of
specimen must be held rigidly clamped. The this appendix using the oil burner test, the
upper end of the specimen must pass over a dress covering of that cushion may be re-
pulley or rod and must have an appropriate placed with a similar dress covering provided
weight attached to it so that the specimen is the burn length of the replacement covering,
held tautly throughout the flammability as determined by the test specified in
test. The test specimen span between lower 25.853(c), does not exceed the corresponding
clamp and upper pulley or rod must be 24 burn length of the dress covering used on the
inches and must be marked 8 inches from the cushion subjected to the oil burner test.
lower end to indicate the central point for (4) For at least two-thirds of the total
flame application. A flame from a Bunsen or number of specimen sets tested, the burn
Tirrill burner must be applied for 30 seconds length from the burner must not reach the
at the test mark. The burner must be mount- side of the cushion opposite the burner. The
ed underneath the test mark on the speci- burn length must not exceed 17 inches. Burn
men, perpendicular to the specimen and at length is the perpendicular distance from the
an angle of 30 to the vertical plane of the inside edge of the seat frame closest to the
specimen. The burner must have a nominal burner to the farthest evidence of damage to
bore of 38-inch and be adjusted to provide a the test specimen due to flame impingement,
3-inch high flame with an inner cone ap- including areas of partial or complete con-
proximately one-third of the flame height. sumption, charring, or embrittlement, but
The minimum temperature of the hottest not including areas sooted, stained, warped,
portion of the flame, as measured with a or discolored, or areas where material has
calibrated thermocouple pyrometer, may not shrunk or melted away from the heat source.
be less than 1750 F. The burner must be posi- (5) The average percentage weight loss
tioned so that the hottest portion of the must not exceed 10 percent. Also, at least
flame is applied to the test mark on the two-thirds of the total number of specimen
wire. Flame time, burn length, and flaming sets tested must not exceed 10 percent
time of drippings, if any, must be recorded. weight loss. All droppings falling from the
The burn length determined in accordance cushions and mounting stand are to be dis-
with paragraph (8) of this paragraph must be carded before the after-test weight is deter-
measured to the nearest tenth of an inch. mined. The percentage weight loss for a spec-
Breaking of the wire specimens is not consid- imen set is the weight of the specimen set
ered a failure. before testing less the weight of the speci-
(8) Burn length. Burn length is the distance men set after testing expressed as the per-
from the original edge to the farthest evi- centage of the weight before testing.
dence of damage to the test specimen due to (b) Test Conditions. Vertical air velocity
flame impingement, including areas of par- should average 25 fpm10 fpm at the top of
tial or complete consumption, charring, or the back seat cushion. Horizontal air veloc-
embrittlement, but not including areas soot- ity should be below 10 fpm just above the
ed, stained, warped, or discolored, nor areas bottom seat cushion. Air velocities should be
where material has shrunk or melted away measured with the ventilation hood oper-
from the heat source. ating and the burner motor off.

510

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00520 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F
(c) Test Specimens. (1) For each test, one set (ii) Because crumbling of the insulating
of cushion specimens representing a seat bot- board with service can result in misalign-
tom and seat back cushion must be used. ment of the calorimeter, the calorimeter
(2) The seat bottom cushion specimen must must be monitored and the mounting
be 18 18 inches (457 3 mm) wide by 20 18 shimmed, as necessary, to ensure that the
inches (508 3 mm) deep by 4 18 inches (102 calorimeter face is flush with the exposed
3 mm) thick, exclusive of fabric closures plane of the insulating board in a plane par-
and seam overlap. allel to the exit of the test burner cone.
(3) The seat back cushion specimen must (4) Thermocouples. The seven thermocouples
be 18 18 inches (432 3 mm) wide by 25 18 to be used for testing must be 116- to 18-inch
inches (635 3 mm) high by 2 18 inches (51 3 metal sheathed, ceramic packed, type K,
mm) thick, exclusive of fabric closures and grounded thermocouples with a nominal 22
seam overlap. to 30 American wire gage (AWG)-size con-
(4) The specimens must be conditioned at ductor. The seven thermocouples must be at-
70 5 F (21 2 C) 55%10% relative humidity tached to a steel angle bracket to form a
for at least 24 hours before testing. thermocouple rake for placement in the test
(d) Test Apparatus. The arrangement of the stand during burner calibration, as shown in
test apparatus is shown in Figures 1 through Figure 5.
5 and must include the components described (5) Apparatus Arrangement. The test burner
in this section. Minor details of the appa- must be mounted on a suitable stand to posi-
ratus may vary, depending on the model tion the exit of the burner cone a distance of
burner used. 4 18 inches (102 3 mm) from one side of the
(1) Specimen Mounting Stand. The mounting specimen mounting stand. The burner stand
stand for the test specimens consists of steel should have the capability of allowing the
angles, as shown in Figure 1. The length of burner to be swung away from the specimen
the mounting stand legs is 12 18 inches (305
mounting stand during warmup periods.
3 mm). The mounting stand must be used
(6) Data Recording. A recording potentiom-
for mounting the test specimen seat bottom
eter or other suitable calibrated instrument
and seat back, as shown in Figure 2. The
with an appropriate range must be used to
mounting stand should also include a suit-
measure and record the outputs of the calo-
able drip pan lined with aluminum foil, dull
side up. rimeter and the thermocouples.
(2) Test Burner. The burner to be used in (7) Weight Scale. Weighing DeviceA device
testing must must be used that with proper procedures
(i) Be a modified gun type; may determine the before and after test
(ii) Have an 80-degree spray angle nozzle weights of each set of seat cushion specimens
nominally rated for 2.25 gallons/hour at 100 within 0.02 pound (9 grams). A continuous
psi; weighing system is preferred.
(iii) Have a 12-inch (305 mm) burner cone (8) Timing Device. A stopwatch or other de-
installed at the end of the draft tube, with vice (calibrated to 1 second) must be used to
an opening 6 inches (152 mm) high and 11 measure the time of application of the burn-
inches (280 mm) wide, as shown in Figure 3; er flame and self-extinguishing time or test
and duration.
(iv) Have a burner fuel pressure regulator (e) Preparation of Apparatus. Before calibra-
that is adjusted to deliver a nominal 2.0 gal- tion, all equipment must be turned on and
lon/hour of # 2 Grade kerosene or equivalent the burner fuel must be adjusted as specified
required for the test. in paragraph (d)(2).
Burner models which have been used success- (f) Calibration. To ensure the proper ther-
fully in testing are the Lennox Model OB32, mal output of the burner, the following test
Carlin Model 200 CRD, and Park Model DPL must be made:
3400. FAA published reports pertinent to this (1) Place the calorimeter on the test stand
type of burner are: (1) Powerplant as shown in Figure 4 at a distance of 4 18
Enginering Report No. 3A, Standard Fire inches (102 3 mm) from the exit of the burn-
Test Apparatus and Procedure for Flexible er cone.
Hose Assemblies, dated March 1978; and (2) (2) Turn on the burner, allow it to run for
Report No. DOT/FAA/RD/76/213, Reevaluation 2 minutes for warmup, and adjust the burner
of Burner Characteristics for Fire Resistance air intake damper to produce a reading of
Tests, dated January 1977. 10.5 0.5 BTU/ft2-sec. (11.9 0.6 w/cm2) on the
(3) Calorimeter. calorimeter to ensure steady state condi-
(i) The calorimeter to be used in testing tions have been achieved. Turn off the burn-
must be a (015.0 BTU/ft2-sec. 017.0 W/cm2) er.
calorimeter, accurate 3%, mounted in a 6- (3) Replace the calorimeter with the ther-
inch by 12-inch (152 by 305 mm) by 34-inch (19 mocouple rake (Figure 5).
mm) thick calcium silicate insulating board (4) Turn on the burner and ensure that the
which is attached to a steel angle bracket for thermocouples are reading 1900 100 F (1038
placement in the test stand during burner 38 C) to ensure steady state conditions
calibration, as shown in Figure 4. have been achieved.

511

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00521 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
(5) If the calorimeter and thermocouples do run for 2 minutes to provide adequate
not read within range, repeat steps in para- warmup of the burner cone and flame sta-
graphs 1 through 4 and adjust the burner air bilization.
intake damper until the proper readings are (5) To begin the test, swing the burner into
obtained. The thermocouple rake and the the test position and simultaneously start
calorimeter should be used frequently to the timing device.
maintain and record calibrated test param- (6) Expose the seat bottom cushion speci-
eters. Until the specific apparatus has dem- men to the burner flame for 2 minutes and
onstrated consistency, each test should be then turn off the burner. Immediately swing
calibrated. After consistency has been con- the burner away from the test position. Ter-
firmed, several tests may be conducted with minate test 7 minutes after initiating cush-
the pre-test calibration before and a calibra- ion exposure to the flame by use of a gaseous
tion check after the series. extinguishing agent (i.e., Halon or CO2).
(g) Test Procedure. The flammability of (7) Determine the weight of the remains of
each set of specimens must be tested as fol- the seat cushion specimen set left on the
lows: mounting stand to the nearest 0.02 pound (9
(1) Record the weight of each set of seat grams) excluding all droppings.
bottom and seat back cushion specimens to (h) Test Report. With respect to all speci-
be tested to the nearest 0.02 pound (9 grams). men sets tested for a particular seat cushion
(2) Mount the seat bottom and seat back for which testing of compliance is performed,
cushion test specimens on the test stand as the following information must be recorded:
shown in Figure 2, securing the seat back (1) An identification and description of the
cushion specimen to the test stand at the specimens being tested.
top. (2) The number of specimen sets tested.
(3) Swing the burner into position and en- (3) The initial weight and residual weight
sure that the distance from the exit of the of each set, the calculated percentage weight
burner cone to the side of the seat bottom loss of each set, and the calculated average
cushion specimen is 4 18 inches (102 3 mm). percentage weight loss for the total number
(4) Swing the burner away from the test of sets tested.
position. Turn on the burner and allow it to (4) The burn length for each set tested.

512

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00522 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F

513
EC28SE91.064</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00523 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

514
EC28SE91.065</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00524 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F

515
EC28SE91.066</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00525 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

516
EC28SE91.067</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00526 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F

Part IIITest Method to Determine Flame Pen- such as joints, lamp assemblies, etc., the
etration Resistance of Cargo Compartment failure of which would affect the capability
Liners. of the liner to safely contain a fire.
(3) There must be no flame penetration of
(a) Criteria for Acceptance. (1) At least three
any specimen within 5 minutes after applica-
specimens of cargo compartment sidewall or
tion of the flame source, and the peak tem-
ceiling liner panels must be tested.
perature measured at 4 inches above the
(2) Each specimen tested must simulate
upper surface of the horizontal test sample
the cargo compartment sidewall or ceiling
must not exceed 400 F.
liner panel, including any design features,

517
EC28SE91.068</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00527 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
(b) Summary of Method. This method pro- orimeter face is parallel to the exit plane of
vides a laboratory test procedure for meas- the test burner cone.
uring the capability of cargo compartment (4) Thermocouples. The seven thermocouples
lining materials to resist flame penetration to be used for testing must be 116 inch ce-
with a 2 gallon per hour (GPH) #2 Grade ker- ramic sheathed, type K, grounded
osene or equivalent burner fire source. Ceil- thermocouples with a nominal 30 American
ing and sidewall liner panels may be tested wire gage (AWG) size conductor. The seven
individually provided a baffle is used to sim- thermocouples must be attached to a steel
ulate the missing panel. Any specimen that angle bracket to form a thermocouple rake
passes the test as a ceiling liner panel may for placement in the test stand during burn-
be used as a sidewall liner panel. er calibration as shown in Figure 3 of this
(c) Test Specimens. (1) The specimen to be part of this appendix.
tested must measure 16 18 inches (406 3 (5) Apparatus Arrangement. The test burner
mm) by 24+18 inches (610 3 mm). must be mounted on a suitable stand to posi-
(2) The specimens must be conditioned at tion the exit of the burner cone a distance of
70 F.5 F. (21 C. 2 C.) and 55%5% humid- 8 inches from the ceiling liner panel and 2
ity for at least 24 hours before testing. inches from the sidewall liner panel. The
(d) Test Apparatus. The arrangement of the burner stand should have the capability of
test apparatus, which is shown in Figure 3 of allowing the burner to be swung away from
Part II and Figures 1 through 3 of this part the test specimen during warm-up periods.
of appendix F, must include the components (6) Instrumentation. A recording potentiom-
described in this section. Minor details of the eter or other suitable instrument with an ap-
apparatus may vary, depending on the model propriate range must be used to measure and
of the burner used. record the outputs of the calorimeter and
(1) Specimen Mounting Stand. The mounting the thermocouples.
stand for the test specimens consists of steel (7) Timing Device. A stopwatch or other de-
angles as shown in Figure 1. vice must be used to measure the time of
(2) Test Burner. The burner to be used in flame application and the time of flame pen-
tesing must etration, if it occurs.
(i) Be a modified gun type. (e) Preparation of Apparatus. Before calibra-
(ii) Use a suitable nozzle and maintain fuel tion, all equipment must be turned on and
pressure to yield a 2 GPH fuel flow. For ex- allowed to stabilize, and the burner fuel flow
ample: an 80 degree nozzle nominally rated must be adjusted as specified in paragraph
at 2.25 GPH and operated at 85 pounds per (d)(2).
square inch (PSI) gage to deliver 2.03 GPH. (f) Calibration. To ensure the proper ther-
(iii) Have a 12 inch (305 mm) burner exten- mal output of the burner the following test
sion installed at the end of the draft tube must be made:
with an opening 6 inches (152 mm) high and (1) Remove the burner extension from the
11 inches (280 mm) wide as shown in Figure end of the draft tube. Turn on the blower
3 of Part II of this appendix. portion of the burner without turning the
(iv) Have a burner fuel pressure regulator fuel or igniters on. Measure the air velocity
that is adjusted to deliver a nominal 2.0 GPH using a hot wire anemometer in the center of
of #2 Grade kerosene or equivalent. the draft tube across the face of the opening.
Burner models which have been used success- Adjust the damper such that the air velocity
fully in testing are the Lenox Model OB32, is in the range of 1550 to 1800 ft./min. If tabs
Carlin Model 200 CRD and Park Model DPL. are being used at the exit of the draft tube,
The basic burner is described in FAA Power- they must be removed prior to this measure-
plant Engineering Report No. 3A, Standard ment. Reinstall the draft tube extension
Fire Test Apparatus and Procedure for Flexi- cone.
ble Hose Assemblies, dated March 1978; how- (2) Place the calorimeter on the test stand
ever, the test settings specified in this ap- as shown in Figure 2 at a distance of 8 inches
pendix differ in some instances from those (203 mm) from the exit of the burner cone to
specified in the report. simulate the position of the horizontal test
(3) Calorimeter. (i) The calorimeter to be specimen.
used in testing must be a total heat flux Foil (3) Turn on the burner, allow it to run for
Type Gardon Gage of an appropriate range 2 minutes for warm-up, and adjust the damp-
(approximately 0 to 15.0 British thermal unit er to produce a calorimeter reading of 8.0 0.5
(BTU) per ft.2 sec., 017.0 watts/cm2). The cal- BTU per ft.2 sec. (9.1 0.6 Watts/cm2).
orimeter must be mounted in a 6 inch by 12 (4) Replace the calorimeter with the ther-
inch (152 by 305 mm) by 34 inch (19 mm) thick mocouple rake (see Figure 3).
insulating block which is attached to a steel (5) Turn on the burner and ensure that
angle bracket for placement in the test stand each of the seven thermocouples reads 1700
during burner calibration as shown in Figure F. 100 F. (927 C. 38 C.) to ensure steady
2 of this part of this appendix. state conditions have been achieved. If the
(ii) The insulating block must be mon- temperature is out of this range, repeat steps
itored for deterioration and the mounting 2 through 5 until proper readings are ob-
shimmed as necessary to ensure that the cal- tained.

518

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00528 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F
(6) Turn off the burner and remove the The test may be terminated earlier if flame
thermocouple rake. penetration is observed.
(7) Repeat (1) to ensure that the burner is (5) When testing ceiling liner panels,
in the correct range. record the peak temperature measured 4
(g) Test Procedure. (1) Mount a thermo- inches above the sample.
couple of the same type as that used for cali-
(6) Record the time at which flame pene-
bration at a distance of 4 inches (102 mm)
tration occurs if applicable.
above the horizontal (ceiling) test specimen.
The thermocouple should be centered over (h) Test Report. The test report must in-
the burner cone. clude the following:
(2) Mount the test specimen on the test (1) A complete description of the materials
stand shown in Figure 1 in either the hori- tested including type, manufacturer, thick-
zontal or vertical position. Mount the insu- ness, and other appropriate data.
lating material in the other position. (2) Observations of the behavior of the test
(3) Position the burner so that flames will specimens during flame exposure such as
not impinge on the specimen, turn the burn- delamination, resin ignition, smoke, ect., in-
er on, and allow it to run for 2 minutes. Ro- cluding the time of such occurrence.
tate the burner to apply the flame to the (3) The time at which flame penetration
specimen and simultaneously start the tim- occurs, if applicable, for each of the three
ing device.
specimens tested.
(4) Expose the test specimen to the flame
for 5 minutes and then turn off the burner. (4) Panel orientation (ceiling or sidewall).

519

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00529 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

520
EC28SE91.069</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00530 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F

521
EC28SE91.070</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00531 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

522
EC28SE91.071</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00532 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F
Part IVTest Method to Determine the Heat this part IV. The truncated diamond-shaped
Release Rate From Cabin Materials Exposed mask of .042 .002 inch (1.07 .05mm) stainless
to Radiant Heat. steel must be added to provide uniform heat
flux density over the area occupied by the
(a) Summary of Method. Three or more
vertical sample.
specimens representing the completed air-
(4) Air Distribution System. The air entering
craft component are tested. Each test speci-
the environmental chamber must be distrib-
men is injected into an environmental cham- uted by a .25 inch (6.3 mm) thick aluminum
ber through which a constant flow of air plate having eight No. 4 drill-holes, located 2
passes. The specimens exposure is deter- inches (51 mm) from sides on 4 inch (102 mm)
mined by a radiant heat source adjusted to centers, mounted at the base of the environ-
produce, on the specimen, the desired total mental chamber. A second plate of 18 guage
heat flux of 3.5 W/cm2. The specimen is tested stainless steel having 120, evenly spaced, No.
with the exposed surface vertical. Combus- 28 drill holes must be mounted 6 inches (152
tion is initiated by piloted ignition. The mm) above the aluminum plate. A well-regu-
combustion products leaving the chamber lated air supply is required. The air-supply
are monitored in order to calculate the re- manifold at the base of the pyramidal sec-
lease rate of heat. tion must have 48, evenly spaced, No. 26 drill
(b) Apparatus. The Ohio State University holes located .38 inch (10 mm) from the inner
(OSU) rate of heat release apparatus, as de- edge of the manifold, resulting in an airflow
scribed below, is used. This is a modified split of approximately three to one within
version of the rate of heat release apparatus the apparatus.
standardized by the American Society of (5) Exhaust Stack. An exhaust stack,
Testing and Materials (ASTM), ASTM E906. 5.25 2.75 inches (133 70 mm) in cross section,
(1) This apparatus is shown in Figures 1A and 10 inches (254 mm) long, fabricated from
and 1B of this part IV. All exterior surfaces 28 guage stainless steel must be mounted on
of the apparatus, except the holding cham- the outlet of the pyramidal section. A.
ber, must be insulated with 1 inch (25 mm) 1.0 3.0 inch (25 76 mm) baffle plate of
thick, low density, high temperature, fiber- .018 .002 inch (.50 .05 mm) stainless steel
glass board insulation. A gasketed door, must be centered inside the stack, perpen-
through which the sample injection rod dicular to the air flow, 3 inches (76 mm)
slides, must be used to form an airtight clo- above the base of the stack.
sure on the specimen hold chamber. (6) Specimen Holders. (i) The specimen must
(2) Thermopile. The temperature difference be tested in a vertical orientation. The speci-
between the air entering the environmental men holder (Figure 3 of this part IV) must
chamber and that leaving must be monitored incorporate a frame that touches the speci-
by a thermopile having five hot, and five men (which is wrapped with aluminum foil
cold, 24-guage Chromel-Alumel junctions. as required by paragraph (d)(3) of this Part)
The hot junctions must be spaced across the along only the .25 inch (6 mm) perimeter. A
top of the exhaust stack, .38 inches (10 mm) V shaped spring is used to hold the assem-
below the top of the chimney. The bly together. A detachable .50 .50 5.91 inch
thermocouples must have a .050 .010 inch (12 12 150 mm) drip pan and two .020 inch (.5
(1.3 .3mm) diameter, ball-type, welded tip. mm) stainless steel wires (as shown in Fig-
One thermocouple must be located in the ure 3 of this part IV) must be used for testing
geometric center, with the other four located materials prone to melting and dripping. The
1.18 inch (30 mm) from the center along the positioning of the spring and frame may be
diagonal toward each of the corners (Figure changed to accommodate different specimen
5 of this part IV). The cold junctions must be thicknesses by inserting the retaining rod in
located in the pan below the lower air dis- different holes on the specimen holder.
tribution plate (see paragraph (b)(4) of this (ii) Since the radiation shield described in
part IV). Thermopile hot junctions must be ASTM E906 is not used, a guide pin must be
cleared of soot deposits as needed to main- added to the injection mechanism. This fits
tain the calibrated sensitivity. into a slotted metal plate on the injection
(3) Radiation Source. A radiant heat source mechanism outside of the holding chamber.
incorporating four Type LL silicon carbide It can be used to provide accurate posi-
elements, 20 inches (508 mm) long by .63 inch tioning of the specimen face after injection.
(16 mm) O.D., must be used, as shown in Fig- The front surface of the specimen must be 3.9
ures 2A and 2B of this part IV. The heat inches (100 mm) from the closed radiation
source must have a nominal resistance of 1.4 doors after injection.
ohms and be capable of generating a flux up (iii) The specimen holder clips onto the
to 100 kW/m2. The silicone carbide elements mounted bracket (Figure 3 of this part IV).
must be mounted in the stainless steel panel The mounting bracket must be attached to
box by inserting them through .63 inch (16 the injection rod by three screws that pass
mm) holes in .03 inch (1 mm) thick ceramic through a wide-area washer welded onto a 12-
fiber or calcium-silicate millboard. Loca- inch (13 mm) nut. The end of the injection
tions of the holes in the pads and stainless rod must be threaded to screw into the nut,
steel cover plates are shown in Figure 2B of and a .020 inch (5.1 mm) thick wide area

523

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00533 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
washer must be held between two 12-inch (13 ports, all radiating in the same direction.
mm) nuts that are adjusted to tightly cover The first hole must be .50 inch (13 mm) from
the hole in the radiation doors through the closed end of the tubing. The tube must
which the injection rod or calibration calo- be positioned above the specimen holder so
rimeter pass. that the holes are placed above the specimen
(7) Calorimeter. A total-flux type calo- as shown in Figure 1B of this part IV. The
rimeter must be mounted in the center of a fuel supplied to the burner must be methane
12-inch Kaowool M board inserted in the mixed with air in a ratio of approximately
sample holder to measure the total heat flux. 50/50 by volume. The total gas flow must be
The calorimeter must have a view angle of adjusted to produce flame lengths of 1 inch
180 degrees and be calibrated for incident (25 mm). When the gas/air ratio and the flow
flux. The calorimeter calibration must be ac- rate are properly adjusted, approximately .25
ceptable to the Administrator. inch (6 mm) of the flame length appears yel-
(8) Pilot-Flame Positions. Pilot ignition of low in color.
the specimen must be accomplished by si- (c) Calibration of Equipment. (1) Heat Release
multaneously exposing the specimen to a Rate. A calibration burner, as shown in Fig-
lower pilot burner and an upper pilot burner, ure 4, must be placed over the end of the
as described in paragraph (b)(8)(i) and lower pilot flame tubing using a gas tight
(b)(8)(ii) or (b)(8)(iii) of this part IV, respec- connection. The flow of gas to the pilot
tively. Since intermittent pilot flame extin- flame must be at least 99 percent methane
guishment for more than 3 seconds would in- and must be accurately metered. Prior to
validate the test results, a spark ignitor may usage, the wet test meter must be properly
be installed to ensure that the lower pilot leveled and filled with distilled water to the
burner remains lighted. tip of the internal pointer while no gas is
(i) Lower Pilot Burner. The pilot-flame tub- flowing. Ambient temperature and pressure
ing must be .25 inch (6.3 mm) O.D., .03 inch of the water are based on the internal wet
(0.8mm) wall, stainless steel tubing. A mix- test meter temperature. A baseline flow rate
ture of 120 cm3/min. of methane and 850 cm3/ of approximately 1 liter/min. must be set and
min. of air must be fed to the lower pilot increased to higher preset flows of 4, 6, 8, 6
flame burner. The normal position of the end and 4 liters/min. Immediately prior to re-
of the pilot burner tubing is .40 inch (10 mm) cording methane flow rates, a flow rate of 8
from and perpendicular to the exposed liters/min. must be used for 2 minutes to pre-
vertical surface of the specimen. The center- condition the chamber. This is not recorded
line at the outlet of the burner tubing must as part of calibration. The rate must be de-
intersect the vertical centerline of the sam- termined by using a stopwatch to time a
ple at a point .20 inch (5 mm) above the lower complete revolution of the wet test meter for
exposed edge of the specimen. both the baseline and higher flow, with the
(ii) Standard Three-Hole Upper Pilot Burner. flow returned to baseline before changing to
The pilot burner must be a straight length of the next higher flow. The thermopile base-
.25 inch (6.3 mm) O.D., .03 inch (0.8 mm) wall, line voltage must be measured. The gas flow
stainless steel tubing that is 14 inches (360 to the burner must be increased to the high-
mm) long. One end of the tubing must be er preset flow and allowed to burn for 2.0
closed, and three No. 40 drill holes must be minutes, and the thermopile voltage must be
drilled into the tubing, 2.38 inch (60 mm) measured. The sequence must be repeated
apart, for gas ports, all radiating in the same until all five values have been determined.
direction. The first hole must be .19 inch (5 The average of the five values must be used
mm) from the closed end of the tubing. The as the calibration factor. The procedure
tube must be positioned .75 inch (19 mm) must be repeated if the percent relative
above and .75 inch (19 mm) behind the ex- standard deviation is greater than 5 percent.
posed upper edge of the specimen. The mid- Calculations are shown in paragraph (f) of
dle hole must be in the vertical plane perpen- this part IV.
dicular to the exposed surface of the speci- (2) Flux Uniformity. Uniformity of flux over
men which passes through its vertical cen- the specimen must be checked periodically
terline and must be pointed toward the radi- and after each heating element change to de-
ation source. The gas supplied to the burner termine if it is within acceptable limits of
must be methane and must be adjusted to plus or minus 5 percent.
produce flame lengths of 1 inch (25 mm). (3) As noted in paragraph (b)(2) of this part
(iii) Optional Fourteen-Hole Upper Pilot IV, thermopile hot junctions must be cleared
Burner. This burner may be used in lieu of of soot deposits as needed to maintain the
the standard three-hole burner described in calibrated sensitivity.
paragraph (b)(8)(ii) of this part IV. The pilot (d) Preparation of Test Specimens. (1) The
burner must be a straight length of .25 inch test specimens must be representative of the
(6.3 mm) O.D., .03 inch (0.8 mm) wall, stain- aircraft component in regard to materials
less steel tubing that is 15.75 inches (400 mm) and construction methods. The standard size
long. One end of the tubing must be closed, for the test specimens is 5.91 .03 5.91 .03
and 14 No. 59 drill holes must be drilled into inches (149 1 149 1 mm). The thickness of
the tubing, .50 inch (13 mm) apart, for gas the specimen must be the same as that of the

524

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00534 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F
aircraft component it represents up to a (4) The specimen must be placed in the
maximum thickness of 1.75 inches (45 mm). hold chamber with the radiation doors
Test specimens representing thicker compo- closed. The airtight outer door must be se-
nents must be 1.75 inches (45 mm). cured, and the recording devices must be
(2) Conditioning. Specimens must be condi- started. The specimen must be retained in
tioned as described in Part 1 of this appen- the hold chamber for 60 seconds, plus or
dix. minus 10 seconds, before injection. The ther-
(3) Mounting. Each test specimen must be mopile zero value must be determined dur-
wrapped tightly on all sides of the specimen, ing the last 20 seconds of the hold period.
except for the one surface that is exposed The sample must not be injected before com-
with a single layer of .001 inch (.025 mm) alu- pletion of the zero value determination.
minum foil. (5) When the specimen is to be injected, the
(e) Procedure. (1) The power supply to the radiation doors must be opened. After the
radiant panel must be set to produce a radi- specimen is injected into the environmental
ant flux of 3.5 .05 W/cm2, as measured at the chamber, the radiation doors must be closed
point the center of the specimen surface will behind the specimen.
occupy when positioned for the test. The ra- (6) [Reserved]
diant flux must be measured after the air (7) Injection of the specimen and closure of
flow through the equipment is adjusted to the inner door marks time zero. A record of
the desired rate. the thermopile output with at least one data
(2) After the pilot flames are lighted, their point per second must be made during the
position must be checked as described in time the specimen is in the environmental
paragraph (b)(8) of this part IV. chamber.
(3) Air flow through the apparatus must be (8) The test duration is five minutes. The
controlled by a circular plate orifice located lower pilot burner and the upper pilot burner
in a 1.5 inch (38.1 mm) I.D. pipe with two must remain lighted for the entire duration
pressure measuring points, located 1.5 inches of the test, except that there may be inter-
(38 mm) upstream and .75 inches (19 mm) mittent flame extinguishment for periods
downstream of the orifice plate. The pipe that do not exceed 3 seconds. Furthermore, if
must be connected to a manometer set at a the optional three-hole upper burner is used,
pressure differential of 7.87 inches (200 mm) at least two flamelets must remain lighted
of Hg. (See Figure 1B of this part IV.) The for the entire duration of the test, except
total air flow to the equipment is approxi- that there may be intermittent flame extin-
mately .04 m3/seconds. The stop on the guishment of all three flamelets for periods
vertical specimen holder rod must be ad- that do not exceed 3 seconds.
justed so that the exposed surface of the (9) A minimum of three specimens must be
specimen is positioned 3.9 inches (100 mm) tested.
from the entrance when injected into the en- (f) Calculations. (1) The calibration factor is
vironmental chamber. calculated as follows:

Kh =
(F1 FO ) (210.8 22)k cal 273 P Pv mole CH 4STP WATT min kw
(V1 VO ) mole Ta 760 22.41 .01433kcal 1000w

F0=flow of methane at baseline (1pm) Kh=calibration factor (kw/mv)


F1=higher preset flow of methane (1pm)
(3) The integral of the heat release rate is
V0=thermopile voltage at baseline (mv)
the total heat release as a function of time
V1=thermopile voltage at higher flow (mv)
and is calculated by multiplying the rate by
Ta=Ambient temperature (K) the data sampling frequency in minutes and
P=Ambient pressure (mm Hg) summing the time from zero to two minutes.
Pv=Water vapor pressure (mm Hg) (g) Criteria. The total positive heat release
(2) Heat release rates may be calculated over the first two minutes of exposure for
from the reading of the thermopile output each of the three or more samples tested
voltage at any instant of time as: must be averaged, and the peak heat release
rate for each of the samples must be aver-

HRR =
(Vm Vb )K n aged. The average total heat release must
not exceed 65 kilowatt-minutes per square
2 meter, and the average peak heat release
.02323m rate must not exceed 65 kilowatts per square
ER02FE95.006</MATH>

HRR=heat release rate (kw/m2) meter.


Vb=baseline voltage (mv) (h) Report. The test report must include
Vm=measured thermopile voltage (mv) the following for each specimen tested:

525
EC28SE91.072</MATH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00535 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
(1) Description of the specimen. (4) If melting, sagging, delaminating, or
(2) Radiant heat flux to the specimen, ex- other behavior that affects the exposed sur-
pressed in W/cm2. face area or the mode of burning occurs,
(3) Data giving release rates of heat (in kW/ these behaviors must be reported, together
m2 ) as a function of time, either graphically with the time at which such behaviors were
or tabulated at intervals no greater than 10 observed.
seconds. The calibration factor (kn) must be (5) The peak heat release and the 2-minute
integrated heat release rate must be re-
recorded.
ported.

526

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00536 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F
FIGURES TO PART IV OF APPENDIX F

527
ER02FE95.004</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00537 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

528
ER02FE95.005</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00538 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F

529
EC28SE91.073</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00539 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

530
EC28SE91.074</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00540 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F

531
EC28SE91.075</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00541 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

532
EC28SE91.076</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00542 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F

Part V. Test Method to Determine the Smoke Part VITest Method To Determine the Flam-
Emission Characteristics of Cabin Materials mability and Flame Propagation Characteris-
tics of Thermal/Acoustic Insulation Mate-
(a) Summary of Method. The specimens rials
must be constructed, conditioned, and tested
in the flaming mode in accordance with Use this test method to evaluate the flam-
American Society of Testing and Materials mability and flame propagation characteris-
(ASTM) Standard Test Method ASTM F814 tics of thermal/acoustic insulation when ex-
posed to both a radiant heat source and a
83.
flame.
(b) Acceptance Criteria. The specific optical (a) Definitions.
smoke density (Ds), which is obtained by Flame propagation means the furthest
averaging the reading obtained after 4 min- distance of the propagation of visible flame
utes with each of the three specimens, shall towards the far end of the test specimen,
not exceed 200. measured from the midpoint of the ignition
source flame. Measure this distance after
initially applying the ignition source and be-
fore all flame on the test specimen is extin-
guished. The measurement is not a deter-
mination of burn length made after the test.

533
EC28SE91.077</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00543 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
Radiant heat source means an electric material encapsulated by a film covering and
or air propane panel. foams.
Thermal/acoustic insulation means a Zero point means the point of applica-
material or system of materials used to pro- tion of the pilot burner to the test specimen.
vide thermal and/or acoustic protection. Ex- (b) Test apparatus.
amples include fiberglass or other batting

(1) Radiant panel test chamber. Conduct window to provide access to the movable
tests in a radiant panel test chamber (see specimen platform holder. The bottom of the
figure 1 above). Place the test chamber under test chamber must be a sliding steel plat-
an exhaust hood to facilitate clearing the form that has provision for securing the test
chamber of smoke after each test. The radi- specimen holder in a fixed and level position.
ant panel test chamber must be an enclosure The chamber must have an internal chimney
55 inches (1397 mm) long by 19.5 (495 mm) with exterior dimensions of 5.1 inches (129
deep by 28 (710 mm) to 30 inches (maximum) mm) wide, by 16.2 inches (411 mm) deep by 13
(762 mm) above the test specimen. Insulate
inches (330 mm) high at the opposite end of
the sides, ends, and top with a fibrous ce-
ramic insulation, such as Kaowool MTM the chamber from the radiant energy source.
board. On the front side, provide a 52 by 12- The interior dimensions must be 4.5 inches
inch (1321 by 305 mm) draft-free, high-tem- (114 mm) wide by 15.6 inches (395 mm) deep.
perature, glass window for viewing the sam- The chimney must extend to the top of the
ple during testing. Place a door below the chamber (see figure 2).

534
ER31JY03.003</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00544 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F

(2) Radiant heat source. Mount the radiant temperatures up to 1300 F (704 C). An air
heat energy source in a cast iron frame or propane panel must be made of a porous re-
equivalent. An electric panel must have six, fractory material and have a radiation sur-
3-inch wide emitter strips. The emitter strips face of 12 by 18 inches (305 by 457 mm). The
must be perpendicular to the length of the panel must be capable of operating at tem-
panel. The panel must have a radiation sur- peratures up to 1,500 F (816 C). See figures 3a
face of 1278 by 1812 inches (327 by 470 mm). and 3b.
The panel must be capable of operating at

535
ER31JY03.004</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00545 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

536
ER31JY03.005</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00546 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F

(i) Electric radiant panel. The radiant panel (i) The sliding platform serves as the hous-
must be 3-phase and operate at 208 volts. A ing for test specimen placement. Brackets
single-phase, 240 volt panel is also accept- may be attached (via wing nuts) to the top
able. Use a solid-state power controller and lip of the platform in order to accommodate
microprocessor-based controller to set the various thicknesses of test specimens. Place
electric panel operating parameters. the test specimens on a sheet of Kaowool
(ii) Gas radiant panel. Use propane (liquid MTM board or 1260 Standard Board (manufac-
petroleum gas2.1 UN 1075) for the radiant tured by Thermal Ceramics and available in
panel fuel. The panel fuel system must con-
Europe), or equivalent, either resting on the
sist of a venturi-type aspirator for mixing
bottom lip of the sliding platform or on the
gas and air at approximately atmospheric
base of the brackets. It may be necessary to
pressure. Provide suitable instrumentation
for monitoring and controlling the flow of use multiple sheets of material based on the
fuel and air to the panel. Include an air flow thickness of the test specimen (to meet the
gauge, an air flow regulator, and a gas pres- sample height requirement). Typically, these
sure gauge. non-combustible sheets of material are
(iii) Radiant panel placement. Mount the available in 14 inch (6 mm) thicknesses. See
panel in the chamber at 30 to the horizontal figure 4. A sliding platform that is deeper
specimen plane, and 712 inches above the zero than the 2-inch (50.8mm) platform shown in
point of the specimen. figure 4 is also acceptable as long as the sam-
(3) Specimen holding system. ple height requirement is met.

537
ER31JY03.006</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00547 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(ii) Attach a 12 inch (13 mm) piece of (iii) Place the test specimen horizontally
Kaowool MTM board or other high tempera- on the non-combustible board(s). Place a
ture material measuring 4112 by 814 inches steel retaining/securing frame fabricated of
(1054 by 210 mm) to the back of the platform. mild steel, having a thickness of 18 inch (3.2
This board serves as a heat retainer and pro- mm) and overall dimensions of 23 by 1318
tects the test specimen from excessive inches (584 by 333 mm) with a specimen open-
preheating. The height of this board must ing of 19 by 1034 inches (483 by 273 mm) over
not impede the sliding platform movement the test specimen. The front, back, and right
(in and out of the test chamber). If the plat- portions of the top flange of the frame must
form has been fabricated such that the back rest on the top of the sliding platform, and
side of the platform is high enough to pre- the bottom flanges must pinch all 4 sides of
vent excess preheating of the specimen when the test specimen. The right bottom flange
the sliding platform is out, a retainer board must be flush with the sliding platform. See
is not necessary. figure 5.

538
ER31JY03.007</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00548 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F

(4) Pilot Burner. The pilot burner used to (19 mm). A 34 inch (19 mm) guide (such as a
ignite the specimen must be a thin strip of metal) may be soldered to the
BernzomaticTM commercial propane venturi top of the burner to aid in setting the flame
torch with an axially symmetric burner tip height. The overall flame length must be ap-
and a propane supply tube with an orifice di- proximately 5 inches long (127 mm). Provide
ameter of 0.006 inches (0.15 mm). The length a way to move the burner out of the ignition
of the burner tube must be 278 inches (71 position so that the flame is horizontal and
mm). The propane flow must be adjusted via at least 2 inches (50 mm) above the specimen
gas pressure through an in-line regulator to plane. See figure 6.
produce a blue inner cone length of 34 inch

539
ER31JY03.008</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00549 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(5) Thermocouples. Install a 24 American (E) The graphite plate must be electrically
Wire Gauge (AWG) Type K (Chromel-Alumel) heated, have a clear surface area on each
thermocouple in the test chamber for tem- side of the plate of at least 2 by 2 inches (51
perature monitoring. Insert it into the by 51 mm), and be 18 inch 116 inch thick (3.2
chamber through a small hole drilled 1.6 mm).
through the back of the chamber. Place the (F) Center the 2 transducers on opposite
thermocouple so that it extends 11 inches sides of the plates at equal distances from
(279 mm) out from the back of the chamber the plate.
wall, 1112 inches (292 mm) from the right side (G) The distance of the calorimeter to the
of the chamber wall, and is 2 inches (51 mm) plate must be no less than 0.0625 inches (1.6
below the radiant panel. The use of other mm), nor greater than 0.375 inches (9.5 mm).
thermocouples is optional. (H) The range used in calibration must be
(6) Calorimeter. The calorimeter must be a at least 03.5 BTUs/ft2 second (03.9 Watts/
one-inch cylindrical water-cooled, total heat cm2) and no greater than 05.7 BTUs/ft2 sec-
flux density, foil type Gardon Gage that has ond (06.4 Watts/cm2).
a range of 0 to 5 BTU/ft2-second (0 to 5.7 (I) The recording device used must record
Watts/cm2). the 2 transducers simultaneously or at least
(7) Calorimeter calibration specification and within 110 of each other.
procedure. (8) Calorimeter fixture. With the sliding plat-
(i) Calorimeter specification. form pulled out of the chamber, install the
(A) Foil diameter must be 0.25 0.005 inches calorimeter holding frame and place a sheet
(6.35 0.13 mm). of non-combustible material in the bottom
(B) Foil thickness must be 0.0005 0.0001 of the sliding platform adjacent to the hold-
inches (0.013 0.0025 mm). ing frame. This will prevent heat losses dur-
(C) Foil material must be thermocouple ing calibration. The frame must be 1318
grade Constantan. inches (333 mm) deep (front to back) by 8
(D) Temperature measurement must be a inches (203 mm) wide and must rest on the
Copper Constantan thermocouple. top of the sliding platform. It must be fab-
(E) The copper center wire diameter must ricated of 18 inch (3.2 mm) flat stock steel
be 0.0005 inches (0.013 mm). and have an opening that accommodates a 12
(F) The entire face of the calorimeter must inch (12.7 mm) thick piece of refractory
be lightly coated with Black Velvet paint board, which is level with the top of the slid-
having an emissivity of 96 or greater. ing platform. The board must have three 1-
(ii) Calorimeter calibration. inch (25.4 mm) diameter holes drilled
(A) The calibration method must be by through the board for calorimeter insertion.
comparison to a like standardized trans- The distance to the radiant panel surface
ducer. from the centerline of the first hole (zero
(B) The standardized transducer must meet position) must be 712 18 inches (191 3 mm).
the specifications given in paragraph VI(b)(6) The distance between the centerline of the
of this appendix. first hole to the centerline of the second hole
(C) Calibrate the standard transducer must be 2 inches (51 mm). It must also be the
against a primary standard traceable to the same distance from the centerline of the sec-
National Institute of Standards and Tech- ond hole to the centerline of the third hole.
nology (NIST). See figure 7. A calorimeter holding frame
(D) The method of transfer must be a heat- that differs in construction is acceptable as
ed graphite plate. long as the height from the centerline of the

540
ER31JY03.009</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00550 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F
first hole to the radiant panel and the dis-
tance between holes is the same as described
in this paragraph.

(9) Instrumentation. Provide a calibrated re- cover material is over-cut enough to be


cording device with an appropriate range or drawn down the sides without compressing
a computerized data acquisition system to the core material. The fastening means
measure and record the outputs of the calo- should be as continuous as possible along the
rimeter and the thermocouple. The data ac- length of the seams. The specimen thickness
quisition system must be capable of record- must be of the same thickness as installed in
ing the calorimeter output every second dur- the airplane.
ing calibration. (3) Specimen Dimensions. To facilitate prop-
(10) Timing device. Provide a stopwatch or er placement of specimens in the sliding
other device, accurate to 1 second/hour, to
platform housing, cut non-rigid core mate-
measure the time of application of the pilot
rials, such as fiberglass, 1212 inches (318mm)
burner flame.
wide by 23 inches (584mm) long. Cut rigid
(c) Test specimens.
materials, such as foam, 1112 14 inches (292
(1) Specimen preparation. Prepare and test a
mm 6mm) wide by 23 inches (584mm) long in
minimum of three test specimens. If an ori-
order to fit properly in the sliding platform
ented film cover material is used, prepare
and test both the warp and fill directions. housing and provide a flat, exposed surface
(2) Construction. Test specimens must in- equal to the opening in the housing.
clude all materials used in construction of (d) Specimen conditioning. Condition the
the insulation (including batting, film, test specimens at 70 5 F (21 2C) and 55%
scrim, tape etc.). Cut a piece of core material 10% relative humidity, for a minimum of 24
such as foam or fiberglass, and cut a piece of hours prior to testing.
film cover material (if used) large enough to (e) Apparatus Calibration.
cover the core material. Heat sealing is the (1) With the sliding platform out of the
preferred method of preparing fiberglass chamber, install the calorimeter holding
samples, since they can be made without frame. Push the platform back into the
compressing the fiberglass (box sample). chamber and insert the calorimeter into the
Cover materials that are not heat sealable first hole (zero position). See figure 7.
may be stapled, sewn, or taped as long as the

541
ER31JY03.010</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00551 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
Close the bottom door located below the slid- the unit to reach steady state (this may take
ing platform. The distance from the center- up to 1 hour). The pilot burner must be off
line of the calorimeter to the radiant panel and in the down position during this time.
surface at this point must be 7.12 inches 18 (3) After steady-state conditions have been
(191 mm 3). Prior to igniting the radiant reached, move the calorimeter 2 inches (51
panel, ensure that the calorimeter face is mm) from the zero position (first hole) to
clean and that there is water running position 1 and record the heat flux. Move the
through the calorimeter.
calorimeter to position 2 and record the heat
(2) Ignite the panel. Adjust the fuel/air
flux. Allow enough time at each position for
mixture to achieve 1.5 BTUs/ft2-second 5%
the calorimeter to stabilize. Table 1 depicts
(1.7 Watts/cm2 5%) at the zero position. If
using an electric panel, set the power con- typical calibration values at the three posi-
troller to achieve the proper heat flux. Allow tions.

TABLE 1CALIBRATION TABLE


Position BTUs/ft2sec Watts/cm2

Zero Position ...................................................................................................... 1.5 1.7


Position 1 ............................................................................................................... 1.511.501.49 1.711.701.69
Position 2 ............................................................................................................... 1.431.44 1.621.63

(4) Open the bottom door, remove the calo- make a slit in the film cover to purge any air
rimeter and holder fixture. Use caution as inside. This allows the operator to maintain
the fixture is very hot. the proper test specimen position (level with
(f) Test Procedure. the top of the platform) and to allow ventila-
(1) Ignite the pilot burner. Ensure that it is tion of gases during testing. A longitudinal
at least 2 inches (51 mm) above the top of the slit, approximately 2 inches (51mm) in
platform. The burner must not contact the length, must be centered 3 inches 12 inch
specimen until the test begins. (76mm13mm) from the left flange of the se-
(2) Place the test specimen in the sliding curing frame. A utility knife is acceptable
platform holder. Ensure that the test sample for slitting the film cover.
surface is level with the top of the platform. (4) Immediately push the sliding platform
At zero point, the specimen surface must into the chamber and close the bottom door.
be 712 inches 18 inch (191 mm 3) below the (5) Bring the pilot burner flame into con-
radiant panel. tact with the center of the specimen at the
(3) Place the retaining/securing frame over zero point and simultaneously start the
the test specimen. It may be necessary (due timer. The pilot burner must be at a 27
to compression) to adjust the sample (up or angle with the sample and be approximately
down) in order to maintain the distance from 12 inch (12 mm) above the sample. See figure

the sample to the radiant panel (712 inches 7. A stop, as shown in figure 8, allows the op-
18 inch (191 mm3) at zero position). With erator to position the burner correctly each
film/fiberglass assemblies, it is critical to time.

542

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00552 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F

(6) Leave the burner in position for 15 sec- (1) There must be no flame propagation be-
onds and then remove to a position at least yond 2 inches (51 mm) to the left of the cen-
2 inches (51 mm) above the specimen. terline of the pilot flame application.
(g) Report. (2) The flame time after removal of the
(1) Identify and describe the test specimen. pilot burner may not exceed 3 seconds on any
(2) Report any shrinkage or melting of the specimen.
test specimen.
(3) Report the flame propagation distance. Part VIITest Method To Determine the
If this distance is less than 2 inches, report Burnthrough Resistance of Thermal/Acoustic
this as a pass (no measurement required). Insulation Materials
(4) Report the after-flame time. Use the following test method to evaluate
(h) Requirements. the burnthrough resistance characteristics

543
ER31JY03.011</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00553 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
of aircraft thermal/acoustic insulation mate- Insulation blanket specimen means one of
rials when exposed to a high intensity open two specimens positioned in either side of
flame. the test rig, at an angle of 30 with respect to
(a) Definitions. vertical.
Burnthrough time means the time, in sec- Specimen set means two insulation blanket
onds, for the burner flame to penetrate the specimens. Both specimens must represent
test specimen, and/or the time required for the same production insulation blanket con-
the heat flux to reach 2.0 Btu/ft2sec (2.27 W/ struction and materials, proportioned to cor-
cm2) on the inboard side, at a distance of 12 respond to the specimen size.
inches (30.5 cm) from the front surface of the (b) Apparatus.
insulation blanket test frame, whichever is (1) The arrangement of the test apparatus
sooner. The burnthrough time is measured at is shown in figures 1 and 2 and must include
the inboard side of each of the insulation the capability of swinging the burner away
blanket specimens. from the test specimen during warm-up.

544

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00554 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F

(2) Test burner. The test burner must be a eters such as fuel pressure, nozzle depth, sta-
modified gun-type such as the Park Model tor position, and intake airflow must be
DPL 3400. Flame characteristics are highly properly adjusted to achieve the correct
dependent on actual burner setup. Param- flame output.

545
ER31JY03.012</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00555 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(i) Nozzle. A nozzle must maintain the fuel (ii) Fuel Rail. The fuel rail must be ad-
pressure to yield a nominal 6.0 gal/hr (0.378 L/ justed to position the fuel nozzle at a depth
min) fuel flow. A Monarch-manufactured 80 of 0.3125 inch (8 mm) from the end plane of
PL (hollow cone) nozzle nominally rated at the exit stator, which must be mounted in
6.0 gal/hr at 100 lb/in2 (0.71 MPa) delivers a the end of the draft tube.
proper spray pattern. (iii) Internal Stator. The internal stator, lo-
cated in the middle of the draft tube, must

546
ER31JY03.013</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00556 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F
be positioned at a depth of 3.75 inches (95 (vi) Fuel. Use JP8, Jet A, or their inter-
mm) from the tip of the fuel nozzle. The sta- national equivalent, at a flow rate of 6.0 0.2
tor must also be positioned such that the in- gal/hr (0.378 0.0126 L/min). If this fuel is un-
tegral igniters are located at an angle mid- available, ASTM K2 fuel (Number 2 grade
way between the 10 and 11 oclock position, kerosene) or ASTM D2 fuel (Number 2 grade
when viewed looking into the draft tube. fuel oil or Number 2 diesel fuel) are accept-
Minor deviations to the igniter angle are ac- able if the nominal fuel flow rate, tempera-
ceptable if the temperature and heat flux re-
ture, and heat flux measurements conform to
quirements conform to the requirements of
the requirements of paragraph VII(e) of this
paragraph VII(e) of this appendix.
(iv) Blower Fan. The cylindrical blower fan appendix.
used to pump air through the burner must (vii) Fuel pressure regulator. Provide a fuel
measure 5.25 inches (133 mm) in diameter by pressure regulator, adjusted to deliver a
3.5 inches (89 mm) in width. nominal 6.0 gal/hr (0.378 L/min) flow rate. An
(v) Burner cone. Install a 12 +0.125-inch (305 operating fuel pressure of 100 lb/in2 (0.71
3 mm) burner extension cone at the end of MPa) for a nominally rated 6.0 gal/hr 80
the draft tube. The cone must have an open- spray angle nozzle (such as a PL type) deliv-
ing 6 0.125-inch (152 3 mm) high and 11 ers 6.0 0.2 gal/hr (0.378 0.0126 L/min).
0.125-inch (280 3 mm) wide (see figure 3).

547

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00557 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

(3) Calibration rig and equipment. temperature. Position the calibration rigs to
(i) Construct individual calibration rigs to allow movement of the burner from the test
incorporate a calorimeter and thermocouple rig position to either the heat flux or tem-
rake for the measurement of heat flux and perature position with minimal difficulty.

548
ER31JY03.014</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00558 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F
(ii) Calorimeter. The calorimeter must be a 3 mm) by 0.75 0.125 inch (19 mm 3 mm)
total heat flux, foil type Gardon Gage of an thick insulating block which is attached to
appropriate range such as 020 Btu/ft 2-sec (0 the heat flux calibration rig during calibra-
22.7 W/cm 2), accurate to 3% of the indicated tion (figure 4). Monitor the insulating block
reading. The heat flux calibration method for deterioration and replace it when nec-
must be in accordance with paragraph essary. Adjust the mounting as necessary to
VI(b)(7) of this appendix. ensure that the calorimeter face is parallel
(iii) Calorimeter mounting. Mount the calo- to the exit plane of the test burner cone.
rimeter in a 6- by 12- 0.125 inch (152- by 305-

549

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00559 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

550
ER31JY03.015</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00560 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F

(iv) Thermocouples. Provide seven 18-inch Wire Gauge (AWG) size conductor for cali-
(3.2 mm) ceramic packed, metal sheathed, bration. Attach the thermocouples to a steel
type K (Chromel-alumel), grounded junction angle bracket to form a thermocouple rake
thermocouples with a nominal 24 American

551
ER31JY03.016</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00561 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
for placement in the calibration rig during inch (3.2 mm) thick steel as shown in figure
burner calibration (figure 5). 1, except for the center vertical former,
(v) Air velocity meter. Use a vane-type air which should be 14-inch (6.4 mm) thick to
velocity meter to calibrate the velocity of minimize warpage. The specimen mounting
air entering the burner. An Omega Engineer- frame stringers (horizontal) should be bolted
ing Model HH30A is satisfactory. Use a suit- to the test frame formers (vertical) such that
able adapter to attach the measuring device the expansion of the stringers will not cause
to the inlet side of the burner to prevent air
the entire structure to warp. Use the mount-
from entering the burner other than through
ing frame for mounting the two insulation
the measuring device, which would produce
erroneously low readings. Use a flexible duct, blanket test specimens as shown in figure 2.
measuring 4 inches wide (102 mm) by 20 feet (5) Backface calorimeters. Mount two total
long (6.1 meters), to supply fresh air to the heat flux Gardon type calorimeters behind
burner intake to prevent damage to the air the insulation test specimens on the back
velocity meter from ingested soot. An op- side (cold) area of the test specimen mount-
tional airbox permanently mounted to the ing frame as shown in figure 6. Position the
burner intake area can effectively house the calorimeters along the same plane as the
air velocity meter and provide a mounting burner cone centerline, at a distance of 4
port for the flexible intake duct. inches (102 mm) from the vertical centerline
(4) Test specimen mounting frame. Make the of the test frame.
mounting frame for the test specimens of 18-

552

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00562 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F

(i) The calorimeters must be a total heat The heat flux calibration method must com-
flux, foil type Gardon Gage of an appropriate ply with paragraph VI(b)(7) of this appendix.
range such as 05 Btu/ft2-sec (05.7 W/cm2),
accurate to 3% of the indicated reading.

553
ER31JY03.017</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00563 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
(6) Instrumentation. Provide a recording po- (i) Fire barrier material. If the insulation
tentiometer or other suitable calibrated in- blanket is constructed with a fire barrier
strument with an appropriate range to meas- material, place the fire barrier material in a
ure and record the outputs of the calo- manner reflective of the installed arrange-
rimeter and the thermocouples. ment For example, if the material will be
(7) Timing device. Provide a stopwatch or placed on the outboard side of the insulation
other device, accurate to 1%, to measure material, inside the moisture film, place it
the time of application of the burner flame the same way in the test specimen.
and burnthrough time. (ii) Insulation material. Blankets that uti-
(8) Test chamber. Perform tests in a suitable lize more than one variety of insulation
chamber to reduce or eliminate the possi- (composition, density, etc.) must have speci-
bility of test fluctuation due to air move- men sets constructed that reflect the insula-
ment. The chamber must have a minimum tion combination used. If, however, several
floor area of 10 by 10 feet (305 by 305 cm). blanket types use similar insulation com-
(i) Ventilation hood. Provide the test cham- binations, it is not necessary to test each
ber with an exhaust system capable of re- combination if it is possible to bracket the
moving the products of combustion expelled various combinations.
during tests. (iii) Moisture barrier film. If a production
(c) Test Specimens. blanket construction utilizes more than one
(1) Specimen preparation. Prepare a min- type of moisture barrier film, perform sepa-
imum of three specimen sets of the same rate tests on each combination. For example,
construction and configuration for testing. if a polyimide film is used in conjunction
(2) Insulation blanket test specimen. with an insulation in order to enhance the
(i) For batt-type materials such as fiber- burnthrough capabilities, also test the same
glass, the constructed, finished blanket spec- insulation when used with a polyvinyl fluo-
imen assemblies must be 32 inches wide by 36 ride film.
inches long (81.3 by 91.4 cm), exclusive of (iv) Installation on test frame. Attach the
heat sealed film edges. blanket test specimens to the test frame
(ii) For rigid and other non-conforming using 12 steel spring type clamps as shown in
types of insulation materials, the finished figure 7. Use the clamps to hold the blankets
test specimens must fit into the test rig in in place in both of the outer vertical
such a manner as to replicate the actual in- formers, as well as the center vertical former
service installation. (4 clamps per former). The clamp surfaces
(3) Construction. Make each of the speci- should measure 1 inch by 2 inches (25 by 51
mens tested using the principal components mm). Place the top and bottom clamps 6
(i.e., insulation, fire barrier material if used, inches (15.2 cm) from the top and bottom of
and moisture barrier film) and assembly the test frame, respectively. Place the mid-
processes (representative seams and clo- dle clamps 8 inches (20.3 cm) from the top
sures). and bottom clamps.

554

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00564 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F

(Note: For blanket materials that cannot blower. Measure the airflow of the test
be installed in accordance with figure 7 chamber using a vane anemometer or equiv-
above, the blankets must be installed in a alent measuring device. The vertical air ve-
manner approved by the FAA.) locity just behind the top of the upper insu-
(v) Conditioning. Condition the specimens lation blanket test specimen must be 100 50
at 70 5 F (21 2 C) and 55% 10% relative ft/min (0.51 0.25 m/s). The horizontal air ve-
humidity for a minimum of 24 hours prior to locity at this point must be less than 50 ft/
testing. min (0.25 m/s).
(d) Preparation of apparatus. (3) If a calibrated flow meter is not avail-
(1) Level and center the frame assembly to able, measure the fuel flow rate using a grad-
ensure alignment of the calorimeter and/or uated cylinder of appropriate size. Turn on
thermocouple rake with the burner cone. the burner motor/fuel pump, after insuring
(2) Turn on the ventilation hood for the that the igniter system is turned off. Collect
test chamber. Do not turn on the burner the fuel via a plastic or rubber tube into the

555
ER31JY03.018</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00565 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. F 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
graduated cylinder for a 2-minute period. De- rimeter face. Ensure that the horizontal cen-
termine the flow rate in gallons per hour. terline of the burner cone is offset 1 inch
The fuel flow rate must be 6.0 0.2 gallons per below the horizontal centerline of the calo-
hour (0.378 0.0126 L/min). rimeter (figure 8). Without disturbing the
(e) Calibration. calorimeter position, rotate the burner in
(1) Position the burner in front of the calo- front of the thermocouple rake, such that
rimeter so that it is centered and the the middle thermocouple (number 4 of 7) is
vertical plane of the burner cone exit is 4 centered on the burner cone.
0.125 inches (102 3 mm) from the calo-

556
ER31JY03.019</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00566 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. F
Ensure that the horizontal centerline of the average temperature of each thermo-
the burner cone is also offset 1 inch below couple over this 30-second period and record.
the horizontal centerline of the thermo- The average temperature of each of the 7
couple tips. Re-check measurements by ro- thermocouples should be 1900F 100F (1038
tating the burner to each position to ensure 56 C).
proper alignment between the cone and the (6) If either the heat flux or the tempera-
calorimeter and thermocouple rake. (Note: tures are not within the specified range, ad-
The test burner mounting system must in- just the burner intake air velocity and re-
corporate detents that ensure proper cen- peat the procedures of paragraphs (4) and (5)
tering of the burner cone with respect to above to obtain the proper values. Ensure
both the calorimeter and the thermocouple
that the inlet air velocity is within the
rakes, so that rapid positioning of the burner
range of 2150 ft/min 50 ft/min (10.92 0.25 m/
can be achieved during the calibration proce-
s).
dure.)
(2) Position the air velocity meter in the (7) Calibrate prior to each test until con-
adapter or airbox, making certain that no sistency has been demonstrated. After con-
gaps exist where air could leak around the sistency has been confirmed, several tests
air velocity measuring device. Turn on the may be conducted with calibration con-
blower/motor while ensuring that the fuel so- ducted before and after a series of tests.
lenoid and igniters are off. Adjust the air in- (f) Test procedure.
take velocity to a level of 2150 ft/min, (10.92 (1) Secure the two insulation blanket test
m/s) then turn off the blower/motor. (Note: specimens to the test frame. The insulation
The Omega HH30 air velocity meter meas- blankets should be attached to the test rig
ures 2.625 inches in diameter. To calculate center vertical former using four spring
the intake airflow, multiply the cross-sec- clamps positioned as shown in figure 7 (ac-
tional area (0.03758 ft2) by the air velocity cording to the criteria of paragraph (c)(4) or
(2150 ft/min) to obtain 80.80 ft3/min. An air (c)(4)(i) of this part of this appendix).
velocity meter other than the HH30 unit can (2) Ensure that the vertical plane of the
be used, provided the calculated airflow of burner cone is at a distance of 4 0.125 inch
80.80 ft3/min (2.29 m3/min) is equivalent.) (102 3 mm) from the outer surface of the
(3) Rotate the burner from the test posi- horizontal stringers of the test specimen
tion to the warm-up position. Prior to light- frame, and that the burner and test frame
ing the burner, ensure that the calorimeter are both situated at a 30 angle with respect
face is clean of soot deposits, and there is
to vertical.
water running through the calorimeter. Ex-
amine and clean the burner cone of any evi- (3) When ready to begin the test, direct the
dence of buildup of products of combustion, burner away from the test position to the
soot, etc. Soot buildup inside the burner warm-up position so that the flame will not
cone may affect the flame characteristics impinge on the specimens prematurely. Turn
and cause calibration difficulties. Since the on and light the burner and allow it to sta-
burner cone may distort with time, dimen- bilize for 2 minutes.
sions should be checked periodically. (4) To begin the test, rotate the burner into
(4) While the burner is still rotated to the the test position and simultaneously start
warm-up position, turn on the blower/motor, the timing device.
igniters and fuel flow, and light the burner. (5) Expose the test specimens to the burner
Allow it to warm up for a period of 2 min- flame for 4 minutes and then turn off the
utes. Move the burner into the calibration burner. Immediately rotate the burner out of
position and allow 1 minute for calorimeter the test position.
stabilization, then record the heat flux once (6) Determine (where applicable) the
every second for a period of 30 seconds. Turn burnthrough time, or the point at which the
off burner, rotate out of position, and allow heat flux exceeds 2.0 Btu/ft2-sec (2.27 W/cm2).
to cool. Calculate the average heat flux over (g) Report.
this 30-second duration. The average heat (1) Identify and describe the specimen
flux should be 16.0 0.8 Btu/ft2 sec (18.2 0.9 W/ being tested.
cm 2).
(2) Report the number of insulation blan-
(5) Position the burner in front of the ther-
ket specimens tested.
mocouple rake. After checking for proper
alignment, rotate the burner to the warm-up (3) Report the burnthrough time (if any),
position, turn on the blower/motor, igniters and the maximum heat flux on the back face
and fuel flow, and light the burner. Allow it of the insulation blanket test specimen, and
to warm up for a period of 2 minutes. Move the time at which the maximum occurred.
the burner into the calibration position and (h) Requirements.
allow 1 minute for thermocouple stabiliza- (1) Each of the two insulation blanket test
tion, then record the temperature of each of specimens must not allow fire or flame pene-
the 7 thermocouples once every second for a tration in less than 4 minutes.
period of 30 seconds. Turn off burner, rotate (2) Each of the two insulation blanket test
out of position, and allow to cool. Calculate specimens must not allow more than 2.0 Btu/

557

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00567 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. G 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
ft2-sec (2.27 W/cm2) on the cold side of the in- similar design with extensive satisfactory
sulation specimens at a point 12 inches (30.5 service experience, it will be acceptable to
cm) from the face of the test rig. select U at Vc less than 85 fps, but not less
than 75 fps, with linear decrease from that
[Amdt. 2532, 37 FR 3972, Feb. 24, 1972]
value at 20,000 feet to 30 fps at 80,000 feet.
EDITORIAL NOTE: For FEDERAL REGISTER ci- The following factors will be taken into ac-
tations affecting Appendix F to Part 25, see count when assessing comparability to a
the List of CFR Sections Affected, which ap- similar design:
pears in the Finding Aids section of the (1) The transfer function of the new design
printed volume and on GPO Access. should exhibit no unusual characteristics as
compared to the similar design which will
APPENDIX G TO PART 25CONTINUOUS significantly affect response to turbulence;
GUST DESIGN CRITERIA e.g., coalescence of modal response in the
frequency regime which can result in a sig-
The continuous gust design criteria in this nificant increase of loads.
appendix must be used in establishing the (2) The typical mission of the new airplane
dynamic response of the airplane to vertical is substantially equivalent to that of the
and lateral continuous turbulence unless a similar design.
more rational criteria is used. The following (3) The similar design should demonstrate
gust load requirements apply to mission the adequacy of the U selected.
analysis and design envelope analysis: (ii) At speed VB: U is equal to 1.32 times
(a) The limit gust loads utilizing the con- the values obtained under paragraph (b)(3)(i)
tinuous turbulence concept must be deter- of this appendix.
mined in accordance with the provisions of (iii) At speed VD: U is equal to 12 the val-
either paragraph (b) or paragraphs (c) and (d) ues obtained under paragraph (b)(3)(i) of this
of this appendix. appendix.
(b) Design envelope analysis. The limit loads (iv) At speeds between VB and Vc and be-
must be determined in accordance with the tween Vc and VD: U is equal to a value ob-
following: tained by linear interpolation.
(1) All critical altitudes, weights, and (4) When a stability augmentation system
weight distributions, as specified in is included in the analysis, the effect of sys-
25.321(b), and all critical speeds within the tem nonlinearities on loads at the limit load
ranges indicated in paragraph (b)(3) of this level must be realistically or conservatively
appendix must be considered. accounted for.
(2) Values of A (ratio of root-mean-square
(c) Mission analysis. Limit loads must be
incremental load root-mean-square gust ve- determined in accordance with the following:
locity) must be determined by dynamic anal- (1) The expected utilization of the airplane
ysis. The power spectral density of the at- must be represented by one or more flight
mospheric turbulence must be as given by profiles in which the load distribution and
the equation the variation with time of speed, altitude,
gross weight, and center of gravity position
8
1+ (1.339 L )2 are defined. These profiles must be divided
into mission segments or blocks, for anal-
() = L /
2 3
[1 + (1.339 L) ]
ysis, and average or effective values of the
2 11
6 pertinent parameters defined for each seg-
ment.
where: (2) For each of the mission segments de-
fined under paragraph (c)(1) of this appendix,
j=power-spectral density (ft./sec.) 2/rad./ft. and No must be determined by
values of A
s=root-mean-square gust velocity, ft./sec. is defined as the ratio of root-
analysis. A
W=reduced frequency, radians per foot.
mean-square incremental load to root-mean-
L=2,500 ft.
square gust velocity and No is the radius of
(3) The limit loads must be obtained by gyration of the load power spectral density
multiplying the A values determined by the function about zero frequency. The power
dynamic analysis by the following values of spectral density of the atmospheric turbu-
the gust velocity U: lence must be given by the equation set forth
(i) At speed Vc: U=85 fps true gust velocity in paragraph (b)(2) of this appendix.
in the interval 0 to 30,000 ft. altitude and is (3) For each of the load and stress quan-
linearly decreased to 30 fps true gust veloc- tities selected, the frequency of exceedance
ity at 80,000 ft. altitude. Where the Adminis- must be determined as a function of load
trator finds that a design is comparable to a level by means of the equation

558
EC28SE91.078</MATH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00568 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. G

y y one g y y one g
N ( ) = t N o P1 exp + P2 exp
b1 A b2 A

where ation must be given to the fraction of flight


t=selected time interval. time that the system may be inoperative.
y=net value of the load or stress. The flight profiles of paragraph (c)(1) of this
Yone=g=value of the load or stress in one-g appendix must include flight with the sys-
level flight. tem inoperative for this fraction of the flight
N(y)=average number of exceedances of the time. When a stability augmentation system
indicated value of the load or stress in unit is included in the analysis, the effect of sys-
time. tem nonlinearities on loads at the limit load
=symbol denoting summation over all mis- level must be conservatively accounted for.
sion segments. (d) Supplementary design envelope analysis.
No, A =parameters determined by dynamic In addition to the limit loads defined by
analysis as defined in paragraph (c)(2) of paragraph (c) of this appendix, limit loads
this appendix. must also be determined in accordance with
P1, P2, b1, b2=parameters defining the prob- paragraph (b) of this appendix, except that
ability distributions of root-mean-square (1) In paragraph (b)(3)(i) of this appendix,
gust velocity, to be read from Figures 1 the value of U=85 fps true gust velocity is
and 2 of this appendix. replaced by U=60 fps true gust velocity on
The limit gust loads must be read from the the interval 0 to 30,000 ft. altitude, and is lin-
frequency of exceedance curves at a fre- early decreased to 25 fps true gust velocity
quency of exceedance of 2105 exceedances at 80,000 ft. altitude; and
per hour. Both positive and negative load di- (2) In paragraph (b) of this appendix, the
rections must be considered in determining reference to paragraphs (b)(3)(i) through
the limit loads. (b)(3)(iii) of this appendix is to be understood
(4) If a stability augmentation system is as referring to the paragraph as modified by
utilized to reduce the gust loads, consider- paragraph (d)(1).

559
EC28SE91.079</MATH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00569 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. G 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)

560
EC28SE91.080</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00570 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8006 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. H

[Amdt. 2554, 45 FR 60173, Sept. 11, 1980]

APPENDIX H TO PART 25INSTRUCTIONS designated products), for each appliance


FOR CONTINUED AIRWORTHINESS required by this chapter, and any required
information relating to the interface of
H25.1 General. those appliances and products with the air-
(a) This appendix specifies requirements plane. If Instructions for Continued Air-
for the preparation of Instructions for Con- worthiness are not supplied by the manufac-
tinued Airworthiness as required by 25.1529. turer of an appliance or product installed in
(b) The Instructions for Continued Air- the airplane, the Instructions for Continued
worthiness for each airplane must include Airworthiness for the airplane must include
the Instructions for Continued Airworthiness the information essential to the continued
for each engine and propeller (hereinafter airworthiness of the airplane.

561
EC28SE91.081</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00571 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. I 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
(c) The applicant must submit to the FAA (2) Troubleshooting information describing
a program to show how changes to the In- probable malfunctions, how to recognize
structions for Continued Airworthiness made those malfunctions, and the remedial action
by the applicant or by the manufacturers or for those malfunctions.
products and appliances installed in the air- (3) Information describing the order and
plane will be distributed. method of removing and replacing products
H25.2 Format. and parts with any necessary precautions to
be taken.
(a) The Instructions for Continued Air- (4) Other general procedural instructions
worthiness must be in the form of a manual including procedures for system testing dur-
or manuals as appropriate for the quantity ing ground running, symmetry checks,
of data to be provided. weighing and determining the center of grav-
(b) The format of the manual or manuals ity, lifting and shoring, and storage limita-
must provide for a practical arrangement. tions.
H25.3 Content. (c) Diagrams of structural access plates
The contents of the manual or manuals and information needed to gain access for in-
must be prepared in the English language. spections when access plates are not pro-
The Instructions for Continued Airworthi- vided.
ness must contain the following manuals or (d) Details for the application of special in-
sections, as appropriate, and information: spection techniques including radiographic
(a) Airplane maintenance manual or section. and ultrasonic testing where such processes
(1) Introduction information that includes an are specified.
(e) Information needed to apply protective
explanation of the airplanes features and
treatments to the structure after inspection.
data to the extent necessary for mainte-
(f) All data relative to structural fasteners
nance or preventive maintenance.
such as identification, discard recommenda-
(2) A description of the airplane and its tions, and torque values.
systems and installations including its en- (g) A list of special tools needed.
gines, propellers, and appliances.
H25.4 Airworthiness Limitations section.
(3) Basic control and operation information
describing how the airplane components and (a) The Instructions for Continued Air-
systems are controlled and how they oper- worthiness must contain a section titled Air-
ate, including any special procedures and worthiness Limitations that is segregated
limitations that apply. and clearly distinguishable from the rest of
(4) Servicing information that covers de- the document. This section must set forth
tails regarding servicing points, capacities of (1) Each mandatory replacement time,
tanks, reservoirs, types of fluids to be used, structural inspection interval, and related
pressures applicable to the various systems, structural inspection procedures approved
location of access panels for inspection and under 25.571; and
servicing, locations of lubrication points, lu- (2) Each mandatory replacement time, in-
bricants to be used, equipment required for spection interval, related inspection proce-
dure, and all critical design configuration
servicing, tow instructions and limitations,
control limitations approved under 25.981
mooring, jacking, and leveling information.
for the fuel tank system.
(b) Maintenance instructions. (1) Scheduling
(b) If the Instructions for Continued Air-
information for each part of the airplane and worthiness consist of multiple documents,
its engines, auxiliary power units, propellers, the section required by this paragraph must
accessories, instruments, and equipment be included in the principal manual. This
that provides the recommended periods at section must contain a legible statement in
which they should be cleaned, inspected, ad- a prominent location that reads: The Air-
justed, tested, and lubricated, and the degree worthiness Limitations section is FAA-ap-
of inspection, the applicable wear tolerances, proved and specifies maintenance required
and work recommended at these periods. under 43.16 and 91.403 of the Federal Avia-
However, the applicant may refer to an ac- tion Regulations, unless an alternative pro-
cessory, instrument, or equipment manufac- gram has been FAA approved.
turer as the source of this information if the
applicant shows that the item has an excep- [Amdt. 2554, 45 FR 60177, Sept. 11, 1980, as
tionally high degree of complexity requiring amended by Amdt. 2568, 54 FR 34329, Aug. 18,
specialized maintenance techniques, test 1989; Amdt. 25102, 66 FR 23130, May 7, 2001]
equipment, or expertise. The recommended
overhaul periods and necessary cross ref- APPENDIX I TO PART 25INSTALLATION
erences to the Airworthiness Limitations OF AN AUTOMATIC TAKEOFF THRUST
section of the manual must also be included. CONTROL SYSTEM (ATTCS)
In addition, the applicant must include an
inspection program that includes the fre- I25.1 General.
quency and extent of the inspections nec- (a) This appendix specifies additional re-
essary to provide for the continued air- quirements for installation of an engine
worthiness of the airplane. power control system that automatically

562

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00572 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 25, App. I
resets thrust or power on operating engine(s) actuate fuel controls or power levers or in-
in the event of any one engine failure during crease engine power by other means on oper-
takeoff. ating engines to achieve scheduled thrust or
(b) With the ATTCS and associated sys- power increases, and furnish cockpit infor-
tems functioning normally as designed, all mation on system operation.
applicable requirements of Part 25, except as (b) Critical Time Interval. When conducting
provided in this appendix, must be met with- an ATTCS takeoff, the critical time interval
out requiring any action by the crew to in- is between V1 minus 1 second and a point on
crease thrust or power. the minimum performance, all-engine flight
path where, assuming a simultaneous occur-
I25.2 Definitions. rence of an engine and ATTCS failure, the
(a) Automatic Takeoff Thrust Control System resulting minimum flight path thereafter
(ATTCS). An ATTCS is defined as the entire intersects the Part 25 required actual flight
automatic system used on takeoff, including path at no less than 400 feet above the take-
all devices, both mechanical and electrical, off surface. This time interval is shown in
that sense engine failure, transmit signals, the following illustration:

I25.3 Performance and System Reliability Re- The applicant must comply with the per-
quirements. formance and ATTCS reliability require-
ments as follows:

563
EC28SE91.082</GPH>

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00573 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Pt. 25, App. J 14 CFR Ch. I (1106 Edition)
(a) An ATTCS failure or a combination of (3) Provide a means to verify to the
failures in the ATTCS during the critical flightcrew before takeoff that the ATTCS is
time interval: in a condition to operate; and
(1) Shall not prevent the insertion of the (4) Provide a means for the flightcrew to
maximum approved takeoff thrust or power, or deactivate the automatic function. This
must be shown to be an improbable event. means must be designed to prevent inad-
(2) Shall not result in a significant loss or vertent deactivation.
reduction in thrust or power, or must be
I25.6 Powerplant Instruments.
shown to be an extremely improbable event.
(b) The concurrent existence of an ATTCS In addition to the requirements of 25.1305:
failure and an engine failure during the crit- (a) A means must be provided to indicate
ical time interval must be shown to be ex- when the ATTCS is in the armed or ready
tremely improbable. condition; and
(c) All applicable performance require- (b) If the inherent flight characteristics of
ments of Part 25 must be met with an engine the airplane do not provide adequate warn-
failure occurring at the most critical point ing that an engine has failed, a warning sys-
during takeoff with the ATTCS system func- tem that is independent of the ATTCS must
tioning. be provided to give the pilot a clear warning
I25.4 Thrust Setting. of any engine failure during takeoff.
The initial takeoff thrust or power setting [Amdt. 2562, 52 FR 43156, Nov. 9, 1987]
on each engine at the beginning of the take-
off roll may not be less than any of the fol- APPENDIX J TO PART 25EMERGENCY
lowing: EVACUATION
(a) Ninety (90) percent of the thrust or
power set by the ATTCS (the maximum The following test criteria and procedures
takeoff thrust or power approved for the air- must be used for showing compliance with
plane under existing ambient conditions); 25.803:
(b) That required to permit normal oper- (a) The emergency evacuation must be con-
ation of all safety-related systems and equip- ducted with exterior ambient light levels of
ment dependent upon engine thrust or power no greater than 0.3 foot-candles prior to the
lever position; or activation of the airplane emergency light-
(c) That shown to be free of hazardous en- ing system. The source(s) of the initial exte-
gine response characteristics when thrust or rior ambient light level may remain active
power is advanced from the initial takeoff or illuminated during the actual demonstra-
thrust or power to the maximum approved tion. There must, however, be no increase in
takeoff thrust or power. the exterior ambient light level except for
I25.5 Powerplant Controls. that due to activation of the airplane emer-
(a) In addition to the requirements of gency lighting system.
25.1141, no single failure or malfunction, or (b) The airplane must be in a normal atti-
probable combination thereof, of the ATTCS, tude with landing gear extended.
including associated systems, may cause the (c) Unless the airplane is equipped with an
failure of any powerplant function necessary off-wing descent means, stands or ramps may
for safety. be used for descent from the wing to the
(b) The ATTCS must be designed to: ground. Safety equipment such as mats or
(1) Apply thrust or power on the operating inverted life rafts may be placed on the floor
engine(s), following any one engine failure or ground to protect participants. No other
during takeoff, to achieve the maximum ap- equipment that is not part of the emergency
proved takeoff thrust or power without ex- evacuation equipment of the airplane may be
ceeding engine operating limits; used to aid the participants in reaching the
(2) Permit manual decrease or increase in ground.
thrust or power up to the maximum takeoff (d) Except as provided in paragraph (a) of
thrust or power approved for the airplane this appendix, only the airplanes emergency
under existing conditions through the use of lighting system may provide illumination.
the power lever. For airplanes equipped with (e) All emergency equipment required for
limiters that automatically prevent engine the planned operation of the airplane must
operating limits from being exceeded under be installed.
existing ambient conditions, other means (f) Each internal door or curtain must be
may be used to increase the thrust or power in the takeoff configuration.
in the event of an ATTCS failure provided (g) Each crewmember must be seated in
the means is located on or forward of the the normally assigned seat for takeoff and
power levers; is easily identified and oper- must remain in the seat until receiving the
ated under all operating conditions by a sin- signal for commencement of the demonstra-
gle action of either pilot with the hand that tion. Each crewmember must be a person
is normally used to actuate the power levers; having knowledge of the operation of exits
and meets the requirements of 25.777 (a), and emergency equipment and, if compliance
(b), and (c); with 121.291 is also being demonstrated,

564

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00574 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8002 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
Federal Aviation Administration, DOT Pt. 27
each flight attendant must be a member of a disclosed to the occupants. If this method is
regularly scheduled line crew. used, the exit preparation time for each exit
(h) A representative passenger load of per- utilized must be accounted for, and exits
sons in normal health must be used as fol- that are not to be used in the demonstration
lows: must not be indicated before the demonstra-
(1) At least 40 percent of the passenger load tion has started. The exits to be used must
must be female. be representative of all of the emergency
(2) At least 35 percent of the passenger load exits on the airplane and must be designated
must be over 50 years of age. by the applicant, subject to approval by the
(3) At least 15 percent of the passenger load Administrator. At least one floor level exit
must be female and over 50 years of age. must be used.
(4) Three life-size dolls, not included as (q) Except as provided in paragraph (c) of
part of the total passenger load, must be car- this section, all evacuees must leave the air-
ried by passengers to simulate live infants 2 plane by a means provided as part of the air-
years old or younger. planes equipment.
(5) Crewmembers, mechanics, and training (r) The applicants approved procedures
personnel, who maintain or operate the air- must be fully utilized, except the flightcrew
plane in the normal course of their duties, must take no active role in assisting others
may not be used as passengers. inside the cabin during the demonstration.
(i) No passenger may be assigned a specific (s) The evacuation time period is com-
seat except as the Administrator may re- pleted when the last occupant has evacuated
quire. Except as required by subparagraph the airplane and is on the ground. Provided
(g) of this paragraph, no employee of the ap- that the acceptance rate of the stand or
plicant may be seated next to an emergency ramp is no greater than the acceptance rate
exit. of the means available on the airplane for de-
(j) Seat belts and shoulder harnesses (as re- scent from the wing during an actual crash
quired) must be fastened. situation, evacuees using stands or ramps al-
(k) Before the start of the demonstration, lowed by paragraph (c) of this appendix are
approximately one-half of the total average considered to be on the ground when they are
amount of carry-on baggage, blankets, pil- on the stand or ramp.
lows, and other similar articles must be dis-
tributed at several locations in aisles and [Amdt. 2572, 55 FR 29788, July 20, 1990, as
emergency exit access ways to create minor amended by Amdt. 2579, Aug. 26, 1993; Amdt.
obstructions. 25117, 69 FR 67499, Nov. 17, 2004]
(l) No prior indication may be given to any
crewmember or passenger of the particular PART 27AIRWORTHINESS STAND-
exits to be used in the demonstration.
(m) The applicant may not practice, re- ARDS: NORMAL CATEGORY
hearse, or describe the demonstration for the ROTORCRAFT
participants nor may any participant have
taken part in this type of demonstration Subpart AGeneral
within the preceding 6 months.
(n) Prior to entering the demonstration Sec.
aircraft, the passengers may also be advised 27.1 Applicability.
to follow directions of crewmembers but may 27.2 Special retroactive requirements.
not be instructed on the procedures to be fol-
lowed in the demonstration, except with re- Subpart BFlight
spect to safety procedures in place for the
GENERAL
demonstration or which have to do with the
demonstration site. Prior to the start of the 27.21 Proof of compliance.
demonstration, the pre-takeoff passenger 27.25 Weight limits.
briefing required by 121.571 may be given. 27.27 Center of gravity limits.
Flight attendants may assign demonstration 27.29 Empty weight and corresponding cen-
subjects to assist persons from the bottom of ter of gravity.
a slide, consistent with their approved train- 27.31 Removable ballast.
ing program. 27.33 Main rotor speed and pitch limits.
(o) The airplane must be configured to pre-
vent disclosure of the active emergency exits PERFORMANCE
to demonstration participants in the air- 27.45 General.
plane until the start of the demonstration. 27.51 Takeoff.
(p) Exits used in the demonstration must 27.65 Climb: all engines operating.
consist of one exit from each exit pair. The 27.67 Climb: one engine inoperative.
demonstration may be conducted with the 27.71 Glide performance.
escape slides, if provided, inflated and the 27.73 Performance at minimum operating
exits open at the beginning of the dem- speed.
onstration. In this case, all exits must be 27.75 Landing.
configured such that the active exits are not 27.79 Limiting heightspeed envelope.

565

VerDate Aug<31>2005 13:49 Jan 25, 2006 Jkt 208043 PO 00000 Frm 00575 Fmt 8010 Sfmt 8010 Y:\SGML\208043.XXX 208043
14 CFR Ch. I (1-1-06 Edition)

Title 14--Aeronautics and Space

(This index contains parts 1 to 59)

CHAPTER I--FEDERAL AVIATION ADMINISTRATION, DEPARTMENT OF


TRANSPORTATION

Part
1 Definitions and abbreviations
3 General requirements
11 General rulemaking procedures
13 Investigative and enforcement procedures
14 Rules implementing the Equal Access to Justice Act of 1980
15 Administrative claims under Federal Tort Claims Act
16 Rules of practice for Federally-assisted airport enforcement poceedings.
17 Procedures for protests and contracts disputes
21 Certification procedures for products and parts
23 Airworthiness standards: Normal, utility, acrobatic, and commuter category airplanes
25 Airworthiness standards: Transport category airplanes
27 Airworthiness standards: Normal category rotorcraft
29 Airworthiness standards: Transport category rotorcraft
31 Airworthiness standards: Manned free balloons
33 Airworthiness standards: Aircraft engines
34 Fuel venting and exhaust emission requirements for turbine engine powered airplanes
35 Airworthiness standards: Propellers
36 Noise standards: Aircraft type and airworthiness certification
39 Airworthiness directives
43 Maintenance, preventive maintenance, rebuilding, and alteration
45 Identification and registration marking
47 Aircraft registration
49 Recording of aircraft titles and security documents
50-59 [Reserved]

http://www.access.gpo.gov/nara/cfr/waisidx_06/14cfrv1_06.html (1 of 2) [06/10/06 06:36:51 p.m.]

You might also like